Punjab Police Rules III

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 279

Preventive and Detective Organization 553

PUNJAB POLICE RULES

VOLUME 3

CHAPTER 21
Preventive and Detective Organization
Rule 21.1

21.1. Principles of the Criminal Law and Police Organization. - The Criminal law
of India and the Police organization, which is based upon it, are both founded on the prin-
ciple that public order depends essentially upon the responsibility of every member of the
community within the law to prevent offences and to arrest offenders. The magisterial
and police organization is set up to enforce, control and assist this general responsibility.
This fundamental principle must be thoroughly understood and borne constantly in
mind by police officers of all ranks, but more especially by gazetted officers and upper
subordinates.
Instructions as to the general relations between police officers and Magistrates are con-
tained in Chapter I of these Rules and some further detailed instructions are placed in this
chapter. The ideal to be aimed at in respect of relations with the public is that every police
officer, of whatever rank, should be regarded by every law-abiding person as a wise
and impartial friend and a protector against injury to his person and property. In propor-
tion as this ideal is approached, the police will receive the information and assistance
which they need, in order to combat crime successfully. When confidence and co-opera-
tion are lacking, private persons and village officials resort to connivance at crime and to
seeking redress for their own losses through treaty with criminals; the police are isolated
in their efforts to prevent and detect offences, and can hope for but a small measure of
success.
The proper relations between the police and the public in a district depend primarily
upon the personal attitude of the Superintendent, and the example set by him and en-
forced upon his subordinates. The most important duties of a Superintendent are to know
the people of his district and to know what his subordinates are doing. Such knowledge
can only be gained by the fullest personal accessibility, activity in touring, thorough and
intelligent supervision and a sympathetic interest in the life of the district and the facts
and difficulties of the work of his own men. He must inspire confidence in his subordi-
nates, as well as in the public. While alert to check tyranny, dishonesty and other abuses
by his subordinates, he must be as accessible to them as to non-officials, and ready at all
times to help them in their difficulties and support them against the evil influences, which
they have to face. This should be the attitude of all supervising officers. They should en-
sure direct access to themselves unimpeded by their subordinates, and must be ready to
give a patient hearing to all complaints and grievances, but must avoid creating any im-
pression of spying which would destroy the confidence and undermine the authority of
their officers.
Rule 21.2

21.2. Ilaqa Magistrate Relations with. - The relations between the Ilaqa Magis-
trate and the police officers with whom he has to deal should be both cordial and intimate,
and every opportunity shall be taken to keep him informed of the state of crime in his
ilaqa. Conferences between magistrates and police officers, at which difficulties on
either side can be discussed and remedies devised, should be encouraged; police officers
554 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

coming in with chalans should take the opportunity of obtaining an interview with the
Ilaqa magistrate and discussing with him the state of crime in their jurisdictions; and
prosecuting officers, who form a valuable link between the investigating officer and the
magistracy, should be instructed to pass on to magistrates any information of interest or
importance regarding criminal matters on which they may be aware. When a magistrate
visits the local area of a police station, the sub-inspector should make an effort to attend
at his camp and should offer his assistance as well as discuss with him all matters con-
cerning crime. It is, however, not intended that, in such cases, the Sub- Inspector should
leave important duties in order to remain in attendance throughout the tour.
Rule 21.3

21.3. Zaildars, Inamdars, Headmen and village watchmen. - (1) The conditions of
appointment and removal, and the duties and remuneration of zaildars, inamdars, and
headmen are set forth in the Land Revenue Rules (see Land Revenue Rule 9) with which
gazetted and upper subordinate police officers should be familiar. While these village of-
ficials have many duties besides those connected with the suppression of crime, capacity
to assist the criminal administration is one of the factors considered in making appoint-
ments, and failure in this duty is a ground for removal from office or forfeiture of
emoluments. In the case of headmen, definite duties in respect of reporting and preventing
offences are prescribed by the Criminal Procedure Code, and the Land Revenue Rules
(see Land Revenue Rules 16 and 20) require them to attend the summons of all officers
having jurisdiction in the estate in which they are appointed; to assist all Government of-
ficials in the execution of their public duties; to supply information; to assist, if so ordered
by the Collector, in the provision on payment of supplies or transport to Government of-
ficers on duty, and generally to represent the people of their estates in their relations with
Government. Zaildars and inamdars are required by the Land Revenue Rules to report to
the police heinous crime and the presence in the zail of bad characters; to assist in pre-
vention, investigations and arrests; see to that headmen perform their duties properly; to
notify all orders of Government in their zails and to obey all such orders as require their
personal obedience to exert their influence to secure within their zails prompt obedience
to all orders of Government; to abstain from interference in litigation, except under or-
ders of Government; to assist all Government officers in the execution of their duties, to
supply them with information and to attend them when they visit their zails.
(2) It is the duty of gazetted police officers and inspectors to take particular note of the
work of zaildars, inamdars and headmen. These officials should be encouraged in the
performance of their duties and suitably rewarded when they do well; serious or persistent
neglect of duty should be brought to the notice of the Superintendent, and by him to that
of the District Magistrate. In the periodical inspections of police stations mention shall al-
ways be made of the degree of assistance received by the police from the zaildars and
other village officials of the jurisdiction, and of particularly meritorious work or notewor-
thy dereliction of duty on the part of individuals.
(3) Gazetted officers should, from time to time, record remarks in the books kept for
the purpose by zaildars and inamdars regarding the extent to which such officials fulfil
the purpose of their appointment in so far as the police are concerned. Notes may also ap-
propriately be made by gazetted officers in the police station minute book (Register No.
13) and in Part IV of Village Crime Books regarding particular zaildars, inamdars and
headmen.
(4) The village watchman, or chaukidar, is a village servant whose chief duty is the
watch and ward of the village. He is required to carry reports for the headman, to assist
him in tracing offenders and to make arrests as authorized by law. He is responsible to
the District Magistrate for the due performance of his duties.
Chaukidars are also the agency for the reporting of births and deaths occurring in the
rural tracts. For the purpose of recording vital statistics they attend at the police station
within the jurisdiction of which their villages are situated at certain appointed times, and
Preventive and Detective Organization 555

these occasions are made use of to disseminate items of news and orders connected with
the preventive and detective duties of the village officers.
The rules regarding the appointment, dismissal, powers, duties and responsibilities of
watchmen are framed by Government under Section 39-A of the Punjab Laws Act of
1872.
Rule 21.4

21.4 Duties of Police under local and special laws. - Many of the most important and
most frequently exercised functions of the police derive from local and special laws. In
some case powers so derived have been specially referred to in different chapters of
these rules, but, irrespective of such references, a knowledge of the provisions of all local
and special laws, more or less comprehensive according to the duties of his rank, is re-
quired to every trained police officer.
The constitution of the Police Force itself rests on a special law, the Police Act (V of
1861). The administration of the Excise Act, in co-operation with officials of the Excise
Department, is one of the most important of the duties of the police. Under this Act, all
police officers of and above the rank of head constable are invested with the powers of ex-
cise officers Ist class, and all constables with those of excise officers, 3rd class. The
control of crime, especially in rural areas, depends largely upon the Punjab Laws Act, the
Registration of Habitual Offenders Act and the Criminal Tribes Act. The Arms Act con-
tains cognizable offences of first class importance, and imposes on the police important
duties in connection with the inspection of licences. The Cantonment and Municipal Act
impose very extensive and varied duties upon police officers serving in areas to which
they apply in relation to the enforcement of bye-laws of all sorts. The powers and duties
of the police in relation to fires also emanate from the Municipal Act. The same Act, to-
gether with the Hackney Carriage Act, Indian Motor Vehicles Act, Prevention of Cruelty
to Animals Act and certain sections of the Indian Penal Code give to the police all their
powers in relation to the control of traffic. The Indian Extradition Act governs the deal-
ings of the police in respect of criminals with Indian States. Many other Acts give powers
or impose duties in respect of arrests, custody, search and inspection in relation to par-
ticular classes of offence.
Rule 21.5

21.5. Absconders and Harbourers. - (1) A vital factor in both the detection and pre-
vention of crime is the execution of the law in respect of absconding and harbouring. The
provisions of the law are adequate to prevent both these offences but their proper and
comprehensive administration demands the constant attention of Magistrates and super-
vising police officers. The absence or prevalence of absconding and harbouring are
among the acid tests of the efficiency of the criminal administration. Instructions as to the
taking out and execution of warrants when persons, whose arrest is required, are not im-
mediately found, are contained in rule 26.5. This is the first essential. Under Section 87,
Code of Criminal Procedure, any Court may at any time issue a proclamation against a
person for whose arrest that court has issued a warrant. All that is necessary is that the
court should be satisfied, not necessarily by evidence, that the said person ‘‘has ab-
sconded or is concealing himself so that such warrant cannot be executed’’. The court
may further at any time after proclamation ‘‘order the attachment of any property, move-
able or immovable, or both, belonging to the proclaimed person’’. The period of thirty
days mentioned in Section 87, Code of Criminal Procedure, is that within which the ab-
sconder is called upon to surrender, it imposes no delay on the issue of attachment orders.
The issue of a proclamation under Section 87, Code of Criminal Procedure, renders liable
to the penalties of Section 216, Indian Penal Code, any one who gives to the person pro-
claimed any assistance of the nature described in Section 52-A, Indian Penal Code.
(2) The action prescribed in rule 26.5 for obtaining a warrant of arrest shall be taken
by the police immediately they have grounds for making such arrest. Every reasonable
efforts to execute such warrant shall then be taken. If such efforts fail, the court which
556 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

issued the warrant must be satisfied that the warrant cannot be executed; evidence of the
guilt of the wanted man in the offence under investigation is not required. When a proc-
lamation order has been obtained, the police are bound to publish that order as required
by Section 87(2), Code of Criminal Procedure. Immediately this has been done the re-
quirements of Section 87(3), Code of Criminal Procedure, shall be complied with.
Thereupon, the person wanted becomes a ‘‘proclaimed offender’’ and the rules in Chap-
ter XXIII regarding the entry of such person’s name in the surveillance register, list of
proclaimed offenders, notices to village headmen and watchmen of all places where he
has connections or which he is likely to visit etcetera shall be forthwith complied with.
(3) The procedure of search under warrant and proclamation shall be carried out in
every case in which a wanted person cannot be immediately arrested without warrant by
the investigating officer. Discretion may be exercised by both the police and magistrates
whether to proceed with attachment of property under Section 88, Code of Civil Proce-
dure. In every case, where there is danger of more crime resulting from an absconder
remaining at large an attachment order shall be immediately applied for. The police are
not authorized to carry out attachment, but it is the duty of the prosecuting branch to see
that the necessary orders issued from the court without any delay, and of the officer con-
ducting the investigation to take steps to prevent the improper alienation of attachable
property by fictitious mortgage or sale. For this purpose lists of such property should be
made, as part of the investigation, and attached to the police file of the case, and the village
headman concerned should be directed to report any attempt at alienation or removal
pending the issue of attachment orders. The lists of property prepared by the investigat-
ing officer, attested by competent witnesses, should be put into court with the
application for an attachment order.
(4) To prevent harbouring, without which no absconder can remain at large, thorough
publicity in regard to the issue of a warrant and subsequent proclamation order is essen-
tial. If this receives proper attention, the defence of ignorance is denied to the person
who can be proved to have rendered any sort of assistance to an absconder.
Rule 21.6

21.6. Reports and records. - In order that continuity in the method of administration
outlined in rule 21.1 may not be lost owing to changes of personnel, the proper mainte-
nance of those reports, records and notes which review the history of the criminal
administration of a district, or from which information regarding individuals and past
events may be obtained, is essential. Apart from personal records of police officers, po-
lice station records and inspection notes, referred to in other chapters of these rules, such
records comprise:-
(i) Transfer of charge memoranda (rule 21.7).
(ii) Confidential note books (rule 21.8).
(iii) Weekly diaries I and II (rule 21.9 et. seq.).
(iv) Monthly crime reports (rule 21.15).
(v) Annual Police Administration reports (rule 21.16).
(vi) Annual reports on the administration of the Criminal Tribes Act (rule 21.18).
(vii) Reports on political events or meetings (rule 21.19).
(viii) Reports on important fares and festivals (rule 21.20).
Rule 21.7

21.7. Transfer of charge memoranda. - (1) Every Superintendent and Deputy In-
spector-General shall, before leaving a district or range on transfer, or otherwise record
a memorandum containing all necessary information for the guidance of his successor
and for the preparation of the annual administration report.
Preventive and Detective Organization 557

(2) The following are some of the matters to be attended to in taking over charge of a
district and in preparing the memorandum mentioned in sub-rule (1) above :-
(a) State of contingent allotments, and adequacy or inadequacy under different
heads of the budget;
(b) Additional police, existing and proposed;
(c) New buildings or repairs required;
(d) Pending cases of importance;
(e) Confidential records and correspondence;
(f) General state of crime;
(g) Organization of preventive and detective operations including special mention
of the duties of the Central Investigating Agency and modus operandi office,
and current measures of co-operation between the police and public for the pre-
vention of offences;
(h) Proclaimed offenders and dangerous and active gangs;
(i) Matters noted at the Deputy Inspectors-General’s inspection as requiring atten-
tion;
(j) Custody of keys of cash chest, confidential box, etc.;
(k) Notes on the character and capabilities of officers;
(l) Note of three men in the rank of head constable, selection grade constables and
time scale constables ear-marked for the next ensuing officiating or substantive
promotion vacancies;
(m) Punishment files pending;
(n) Vacancies and suggestions regarding recruiting.
Rule 21.8

21.8. Confidential note-book. - There being many matters connected with the police
administration of a district which find no place in office registers, and a period of which
is necessary, both for the Superintendent’s own information and for the benefit of suc-
ceeding officers, every Superintendent shall maintain a ‘‘confidential note-book’’. The
details given below shall, among others, find a place in this note-book, each successive
Superintendent adding to and revising, in his own notes, the information on record; and
Deputy Inspectors-General shall, at their inspections, examine the books and comment
on the adequacy or otherwise of the notes recorded. The book shall be in two parts as fol-
lows :-

PART I
(a) Villages specially notorious for the bad character of their inhabitants.
(b) Names of zaildars, safedposhes, lambardars, etc., good or bad, who have come
prominently to notice, with brief notes regarding them.
(c) Names and brief accounts of noted or professional political agitators or refer-
ence to their files.
(d) Names and brief accounts regarding specially notorious bad characters and, in
cattle thieving districts, of the chief ‘‘Rassagirs’’.
(e) Notes on matters connected with the administration of the Criminal Tribes Act.
(f) Notes of fairs, periodical religious processions and other local gatherings with
reference to the file explaining the police arrangements necessary at each.
(g) A list of capable detectives and intelligence agents among lower subordinates
with reference to the special qualifications of each.
558 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

(h) Other matters of permanent interest.


An index to the contents in Part I shall be maintained on the first page, as many pages
as may be considered necessary being allotted to each subject. Subject to the
above rules the information may be recorded by Superintendents in any form
they deem most convenient. It should be as concise as possible, a reference be-
ing given to other files or previous papers for more detailed information.

PART II
Part II shall be in the form of a permanent file containing the making over charge
memoranda referred to in rule 21.7.
Rule 21.9

21.9. Superintendent’s weekly diary No. 1. - (1) Superintendents shall submit a


weekly diary on Saturdays in Form 21.9(1) through the District Magistrate to the Deputy
Inspector-General. Unless the diary contains matter which the Deputy Inspector-General
considers it expedient to bring to the notice of the Commissioner or Inspector-General,
it shall be returned direct to the Superintendent of Police.
(2) If the District Magistrate is absent from duty the diary shall be submitted direct by
the Superintendent of Police to the Deputy Inspector- General.
(3) Every Assistant or Deputy Superintendent on tour or inspection duty, and every
Probationary Assistant Superintendent shall submit a diary in this form to the Superin-
tendent. Such diaries shall not be forwarded to the District Magistrate or Deputy
Inspector-General unless the Superintendent has special reasons to do so.
(4) Diaries shall be regarded as confidential communications, and shall not be sent into
offices, and shall be forwarded by District Magistrates and Deputy Inspectors-General
without delay.
Rule 21.10

21.10. Weekly Diary No. 1 - Contents of. - Diaries shall be paragraphed. Each para-
graph shall bear a weekly serial number, and the following matters shall be entered in
them :-
(a) All matters of importance connected with the police administration of the dis-
trict.
(b) Comments on the state of crime in the district and importance cases under in-
vestigation or trial.
(c) Matters of special interest connected with the discipline and conduct of the force.
(d) Inspection and touring work performed by gazetted officers.
Rule 21.11

21.11 Weekly Diary No. I - Check list of. - A check register of weekly diaries shall
be kept by each range Deputy Inspector-General.
Rule 21.12

21.12. Weekly Diary No. II - Channel of submission. - (1) Five copies of confidential
diary No. II in form 221.12(1) shall be prepared each week by Superintendents of Police.
These copies shall be despatched punctually on Saturday evenings [vide serial No. 3 of
Appendix No. 11.39(1)(A)] and should be marked ‘Immediate’. The first copy will be
retained for record, the second copy will be sent direct to the Deputy Inspector-General
of Police of the range, the third and fourth copies will be sent direct to the Assistant to the
Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Criminal Investigation Department, and the fifth
copy will be sent through the District Magistrate to the Commissioner. If the Commis-
sioner or the District Magistrate have recorded any comments on the fifth copy, the
Commissioner will forward it to the Deputy Inspector-General of Police of the range,
who will add his own comments, if any, and transmit the diary to the Assistant of the
Preventive and Detective Organization 559

Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Criminal Investigation Department. If neither the


Commissioner nor the District Magistrate have any comments to record the diary shall be
destroyed by the Commissioner. Action, if any, taken on the advance (Second) copy of
the diary by the Deputy Inspector-Gerneral should normally be confined to addressing
the Superintendent of Police concerned. If it is desired to record remarks for the infor-
mation of higher officers, this may be done either on the copy received from the District
Magistrate and the Commissioner, or by means of a separate reference. The Assistant In-
spector- General, Government Railway Police, shall submit a diary, in duplicate, in the
same form direct to the Assistant to the Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Criminal In-
vestigation Department.
(2) Office copies of confidential diaries shall be kept for three years, or for such
longer period as the Superintendent of Police considers desirable.
(3) The advance (second) copy of the confidential diary should be kept by the Deputy
Inspector-General of Police of the Range concerned for three years.
Rule 21.13

21.13. Weekly Diary No. II - Contents of. - The following are among the matters
which shall be mentioned in the confidential diary :-
(a) Information regarding political movements, parties, leaders, publications, and
the like.
(b) Information regarding religious sects, changes in doctrine and practice having
a political significance, proselytism, or preaching of a provocative nature.
(c) Information regarding foreigners and others, the reporting of whose movements
and activities has been ordered or is considered necessary.
(d) Information regarding current rumours or topics of interest, which are causing
or are likely to cause animosity between classes or disturbance of public tran-
quillity.
(e) Public opinion regarding the legislative or executive measures of Government.
(f) Noteworthy movements of population, whether emigration or immigration.
(g) Political or religious meetings and celebrations which are important either in-
trinsically or by reason of public speeches, propaganda and the like associated
with them.
(h) The effect of public opinion of current discussions in the press.
Rule 21.14

21.14. Weekly Diary No. II - Miscellaneous order regarding. - (1) Every confiden-
tial diary shall be written on half margin, and every separate subject shall be entered in a
separate paragraph, and each paragraph shall be numbered seriatim.
(2) To ascertain and to report correctly the prevailing temper of the people is one of
the most important duties a Superintendent has to perform.
(3) When an entry in a gazetted police officer’s diary, or in the confidential diary, con-
cerns the police of a district, other than the one from which it is submitted, the
Superintendent by or through whom it is submitted, shall state whether he has, or has not,
communicated the facts direct to the Superintendent concerned.
Rule 21.15

21.15 Monthly Crime Report. - (1) The monthly crime statement in Form 21.15(1)
shall be prepared in every district, on the first of each month. On receipt of this state-
ment together with such further statistical information as may be prescribed from time
to time, the Superintendent shall personally compose a brief review of the state of crime
in the district, both in regard to its main divisions and generally. Noteworthy features in
the monthly statistics shall be commented upon, and references shall be made to the
560 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

progress and development of any special measures for combating crime. The review with
the full statement by police stations shall be attached to the first weekly diary submitted
in the month, and a copy, with an extract from the statement showing district totals only,
shall be sent direct to the Deputy Inspector-General to reach him by the 5th of the month
without fail.
(2) On receipt of the extracts mentioned in sub-rule (1) above each Deputy Inspector-
General shall prepare on similar lines to the district reports a consolidated range report,
and submit it on or before the 15th to the Deputy Inspector-General Criminal Investiga-
tion Department. Copies of the range report shall also be sent to Commissioners of
Divisions included in the range, who will forward their copies,with their comments, if
any, to the Inspector-General of Police, and to all Superintendents of Police in the range,
who will show their copies to District Magistrates.
Rule 21.16

21.16. Annual Police Administration Reports. - (1) Every Superintendent shall pre-
pare and despatch to the District Magistrate an Annual Administration Report in January
of each year for the previous calendar year. The Assistant Inspector-General, Govern-
ment Railway Police, shall also submit his Annual Administration Report in January to
the Inspector-General, through the Agent, North-Western Railway.
(2) Each district report shall be forwarded as follows :-
by the Superintendent to the District Magistrate on or before the 20th January;
by the District Magistrate to the District Inspector-General on or before the 31st Janu-
ary.
The district reports (without the returns) shall, as they are received, be forwarded by
Deputy Inspectors-General, accompanied by any marginal remarks considered neces-
sary, to Commissioners by whom they will be returned to Deputy Inspectors-General on
or before the 20th February.
They will then be forwarded by Deputy Inspectors-General to the Inspector- General
with a covering letter containing comments on any improvements in methods of work-
ing, outbreaks of crime affecting more than one district, or other matters of interest not
specifically mentioned in any district and the returns prescribed for the whole range on
or before 1st April.
(3) Every Superintendent and the Assistant Inspector-General, Government Railway
Police shall also submit direct to the Inspector-General an advance copy of the annual re-
port and the returns appended to it, on or before the 20th January.
Rule 21.17

21.17. Annual Report - Form of. - (1) The report should consist of concise and in-
telligent criticism of facts and of the figures given in the prescribed returns. No mere
paraphrasing and reproduction of statistics should be allowed in the body of the report.
Variations in the figures, which are not unusual or important, should not be commented
on. The briefer a report is the better, if it includes all that is necessary to show an intel-
ligent comprehension of the meaning of the facts and figures and of the salient features
of the year’s work. The object of the report is to state what has been done rather than to
suggest what should be done. Matters of the latter nature should be reported in separate
official latter. Any such comment or suggestion which is considered necessary in the an-
nual report should be as brief as possible, especially where the matter is complicated or
controversial.
(2) Lists of subjects to be reported on, the returns to be submitted, and detailed instruc-
tions for their preparation are printed and issued every year by the Central Police Office.
No alternation in, or additions to, the printed forms shall be made without a reference to
the Inspector-General.
Preventive and Detective Organization 561
Rule 21.18

21.18. Criminal Tribe Report. - (1) Each Superintendent of a district shall prepare
an annual report on the working of the Criminal Tribes Act in his district for the calendar
year. The subjects to be reviewed are given in Appendix 21.18(1) and blank forms for
the printed statements required to accompany the report supplied by the Deputy Com-
missioner, Criminal Tribes. Rule 21.17(1) shall apply to the preparation of this report
also.
(2) The latest date for submission of the Criminal Tribes Report shall be:-
(a) by the Superintendent to the District Magistrate; 1st March.
(b) by the District Magistrate to the Deputy Inspector-General; 15 March.
(c) by the Deputy Inspector-General to the Commissioner; 1st April.
(d) by the Commissioner to the Deputy Commissioner, Criminal Tribes; 15 April.
(3) Each Superintendent shall forward a copy of his annual Criminal Tribes Report to
the Assistant to the Inspector-General of Police for Criminal Tribes to reach that officer
by the 1st March, each year.
(4) The Deputy Commissioner, Criminal Tribes, is required to prepare a consolidated
report for the province, which is due with Press not later than June 15th. The report,
when printed, is due to reach Government through the Inspector-General of Police by Au-
gust 15th.
Rule 21.19

21.19. Public Meetings. - It is the duty of Superintendent of Police to arrange for the
accurate reporting of the proceedings of all political and other public meetings held to dis-
cuss matters which are likely to disturb the public transquillity. To this end they shall
encourage officers to learn Urdu shorthand. If the meetings to be reported are of provin-
cial importance, Superintendent of Police may request the assistance of the
Superintendent of Police, Political, Criminal Investigation Department, who will depute
stenographers from the Criminal Investigation Department, or if none are available, will
arrange with the Deputy Inspector-General of the Range for the deputation of a stenog-
rapher from another district in his Range. At meetings at which inflammatory speeches
are considered likely, arrangements shall also be made to have official and non-official
witnesses present who may be available in the event of the prosecution of any of the
speakers being undertaken.
When meetings are obviously of importance in connection with a particular form of
agitation or when the speeches at them appear to be actionable, a detailed report shall be
sent immediately to the Assistant to the Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Criminal In-
vestigation Department, with a list of the official and non-official witnesses present.
Reports in such cases shall not be delayed for inclusion in the weekly confidential diary,
but copies shall be forwarded with the confidential weekly diary to the Deputy inspector-
General of the range for information. Superintendents of Police are responsible that the
reports of all meetings are written in clear and intelligible English. Reports should show
the classes present at the meetings and estimate the effect of the speeches on the audience.
The police have the right to attend public meetings with view to (i) preventing any in-
fringement of the law of, (ii) taking evidence with a view to the possible prosecution of
law breakers. All public meetings can, therefore, be attended by police reporters, but
as the right of entry may at times be questioned or even forcibly resisted by the organ-
izers. It is important, when such tactics are apprehended, that a sufficient body of police
in uniform should be deputed to discourage opposition. Recourse may also be had to the
procedure enacted in Chapter III of the Punjab Criminal Law (Amendment) Act III of
1932.
Rule 21.20

21.20 Reports of fairs and festivals. - (1) Every Superintendent in whose district any
562 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

fairs or public assemblies of importance are to take place shall, on the 1st December in
each year, submit a list of such fairs and assemblies for the year next ensuing, with the
date or dates on which they will be held, to the Inspector-General for publication in the
Police Gazette.
(2) On the termination of important fairs and festivals, Superintendents shall submit a
report in Form 21.20(2) dealing briefly with the prominent features of the fair; crime oc-
curring in connection with it; conduct of the police; accidents or fatalities occurring, if
any, and the existence of any excitement of a political or religious nature etc. Such re-
ports shall be submitted through the District Magistrate to the Deputy Inspector-General
of the range, who will at his discretion forward them through the Commissioner to the In-
spector-General of Police. Events of immediate importance shall also be reported
promptly and by telegram if necessary, by the Superintendent direct to the Deputy In-
spector-General of the range and the Deputy inspector- General, Criminal Investigation
Department.
Rule 21.21

21.21. Political and communal activities in relation to law and order. - Rule 21.19
lays upon Superintendents of Police the duty of watching and reporting on political or
communal movements as such. As part of his general duty to maintain touch with the pro-
gress of activities, which may have consequences likely to disturb public tranquility, it
is incumbent upon every officer in charge of a police station and office superior thereto,
to keep himself fully informed of all developments or offshoots of such movements in his
jurisdiction. To this end such officers must know the persons who take the lead in such
matters, and the attitude towards them of men of influence. As soon as any such move-
ments shows signs of developing on lines which are likely to cause animosity between
sections of the people and breaches of the peace, or to be otherwise clearly subversive of
law and order, the Superintendent, in consultation with the District Magistrate, shall take
such action as may be most appropriate to the occasion; but when the activity is political
rather than communal and no orders of Government cover the case, ordinarily, a refer-
ence should be made to Government before measures to check it are set in motion. Police
officers of all ranks are required to refrain absolutely from personal participation in po-
litical or communal affairs; they are not concerned with the merits of such controversies,
but solely with the maintenance of the public peace. In the category of personal partici-
pation, however, acquaintance and maintenance of touch with communal leaders is not
included. Relations of this kind may help Superintendents and other gazetted police of-
ficers to prevent the development of communal trouble and the occurrence of open
disputes, and may enable them on occasions to bring leaders together with salutary re-
sults for the settlement of minor causes of friction, with which the District Magistrate
need not to troubled in their initial stages.
Rule 21.22

21.22. Religious processions. - (1) Periodical public religious processions shall not
be permitted to proceed along any routes without the written sanction of the District Mag-
istrate.
(2) When a periodical public religious procession is about to take place the Superinten-
dent shall acquaint himself with the police arrangements made in past years and shall
make the necessary arrangements in consultation with the District Magistrate, following,
as far as may be, the procedure previously adopted.
(3) In each district a separate file shall be kept of each periodical public religious pro-
cession showing the strength and disposition of the police force employed and the
average number of persons attending the procession.
(4) Whenever a licence is granted for a procession there shall, if possible, be a plan of
the route on the back of licence. All licences granted shall be in Form 21.22(4).
(5) The Superintendent shall not grant a licence for an important public religious pro-
Preventive and Detective Organization 563

cession of a novel character or on an occasion when public feeling is excited, without tak-
ing the orders of the District Magistrate.
(6) When a procession other than one of regularly exercised custom is allowed to take
place any sums necessary to defray the cost of barriers, additional police and the carriage
of such police shall the deposited with the Superintendent by the managers of such pro-
cessions before the licence is granted.
Rule 21.23

21.23. Press advertisements. - (1) The newspapers press shall be used as a medium
both for advertising police regulations affecting the public and for enlisting the assistance
of the public in the investigation of crime.
Examples :-
(i) Traffic regulations and directions for festivals and official functions.
(ii) Descriptions of wanted offenders or lost property, especially when a reward is
offered.
In both classes of publicity referred to in this rule, press advertising shall be supple-
mented, when considered advisable, by posters for affixing to notice boards
and leaflets for wholesale distribution. Advertising shall be in English or ver-
nacular or both, as may be most appropriate in each case.
(2) The charges for the publication of Government advertisements in newspapers shall
be met from police contract contingencies. With regard to the printing of posters and
leaflets the instruction contained in rule 11.57(3) should be followed.
Rule 21.24

21.24. Criminal Intelligence Gazette - Notice for. - Notices of novel or professional


offences and memoranda embodying the shifts and artifices of criminals shall be sent for
publication in the Criminal Intelligence Gazette for general information. Such notices
shall be sent direct to the Assistant Inspector-General, Crime and Criminal Tribes, Crimi-
nal Investigation Department, and shall be in narrative or other form, as far as possible,
ready for the press.
Rule 21.25

21.25. Appointments to Criminal Investigation Department. - (1) Upper and lower


subordinate posts other than those of inspectors in the Criminal Investigation Department
shall be filled by the deputation of suitable men from districts for periods of three years
extendible by not more than two years at a time at the discretion of the Deputy Inspector-
General, Criminal Investigation Department.
(2) A police officer on deputation to the Criminal Investigation Department will retain
his original position in the cadre of his district or range. While in the Criminal Investiga-
tion Department he will be eligible for officiating promotion in that branch; on
reversion from the Criminal Investigation Department he will assume his place in his
original cadre. Officiating promotion may be given in the district or range in the place
of an officer deputed to the Criminal Investigation Department, such officiating post laps-
ing on the officer’s reversion.
(3) When an officer borne on the rolls of a district or range reaches a place in seniority
which would entitle him to be considered for substantive promotion if he were serving
in the establishment to which he belongs permanently, he shall be informed and given
the opportunity of returning to district police work. No officer on deputation to the Crimi-
nal Investigation Department shall be substantively promoted to head constable or higher
rank unless both the Deputy Inspector-General, Criminal Investigation Department and
the Deputy Inspector-General of the range to which he belongs agree that he is qualified
for such promotion by all the prescribed standards.
(4) The Deputy Inspector-General, Criminal investigation Department, may make
564 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

recommendation on behalf of sub-inspectors serving under him to the Deputy Inspector


General of the range and the Inspector-General of Police, respectively for promotion to
the selection grade or admission to List F. A sub-inspector who becomes eligible while
serving in the Criminal Investigation Department for grade promotion in the selection
grade, shall receive such promotion, if the Deputy Inspector General of the range and
Criminal Investigation Department agree that he is fit for it.
(5) Annual reports on upper subordinates serving on deputation in the Criminal Inves-
tigation Department shall be sent by the Deputy inspector- General, Criminal
Investigation Department, to the range Deputy Inspector- General concerned for record
and other necessary action.
(6) In very exceptional cases and for the political branch only and with the written
sanction of the Deputy Inspector-General personally, direct enrolment as constable or in
higher ranks, may be made to the Criminal Investigation Department. Specialists shall,
however, when possible, be entertained on contract terms, so that their services may be
dispensed with when their utility ceases or deteriorates.
Rule 21.25-A

21.25-(A). Discipline in the Criminal Investigation Department. - The Deputy In-


spector General, Criminal Investigation Department, shall have complete disciplinary
control over all police officers while serving in the Criminal Investigation Department.
Rule 21.26

21.26. Duties of Criminal Investigation Department. - The following are the chief
duties of the Criminal Investigation Department in so far as they affect the district police:-
(i) To promote co-operation between the police of different districts and different
provinces.
(ii) To undertake or assist in the investigation of cases or classes of crime which
have provincial or inter-provincial ramifications if the Inspector-General or
Deputy inspector-General, Criminal Investigation Department, considers that
such action is in the interests of the criminal administration.
(iii) To watch and report on all communal, political and subversive movements af-
fecting the province and India as a whole; to maintain close co- operation with
district authorities in all such matters and to direct investigations connected
with them.
(iv) Through the medium of the Criminal Intelligence Gazette :-
(a) to check crime by the prompt publication of information of the prevalence
of a particular class of crime and of the absence from their homes of dan-
gerous criminals;
(b) to secure the detection and arrest of persons wanted for offences commit-
ted;
(c) to trace property stolen and recovered;
(d) to act generally as an agency for disseminating intelligence likely to aid
the police in their work.
(v) To collect, co-ordinate and disseminate political and criminal intelligence.
(vi) The Criminal Tribes Branch to deal with all aspects of the control of Criminal
Tribes which fall within the sphere of the Inspector- General of Police as pre-
scribed from time to time by the Provincial Government.
Rule 21.27

21.27. Requests for services of officers of Criminal Investigation Department. -


The services of investigating officers of the Criminal Investigation Department may be
asked for by Superintendents of Police in any case of the following nature:-
Preventive and Detective Organization 565

(a) Note forgery, counterfeit coining or professional poisoning cases where the
conspiracy appears to extend to other provinces and there is not a suitable staff
to deal with them in the district.
(b) Theft of Government arms and ammunition and illicit trade in arms.
(c) Extensive frauds and bogus company promoting.
(d) Cases of dacoity concerning more than one district.
(e) Organised traffic in women.
(f) Cases of such a technical nature as, in the opinion of the District Superintendent
of Police, appear to call for the services of an officer of the Criminal Investi-
gation Department.
The Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Criminal Investigation Department, shall de-
cide in each such case whether he can comply with the request of the Superintendent of
Police.
Rule 21.28

21.28. Status of Criminal Investigation Department Officers in investigations. -


(1) The Criminal Investigation Department has no separate jurisdiction and can only in-
vestigate under the cover of a First Information Report registered at a police station
having jurisdiction. The Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Criminal Investigation
Department, may decide to take over the control of any particular investigation himself
or to depute one or more of his officers to work directly under the control of the Super-
intendent of Police of the district concerned. In either case the latter officer has the right
to be kept fully informed of the progress of the investigation. All case diaries written by
officers of the Criminal Investigation Department shall be forwarded to the gazetted of-
ficer of the Criminal Investigation Department under whom they are working through the
Superintendent of Police, advance copies being sent direct if so ordered.
(2) When dealing with cases in conjunction with the district police, officers of the
Criminal Investigation Department must bear in mind that it is indispensable to gain the
confidence and goodwill of the local police and to avoid giving cause for jealousy.
(3) When good results are obtained full credit must be given to district police officers
for any share they may have had in the work and, when results are unsatisfactory, care
must be taken not to criticise the local police unfairly.
(4) All recommendations, made by officers of the Criminal Investigation Department
for rewards for exceptionally good work done in cases wholly or partly investigated by
officers of the Criminal Investigation Department shall invariably be submitted to the
Deputy Inspector-General through the Superintendent of the district concerned who may
add any recommendation or remarks he may consider necessary.
Rule 21.29

21.29. Criminal Investigation Department - no control over district police. - Offi-


cers of the Criminal Investigation Department shall have no control or executive authority
over the district police except in an emergency and within the powers vested in them by
their rank in the provincial police force.
All matters affecting the discipline of or rewards to, and complaints against, the district
police, shall be referred by the Deputy Inspector- General of Police, Criminal Investiga-
tion Department, to the Deputy Inspector-General of Police of the range concerned.
Rule 21.30

21.30. Prosecution of cases investigated by the Criminal Investigation Depart-


ment. - The consent of the Deputy Inspector-General, Criminal Investigation
Department, shall be obtained before an officer of the department is presented as a witness
in court. Criminal Investigation Department officers shall advise and assist the district in-
566 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

vestigating and prosecuting officers in the conduct in court of cases in the investigation
of which they have shared.
Rule 21.31

21.31. Rules of the Criminal Investigation Department. - The full rules of the Crimi-
nal Investigation Department are contained in the Manual of that department.
Rule 21.32

21.32. Circumstances in which Criminal Investigation Department can assist in-


vestigating officers. - The Criminal Investigation Department is in possession of special
apparatus and its officers include those accustomed to the handling of certain branches of
police technique. Investigating district police officers and Superintendents of Police
should remember, therefore that the Criminal Investigation Department is in a position
to give assistance in circumstances such as are described below :-
(a) the reconstruction of faded writing;
(b) the examination of arms and bullets used in crime;
(c) the examination of minutioe such as hairs, pieces of skin, dust, etc.;
(d) the solution of ciphers;
(e) the examination of forged documents, counterfeit coins and moulds;
(f) the photographing of important documents;
(g) the interrogation of suspects from other provinces;
(h) the connection of local suspects with suspects of other districts or provinces;
(i) when an opinion on handwriting is required to assist the investigation;
(j) where invisible inks are suspected to have been used.
Such matters shall only be referred to the Criminal Investigation Department in impor-
tant cases when other evidence sufficient for the purpose of the case concerned is not
forthcoming. In important cases the Criminal Investigation Department will enlist the aid
of scientific persons outside the police department.
The department is also ready, when circumstances permit, to assist district police of-
ficers with technical advices on the spot as to the discovery and preservation of clues at
the scene of crimes and can sometimes loan apparatus and qualified operators thereof for
these and similar purposes.
Rule 21.33

21.33. Officers of Criminal Investigation Department to report to Superintendent


of Police. - Ordinarily, when an officer of the Criminal Investigation Department is sent
to a district to take up enquiries, and invariably, when he is sent to investigate a case, he
will take within him a letter addressed to the Superintendent of Police, or senior officer
present at headquarters, describing the nature of the work on which he is sent and, when
necessary, asking for his assistance. When directed to do so he will also call on the Dis-
trict Magistrate.
Rule 21.34

21.34. Organization of police in towns and cities. - (1) In each district the Superin-
tendent of Police shall issue standing orders regulating the point and beat duty to be
carried out in each town and cantonment for which police establishment is provided.
These orders shall be in accordance with the principles set forth in rule 2.2(2) and shall
be revised as often as may be necessary to meet variations in the local incidence of crime,
development of new residential or commercial areas, increase in establishment and the
like. The division between the investigation and clerical staff and the watch and ward staff
shall be maintained as far as is practicable, though inter-change of duties should be made.
Men, even though qualified, should not be employed on the investigation staff while
Preventive and Detective Organization 567

posted to the watch and ward staff, except in cases of emergency, as such employment
must detract from the efficiency of the watch and ward system.
(2) The success of a system of watch and ward in a town or city will depend on -
(a) the discipline of the men on beat the patrol duties;
(b) the extent to which the men have been instructed in their duties;
(c) the amount of supervision exercised by supervisor officers. Superintendents of
Police must therefore arrange that, in addition to the standing orders referred to
in the above rule, head constables and constables are frequently questioned so
as to ensure that the training they have received in the lines school and at the Po-
lice Training School is not forgotten but put into practice. Each constable on
beat or patrol duty should continually have in mind the specific duties required
of him.
Rule 21.35

21.35. Central Investigating Agencies. - (1) In order to assist the Superintendent of


Police and his Supervising staff in co-ordinating the preventive and detective work of the
District Police and in order to act as clearing house for criminal intelligence for the use
of investigating officers in the district and in other districts a Central Intelligence Agency
shall be established in each district. This body shall be formed from the establishment
sanctioned for the district for the prevention and detection of crime. Officers of different
ranks shall be selected for service in the C.I.A. in the light of their intelligence, efficiency
and practical experience of preventive and detective work in a police station. In order to
promote co-operation and the inter-change of ideas between the C.I.A. and police station
staff no officer shall ordinarily remain more than two years at a time in the C.I.A. No of-
ficer shall be appointed to the C.I.A. who is not well educated and who has not an
unblemished reputation for honesty.
The functions of the Central Investigation Agency are :-
(a) The preparation of crime maps relating to offences against property classified
under the methods employed by the criminals.
(b) The receipt, consideration and filing according to classification, of information
received from investigating officers.
(c) The comparing of the data collected under (a) and (b) and the communication
of any deduction therefrom to the investigation officers concerned.
(d) The preparation of a crime index of cases from the materials collected under (a)
and (b) classified according to: (1) methods employed by the criminals, and
(2) various clues provided by the criminals such as nick-names used; special
clothing worn; peculiarities of the culprits noticed by witnesses; special weap-
ons used; special signals used etc. etc.
(e) The preparation of a crime index of criminals. This shall normally be in two
parts-
(i) an index of names of known criminals classified according to their meth-
ods of operating;
(ii) an index of known criminals classified according to their peculiarities of
appearance, gait, speech, nicknames, etc.
(f) The provision of information by means of which the Superintendent of Police
may be assisted in controlling the crime of his district, forestalling outbreaks of
crime and directing preventive operations.
(g) The publication of weekly Criminal Intelligence Gazette.
(h) To co-ordinate and guide the efforts of police station staff throughout the district
in securing the arrest of absconders and proclaimed offenders and in locating
568 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

absentee bad characters, criminal tribesmen and other untraced persons and to
maintain close co-operations with the C.I.As of other districts in this work.
(i) When information received from records or otherwise indicates that a se-
ries of cases, whether in the jurisdictions of one or of several police sta-
tions, is the work of the same criminal or of a gang to co- ordinate or,
under the orders of the Superintendent of Police, direct the investigation of
such cases.
The primary function of a Central Intelligence Agency is to assist station house officers
and their staffs. The A.C.I.A. can only afford assistance effectively, if it is continuously
supplied by Station House Officers with detailed information about the movements of bad
characters and peculiar features of cases. Information so received shall be examined,
compared, and classified by the C.I.A. Information of general use of Station House Of-
ficers and neighbouring districts and deductions from it shall be disseminated as speedily
as possible through the C.I. Gazette or, in case of urgency, by special circular. Informa-
tion which is of value to a particular police station only or clues in local cases shall be
communicated immediately to the particular officers or officer concerned, who shall be
held responsible for making proper use of it.
The C.I.A. shall be in charge of one of the District Inspectors. A room shall be provided
for it in the office of the Superintendent of Police which is conveniently situated in rela-
tion to the rooms of the Superintendent of Police and Gazetted Officers. These officers
and their readers and officers of the prosecuting branch and all Station House Officers and
investigating officers visiting headquarters shall make a practice of visiting the C.I.A.
room regularly, studying the records of crime and criminals which are concerting meas-
ures for the better control of criminals through the agency of the records and machinery
of the district Police.
All investigating officers in the district shall be encouraged to visit the room where the
Central Investigating Agency functions when they visit headquarters and to discuss their
cases with the personnel of the Central Investigating Agency.
[(2) The instructions concerning the examination of scenes of all criminal cases and the
particulars required to be submitted in the case of all such offences to the Central Inves-
tigation Agency are given in Appendix 21.35(2) and the various forms to be used are
detailed below. One copy shall be submitted to the District Crime Records Bureau of the
District concerned for record :-
(1) Crime Details Forms;
(2) Arrest/Court Surrender Form;
(3) Property Search and Seizure Form.]1
Rule 21.36

21.36. Range mobile traffic patrols. Duties of. - For each range of the province at
least one mobile traffic patrol, consisting of an inspector, a sub-inspector and two consta-
bles, has been sanctioned for the control and checking of traffic on the roads of the range.
These patrols shall be under the direct control of Deputy Inspectors-General who shall
be responsible for so directing their movements and activities as to obtain the maximum
effect.
The duties of these patrols shall be :-
(a) The checking at irregular intervals on different roads of all motor-licences to
drive and to ply for hire. At these inspections of licences the officer in-charge

1. Substituted vide Punjab Govt. Notification No. G.S.R. 20 -/C.A.V./1861/S. 46/Amd. (23)/2003,
dated 6.3.2003.
Preventive and Detective Organization 569

of the patrol shall satisfy himself that all licences are uptodate and that all ve-
hicles have paid the taxes imposed under the Punjab Motor Vehicles Rules,
1916, the Punjab Heavy Motor Vehicles Rules, 1931 and the Punjab Motor
Vehicles Plying for Hire Rules, 1922.
(b) The reporting in Form 21.36(b) of offences under the above mentioned ruled
and under the Indian Penal Code to the prosecuting agency of the district con-
cerned with a view to the prosecution of the offenders.
(c) The checking at irregular intervals and on different roads of dangerous driving
at specific places on the roads where furious or dangerous driving is likely to re-
sult in accidents. This shall be done by the watching of specific points on dan-
gerous portions of the roads and the checking of the speed of cars passing and
their manner of negotiating such places. Motor vehicles moving recklessly, fu-
riously or in a manner against the rules of the road shall be stopped, their num-
bers and the names of the drivers with other particulars noted and the cases
reported for prosecution.
(d) The checking of motor vehicles plying for hire on the occasions mentioned in
(a) and (c) above, with a view to ensuring that the conditions of their licences
with regard to the safety and comfort of passengers have been complied with.
(e) The rendering of first aid to the injured and all possible assistance in serious mo-
toring accidents and the noting of all particulars in such cases when the patrol
should happen to be in the vicinity.
(f) The giving of assistance in the instruction of traffic police of smaller districts.
(g) The continuous warning and advising of drivers of all kinds of vehicles who may
be observed infringing the rules of the road.
(h) The reporting of offences against Municipal or District Board bye-laws in con-
nection with the overloading of horse-drawn vehicles plying for hire, etc.
(i) The reporting of cases of cruelty to animals when Section 34 of Act V of 1861
applies.
(j) The organisation, in conjunction with owners, drivers and any of their associa-
tions of methods for the improvement to traffic control and the prevention of of-
fences.
(k) the acquisition of knowledge on all matters connected with traffic and motor ve-
hicle transport sufficient to enable them to keep in touch with and report on any
innovations, developments or unusual situations within their jurisdiction.
For this purpose it will be necessary for them to maintain a confidential register by dis-
tricts containing notes on the following:-
(1) Routes carrying motor vehicle transport.
(2) The number of public motor vehicles on each route and their relation to the pub-
lic demand.
(3) Unions and their working.
(4) Lorry stands.
(5) Regular bus services and their working.
(6) The working of any system of monopolies that may be in force.
Rule 21.37

21.37. Traffic patrols - Duties of inspectors of. - (1) Inspectors in charge of mobile
traffic patrols are required to have a working knowledge of motor mechanics and shall
have received training in traffic control. They shall report all cases noticed by them of
bad work on the part of constables on traffic control to the Superintendent of the district
concerned.
570 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

(2) They shall submit a daily diary to the Deputy Inspector-General of Police in form
21.37(2)(A) and shall maintain a ‘working account’ in Form 21.37(2)(B) on each motor
vehicle showing the mileage done and the petrol and oil consumed with, in each case,
a reference to the entry in the daily diary of Inspector. The repairs carried out to the ve-
hicle shall be shown in the ‘Remarks’ column.
(3) All bills for petrol, oil and repairs shall be submitted separately for each vehicle to
the Superintendent of Police of the district on which the patrol is based and, in the case
of the Central Range Patrol, to the Assistant Inspector-General, Traffic. The Superinten-
dents of Police concerned and the Assistant Inspector-General, Traffic, will check the
bills with the ‘working account’ and the speedometer of the patrol vehicles before sanc-
tioning payment.
Rule 21.38

21.38. Range mobile patrols - Co-operation of District Police. - Each district in


which range mobile patrols operate shall place two constables from the traffic staff at
headquarters at the disposal of the inspector while the latter is within the district. These
men may be taken by the patrol to the headquarters of the next district when necessary,
but shall be returned at once with a note from the officer-in-charge giving the duties per-
formed by them and the date and time of their release. They shall return to their
headquarters by rail or road as convenient. These men shall be used as far as possible for
giving evidence in cases so as to obviate the necessity of the regular members of the pa-
trol being taken off the road to attend courts.
Preventive and Detective Organization 571

APPENDIX No. 21.18(1)


SUBJECTS TO BE DISCUSSED IN THE DISTRICT CRIMINAL TRIBES RE-
PORTS
Serial No. Subject
1. Mention the tribes registered in your district under the Criminal Tribes Act (Act III of 1911).
2. Remarks on the general behaviour during the past year of each such tribe and state whether any
of the members are settling down to an honest livelihood. Note if there are any signs of
improvement or the reverse.
3. With regard to the absentees shown in column 19 of Statement I
4. Mention the number of members of notified criminal tribes whether exempted or registered
who were convicted of offences under Chapter XVII
Note. - Information under Serial Nos. 2 to 4 above to be given separately for each tribe in the
order given on column 1 of Statement 1.
5. Mention the amount paid during the past year for rewards for the arrest of absentees under Rule
15.17.
6. Mention any special measures taken to enforce responsibility of lambardars and chaukidars in
connection with reporting the presence or absence of members of criminal tribes.
7. Mention in sufficient detail any cases in which inadequate punishments appear to have been
inflicted
8. Remarks on the Finger Print System as applied to members of criminal tribes and the results
obtained therefrom.
9. Remarks on the procedure followed in connection with the control of wandering gangs and
others not yet registered under the Act.
10. Mention any other matter deserving the notice

APPENDIX No. 21.35(2)


INSTRUCTIONS CONCERNING THE EXAMINATIONS OF SCENES OF
THEFTS AND BURGLARIES AND PARTICULARS REQUIRED TO BE SUB-
MITTED IN THE CASE OF ALL SUCH OFFENCES TO THE CENTRAL INVES-
TIGATION AGENCY.
The scenes of all offences under Chapter 17, Indian Penal Code shall be most carefully
examined as soon as possible, by the investigating officer who, in cases of theft (except
cattle theft) and burglary, shall attach a separate site inspection report with the first case
diary irrespective of the fact whether the accused are known, unknown, arrested or at
large. This site inspection report on arrival at headquarters shall be passed on without de-
lay to the Central Investigating Agency.
In the case of offences against property, other than theft and burglary, no site inspection
report need be prepared unless the scene of the offence presents such peculiarities as
make such a report desirable or unless a report is called for by the officer in charge of the
Central Investigating Agency.
The object of a site inspection report is (a) to enable other officers who have not been
to the spot to visualise the scene, (b) to permit of an intelligent study of the ways and meth-
ods of the particular criminal by the Central Investigating Agency, (c) to enable the
Central Investigating Agency from their records of individual criminals to suggest iden-
tity of the accused responsible for the particular case under investigation. Obviously,
therefore, every site inspection report must be intelligently and carefully compiled after
a deliberate study of the scene. A list of points that should find mention in site inspection
reports is given below, but the list is by no means exhaustive and is entered merely as a
guide.
572 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

A. - Burglaries of all kinds


1. Number of the First Information Report; date; section of the offence; police sta-
tion and district.
2. Time and date of (a) occurrence, (b) report to the police.
3. Special circumstances, if any, concerning the time and date of occurrence (e.g.,
fair, festival, or evening meals, etc., etc.).
4. Place of occurrence, with distance and direction from (a) police station, (b) rail-
way station, and (c) main road.
5. Nature of locality (i.e., dwelling house, office, mosque shop, etc., etc.) and its re-
lation to the rest of the village or town.
6. Name, address, profession and status of the complainant.
7. Class of property attached.
8. Class of property removed.
9. Number of rooms entered by the accused and whether or not they were occupied
at the time.
10. Whether or not property was removed from the particular rooms to which the
accused first gained admittance.
11. Any clue left to indicate whether the accused worked in the dark or by means
of a light.
12. Particulars of any belongings of the accused left by him on the spot.
13. Any boxes, safes, almirahs, etc., etc. containing articles of value overlooked by
the accused and not touched by him and if so their locality.
14. Precautions, if any, adopted by the accused during the commission of the of-
fence to guard against surprise (such as chaining of door, etc.).
15. When property removed was last seen at the place from which it was stolen.
16. Finger-prints. - Description of traces of finger-prints found, their exact position
and steps taken for their preservation, development, photograph, transfer, iden-
tification, etc.
17. Foot-prints. - (1) Number of foot-prints found, (a) leading to the spot, (b) on the
spot, (c) leading from the spot and deduction therefrom as to the number of cul-
prits involved, (2) Direction from which the accused came and direction in
which they went, (3) Distance to which tracks leading (a) to and (b) from the
scene were followed, (4) Measurements (in inches) of individual foot-prints,
(5) Precautions, if any, adopted by the accused to conceal their foot-prints, (6)
Whether moulds, etc., taken or not and, in latter case reason for failure to do
so.
18. Opinion as to whether accused were expert or amateurs and class of society to
which they belonged and reasons, in support thereof.
19. Means of transport, if any, employed by the accused for the removal of property.
20. Any other clues or matters of importance requiring mention.
IF ADMITTANCE OF THE HOUSE OBTAINED BY MEANS OF A HOLE IN
THE WALL.
21. Condition of the wall (kacha, pacca, burnt bricks, stone, etc.)
22. The exact situation of the hold and its relative position, with regard to doors,
windows, ventilators, etc.
23. Shape of the hole (illustrate by diagram).
Preventive and Detective Organization 573

24. Height of the base of the hold from the ground (a) outside, and (b) inside.
25. Exact measurements (in inches and not in ungals or other such unauthorised
measurements) of the hole (a) outside, and (b) inside,
26. Thickness of the wall where hole made.
27. Side to which excavated earth was thrown.
28. Details of marks left by instrument used and inference drawn therefrom as to the
nature of the instrument.
29. Whether room in which hole was made was occupied or not at the time.
IF ADMITTANCE WAS OBTAINED BY LOCK BREAKING OR LOCK
OPENING
30. Type of lock broken.
31. If opened by key any indication as to whether key used was (a) the original one
and if so how accused obtained possession of it, (b) duplicate, (c) skeleton or
false.
32. If lock forced (a) give particulars of marks on it and inference drawn therefrom
as to the instrument used, and (b) state if lock is still in working order.
33. If lock intact and hasp or chain wrenched out, state the type of instrument that
appears to have been used.
IF ADMITTANCE OBTAINED BY MEANS OF A HOLE IN ROOF.
34. The construction of the roof (whether kacha, pacca, thatched, etc., etc.).
35. Any indication as to how the accused ascended the roof.
36. Position of hole (whether of adjoining beam, in one corner, etc., etc.).
37. Whether room beneath was occupied or not.
38. Whether property was removed from the room in which hole was made.
39. Means employed by the accused to descend into the room below.
40. How earth removed was disposed of and precautions adopted by the accused
to prevent earth from falling into the room below.
41. Any other matters of importance requiring special mention.
IF ADMITTANCE OBTAINED BY ANY WAY OTHER THAN THOSE MEN-
TIONED ABOVE
42. How admittance was gained.
43. If admittance gained by closed windows or ventilators, give particulars to in-
dicate how bars were forced or glasses broken and means adopted by accused
for preventing noise.
44. If culprit scaled the wall (a) state means employed (i.e., rope, leather, bamboo,
water pipe, etc.; (b) give particulars of marks, if any, left on the wall.
45. If admittance gained through a drain give dimensions and position with respect
to the rest of the house.
46. If admittance gained through a chimney give similar particulars.
47. In case of admittance obtained by deceitful means, threat, force, etc., give de-
tails of story told by suspect.
IN THE CASE OF DAY LIGHT BURGLARIES
48. State whereabouts of the owner of the time of the commission of offence.
49. Precautions, if any, taken, by the accused or his associates to divert the attention
of neighbours away from the house attacked.
574 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

B. - Thefts of all kinds


The same particulars as for burglaries, where applicable, together with a brief report of
the facts.
IN CASE OF PICK-POCKETING
1. Means employed by culprit (i.e., razor, blade, knife etc.)
2. The position of the picked pocket (waist-coat, inner pocket of coat, etc.) and its
contents.
3. Position of other pockets and contents which were not touched.
4. Reasons, if any, for believing that the accused had associates.
5. Means adopted to distract the attention of the victim.

FORM No. 21.9(1)


PUNJAB POLICE ______ DISTRICT
WEEKLY DIARY No. 1.
For week ending Saturday. _____________________ 19
Despatched by Superintendent on ___________________
Despatched by Deputy Commissioner on _____________
Despatched by Deputy Inspector-General on __________
Returned by Commissioner ____________________

STATEMENT OF CRIME REPORTED BY "F.I.R." UP TO WEEK


ENDING SATURDAY______________ 19 .
CASES REPORTED UP TO DIFFERENCE
DATE
Serial Police Cases reported 19 ___ . 19 ______. More Less REMARK
No. Stations during past week S

Total

COMPARATIVE STATEMENT OF HEINOUS OFFENCES REPORTED.


Murders ..
Riots ..
Dakaities ..
Burglaries ..
Preventive and Detective Organization 575

DISPOSAL OF POLICE CASES IN WEEK ENDING _______ 19


SENT FOR TRIAL DECIDED IN COURT
Cases and per- During the Pending from Total Convicted Discharged Pending Pending over
sons week last week or acquitted one month
Cases ..

Persons ..

Serial No. Subject REMARKS


Details of working of preventive sections during the past week
Persons 106, 107, C.P.C 109, C.P.C 110, C.P.C Total
Sent for security
Convicted
Discharged
Pending at end of week
Convicted during the year up to
date
Convicted on corresponding date
of previous year
Number of persons on security on
date
Numberof persons on security on
corresponding date of previous
year

FORM No. 21.12(1)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _____ DISTRICT
CONFIDENTIAL
Weekly Diary No. II for week ending _________ 19 .
Acknowledgement of Secret Abstract -- 1
Certificate regarding Cypher Code and Key word -- 2
Dated ________ 19
Superintendent of Police
(REVERSE)
POLICE 19 DEPARTMENT
Weekly Diary No. II
______ DISTRICT
For the week ending _____________________-
Received by Inspector-General on the _______
_________
576 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

FORM No. 21.15(1)


COMPARATIVE STATEMENT OF REPORTED CRIME DURING THE MONTH
_____ AND FROM THE 1ST JANUARY 19 ______ TO THE END OF _____ 19
(To be attached to Superintendent’s first weekly diary in each month.)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Murders Dakaities Burglaries
Serial District or police Period 19 19 19 19 19 19
No. station (A or B)

10 11 12 13 14 15
ALL REPORTED CRIME EXCLU-
SIVE OF
Security Cases
19 19 Plus or minus Number of Persons on Number of cases Percentage column 14
security under Section pending in court for bears to total Police
110, C.P.C. over one month cases reported during
exclusive of security past month
cases

A. - The figures for the past month.

B. - The figures for the year upto date, to be written in red ink

Dated __________ Superintendent or Deputy Inspector-General

The __________

FORM No. 21.20(2)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _______ DISTRICT

Report of a fair held at ___________________ District.


(1) Local name of fair or assembly _______________________________

(2) Object of fair or assembly ___________________________________

(3) Average daily attendance ____________________________________

(4) Number of days the fair lasts _________________________________

(5) Notworthy particulars :-

(6) Remarks by District Magistrate and Deputy Inspector-General to follow :-

Dated the ______ 19 Countersigned


Superintendent
Magistrate of the District
(Bilingual Standard Form)
Preventive and Detective Organization 577

FORM No. 21.22(4)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _________ DISTRICT
License No. _______ DISTRICT
Free of a fee.
WHEREAS _____________________________________ have applied for a licence
under Section 30, Act V of 1861, the following licence is granted.
License for ________________ On the occasion of ____________ at ________ On
______ under Section 30 of Act V of 1861 (Police Act).
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Names Period Place or Place Place Route Places Kind of Officer in REMARK
and de- for area for and time and time to be and music charge of S
scription which which of of followed periods allowed the
of licen- the the commence concusion (to be of halts, and the procession
secs licence licence ment given if any places (if
is valid is granted in detai) any),
where it
would not
be played

* If there are more licensees, their names, should be entered.


In the remarks column shall be entered all particulars which it is necessary to prescribe,
but for which a special column is not provided e.g., height of tazias in Moharram proces-
sions.
Dated the _________ 19 Seal. Suptd. of Police
1. This license is granted subject to all the provisions of the Police act (No. V of 1861)
and subject to strict observance of all terms and conditions of the licence.
2. The licensees and the processionists generally, shall comply with any orders issued
by the Magistrate or other Officer in charge of the procession with regard to -
(a) the speed of the procession;
(b) any changes of route decided on by the Magistrate or the Officer-in-charge of
the procession; and
(c) any orders deemed necessary such as stopping of music, speeches, or songs
etc., at specified places.
3. The licence shall be promptly shown or surrendered on demand by the Magistrate or
Police Officer of and above the rank of Officer-in-charge of the Police Station.
4. It shall be subject to cancellation by the Officer who granted it.
5. The licensees severally and individually shall be present throughout and shall be re-
sponsible for rendering all assistance in their power to the Police in maintaining order at
the place of the meeting or on the route of the procession and for compliance by the mem-
bers of the meeting or procession with all the conditions of the licence or any order issued
in accordance with these conditions of the licence or any order issued in accordance with
these conditions. This responsibility rests upon the licensees whether they happen to be
present or not at any particular time or place during the course of the procession.
6. Special conditions (if any).
Certificate of receipt from licensees.
I/We the undersigned have received this licence and undertake to abide by the condi-
tions therein inserted.
578 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

Signature

FORM No. 21.35(2)(a)


CASE INDEX CARD
Head ___________ Sub-head _______ Index No. _____ Police Stn. ____ F.I.R. No.
_______ Date ______ Law and Sec. ____________________
Facts in brief particularly those showing method..

(Reverse) (Reference)
Name and aliase _____________________________ Name Index Card No. _________________________
Parentage and address ________________________ Photo album No. page _________________________
Caste and trade or occupation __________________ P.R. No. ____________________________________
Description ________________________________ Index Card No. ______________________________
Deformaties and Peculiarities __________________ Index Card No. ______________________________

FORM No. 21.35(2)(b)


CRIMINAL INDEX CARD
NAME Aliases or Nicknames No.
Parentage Residence Caste occupation
HEIGHT
Date of birth Ft. In Build Eyes Hair Complexio Hair on Descriptive Index No. ___
n face Deformity Index No. ___

Marks and peculiarities ____________________________________


ASSOCIATES
1. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
2. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
3. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
4. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
5. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
6. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
7. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
8. ____________________________ C.I. No. ________________________
P.R. No. __________ Photo Vol. ________________ Page _____________
(Reverse)
Medhod
CRIMINAL HISTORY
Preventive and Detective Organization 579

FORM No. 21.35(2)(c)


No. _____________
DESCRIPTIVE INDEX CARD
(To be indexed by height and where this is identical by age and so on)
Height _________________________ Date of birth ______________________
Build __________________________ Eyes ____________________________
Hair on head ____________________ Hair on face ______________________
Complexion _____________________
Identification marks (scars, etc.)_____
Gait, speech and manner ___________ Deformity Card No. (if any) _________
Dress __________________________
Deformities _____________________
Name __________________________
Parentage _______________________
Criminal Index Card No. ___________
Deformity Index Card No. __________

FORM No. 21.35(2) (d)


DEFORMITY INDEX CARD
Class _____________________________________________________
Sub-Class _________________________________________________
Nature of deformity _________________________________________
Name _____________________________Parentage________________
Residence _________________________________________________
Criminal Index Card No. _____________________________________

FORM No. 21.35(2)(e)


(To be completed by Investigating Officers and sent to the Criminal Investigation
Agency immediately and arrest is made for offences under Chapter 12 or 17, Indian Penal
Code).
1. Police Station __________________________________________
2. F.I.R. No. and date ______________________________________
3. Section _______________________________________________
4. Name of accused and aliases ______________________________
5. Parentage _____________________________________________
6. Caste _________________________________________________
7. Trade or profession _______________________________________
8. Residence (Original/Present) ________________________________
580 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

9. Description ______________ Height _________________________


Date of birth _______________ Build _________________________
Eyes _____________________ Hair _________________________
Complexion __________________ Hair on face _________________
Particular identification marks _______________________________
Gait, speech and manner ____________________________________
Dress ___________________________________________________
Deformities and peculiarities ________________________________
Habits and weaknesses _____________________________________
10. Female acquaintances ___________________________________
11. Associates in crime _____________________________________
12. Position occupied in the gang and importance generally as a criminal __________
________________________________________________________
13. Receivers with whom he deals ____________________________
14. Relatives _____________________________________________
15. Persons likely to afford him shelter ________________________
16. Convictions ___________________________________________
17. Suspicions since last arrested _______________________________
18. Grounds for arrest ______________________________________
19. Remarks regarding his criminal activities and method ___________________
Signature of Investigating Officer
Date of submission of report ______

FORM No. 21.35(2)(f)


PROPERTY CARD
Lost/Stolen
Name of article ____________________________________________
Local or Punjabi name ______________________________________
Marks of identity __________________________________________
Date of loss ____________ from whose possession and place _______
Owner’s name and address ___________________________________
Persons suspected (if any), his mode of disposal __________________
Under what circumstances lost (Report at Police Station) __________
__________
Preventive and Detective Organization 581

FORM No. 21.35(2)(g)


Method
PROPERTY CARD
Recovered
Name of article _____________________________________________
Local or Punjabi name _______________________________________
Marks of identity ___________________________________________
Date of recovery ______________ from whose possession and place __
Action taken against possessor _________________________________
Circumstances under which recovered ___________________________
Method of disposal __________________________________________
FORM No. 21.36(b)
REPORT OF OFFENCE UNDER THE MOTOR VEHICLES ACT
Counterfoil ____________ Date __________________
Serial number _______________________________
Police Station or Post _________________________
Cross reference to Intimation Book ____________
District ____________________________________________
Police Report or Complaint to a Magistrate for action
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Name Tempora Permane Whether Date on Number Registere Section Brief Names
and post- ry nt the which of d and rule description of and
ing of address address accused the driving number the charge and address of
the offi- of of is in accused licence of the any
cer mak- accused accused custody, is sent with vehicle circumstances witnesses
ing the on bail or required challan under which
com- recognizan to or the the offence was
plaint or ce or has attend driver’s committed
report been court number
otherwise in the
intimated case of
tongas

Fordwarded to _________________ (Incharge of the Traffic Staff)


(Signature) ____________________________
(Station House Officer)
Forwarded to ___________________ Magistrate _______________________
Prosecuting Deputy Superintendent of Police
-----------------------------------------------------------
Prosecuting Inspector of Police
Class __________________________ through the----------------------------------------------------------------
Prosecuting Sub-Inspector of Police
The accused has has the following convictions on record______________________________
Signature ______________________________
582 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

(Officer-in-charge of the Traffic Staff)


Foil ___________________________________________________
Serial No. ______________________________________________
Cross reference to form L. Tem (Police) _____________________
Name and posting of officer making the complaint or report ______
Name of accused ________________________________________
Temporary address of the accused __________________________
Permanent address of the accused ____________________________
No. of any driving licence impounded ________________________
Registered number of vehicle _______________________________
Number of original permit and Regional Transport Authority by which it was issued
____

Particulars of the offence with section and rule __________________________


Date of forwarding of report _________________________________________
Name of any witnesses ______________________________________________
REPORT OF OFFENCE UNDER THE MOTOR VEHICLES ACT
Conviction slip ________________________________________________
Serial number _______________________ Date ______________________
Result of Trial
Name of accused _______________________________________________
Temporary address of accused ____________________________________
Offence charged ________________________________________________
Order of the Court _______________________________________________
Signature ____________
(Magistrate)
Where the driving licence has been suspended, if so, for what period ___________
Whether details of section or Act and Rule have been enforsed on driving licence __
.
Returned to
(In charge of the Traffic Staff)
Signature ___________________________
Prosecuting Deputy Superintendent of Police
---------------------------------------------------------------------
Prosecuting Inspector of Police
--------------------------------------------------------------------
Prosecuting Sub-Inspector of Police
-------------------------------------------------------------------
Returned to ____________________________. The necessary entries have been made
in the Traffic Office records.
Signature _____________________________
(Officer-in-charge of the Traffic Staff)
No. _____________________
Preventive and Detective Organization 583

Name and address of accused ____________________________________


Registration number of vehicle _____________ Section and rule ________
Brief particulars of offence ______________________________________
Regional Transport Authority by which original permit was issued ______
Brief particulars of Magistrate’s order with date _____________________
Forwarded to the Regional Transport Authority _____________________
___________________________________________________for information
Superintendnet of Police,
(To be used in the case of conviction only).
FORM No. 21.37(2)(A)
Daily Diary of Inspector in charge of Range Mobile Patrol
1. Journeys performed by motor vehicle of patrol
2. Cases reported to district police
3. Cases decided with results
4. Cases in which inadequate sentences have been imposed or which have been inordinately
delayed
5. Warnings given to motorists
6. Other duties performed under rule 21.37 including attendance at court
Signature of Inspector
FORM NO. 21.37(2)(B)
Motor Lorry Working Account
Driver’s name :-
Lorry No.
Date of purchase of lorry :-
Par- Date WORK DONE *RECOVERIES FROM INDIVIDUAL
ticu- and
lars of purpose WHEN THE LORRY IS EMPLOYED
orders of FOR PRIVATE USE
(if Journey Journey Time Distance No. Date Name of Amount Amount Numbe
any) of the recoverablrecovered r and
sanc- From to Away Back Milimeter miles person e date
tion- reading travelle from of
ing d whom receipt
the recoverabl issued
Jour- e in
ney acknow
ledgem
ent
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
Before After
trip trip
584 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3,

MATERIALS AVERAGE
CONSUMPTION
Material issued to Material consumed Balance with the Petrol Mobile Grease REMAR
miles oil KS
driver by driver driver per miles
gallon per
Petrol Mobile Grease Petrol Mobile Grease Petrol Mobile Grease gallon
Oil oil oil
15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27

*N.B. - Columns 10 - 13 may be left blank unless the lorry is employed for private use.
The Police Station 585

CHAPTER 22
The Police Station
Rule 22.1

22.1. Officer in charge of police station. - (1) The officer in charge of a police station
is ordinarily a sub-inspector. Within the limits of the police station jurisdiction the sub-
inspector is primarily responsible for the effective working, management, good conduct
and discipline of the local police, for the preservation of peace and the prevention and de-
tection of crime. The due performance of all police duties, the exercise by the police of
the powers granted them by law, the correctness of all registers, records and reports pre-
pared by them, and the direction, instruction and efficiency of all police subordinates in
the station jurisdiction are matters for which the officer in charge of a police station is es-
sentially answerable.
(2) It is the duty of the officer in charge of a police station to acquire detailed and ac-
curate local knowledge, to secure the whole-hearted co- operation of his zaildars,
inamdars, village headmen and chaukidars, encouraging them to give him information,
to assist him in this work and to range themselves loyally on the side of the administra-
tion. Through them and his own subordinates he is required to keep a strict watch over
all known bad characters, and he shall communicate all intelligence of moment to his su-
periors and to other police stations without delay.
(3) Within the limits of his charge he is the chief investigating officer, and as such he
shall conduct all investigations in person, so far as circumstances permit. His responsibil-
ity in this matter must be carefully maintained. Should it be necessary, owing to the
absence of the sub- inspector or any other cause, for a subordinate to undertake an in-
vestigation, the sub-inspector shall satisfy himself by perusing the case diary and
questioning the investigating officer that the investigation has been fully and properly
conducted, shall remedy what is defective, and take over the investigation as soon as he
is free to do, so except in a case originally investigated by an assistant sub-inspector where
he will be guided by rule.
(4) When present at the police station, he shall personally supervise the routine work
of the station house, and shall be careful to see that there are no arrears of correspondence
and that the accounts are correct.
Rule 22.2

22.2. Assistant sub-inspectors. - (1) One or more assistant sub-inspectors are attached
to each police station, in proportion to the normal amount of crime registered, as subor-
dinate investigating officers. An assistant sub- inspector may be a directly appointed
probationer under training, in which case his duties will be as prescribed in Chapter XIX.
In other cases an assistant sub-inspector is the assistant and deputy of the officer in charge
of the police station, who, without detracting from his own authority or ultimate respon-
sibilities as described in rule 22.1, may delegate powers and duties generally or
specifically to one or other of his assistants, on the same principles as the Superintendent
of Police delegates authority and duties to gazetted officers subordinate to him.
(2) An assistant sub-inspector is required to have approximately the same standard of ef-
ficiency in all branches of police station work, detective, preventive and administrative,
as a sub-inspector, but his responsibilities are less, in that he is not in independent charge,
and his powers are subject to the detailed control and supervision of the sub-inspector.
In respect of investigations, the sub-inspector is required to exercise careful supervision
over the work of his assistant sub-inspector, as laid down in rule 22.1, but need not, and
should not, normally take into his own hands an investigation started by an assistant sub-
inspector, except when he finds the latter’s investigation gravely defective.
Rule 22.3

22.3. The station clerk. - The police station clerk is a literate head constable, who un-
586 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

der the control and supervision of the officer in charge of the police station, acts as clerk,
accountant, record-keeper and custodian of Government and other property at a police
station. He may be assisted by one or more assistant clerks.
Rule 22.4

22.4. Duties as a clerk. - As clerk of the police station, the station clerk performs the
following duties:-
(a) He opens, registers and hands over all correspondence to the officer in charge
of the police station or senior officer present and takes his orders for the disposal
of papers. He writes all reports and returns called for by competent authorities
and is responsible that all pending papers are promptly disposed of.
(b) Every morning he brings to the notice of the officer in charge of the station (that
is, senior officer present) all postponed orders and pending papers awaiting exe-
cution and reply. At morning roll call he records the orders of the same officer
as to the distribution of duties for the day.
(c) he writes up the daily diary and other station house registers. He sees that the
file of the Police Gazette is kept up to date, and that all orders and notices con-
tained in it, which concern the staff or the work of the staff, are carefully noted
and explained to all concerned. He registers all births and deaths reported at the
station by the village watchmen.
Rule 22.5

22.5. Duties as an accountant. - As accountant, the station clerk is responsible for the
correctness of the cash book, of the cash balance in hand, and for all accounts of receipts
or expenditure rendered to his superiors. He must, without fail, bring every item of re-
ceipt or expenditure promptly and fully to account. If any appropriation of public money
to purposes for which it was not intended occurs, or if money shown as expended is not
expended, or is expended in a different way from that shown, he is bound to report the
matter at once to the Superintendent. He will not be allowed to shield himself by pleading
the orders of a superior officer, but will be held responsible for malversations which
would not have been possible if his accounts had accurately represented the facts. He
writes out invoices, and checks and files receipts and other vouchers for payments
made. He prepares the monthly acquittance rolls and accounts of deductions and stop-
pages from pay and all travelling allowance and other claims of the officers and men of
the station concerned, and sees that acquittance rolls are duly signed and forwarded. The
duties and responsibilities of the station clerk under this rule shall not be delegated to any
other member of the police station staff.
Rule 22.6

22.6. Duties as a record-keeper. - As a record-keeper, the station clerk is responsible


that all registers and other records are safely kept and that they do not suffer injury from
damp, vermin or other cause. He periodically eliminates and sends to headquarters the
records which are no longer required to be maintained according to rule.
Rule 22.7

22.7. Duties as a custodian of property. - As custodian, the station clerk is responsible


for all Government property, including arms, ammunition, bicycles, articles of clothing
and equipment other than such as are in the personal charge of individual officers, and all
unclaimed property connected with cases, including cattle in the pound. He is in direct
charge of the store-room and shall keep the keys thereof and personally superintend all
receipts and issues therefrom. He shall also be responsible for the safe custody and diet-
ing of persons in the lock-up and shall personally keep the keys thereof.
Rule 22.8

22.8. Continuous presence at police station. - The station clerk’s duties necessitate his
continuous presence at the police station; accordingly he shall not be employed on inves-
tigation work or any other duty involving his absence from the police station for any
The Police Station 587

long period. If he leaves the station house for any purpose which is likely to prevent his
return within a few minutes on an urgent summons, or under the provisions of rule 22.42,
he shall formally make over charge to the assistant clerk and shall make an entry in the
daily diary. Similarly, on return to duty, he shall again enter the fact in the daily diary
and both entries shall be signed by the assistant clerk as evidence of his responsibility dur-
ing the absence of the station clerk. Under no circumstances shall the station clerk and
the assistant clerk be both absent from the police station at the same time.
Rule 22.9

22.9. Literate police officers. - Other literate police officers shall be employed under
the general direction of the officer in charge of the police station to assist the clerk in the
up-keep of criminal records, and to assist in the investigation of cases and the collection,
recording and dissemination of intelligence.
Rule 22.10

22.10. Watch of police stations. - (1) A standing sentry at police stations shall ordi-
narily not be posted, but at night one of the constables sleeping at the station shall be told
off by the station clerk or senior officer present to sleep in front of the door of the police
station which shall be securely fastened.
(2) In cases where the lock-up contains prisoners, or there is valuable property in the
store-room [vide rule 22.18(1)] or animals in the cattle- pound, there shall be a constable
on watch, who shall be posted with special regard to the protection of lock-up, the store-
room or the cattle pound, as the case may be, and he shall be responsible for its safe
custody. Standing orders describing the duties of the sentry in regard to the protection of
each of these three places shall be framed by the Superintendent of Police and hung up in
the police station office. The officer in charge of the police station shall read out the ap-
propriate part or parts of this standing order when allocating duties at roll call (vide rule
22.11). If the subsequent arrival of prisoners, valuable property or cattle necessitates an
extension of the duties detailed at roll call, the station clerk shall inform the constables
concerned, shall read out to them the standing order applicable and shall obtain their sig-
natures or thumb-impressions in the station diary.
(3) Ordinarily there shall be a police officer, who shall usually be the senior police of-
ficer present at the station house, available and ready in proper uniform to receive
information and complaints and to afford such assistance as may be lawful and neces-
sary; and at every post there shall be at all times one police officer in uniform in charge
of the building and property, but such police officer shall not be expected to do more than
keep on the alert.
Rule 22.11

22.11. Roll Calls. - At sunrise and at sunset the officer in charge of the police station,
i.e., the senior officer present, shall fall in all the police present at the station and hold
a roll call. At this roll call instruction shall be given in respect of all general and special
orders which may have been received from superior authority or which the officer in
charge of the police station may see fit to promulgate, and duties shall be allocated. The
police detailed for watch duty shall be under the orders of the station clerk who shall allot
particular hours of duty to each man and note the times alloted in the daily diary imme-
diately after the roll call, taking the signature or thumb-impression of each man in the
diary in token of his having been informed.
Rule 22.12

22.12. Inspection before proceeding on duty. - All officers proceeding on duty shall
appear before the senior officer present at the station, who shall satisfy himself that they
are correctly turned out and understand the duties alloted to them and who shall record
in the daily diary an entry to the effect that he has done so, giving particulars as to the men,
the duties and the time of inspection. This rule is binding on men posted on watch duty
and the entry in the daily diary in their case shall be in addition to the entry required under
rule 22.11 above.
588 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22
Rule 22.13

22.13. Parades. - The officer in charge of the police station is responsible for keeping
his staff proficient in drill and to secure this end must hold parades as frequently as pos-
sible. The small number of men available for parade in a police station is no bar to the
giving of much useful instruction.
The following portions of the Police Drill Manual, 1929, shall be taught at police sta-
tions:-
Chapter I, lecture 6 (traffic control).
Chapter IV, Sections 3, 5 to 7, 9, 12 to 21, 24 to 34, 36 to 57, 65 to 69, 74, 75, 86 to
90.
Chapter VII, physical training.
Table Card (a few exercises on each occasion). When a parade is held, a record must
be made in the daily diary in which will be incorporated a parade statement and a note
of the instruction given.
Rule 22.14

22.14. The police station lock-up. - The rules of Chapter XXVI for the control of lock-
ups and the custody and care of prisoners shall apply strictly to all police stations and
posts.
Rule 22.15

22.15. Public property. - Subject to the orders and responsiblity of the officer in
charge of the police station, the station clerk shall be considered to be in charge of all pub-
lic property including money and case property in his station house. Every officer in
charge of the station shall examine the property at least twice a month and shall report in
the following Monday’s diary that he has done so. If property is found to be incomplete
or to be in any way damaged he shall add to his report the names of the persons responsible
for the loss or damage.
He shall also see that the property in connection with a case is expeditiously disposed
of according to magisterial orders on the conclusion of the case.
All property shall be examined by officers in charge of police stations on receiving and
handing over charge and by station clerks on relief. All damages and shortages must
then the carefully noted and reported to the Superintendent of Police.
Rule 22.16

22.16. Case property. - (1) The police shall seize weapons, articles and property in
connection with criminal cases and take charge of property which may be unclaimed:-
(a) under the implied authority of Section 170, Code of Criminal Procedure ;
(b) in the course of searches made in police investigations under Sections 51, 165
and 166, Code of Criminal Procedure ;
(c) under Section 153, Code of Criminal Procedure, as regards weights, measures,
or instruments for weighing that are false;
(d) under Section 550, Code of Criminal Procedure, as regards property alleged or
suspected to have been stolen : provided that if the property consists of an ani-
mal or animals belonging to Government or to persons of good status it may be
made over to them or to a commissioned or a gazetted officer, under the orders
of a Magistrate, who is empowered to make such an order under Section 523,
Criminal Procedure Code.
(e) under Section 550, Code of Criminal Procedure, as regards property found un-
der circumstances which create suspicion of the commission of an offence;
when an offence in respect of an animal is committed and such animal is not sto-
len property such animal shall be seized and sent with the case to the magistrate
having jurisdiction;
The Police Station 589

(f) under Section 25 of the Police Act, as regards unclaimed property;


Ordinarily the police shall not take possession of movable property as unclaimed
when it is in the possession of an innocent finder; but in cities and in canton-
ments the police may, in compliance with an order issued under Section 26 or
27 of the Police Act, take possession and dispose of unclaimed property made
over to them by innocent finders.
Such property shall be entered in the store-room register, unless a special register
is prescribed for the purpose by the District Magistrate.
(g) under the provisions of Local and Special Laws.
(2) Each weapon, or article of property not being cattle, seized under the above rule,
shall be marked or labelled with the name of the person from whom, or the place where,
it was seized, and a reference to the case diary or other report submitted from the police
station.
If articles are made up into a parcel,the parcel shall be secured with sealing wax bearing
the seal impression of the responsible officer, and shall be similarly marked or labelled.
Such articles or parcels shall be placed in safe custody, pending disposal as provided by
law or rule.
Cattle shall be placed in the pound and shall be carefully described in the case diary or
other report regarding their seizure from the police station.
All expenses for feeding and watering cattle kept in the pound in connection with cases
shall invariably be recovered from the District Magistrate and not from the complainant.
(3) The police shall send to headquarters or to magisterial outposts -
(a) all weapons, articles and property connected with cases sent for trial;
(b) suspicious, unclaimed and other property, when ordered to do so by a compe-
tent magistrate.
(4) Motor vehicles detained or seized by the police in connection with cases or acci-
dents shall be produced before a magistrate after rapid investigation or by means of
incomplete challan. The evidence relating to the identity or condition of the vehicle
should be led and disposed of at an early date, and the magistrate should then be invited
to exercise the discretion vested in him by section 516-A, Code of Criminal Procedure,
to order that the vehicle be made cover to the owner pending conclusion of the case or
security to be produced whenever demanded by the Court.
Rule 22.17

22.17. Custody of money. - All Government money received in the police station and
not disbursed forthwith shall be kept in a locked box in the store-room.
Whenever the pound receipts at a police station amount for Rs. 50 or over they shall
be forwarded to the sadar or tahsil treasury, whichever may be nearer.
If large sums are taken under the Cattle Trespass Act, and it is impossible to pay in such
sums immediately to the sadar or tahsil treasury, they shall be placed in the locked box
in the store-room.
Rule 22.18

22.18. Custody of property. - (1) Property exceeding in value of Rs. 500, whether ap-
pertaining to cases, or seized on suspicion, or taken as unclaimed, shall be forwarded as
soon as possible to district headquarters for deposit in the treasury in accordance with Po-
lice Rule 27.18(2) or, in the case of property connected with a case to be tried at an
outstation or tahsil, to the tahsil treasury, where it shall be placed in the tahsil store-room
under charge of the tahsildar.
Large sums of money or valuable property of any description shall not be entrusted to
police officers below the rank of head constable.
590 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

When property is brought from outstations to headquarters at a time when the prose-
cuting inspector and sub-inspectors are engaged in court duties, the bearer shall hand it
over to the head constable acting as assistant to the prosecuting inspector under rule
27.14(4) and obtain his receipt in acknowledgement on the road certificate. When a
prosecuting officer is free, the bearer of the property shall have the road certificate coun-
tersigned by him before his return to his police station.
(2) All case property and unclaimed property, other than cattle, of which the police
have taken possession shall, if capable of being so treated, be kept in the store-room.
Otherwise the officer in charge of the police station shall make other suitable arrange-
ments for its safe custody until such time as it can be dealt with under sub-rule (1) above.
Each article shall be entered in the store-room register and labelled. The label shall
contain a reference to the entry in the store-room register and a description of the article
itself and, in the case of articles of case property, a reference to the case number. If several
articles are contained in a parcel, a detail of the articles shall be given on the label and in
the store-room register.
The officer in charge of the police station shall examine Government and other property
in the store-room at least twice a month and shall make an entry in the station diary on
the Money following the examination to the effect that he has done so.
Rule 22.19

22.19. Post Office cash safe. - Police office cash safes may be embedded in safe po-
sitions in police stations by arrangement between the Superintendent of Police and the
Superintendent of Post Office.
The police department accepts no responsibility for the safe custody of such safes and
Superintendents shall not permit them to be embedded at places where no safe accom-
modation exists.
The work of embedding shall be carried out by the postal department.
Rule 22.20

22.20. Cattle Pounds Management of. - (1) The management of cattle pounds situ-
ated at police stations shall be undertaken by the police, when the District magistrate so
requires, provided that the pay of a herdsman and an allowance of not less than two rupees
per mensem for the pound-keeper be paid by the local body, which is responsible for the
up-keep of such pounds.
(2) For each cattle-pound in charge of the police, an officer on the establishment of the
police station concerned shall be appointed pounded- keeper ex-officio. Such officer
shall ordinarily be the assistant clerk, but, in police stations where the receipts of the
pound normally exceed rupees fifty per mensem, he shall be the station clerk.
(3) The pound-keeper shall be required to have a through knowledge of the Cattle
Trespass Act (I of 1871); the rules relating to cattle pounds contained in the District
Board Account Code (Appendix 22.20), or corresponding rules in force in respect of Mu-
nicipal and Cantonment Cattle pounds; Sections 69 and 70 of the Indian Forest Act (VII
of 1878); Section 125 of the Indian Railway Act (IX of 1890) and of these rules. He
shall maintain accounts in the forms prescribed in the rules referred to above, which are
obtainable from the local body concerned, and shall observe those rules in all matters con-
nected with the management of the pound.
(4) The pound accounts shall be under the close and constant supervision of the station
clerk (where he is not himself the pound-keeper) and shall be checked at least once a
month by the officer in charge of the police station, who shall certify accordingly in the
station diary and shall countersign the monthly balance of the accounts in token of his
having satisfied himself (1) that the balance in hand has been checked; (2) that the ac-
counts are on the face of them being properly kept; and (3) that the signature or initials
The Police Station 591

of the pound-keeper are in their required places. Net receipts shall be credited at least
once a month in the nearest sub- treasury.
(5) Bills for miscellaneous expenses incurred by the police in connection with cattle
pounds, e.g., emergent repairs, cost of locks, ropes, etc., shall be submitted, as the charges
are incurred, to the Superintendent of Police, in form 10.33(1) to be dealt with by him as
prescribed in Rule 10.109(2).
(6) The lists of fines and of the rates authorized to be charged for feeding and watering
impounded animals are required to be displayed conspicuously at every pound. Failure
to keep this notice so displayed and legible, and neglect to water and feed impounded ani-
mals to the full extent which the sanctioned rates permit, are offences, under Section 27
of the Cattle Trespass Act and render the pound-keeper liable, in addition to any other
penalty under any other law or under police rules, to a fine of fifty rupees. This liability
falls upon the pound-keeper and not upon the herdsman.
Rule 22.21

22.21. Cattle in the custody of the police. - (1) Cattle seized as suspicious or stolen
property, held by the police by order of a Court under Section 88, Criminal Procedure
Code, or otherwise received into police custody under competent authority, may be
placed in the pound, and shall be fed at the rates prescribed for impounded cattle. Keepers
of pounds which are not in charge of the police are bound to receive such cattle.
When there is any risk of an attempt being made unlawfully to remove or to rescue such
cattle, a police guard shall be posted on the pound, or the cattle shall be removed to such
place within or in the immediate vicinity of the police station precincts as the officer in
charge considers most suitable for their adequate protection.
(2) Entries in respect of cattle placed in the pound under this rule shall be made in red
ink and any expenses incurred shall be recovered by means of judicial bills in form
10.109(1) through the prosecuting inspector, and shall not be included in the totals of the
pound accounts.
Rule 22.22

22.22. Miscellaneous provisions regarding pounds. - (1) A brief note of the circum-
stances under which a seizure was made and animals impounded shall be entered in the
‘‘remarks’’ column of the register. If any seizure appears to have been illegally made, the
pound-keeper shall take the orders of the officer in charge of the police station before im-
pounding the animal or animals concerned.
(2) Pound registers shall be destroyed three years after the date of last entry in them.
(3) Special attention of all police officers is drawn to Section 19 of the Cattle Trespass
Act, forbidding any purchase by them, directly or indirectly, at a sale held under the Act.
Rule 22.23

22.23. Special procedure in regard to animals of value. - (1) When an animal which
is clearly of more than ordinary value is impounded and the owner cannot be immedi-
ately ascertained, the officer in charge of the police station shall issue special notices, in
the form of a copy of columns 1 to 7 of the pound register, (a) to the Superintendent of
Police, (b) to all adjacent police stations, whether within or without the district, (c) to the
owners or managers of important farms or breeding establishments, and the officers in
charge of veterinary establishments, remount depots, etc., in the neighbourhood, and take
all other reasonable measures, which the circumstances of the case may suggest, to give
the owner an opportunity of reclaiming his animal. If the animal in question is branded,
the department or private owner, to whom the brand is believed to belong, shall be in-
formed.
(2) Animals in respect of which notices as above have been issued shall not be sold till
at least twelve days after the issue of such notices.
592 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22
Rule 22.24

22.24. Supervision by superior officers. - Officers in charge of police stations shall


be held strictly responsible, in so far as their other duties permit, for ensuring that the sums
recovered on account of feeding charges are actually spent by the pound-keeper on wa-
tering and feeding impounded animals. No exact account of such expenditure is
prescribed, as the conditions for obtaining suitable fodder vary according to localities
and the various kinds of animals. Superintendents and all inspecting officers are, how-
ever, specially enjoined to pay particular attention to ensuring (a) that rates suitable to the
prevailing prices in each locality are sanctioned; (b) that animals are properly cared for
while in the pound, and that misappropriation by the pound-keeper and herdsman of the
charges levied is prevented. All cases of neglect of animals in the pound shall be severely
punished departmentally, apart from any action which may be taken under Section 127 of
the Act.
Rule 22.25

22.25. Beat and patrolling duties. - The orders in connection with beat and patrolling
duties are contained in Rule 21.34.
Rule 22.26

22.26. Troops and encamping grounds. - (1) The memorandum of instructions for
Collectors and Deputy Commissioners with regard to troops marching through districts
under their jurisdictions is given in Appendix 22.26
(2) The reports made under paragraph 1(iv) of the memorandum shall, if made by a po-
lice officer, be made through the Superintendent of Police, and the District Magistrate
of the district concerned.
(3) If, under the terms of the memorandum, a police officer is not appointed for duty,
the Superintendent of Police may, if he considers it desirable, appoint a police officer of
suitable rank to accompany the troops. His duties shall, however, be strictly confined to
co-operation with the local police in the prevention and detection of crime. He shall re-
port to the officer in command of the troops and keep him informed of the measures
adopted.
(4) Officers in charge of police stations or, in the absence of the officer in charge, the
senior officer available shall also pay their respects to officers commanding troops on the
march through their jurisdiction.
(5) Officers is charge of police stations, and the headmen and watchmen of villages in
the neighbourhood, shall be held responsible that all possible measures are taken to ren-
der camping grounds safe and free from thieves. Bad characters found in suspicious
circumstances in the vicinity shall be dealt with under the preventive sections of the Code
of Criminal Procedure.
(6) Officers in charge of police stations within the jurisdiction of which troops are en-
camped for training shall report to the officer commanding. They shall make all
necessary arrangements to keep the camp free from thieves but they need not remain in
attendance.
Rule 22.27

22.27. Field firing by troops. - When, under arrangements approved by the Deputy
Commissioner concerned, the military authorities conduct field firing or artillery prac-
tices, they are required by military orders, approved by Government, to provide troops to
clear and keep the ground. Police shall not be supplied for this duty. The police are fur-
ther forbidden to take any part in securing the evacuation of villages or confinement of
people to their houses in connection with such practices. Such action, when ordered by
the Deputy Commissioner, shall be carried out by revenue officers and village officials.
(Police Gazette Memo. No. 5932-23-31.25 of 29th June, 1925).
The Police Station 593
Rule 22.28

22.28. Duties at ferries. - (1) Police officers stationed at ferries shall afford such
lawful assistance as may be necessary to secure obedience to the rules framed under Act
XVII of 1878 for the regulation of traffic and shall prevent the overloading and over-
crowding of ferry boats.
(2) Superior police officers shall, from time to time, visit ferries and ensure that the
police understand the rules and their duties in relation to them.
Rule 22.29

22.29. Religious processions. - The orders relating to periodical religious processions


are contained in Rule 21.22.
Rule 22.30

22.30. Dramatic performance and cinematograph displays. - (1) Whenever a dra-


matic performance is about to take place the officer in charge of the local police station
shall be responsible that all tents, booths and other temporary structures erected for pub-
lic performances are inspected before they are opened to the public.
Such structures must have proper facilities for rapid egress and for the prevention and
extinction of fire, and must be so placed that there is no danger of fire from adjacent
buildings.
(2) If the arrangements appear to be insufficient, immediate report shall be made to the
senior magistrate present at the place in question, or in whose jurisdiction the structures
have been erected.
(3) The Superintendent shall report to the District Magistrate any defects in buildings
commonly used for public performances which are likely to endanger human life.
(4) The rules made by the Punjab Government under Section 8(2)(a) and (c) of the
Cinematograph Act, 11 of 1918, include the following :-
(i) No building shall be used for cinematograph or other exhibition unless it be pro-
vided with sufficient exits of at least 7 x 5 size.
(ii) Space for accommodation shall be not less than 100 square feet per 25 persons.
(iii) Fire appliances shall be provided.
(iv) The cinematograph apparatus shall be in an enclosure of substantial construc-
tion made of, or lined internally with fire resisting material. In the case of build-
ings used habitually for cinematograph or other similar exhibition this enclosure
shall be outside the auditorium.
(v) The license and plan (of the building) and description or any of them shall be
produced on demand to a police officer of or above the rank of sub-inspector.
(vi) The Superintendent of Police or an officer deputed in this behalf by him may,
at any time, inspect the films which it is proposed to exhibit.
The exhibition of any film which has not been licensed for exhibition, or which has
been banned by the local Government, and any breach of the rules above referred to, shall
be brought to the notice of the District Magistrate for action under Section 6 of the Act.
Rule 23.31

23.31. Foundlings. - If a child deserted by his parents or guardian is found by a police


officer or brought to a police station by a person who is under no legal obligation to main-
tain it, and who is unwilling to take care of it, such child shall be cared for at the police
station and brought before the local Magistrate as soon as possible. The orders of such
Magistrate shall be taken as to the disposal of the child, and any reasonable expenditure,
not exceeding four annas per diem incurred from the permanent advance of the police
station for the maintenance of the child, shall be recovered from the Court. Should the de-
lay in bringing in child before the local Magistrate amount to more than a few hours,
advantage shall be taken of the existence of any orphanage or other charitable institution
594 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

which may be willing to shelter the child until it is finally disposed of by the magistrate’s
order.
Rule 22.32

22.32. Soldiers on shooting permit. - Rules relating to game shooting by British sol-
diers and to the grant of shooting passes are contained in Appendix XXXV, Army
Regulations, India, Volume II and are also issued in pamphlet form to all units of the Brit-
ish Army in India.
Under these rules, (1) no soldier is permitted to carry firearms for shooting purposes or
join a shooting party without being in possession of an arms licence and a shooting pass
(Indian Army Form L-1181); (2) on the pass granted to a shooting party will be endorsed
the localities where shooting is forbidden; (3) all soldiers have received instructions (a)
not to shoot within 500 yards of any village, house, temple or enclosure, (b) not to shoot
hinds, does, monkeys, dogs, peafowl or pig (except by special permission); (c) not to en-
ter any village, speak to any Indian woman or child, use any bucket for drawing water
from wells or shoot birds alighting on pipal or other sacred trees.
The following are the orders of the Government of India to the civil and political
authorities in connection with the foregoing rules:-
(i) The civil authorities will periodically explain the substance of the rules and or-
ders in simple language to the inhabitants of all villages and tracts where British
soldiers are in the habit of shooting, warning them that soldiers are on no ac-
count to be attacked or molested, and that any such offences will be severely
punished. The inhabitants, therefore, will have no excuse for interfering unwar-
rantably with members of a shooting party.
(ii) The district or political officer will impress on zemindars, headmen, landlords
and police, that they must use their endeavours to prevent disputes with, or the
molestation of, any members of a shooting party, and that complaints are to be
reported to the proper authorities by the villagers, who must not take the law
into their own hands.
(iii) When the district or political officer receives notice, under Rule 17 of the prob-
able visit of a shooting party, he will at once inform the head men and village
police.
(iv) The district or political officer will, on the arrival of troops in a civil district or
Indian State, at once inform the officer commanding such troops of the prohib-
ited localities, animals and birds and of any special civil rules pertaining to the
district.
(v) When a complaint is made by a villager against any member of a shooting party
the district or political officer will at once report the matter to the officer com-
manding of the soldiers concerned.
(vi) If possible, disputes between members of a shooting party and villagers will be
investigated by a European Magistrate or police officer not below the rank of
Superintendent, and such cases will be tried by a district or joint Magistrate.
The officer commanding concerned will be informed by the district officer of
cases not cognizable by the police or where prosecution is not undertaken by
the civil authorities. The officer commanding will thereupon take such action
as may be necessary.
(vii) The rules for soldiers provide for the punishment of a corps or detachment, or
district in the event of the offenders, not being discovered. A similar responsi-
bility may be enforced upon villages where affray with British soldiers have oc-
curred, if the villagers generally, or a considerable number of them, have made
an unwarranted attack upon a shooting party, but the actual offenders have not
been brought to justice. The villagers will be warned that in all such cases they
are liable by law to have extra police quartered upon them at their own expense.
The Police Station 595
Rule 22.33

22.33. Destruction of snakes and wild animals. - (1) Under the orders contained in
Punjab Government Consolidated Circular 39 allotments as permanent advances are
made by District Boards to all police stations to enable the officer in charge to pay the
prescribed rewards for killing snakes. These advances will be re-couped on the submis-
sion, through the Superintendent of Police, to the District Board, of statements of
accounts showing the name, caste and residence of payees, the amount paid and the num-
ber and description of dead snakes brought in.
(2) The amounts authorised as rewards are Re. 0-4-0 for a cobra and Re. 0-2-0 for a
karait. In the absence of a special local orders no reward is payable for the killing of any
other kind of snake. Officers in charge of police stations are required to satisfy them-
selves before making disbursements, that the snake killed is of a species for which a
reward is authorised. To assist in this every police station has been supplied with a book
of coloured plates of the poisonous snakes common in Punjab; application for the re-
placement of these plates should be made, where necessary to the District Board.
Inspecting officers shall check the proper carrying out of these orders.
(3) The payment of rewards for killing certain wild animals is also authorised. Claim-
ants should be required to present themselves with the heads and skins of the animal on
account of which a claim is made at the office of the Deputy Commissioner.
Rule 22.34

22.34. Destruction of ownerless dogs. - Under section 109 of the Punjab Municipal
Act (III of 1911) municipal committees have power to order the destruction of any dog
or other animal suffering, or reasonably suspected to be suffering, from rabies. They also
have power to issue a standing order for the destruction of all dogs without collars found
wondering about streets. The police shall not act as agents for the destruction of such
dogs but shall support the authority of any agents appointed for the purpose by the mu-
nicipal committees.
Rule 22.35

22.35. Recovery of dead bodies from canals. - Under rule 15.16 any person taking
a corpse out of a canal or river, or causing it to be taken out and delivering it to a head-
man of a village, is entitled to a reward of Rs. 10. Such sums shall be paid at once by
officers in charge of police station from the permanent advance and recovered at once on
simple bills from the Superintendent of Police.
Rule 22.36

22.36. Duties in connection with epidemic diseases. - (1) On the appearance of chol-
era, plague, small-pox or any other disease in epidemic form, or unusual mortality
amongst rats in any police station jurisdiction, the officer in charge of the police station
shall at once inform the Superintendent of Police, the District Medical Officer of Health
and the Medical Officer of the nearest dispensary.
(2) After the first report regarding the out-break of cholera, plague, small-pox or other
infectious disease has been made, the watchmen of infected villages shall continue to
make, as long as the villages remain infected, weekly reports at the police station of the
number of cases and deaths; and the officer in charge of the police station shall transmit
this information weekly to the District medical Officer of Health.
(3) If and when an alternative reporting agency has been established, these weekly re-
ports shall be discontinued, but where required they shall be submitted on stamped
addressed postcards supplied by the Districts Medical Officers of Health for the purpose.
(4) On receipt of information as in sub-rule (1) the Superintendent of Police shall also
notify the District Medical Officer of Health (or in his absence, the Civil Surgeon) and
shall inform the Inspector General of Police by telegram.
596 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22
Rule 22.37

22.37. Additions and alterations to buildings. - (1) Officers in charge of police sta-
tions shall not permit any additions or alterations to existing buildings without the
previous sanction of the Superintendent of Police.
(2) Orders relating to the construction of prayer platforms at police stations are con-
tained in Chapter III.
Rule 22.38

22.38. Diet of accused person. - The rules for the provision of diet at police stations
to accused persons and for the recovery of expenses in this connection are contained in
rules 26.27 and 10.109(1).
Rule 22.39

22.39. Advance of diet money to witnesses. - The rules for the advance at police sta-
tions of diet money to witnesses, and for the recovery of such advances are contained in
rule 27.28.
Rule 22.40

22.40. Charges of animals connected with cases. - Complainants in cattle theft cases,
or sureties to whom cattle have been made over for safe custody and production if and
when required during police investigation, shall receive the cost of maintaining animals
connected with the cases. The rate sanctioned for each day and for each day’s journey
are fixed by the Deputy Commissioner, with the approval of the Provincial Government,
subject to the proviso that the complainant has travelled, or has been detained in the in-
terests of the case at a place, more than five miles from his home.
Superintendents of Police shall provide lists showing the rates for each animal and these
lists shall be hung up in the police station office.
Claims for payment of these charges shall be made in Form 22.40. The amount due to
a complainant or to a surety shall be entered in the form and submitted to district head-
quarters with the chalan or final report in the case. Money shall be recovered from the
allotment for ‘‘Rewards to private persons’’ and remitted to the police station concerned
for prompt payment.
Rule 22.41

22.41. Kits of men on casual leave. - When an officer proceeds on casual leave from
the police station he shall hand over the Government property in his possession to the sta-
tion clerk who shall at once prepare a list of all articles. The kit will be folded and kept
in the store-room. The station clerk is responsible for its safe custody. When the officer
in charge of the police station himself proceeds on casual leave he shall hand over all
Government property for which he is responsible to the officer appointed to act for him,
such property as is not required by the latter for current use being placed in the store-room.
See also rule 6.11(3) regarding the disposal of revolvers by officers proceeding on
leave.
Rule 22.42

22.42. Married police officers. - (1) Married quarters are provided in most police sta-
tions in accordance with rule 3.19. Officers to whom these quarters are allotted may sleep
in them, provided that they are not on watch or sentry duty or required to be in the police
station building for any reason.
(2) At police stations where family quarters are provided up to the maximum scale laid
down in rule 3.19 no other police officers shall be allowed to have rented accommodation
elsewhere.
At police stations where family quarters have not been provided up to the maximum
scale laid down in rule 3.19 the number of officers permitted to occupy quarters outside
the police station shall not exceed such scale.
The Police Station 597

(3) A list of married police officers attached to each police station and its subordinate
posts shall be maintained in the police station.
Rule 22.43

22.43. Despatch of money, property and prisoners. - (1) Police escorts incharge of
money, property or prisoners, and police officers performing other duties shall ordinarily
travel by rail. For journeys, however, both within and beyond the sphere of duty between
places not connected by rail, or between places connected by road and rail, where the road
journey is the shorter, or the rail journey although shorter in distance would cause inor-
dinate delay, police officers below the rank of Inspector may, in cases to be certified as
necessary by the Superintendents of Police, travel by motor omnibus or other road con-
veyance.
(2) The cost of such journeys shall be met under the provisions of the Travelling Allow-
ance Rules. In the case of constables the amount shall be drawn on a contingent bill and
met from the head Carriage of Constabulary. In the case of other officers it shall be drawn
on an abstract travelling allowance bill, to be supported subsequently by a detailed bill.
The drawing officer shall record on each bill a certificate to the effect that the journeys
were performed in the public interest and that travelling allowance was admissible in ac-
cordance with note I of Exception V in Appendix E(5) of the Punjab Financial Hand
Book No. 2 (Volume III - Travelling Allowance Rules).
All such bills relating to journeys within the sphere of duty (except those for Carriage
of Constabulary) shall be countersigned by the Deputy Inspector- General of Police, who
shall among other things satisfy himself that the drawing officer has not given his certifi-
cate as a mere matter of form, but that the saving of time or other considerations actually
justified the performance of the journey by road in the public interest.
Travelling allowance bills for journeys beyond the sphere of duty will be countersigned
by Superintendents of Police.
(3) Police officers up to and including the rank of Sub Inspector who travel by motor
omnibus shall be provided with a lorry voucher in form 22.43(3) which shall be handed
over to the owner or conductor. The owner of the motor omnibus will submit all such
vouchers to the Superintendent of Police for payment. Separate vouchers stations are pro-
vided with books of voucher forms, adapted for the carbon copying process. Three copies
shall be prepared one being made over to the officer who is to travel, one being submitted
to the Superintendent of Police and the third being retained for record at the police station.
The Superintendent of Police will make payment after checking the vouchers with the
daily diary of the police station concerned and comparing the dates.
(4) Ordinarily only the number of seats actually required for the escort and their charges
shall be engaged. Only in the most urgent circumstances shall a whole vehicle be char-
tered by any police officer.
(5) Where under-trial prisoners are conveyed by motor omnibus separate sets of
vouchers shall be prepared for the police escort and for the prisoners. The cost of the latter
will be met from judicial funds on its presentation by the Prosecuting Inspector to the
court concerned.
(6) The rates to be charged by motor transport companies or private omnibus owners
shall be standardized as far as possible. Wherever possible contracts for the carriage of
constabulary shall be entered into.
Note. - The rules as revised will have effect from 25th July, 1933.
(7) The lorry voucher books on receipt from the Controller, Printing and Stationery De-
partment, Punjab, shall be entered in the stock register of printed forms as required by
Police Rule 11.49, and made over to the Head Clerk who shall be responsible for their
safe custody. He shall keep them in a locked almirah, the keys of which shall, in no case,
be transferred to any other person, and shall invariably certify the balance in hand when
598 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

issues are made. In Police Lines the voucher books shall be kept in the personal custody
of the Lines Officer who shall be responsible for the issue of vouchers to Police Officers.
In Police Stations the voucher books shall be kept in the personal custody of the Station
Clerk, but vouchers shall issue only under the instructions of the officer in charge of the
Police Station.
Rule 22.44

22.44. Notices and notice-boards. - (1) Only such notices as are required by rule or
by special order of the Superintendent of Police to be hung at police stations are to be so
displayed.
(2) Notice-boards at police stations shall be used solely for the display of police and
other official notices. Public notices by local bodies may displayed on such boards with
the permission of the officer in charge of the police station, but their use for private or
trade announcements and advertisements is strictly prohibited.
Rule 22.45

22.45. Registers. - The following books shall be maintained at each police station in ac-
cordance with the rules hereinafter prescribed or referred to :-
(1) The first Information Report Register and, in certain stations the Register of
Petty Offences.
(2) The Station Diary.
(3) Part I. Standing Order Book
Part II. Circular and others orders.
(4) Register of Absconders and Deserters.
(5) Register of Correspondence.
(6) Miscellaneous Register.
(7) Cattle Pound Register.
(8) Criminal Tribes Register.
(9) The Village Crime Register.
(10) The Surveillance Register.
(10) (A) Bad Character Rolls despatched.
(10) (B) Bad Character Rolls received.
(11) Index to History Sheets and Personal Files.
(12) Register of information sheets despatched.
(A) Copies of Information sheets received.
(13) Minute Book for Gazetted Officers.
(14) File Book of Inspection Reports.
(15) The Register of Births and Deaths.
(16) Register of Government Officials and Property.
(17) Register of Licenses.
(18) Receipts Books of Arms, Ammunition and military stores.
(19) The Store Room Register.
(20) Cash Accounts.
(21) File Book of Road Certificates.
(22) Printed Receipt Books.
(23) (A) Police Gazette.
(23) (B) Criminal Intelligence Gazette.
The Police Station 599

(24) Police Rules.


(25) Charge notes of officers in charge of police stations.
Rule 22.46

22.46. General orders regarding station registers. - (1) No alteration in the form or
method of keeping the books and no addition to their number may be made without the
sanction of the Inspector General being previously obtained.
(2) Every station register shall be paged in English. In the case of all registers except
Parts I, II, III and IV of register No. (9) and registers 10(B), II and 12(A) this shall be done
in the office of the Superintendent before issue to a police station. No page may be torn
out of the station registers. Any correction which it may be necessary to make shall be
made by drawing a line through the mistake so as to leave the words erased legible and
by writing in the corrected words afterwards or in the margin. A piece of paper shall not
be pasted over a mistake.
(3) All entries shall be neatly and clearly written and all corrections shall be attested by
the signature of the officer making them. If words or lines are omitted form any entry, or
if any entry is omitted altogether, no interpolation shall be made. The omission shall be
supplied by a fresh entry in the regular course. English figures alone shall be used in all
official papers and registers.
Note. - Seals of a uniform pattern have been provided for each police station and for the offices of
Superintendents and Deputy Inspectors-General and no deviations shall be allowed from the
sanctioned design when seals are renewed from contingencies, or new seals are procured for
additional stations.
Rule 22.47

22.47. Register No. I. - The orders regarding the First Information Report Register
are contained in rule 24.5 and regarding the Petty Offences Register in rule 24.9.
Rule 22.48

22.48. Register No. II. - (1) The Daily Diary shall be maintained in accordance with
section 44 of the Police Act. It shall be in Form 22.48(1) and shall be maintained by
means of carbon copying process. There shall be two copies. One will remain in the po-
lice station register and the other shall be despatched to a Gazetted Officer to be
designated by the Superintendent of Police or to the Superintendent of Police himself
every day at the hour fixed in this behalf.
Shortly before the close of each quarter, books containing the proper number of pages
for the ensuing three months shall be issued to police stations by the Superintendent. The
Superintendent shall fix the hours at which station diaries shall be daily closed with ref-
erence to the hour of despatch of the post or messenger.
(2) All entries in the station diary shall be made by the officer in charge of the police
station or by the station clerk. Literate officers making a report shall read the report re-
corded and append their signatures. Every matter recorded in such diary shall be so
recorded as soon as possible; each separate entry shall be numbered and the hour at
which it was made shall commence each such entry. If the hour at which the information,
or otherwise, containing such entries reaches the police station differs from the hour at
which such entry was made, both hours shall be stated. As soon as entry has been made
in the diary, a line shall be drawn across the page immediately below it.
(3) The opening entry each day shall give the name of each person in custody, the of-
fence of which he is accused, and the date and hour of his arrest, the name of each
accused person at large on bail or recognizance and the date of his release on such secu-
rity.
The last entry each day shall show (a) the balance of cash in hand as shown in the cash
account, and (b) the balance of the cattle-pound account.
600 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22
Rule 22.49

22.49. - Matters to be entered in Register No. II - The following matters shall,


amongst others, be entered :-
(a) The number and description of cattle seized in connection with cases or on sus-
picion with a reference to the case or report.
(b) The day, hour and purpose of visits to the police station of persons registered un-
der the Criminal Tribes Act and of convicts released under the Remission Rules
or under section 565, Code of Criminal Procedure, together with the names of
such persons.
(c) The hour of arrival and departure on duty at or from a police station of all en-
rolled police officers of whatever rank, whether posted at the police station or
elsewhere, with a statement of the nature of their duty. This entry shall be made
immediately on arrival or prior to the departure of the officer concerned and
shall be attested by the latter personally by signature or seal.
Note. - The term Police Station will include all places such as Police Lines and Police Posts where
Register No. II is maintained.
(d) Every police officer of or above the rank of head constable, when returning from
duty other than an investigation in which case diaries are submitted, shall have
an entry made in the daily diary by the station clerk or his assistant showing the
places he has visited and the duties performed by him during his absence from
the police station.
(e) All admission to and releases from the cattle pound with the amounts of fines re-
alised.
(f) The hour of receipt and despatch of all communications, property, cash, etc., giv-
ing reference to the number in the correspondence register.
Note. - The word ‘‘communications’’ shall be taken to include the reports required by Police Rule
25.57(2)(ii) and Police Rule 27.1(1)(ii), to be sent to Panchayats.
(g) Information of the commission of non-cognizable offences (rule 24.3) includ-
ing reports of enmities likely to lead to a breach of the peace (rule 23.32); visits
of chaukidars to police stations [rule 21.3(4)] and demands by the police of one
jurisdiction for assistance in extradition cases from the police of another juris-
diction [rule 26.10(7)].
(h) All arrivals at, and dispatches from, the police station of persons in custody, and
all admissions to, and removals from, the police station lock-ups, whether tem-
porary or otherwise, the exact hour being given in every case.
(i) The hour and date of receipt and (separately) or service or execution of each
process; and hour and date of return made to such process.
(j) The report regarding property in the store-room required by rules 22.15 and
22.18(2).
(k) The report regarding excess of expenditure over the permanent advance as re-
quired by rule 22.71.
(l) The entrance of persons, by permission, into a tahsil treasury after office hours.
(m) The deposit in, or removal from, the post office safe in the Police Station of any
article whatsoever the exact hour being given in every case.
Note. - Every such entry shall contain detail of the article deposited or removed and shall be signed
by the Sub or Branch Postmaster effecting the deposit or removal.
(n) A reference to every information relating to the commission of a cognizable of-
fence, and action is taken under section 157, Code of Criminal Procedure, the
number and date of the first information report submitted.
Note. - In case where the information relates to the commission of cognizable offence triable by
a Panchayat, mention shall also be made in the Daily Diary of the measures taken to send a
The Police Station 601

copy of the first information report to the Panchayat concerned as required by Police Rule
24.5(2).
(o) In Monday’s diary a list shall be given of all papers pending for over a week.
Rule 22.50

22.50 Punishment for making false entry. - Any police officer who enters or causes
to be entered in the daily diary a report which he knows, or has reason to believe, to be
untrue, whether he has or has not been directed to make such entry by a superior officer,
shall ordinarily be dismissed from service.
A copy of this rule and also a copy of the following certificate shall be affixed to the
cover of the daily diary in every police station or post and in lines.
‘‘Certified that this register contains - leaves in duplicate. No page should be re-
moved from it. Wrong entries, if any, should be scored out by means of single
line and initialed by a Senior Police Officer, in no case should any such entry be
mutilated or rendered illegible nor should paper be pasted over it.’’
Rule 22.51

22.51. Destruction of daily diaries. - Daily diaries may be destroyed two years after
the date of the last entry.
Rule 22.52

22.52. Copies of certain entries to be sent to orderly head constable. - (1) A copy
of extract of the relevant portions of every entry in the daily diary relating to the arrival
or departure report of any police officer posted to, or transferred from, the police station
or a post subordinate thereto, shall be sent without delay to the orderly head constable.
Copies of the reports of the deaths, admission to and discharge from hospital of police of-
ficer attached to the police station, or its subordinate posts, shall be similarly sent.
(2) All copies required to be made of entries in the daily diary by this or any other rule
shall be made at the time of original entry by means of the carbon copying process, as
many sheets of paper being inserted under carbon paper as may be required.
Rule 22.53

22.53. Register No. III. - Part I. - All standing orders by the Inspector- General, Deputy
Inspector-General or Superintendent shall be entered in a file book which shall be of the
size of a quarter sheet of country paper. These standing orders shall be continuous for five
years and the file shall be indexed. These orders will be checked annually in accordance
with rule 14.55.
Part II. - In each police station an annual file shall be maintained of all circular and
other orders issued for the instruction and guidance of the police and not being standing
orders or orders on which a reply is returned in original. Each paper before being placed
on this file shall receive a registration number in the correspondence register, where the
subject and the fact of its being placed in the file shall be noted. These files shall be de-
stroyed after two years.
Rule 22.54

22.54. Register No. IV. Absconders and deserters. - In addition to the list of all pro-
claimed offenders to be hung up in the office and on the notice-board of police stations
in accordance with rule 23.25, the register of absconders shall be maintained in the fol-
lowing parts:-
Part I. - In Form 22.54(a) containing the names of all absconders in cases registered
in the home police station.
Part II. - In Form 22.54(a) containing the names of absconders in cases registered
in other police stations, but resident of or likely to visit the home police station.
Note. - All entries regarding residents of the home police station shall be made in red ink.
Part III. - List of deserters from the army, in Form 26.16(6)
602 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

Part IV. - A list in Form 22.54(b) of all absconding members of registered criminal
tribes resident of the police station or who were originally registered at the po-
lice station. In this connection see rule 23.24(3).
As soon as an absconder has been proclaimed under section 87, Code of Criminal Pro-
cedure, his name shall also be entered among the proclaimed offenders in Part I of
Register No. X.
Rule 22.55

22.55. Register No. V. - The correspondence register shall be maintained in two parts
in Form 22.55. Each part shall contain 400 pages.
(1) In Part I shall be entered a brief abstract of all reports and orders received at the
police station and of all letters and replies despatched which are not entered in
any other book.
(2) When any entry is made in the receipt columns the corresponding despatch col-
umn shall be left blank for the reply and vice versa.
This register is a receipt and despatch register and is not meant as a record of the full
correspondence. Correspondence received and not meant to be forwarded or
returned shall be filed in monthly files. These shall be destroyed after two
years.
(3) In Part II the receipt and return of processes shall be entered.
Processes include-
(a) Summonses to appear or to produce.
(b) Warrants of arrests.
(c) Search warrants.
(d) Orders of proclamation, attachment, injunction or otherwise under sections 87,
88, 95, 99, 133, 140, 143, 144 and 145, Code of Criminal Procedure.
Warrants in all non-cognizable criminal cases and summonses in non-cognizable
criminal cases in which Government is the complainant are served through the police.
On the last day in each month a statement giving the following information shall be en-
tered in the daily diary and sidelined in red ink:-
(a) The number of warrants remaining un-executed at the end of the previous
month, received and executed during the current month and remaining unexe-
cuted at the end of it.
(b) Similar information regarding summonses in cognizable and non- cognizable
cases.
(c) Similar information regarding other processes.
At the end of the year any statistics required shall be compiled from such entries in the
daily diary.
Rule 22.56

22.56. Register No. VI. - This register shall be divided into four parts :-
Part I. - List of character rolls of applicants for Government service verified by the
police in Form 22.56(1).
Part II. - List of persons on security in form 27.16(6).
Note. - Particulars of arrest under section 109, Code of Criminal Procedure, of persons who are
residents of another police station shall be entered in red ink and given a separate serial num-
ber, the form being completed when the result of the case is intimated by the persecuting
agency.
Part III. - Carbon copies of all reports submitted for action under the Indian Penal
Code and Criminal Procedure Code or local and special laws such as prosecu-
tions under section 182, Indian Penal Code, preventive security under the
The Police Station 603

Criminal Procedure Code or action against village officials under the Punjab
Laws Act when no first information report or charge-sheet is submitted.
Part IV. - Carbon copies of reports of investigation into accidental deaths of human
beings in which forms 25.35(1) A, B and C, are submitted. A yearly index will
be maintained for this part.
This register may be destroyed seven years after the date of the last entry.
Rule 22.57

22.57. Register No. VII. - (1) The cattle-pound register is printed and supplied by the
local bodies concerned and is divided into two parts:-
Part I. - The register of impounded cattle.
Part II. - The cash account.
(2) A book of receipts is also supplied to the pound-keeper who shall give a receipt
to ever seizure or to his agent who brings cattle to the pound.
The instructions contained in rule 22.20 and in the extracts from the District Board Ac-
count Code, 1926, Appendix 22.20, shall be strictly followed in maintaining these
registers.
Rule 22.58

22.58. - Register Nos. VIII(A) and (B). - Register VIII(A) - Adult Criminal Tribes
Register. - This register shall be maintained in Form 22.58(A) for all adult members of
criminal tribes whose registration has been ordered under section 4 of Act VI of 1924. In
the cases of those members concerning whom a further notification has issued under sec-
tion 10 of the Act, a note to this effect will be entered in column 10 of the form. Column
7 will be left blank except in the case of those persons whose restriction has been ordered
under section 11 of the Act. As history sheets are not usually maintained for registered
members of criminal tribes it is essential that as much information as possible concerning
each member should be mentioned in column 10.
The register shall be maintained in as many parts as there are tribes and further sub-di-
vided into sub-parts according to residence under rule 23.28. Care must be taken to allow
a sufficient number of blank sheets at the end of each sub-part for persons whose regis-
tration may have to be effected after the preparation of the register has been completed.
Register VIII-B - Register of male children of members of criminal tribes. - This register
shall be maintained by tribes in Form 22.58(B) for male children under 12 years in the
case of wandering tribes and under 18 years in the case of settled tribes notified as crimi-
nal under section 3 of Act VI of 1924. Sons of both exempted and registered members of
criminal tribes shall be entered in this register as soon as their birth is reported and inti-
mation sent to the Superintendent of Police at headquarters to enable an entry also to be
made in the make juveniles register maintained in English in Form 22.58(C), in the Dis-
trict Police Office.
Officers in charge of the police stations will report to the Superintendent particulars of
male children who attain the age of 12 years in the case of wandering tribes and 18 years
in the case of settled tribes with a view to their registration and entry in the Adult Crimi-
nal Tribes Register. Such registration shall not, however, be carried out in the case of
privileged persons as defined in rule 4 of the rules made under the Criminal Tribes Act
(VI of 1924).
Rule 22.59

22.59. Register No. IX, the Village Crime Register. - (1) This register shall be main-
tained in five parts as follows :-
Part I. - Notes on the village community containing the particulars required by
Form 22.59(1)A.
Part II. - The crime register, in Form 22.59(1)(B). Cognizable cases decided by
604 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

Panchayats shall be entered in Parts II and IV of this register as cases dealt with
direct by magistrates.
Part III. - Cases tracted to the village in Form 22.59(1)C.
The term ‘‘cases tracted to the village,’’ as used above, shall be held to include only
cognizable cases under Chapter XVII, Indian Penal Code, in which strong sus-
picion rested on any resident of the village whether the case occurred in the vil-
lage itself or not. When a case under Chapter XVII remains untraced or fails in
court the necessary entry in this register should never be omitted. Information
Sheets, Book XII-A [Form 23.17(3)] will also provide valuable material for
making this important register complete. In combination with the conviction
register it should be used as an index to the criminals of the ilaqa. A separate
entry shall be made for each suspect with a separate serial number. When a per-
son is again suspected, the fresh entry shall bear the same serial number as the
previous suspicion and the number of suspicion shall be entered below it, in the
form of a fraction similar to the system of numbering used in Part V of Register
No. IX.
Part III-A. - Visits to the village of persons of doubtful character, i.e. -
(i) persons whose history sheets are on record on Bundle A;
(ii) persons established through information sheets (strangers’ roll) to be of
doubtful character either by reason of having been suspected or convicted
of offences in respect of which entries are required to be made in Part III
or Part V of their home police station or for other adequate reasons;
(iii) persons arrested in the village under section 55/109, C.P.C. Provided that
no entry shall be made unless the persons concerned are placed on security.
Note. - This provision will not apply in cases where particulars of the person concerned would oth-
erwise normally be entered by virtue of (i) and (ii) above.
Part IV. - Notes on crime in the village (confidential) in Form 22.59(1)D.
Part V. - The Conviction Register, in Form 22.59(1)E.
Note. - Before proceeding to the scene of an offence Investigating Officers should take down in
a note-book all the information from parts II, III and III-A of the Village Crime Register
which is likely to be of assistance to them in their investigation.
(2) Parts I, II, III and III-A shall be loosely bound together in a cover of standard pat-
tern for each village or group of villages. When a group of closely allied villages is
combined in one volume, separate pages in each part shall be allotted to each village. The
prescribed cover for the village crime note-book is obtainable from the Controller,
Printing and Stationery Department, Punjab.
(3) An alphabetical list of all convicts belonging to any town or village shall be bound
up with Parts I to III of the village crime register concerned and shall be kept up-to-date
from the conviction register.
(4) Each part in each volume shall be paged. The cover shall bear clearly on the out-
side the name of the village or villages to which it relates.
The binding edges of the pages and of the cover shall be punched with two eyelet holes
before issue from the office of the Superintendent of Police and tape shall be provided, so
that the volumes may be neatly kept at all times, but may be easily opened for the inser-
tion of extra pages where necessary. Additional pages shall be given the same number
as the page they follow and distinguished by consecutive letters of the alphabet.
(5) Part IV shall be kept in separate volumes corresponding to the volumes of Parts I
to III, but shall be treated as confidential and shall remain in the personal custody of the
officer in charge of the police station.
Matters to be entered are detailed in rule 23.15.
The Police Station 605

(6) The whole of the Village Crime Register Parts I to V, is an unpublished official re-
cord relating to affairs of State and is privileged under section 123, Indian Evidence Act.
No part of the register may be shown to, nor may any copy or extract therefrom or any in-
formation derived therefrom be given to any person not entitled by his official position to
obtain such information.
Rule 22.60

22.60. The conviction register. - (1) Part V of the Village Crime Register shall be
maintained as a separate register, in volumes of not more than 100 pages each, known
as the Conviction Register. Entries shall be made by the officer in charge of the police sta-
tion personally or, under his special or general orders, by such one of his subordinates as
writes the best hand. Entries in this register shall be confined to the offences mentioned
in rule 27.29.
(2) The conviction register is a permanent record of the crime and criminals of each vil-
lage and of previous convictions, and is to a great extent the basis for the preparation of
history sheets and other measures of surveillance.
(3) On the first page of each volume of the register shall be entered in alphabetical order
a list of the towns and villages of the jurisdiction, the conviction records of which are con-
tained in such volume. The serial number of each town and village shall be entered to the
left and a reference to the pages allotted to it to the right. At the end of the last volume
of the register pages shall be allotted for the names of convicts, whose residence cannot
be traced or who are residents of places outside British India, but who commonly fre-
quent the jurisdiction of the police station. So far as may be possible every conviction
required to be entered in the register shall be entered in the pages allotted to the town or
village in which the convict ordinarily resides.
In all cases of conviction in an offence on the railway the letter ‘‘R’’ in red ink shall be
entered in the remarks column of the entry in the conviction register. Information re-
garding the conviction shall also be sent by the Superintendent of Police to the Assistant
Inspector-General, Government Railway Police, for the use of the railway police Central
Investigation Agency. All subsequent convictions of the offender shall also be commu-
nicated to the Agency which will in turn communicate the information to the railway
police sub-inspector charged with surveillance work and the maintenance of the original
history sheet of the criminal.
(4) When two or more offenders are jointly convicted of committing one and the same
offence and when there is reason to believe that they acted in concert, cross references
shall be inserted in the remarks column of the register, drawing attention to the fact.
(5) When a convict has been classed ‘‘P.R.’’ under the rules in the Police Finger Print
Bureau Manual the letters ‘‘P.R.’’ and a general description of the convict, giving age,
colour of hair and eyes, marks, scars, peculiarities of speech and gait, as endorsed on
his ‘‘P.R.’’ slip, shall be entered in column 3.
(6) When a person is reconvicted, the fresh entry shall bear the same serial number in
column 1 as the previous conviction, and the number of the conviction shall be entered be-
low it, in the form of a fraction, e.g., 16/3 signifies the third conviction of the person
originally entered at serial number 16. The serial number allotted to a convict shall be a
permanent one, just as a constabulary number is permanent. In the remarks column (col-
umn 11) of each re-conviction entry shall be entered references to the number, offence
and page of entry of previous convictions.
Illustration
When the reconviction of a person having six previous convictions is made, the entry
3 and 6
in column 11 shall be of the following nature - ‘‘3791⁄3; 457 - ; 110 Code of Crimi-
3 and 9
606 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

2 and 4 Ξ 5
nal Procedure 9 ". Here the first figure refers to the nature of the offence the
3 78 8
numerator to the serial number of the conviction, and the denominator to the page of the
register.
(7) Each entry shall be signed by the officer in charge of the police station personally,
the conviction stip being retained till this has been done. At every inspection of a police
station by a gazetted officer, the conviction register shall be produced and the inspecting
officer shall attest every entry made since the last inspection, recording orders in column
11 regarding any action, such as the opening history sheet, which he may require to be
taken. The inspecting officer shall also assure himself that orders given at previous in-
spections have been complied with, and shall erase or transfer the names of convicts, who
are shown to his satisfaction to have died or permanently changed their residence. When
the name of a deceased convicted is erased, a reference shall, if possible, be given to the
entry regarding his death in register No. XV.
Rule 22.61

22.61 Register Nos. X, X(A) and X(B). - The surveillance register shall be maintained
in accordance with the orders contained in rules 23.4, 23.5 and 23.16. Register Nos.
X(A), and (B) shall be destroyed two years after the dates of last entries.
Rule 22.62

22.62. Register No. XI. - An index to history sheets and personal files will be main-
tained in forms 23.14(1)-A and 23.14(1)-B.
Rule 22.63

22.63. Register Nos. XII and XII(A). - The registers of information sheets shall be
maintained in the form and subject to the orders contained in rule 23.17.
These registers shall be destroyed seven years after the despatch or receipt of the last
sheet.
Rule 22.64

22.64. Register No. XIII Minute book for gazetted officers. - (1) This is a blank book
of foolscap size in which shall be entered the dates of all inspections and any matters re-
quiring the attention of the officer in charge of the police station which have not been
entered in the inspection report. Inspecting officers shall satisfy themselves that old vol-
umes, of this register, which form a valuable record of the past history of the police
station, are intact.
(2) Notes should be made in this register of matters permanently affecting the condi-
tions of the police station, e.g., changes in police station or jail boundaries; imposition
and removal of additional police posts; construction of new buildings, etc.
(3) The register is a confidential and privileged record; with the exception of gazetted
police officers, no one except the District Magistrate, and a Sub-Divisional Officer spe-
cifically authorised under rule 1.20, may enter remarks in it or examine it.
Rule 22.65

22.65. No XIV-File Book of inspection reports. - A file book shall be maintained for
the record of gazetted officers’ inspection reports, Covers of standard pattern, in which re-
ports can be kept without risk of damage, are obtainable through the annual indent for
departmental forms (vide rule 11.42). An index of inspection reports shall be maintained
on the inside of the front cover.
Rule 22.66

22.66. Register No. XV. Vital Statistics. - (1) These registers are provided by District
Boards and Municipal Committees and are compiled from the figures recorded in the
registers of vital statistics which are supplied to village watchmen who bring their reg-
The Police Station 607

isters for inspection to the police station at prescribed intervals. The registers supplied to
village watchmen are also provided by local bodies on application by the police.
(2) Copies of the death register and abstracts of the information contained in the birth
register shall be submitted fortnightly in prescribed form by each police station to the Su-
perintendent who shall counter-sign such copies of abstracts and forward them to the Civil
Surgeon.
(3) All entries in the registers and in such copies and abstract relating to deaths from
cholera or plague shall be made in red ink.
(4) The vital statistics of each town containing 3,000 or more inhabitants shall be re-
corded and report separately under the name of the town.
(5) Birth and death registers shall be retained at the police station for one year after the
date of the last entry and shall then be sent to the Civil Surgeon for record.
Village registers of vital statistics shall be retained by village watchmen for two years
after the date of the last entry and shall then be sent to the police station for transmission
to the Civil Surgeon for record.
(6) Police station clerks, who maintain the registers of vital statistics, shall be granted
an allowance of Re. 10 per mensem.
(7) If there is reason to believe that a village watchman is neglecting to report the births
and deaths of his village correctly, the officer in charge of the police station shall take
steps to find out if he has been guilty of negligence and, if so, shall report the matter to
the District Magistrate through the Superintendent.
(8) Further instructions regarding vital statistics are contained in the Punjab Medical
Manual.
Rule 22. 67

22. 67. Register No. XVI. - This register shall contain 200 pages which will be divided
into four parts as follows :-
Part I. - List of village watchmen in the station jurisdiction, with the days fixed for
their attendance at the police station, in the Form No. 22.67(a).
Part II. - List of police officers attached to the police station with the dates of their
appointment and transfer, in the Form No 22.67(b).
Part III. - Register of all Government property in use at the police station in form
5.16(1). A printed list of the various kinds of articles supplied to police stations
will be sent out to all police stations before the 15th March and 15th September.
This list will be completed (as regards the numbers of each article on charge)
from the balances in Part III of this register and will be submitted every half-
year to the reserve inspector or Lines officer before the 31st March and 30th
September. A note will be attached explaining all changes from the list last sub-
mitted quoting the dates of and the authority for all receipts, transfers, destruc-
tion or other disposal of property.
Part IV. - List of all land in the police station jurisdiction which is Government prop-
erty in the possession of the police in accordance with rule 3.3(2). The dimen-
sions, area, locality, boundaries and boundary pillars of any place of worship or
praying platform situated on police land shall be entered in this register. Such
entries must correspond with the permanent record maintained at headquarters
under rule 3.3(2).
Rule 22.68

22.68. Register No. XVII. - (1) This register shall be maintained in separate pars as fol-
lows :-
Part I. - List of Arms Act Licenses; sub-divided into five parts, in Forms
608 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

22.68(a)(1), (a)(2), (a)(3), (a)(4) and (a)(5); in the Kangra District, a sixth part
in form 22.68 (a)(6) shall also be maintained.
Part II. - List of licenses under the Excise Laws in Form 22.68(b).
Part III. - List of licenses under the Explosives Act in Form 22.68(c).
Part IV. - List of licenses under the Petroleum Act in Form 22.68(d).
Parv V. - List of licenses under the Pensions Act, in Form 22.68(e).
Part VI. - List of sarais registered under the Sarais Act, in Form 26.68(f).
Parts I to V, except Form 22.68(a)(4), may be destroyed one year after the expiration of
the period for which the licenses were granted.
When the existing Part VI is filled up, all uncancelled entries shall be transcribed in a
new register and the old one destroyed.
(2) Powers and duties of police officers under the Acts mentioned in sub-rule (1) are
given in Appendix 22.68(2).
Rule 22.69

22.69. Register No. XVIII. - A receipt book in Form 22.69 shall be maintained in
which shall be entered a descriptive list in triplicate of all arms, ammunition or military
stores deposited in, or seized and brought to, the police station when such seizure is not
otherwise reported. The form shall be made out by the carbon copying process. One
copy shall be affixed to the weapon or articles, and the duplicate shall be given to the de-
positor.
This book shall be destroyed five years after the date of the last entry.
Rule 22.70

22.70. Register No. XIX. - This register shall be maintained in Form 22.70.
With the exception of articles already included in register No. XVI every article placed
in the store-room shall be entered in this register and the removal of any such article shall
be noted in the appropriate column.
The register may be destroyed three years after the date of the last entry.
Rule 22.71

22.71. Register No. XX. Accounts. - This register shall be maintained in forms
10.52(a) and (b).
(1) A cash account shall be kept of all receipts and expenditure other than those in
connection with the cattle-pound. This account shall be kept separately in two
parts as follows :-
(a) Other moneys, such as receipt and disbursement of pay, travelling allow-
ance, etc.
(b) Permanent advance.
(2) The account shall be balanced daily at the time fixed for the daily diary to close.
(3) At the end of the month any expenditure from (sic) been pending for over a
month, shall be specially the permanent advance, the recovery of which has de-
tailed.
(4) If the permanent advance becomes exhausted and further expenditure has to be
incurred, the minus balance shall be shown in red ink. Such minus balance shall
be shown also in the daily diary. Gazetted officers shall ensure that such entries
in diaries are specially brought to their notice so that prompt measures may be
taken to place the account in credit and to deal with those responsible for delay
in the refund of advances.
(5) The purpose and principles of permanent advances are detailed in rule 10.105.
The Police Station 609

The method of recovery of expenditure on account of diet money, etc., is given in


rules 26.27 and 27.28.
(6) The officer-in-charge of the police station shall personally check the correctness
of the cash account once a month and certify over his own signature in the reg-
ister that he has done so.
Rule 22.72

22.72. Register No. XXI. - A bound book of road certificates in Form 10.17 containing
sufficient certificates in duplicate to last for three months, shall be issued to each police
station as required.
Each certificate, both office copy and duplicate, shall be given an annual serial number
for each police station and, when returned receipted, the copy issued or the receipt in lieu
thereof shall be pasted on to the place from which the copy issued was taken.
Each book shall be destroyed when the last certificate therein is three years old.
Rule 22.73

22.73. Register No. XXII. - (1) Printed receipt books in Form 10.14(1) each contain-
ing 100 receipt forms in duplicate shall be issued to each police station.
(2) The pages of such books shall have printed serial numbers office copies and dupli-
cates having the same numbers and only one such book shall be in use at a time.
(3) It shall be the duty of the station clerk to count and stamp with station seal the re-
ceipts in the book before bringing it into use. Any receipt missing or bearing a wrong
printed page number shall, before the book is brought into use, be brought to the notice
of the officer in charge of the police station and a report entered in the daily diary.
(4) For all sums of money received in a police station, whether in cash or otherwise on
any account whatever, a receipt from this book shall be issued to the remitting party under
the signature of the officer in charge of the police station or the station clerk. The officer
signing the receipt shall satisfy himself that necessary entry has been made in the cash ac-
count which shall be duly attested under his initials at the same time.
(5) The road certificate, if any, received with the money, shall be pasted in place of the
receipt issued in the receiving police station. The receipt issued in lieu thereof shall be
pasted in the remitting office in place of the road certificate issued.
Note. - A road certificate is only an acknowledgement and not a receipt (Rule 10.14(4)).
Rule 22.74

22.74. Register No. XXIII. - The Police Gazette and the Criminal Intelligence Gazette
will be neatly filed in cardboard covers immediately on receipt. All orders contained in
the Gazette, affecting the officers of the police station as a whole or any individual of-
ficer, shall be announced at the first roll-call held after the receipt of the Gazette. - vide
rule 22.11.
Gazetted officers will see at inspections that these rules are carefully followed and that
all orders, etc. in the Gazette are properly dealt with.
Rule 22.75

22.75. Register No. XXIV. - All copies of Police Rules must be kept up-to- date and
gazetted officers shall see that this is done as soon as correction slips are received from
the press.
Rule 22.76

22.76. Register No. XXV. - A blank register of foolscap size shall be maintained in
every police station, in which the officer in charge of the police station, on handing over
charge on permanent transfer, shall record a confidential charge note for the assistance of
his successor. This note should not recapitulate matter which is already on record in Part
610 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

IV of the village crime register or in other registers of the police station, but should deal
with miscellaneous local information, which the outgoing officer has gathered during his
stay in the jurisdiction, and which would be lost to his successor if not recorded.
Matters which may suitably be mentioned in these charge notes are -
(a) the character and capacity of members of the staff of the police station, including
notes of constables who are specially useful for particular types of work;
(b) residents of the jurisdiction who are useful to the police as informers or helpers
and others who are particularly to be guarded against;
(c) directions in which co-operation with other police stations is specially necessary
owing to the habits of the criminals of one or the other jurisdiction;
(d) special factors affecting crime such as seasonal immigrations of labour, local
customs or superstitions, etc.;
(e) matters of temporary importance, such as serious cases under investigation, pre-
ventive action pending, or important orders under compliance.
This list is not intended to be exhaustive, the object of confidential charge notes is
that miscellaneous information, which the experience of successive officers
accumulates, and which would not otherwise come on to record, should be
available to new comers.
Rule 22.77

22.77. Station clerk as officer in charge of police station. - In the absence of senior
officers, the station clerk is frequently called upon to act as officer in charge of the police
station. He must, therefore, be fully acquainted with all the powers, responsibilities and
duties of that officer as laid down in the law and in Police Rules. The most important of
these and the most important of the other duties devolving on the station clerk and not al-
ready detailed in this chapter are -
(1) registration of cognizable cases and action subsequent to registration - Rule
24.1;
(2) recording of complaints in non-cognizable cases - Rule 24.3;
(3) despatch of special reports - Rule 24.12;
(4) disposal and completion of case files and completion of registers on the passing
of orders in cases - Rule 27.29;
(5) carrying out arrests - Rule 26.8;
(6) granting of bail - Rule 26.21;
(7) submitting applications for remands to police custody - Rule 26.25(2);
(8) patrolling at rural stations - Rule 23.1;
(9) issuing orders on the use of handcuffs - Rule 26.23.
In all these matters the station clerk will be guided by the rules referred to and connected
law.
Rule 22.78

22.78. Visit of chaukidars to police station. - (1) The visit of village watchmen to po-
lice stations mentioned in rule 21.3(4) shall be so arranged that while no inconvenience
is caused to the watchmen concerned they shall arrive at the police station on different
days as far as possible. Opportunity shall be taken of these visits by the police station staff
to obtain local information of occurrences in villages, to disseminate intelligence relating
to crime, absconders, etc., and to impart instruction as to the action required by village
officials on the occurrence of crime, etc.
(2) Officers in charge of police station will be held responsible that village watchmen
on their periodical visits to the police station are not detained, and that their services are
The Police Station 611

not utilised in improper ways. Any disobedience of these orders must be severely dealt
with and gazetted officers should, by personal enquiry when on tour, ensure that these
instructions are strictly complied with.
Rule 22.79

22.79. Orders regarding notices. - (1) When it is considered necessary to record or


communicate to other police stations information regarding unidentified corpses, miss-
ing persons, unclaimed, lost or stolen cattle or other property, notices in the forms given
below shall be prepared by the carbon copying process and despatched to the Central In-
vestigating Agency at headquarters and to such police stations as the officer in charge of
the police station thinks fit, care being taken that only property easy of identification is in-
cluded :-
(a) Unidentified corposes - Form 22.79(1)(a).
(b) Missing persons - Form 22.79(1)(b).
(c) Unclaimed property, including cattle - Form 22.79(1)(c).
(d) Property lost or stolen including cattle - Form 22.79(1)(d).
(2) If the matter is urgent the necessary copies shall be made at and despatched direct
from the police station, otherwise notices shall be submitted to the Central Investigating
Agency at headquarters where the required number of copies shall be made by means of
duplicating process and despatched without delay to such police station or posts as the
submitting officer may recommend, and also, in exceptional cases where such a course is
likely to prove effective, to the office of the Assistant Inspector General, Crime and
Criminal Tribes, for publication in the Criminal Intelligence Gazette. In addition, in all
important cases, the information should be communicated to the chaukidars visiting the
police station with a view to its circulation throughout the jurisdiction of the police sta-
tion.
(3) Office copies of the notices referred to shall be kept and these, as well as the notices
received from other police stations, shall, respectively, be given an annual serial number
under each class separately and filed for seven years in two bundles, one containing no-
tices of the home police station and the other those received from other police stations.
(4) Notices shall be compared with a view to tracing missing persons, owners of un-
claimed property, establishing identity of unidentified corpses, etc., and results noted in
the column of remarks.
(5) In the case of similar notices received from other districts or provinces, Superinten-
dents shall exercise their discretion as to the police stations to which they should be
circulated and the necessary number of copies shall be made in their own offices if dupli-
cate copies are not received from the forwarding district.
APPENDIX 20.20
EXTRACTS FROM THE DISTRICT BOARD ACCOUNT CODE, 1926
Rule 60. Po

60. Pound Registers to be maintained. - (1) On the admission of an animal to a pound,


the pound-keeper shall fill up columns 1 to 8 of a Pound Register to be maintained in
Form 42, taking the signature or thumb mark of the person impounding the animal in col-
umn 7, and shall then issue a receipt for the impounded animal in Form 43.
(2) If more than one animal is admitted at a time, each animal shall be entered on a sepa-
rate line in the Pound Register.
Rule 61. Pr

61. Procedure of release of animals from pound. - (1) When the owner of an im-
pounded animal or his agent appears to demand the release of his animal the
pound-keeper shall make the necessary entries in columns 9 to 16 of the Pound Register
612 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

(Form 42) and fill up a Release Pass, with its counterfoil in Form 44; he shall then de-
mand the fines and charges due on account of the impounded animal, and on their receipt
shall take the signature or thumb mark of the owner or his agent in column 20 of the
Pound Register and the signature or thumb mark of some person who can identify the per-
son claiming the animal as the owner thereof or his agent in column 21 and shall then
release the impounded animal.
(2) The progressive total of the sums received shall be entered at the foot of each coun-
terfoil of the Release Passes at the time when the counterfoil is filled up and the pass
issued, and the entering of the totals shall not be deferred till the end of the day.
Rule 62. Sa

62. Sales to be conducted under supervision. - When a pound is directly managed by


the Board, every sale of impounded animals shall be conducted under the direct supervi-
sion of the Secretary or of a member of the Board, or such other person as the Board may
appoint in this behalf or, with the consent of the District Magistrate, a responsible Gov-
ernment official.
Rule 63. Po

63. Pound-keeper to attend sales unless exempted. - The pound-keeper shall attend
every sale of impounded animals, unless exempt from such attendance by general or spe-
cial order of the Board on the ground that this absence would prejudice his other duties;
he shall take with him Pound Register and his counterfoil book of receipts for the purchas-
ers of impounded animals sold to be kept in Form 45.
Rule 64. Me

64. Memorandum to be sent to pound-keeper if not present at sale. - When under


the provisions of rule 63 if the pound-keeper does not attend a sale, the officer conducting
the sale shall send the sale-proceeds to the pound- keeper with a memorandum showing:-
(a) number and description of animals sold;
(b) date on which sold;
(c) name and address of the purchaser;
(d) amount for which sold; and
(e) number of animals, if any, returned unsold.
Rule 65. Re

65. Receipt to be issued to purchaser of animals. - When impounded animals are


sold, the pound-keeper shall enter the details of the sale in the Pound Register and give
to the purchaser of such animals a receipt in form 45; if the sale is one that the pound-
keeper has not attended, he shall immediately, on the arrival of the memorandum referred
to in rule 64 from the officer conducting the sale, send the receipt (Form 45) to the pur-
chaser by registered post, and paste the post-office receipt for the letter on to the
counterfoil.
Rule 66. Me

66. Memorandum showing disposal of proceeds of sales. - When impounded ani-


mals have been sold under the authority of section 14 or section 16 of the Cattle Trespass
Act, 1871, the account to be delivered to the owner as required by that section, shall be
drawn up by the pound-keeper in the form of a memorandum in Form 46, and the receipt
prescribed by the final clause of the section shall be taken in the last column of the coun-
terfoil.
Rule 67. Ne

67. Net sale-proceeds to be sent to Court. - When animals impounded otherwise than
under Chapter III of the Cattle Trespass Act, 1871, have been sold, the pound-keeper
shall fill up a memorandum in the same manner as prescribed in rule 66; but the sale-pro-
ceeds, after deduction of the fines leviable, the expenses of feeding and watering, and the
The Police Station 613

expenses of sale, if any, shall be made over to the court or officer under whose authority
the sale was ordered, the words ‘‘authorising officer or his agent’’ being substituted for
‘‘owner’’ wherever the latter occurs in the memorandum in Form 46.
Rule 68. Su

68. Sums received on behalf of Board to be entered on Counterfoil of Release


passes. - The pound-keeper shall, immediately on receipt, add to the last progressive total
entered in the counterfoils of release passes (Form 44) all sums received by him on behalf
of the Board on account of impounded cattle sold.
Explanation. - Charges for feeding and watering appropriated by the pound-keeper,
the ‘‘balance of the purchase money’’ under section 16 of the Cattle Trespass
Act, and the net sale proceeds under rule 67 are not received on behalf of the
Board.
Note. - (1) See section 17 of the Indian Cattle Trespass Act, 1871.
Note. - (2) The balance of the purchase money should be noted separately in red ink below the
progressive total and carried forward till the collections are remitted to the treasury.
Rule 69. Re

69. Remittance of pound collections to treasury. - (1) At such times as may be fixed
by the Board, but at least once a month, the pound-keeper shall remit his collections to
the Treasury, with a chalan in Form 8; of the two foils of the chalan received back from
the Treasury duly signed, one shall be returned to the pound-keeper, who shall paste it
in his Release Pass Book as evidence of the remittance having been made, and the other
shall be sent to the Secretary to enable him to enter the amount in his General Cash-book.
(2) The challan submitted under sub-rule (1) shall specify -
(1) net sale-proceeds of unclaimed cattle,
(2) other receipts.
Explanation. - The amount shown under head (1) shall be the sums entered in col-
umn 18, Form 42, as ‘‘Surplus credited to account.’’
(3) The Board shall arrange for the remittance of the collections by money order in
cases where this course is necessary in order to avoid interruption in the pound-
keeper’s duties.
Rule 70. Cl

70. Claims for sale-proceeds of sale of unclaimed animals. - (1) When a claim is
preferred under section 17 of the Cattle Trespass Act, 1871 to any sum credited as the net
sale-proceeds of unclaimed cattle, the original credit shall be treated in the Pound Regis-
ter, and, if on investigation the claim is established, the amount repayable shall be paid
under the written orders of the Chairman, and the payment shall be brought to account di-
rect in the General Cash-book (Form 2); the fact of the payment, and the number and date
of the payment vouchers shall be noted in the remarks column of the Pound Register
against the entry of the original credit.
(2) No claim for refund of the net sale-proceeds of unclaimed animals shall be enter-
tained if it is made after the expiry of three months from the date of the sale.
(3) When an investigation into a claim cannot be undertaken by the Board, it may, at
the request of the Board, be made through the District Magistrate.
Rule 71. Fe

71. Feeding and watering of animals. - (1) The Board may give an advance, not ex-
ceeding ten rupees, to the pound-keeper for the purpose of feeding impounded animals.
(2) The charge for feeding and watering different classes of animals shall be fixed by
the Board, from time to time, at such rates that the receipts from this source do not exceed
614 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

the actual cost of feeding and watering, provided that half the daily charges for feeding
shall be recovered when an animal has been in the pound for less than eight hours.
Rule 72. In

72. Inspection of pounds. - A pound directly managed by the board shall be open to
inspection by any member of the Board or of the District or Audit Staff, and so far as pos-
sible, it shall be inspected once a quarter and the results of the inspection shall be recorded
in an inspection book, to be kept up at the pound, and any irregularity in its accounts shall
at once be brought to the notice of the Chairman.
Rule 73. Po

73. Pounds Ledger to be maintained. - A Pound Ledger shall be maintained in the ac-
counts office of the board in Form 47, a separate page being assigned to each pound, in
which shall be shown all expenditure on each pound and all income received from each
pound, and at the end of the year a statement shall be complied by the Secretary and laid
before the Board showing the net loss or gain to the Board during the year from each
pound.
APPENDIX 22.26
MEMORANDUM OF INSTRUCTIONS FOR COLLECTORS AND DEPUTY
COMMISSIONERS WITH REGARD TO TROOPS MARCHING THROUGH DIS-
TRICTS UNDER THEIR JURISDICTION.

PART I
1. (i) On receipt of information that troops are to march through the district under his
jurisdiction, the Collector or Deputy Commissioner concerned will detail a police officer
or other official to accompany them and take steps to prevent the irregular sale of liquor
or fruits to the troops on or near the route, and exclude from the camp or its vicinity all
women of loose character.
(ii) The official will report himself to the officer commanding the troops the day be-
fore the troops enter the limits of his jurisdiction and remain with them until they leave
it.
(iii) He will be the medium of communication in his district between the officer com-
manding the troops and the subordinate civil officials and inhabitants generally and will
give all the assistance in his power to the officer commanding the troops.
(iv) He will settle, in communication with the officer commanding, all disputes with the
inhabitants, or with any transport establishments engaged by the civil authorities within
his powers, and be responsible for reporting cases beyond his powers to his superiors.
(v) He will be provided with written instructions by the Collector or Deputy Commis-
sioner defining his duties and powers, which he will show to the officer commanding the
troops.
(vi) If irregularities committed by the troops are not discovered until they have pro-
ceeded outside the limits of the jurisdiction of the Collector or Deputy Commissioner, he
will send a full report of the occurrence to the Officer Commanding the Brigade Area in
which it occurred, who will investigate the matter and take all action necessary for its dis-
posal.
2. (i) Rationing arrangements of the troops, and animals are made by the Indian Army
Service Corps under the orders of the General Officer Commanding concerned. A suit-
able detachment of supply personnel will be in supply charge of the units whilst on the
march. The civil authorities may be called upon to provide supplies of the kind men-
tioned on Indian Army Form S-1526, and such articles as are not ordinarily kept in stock
(e.g., sheep, fowl and eggs) or which are rapidly perishable (e.g., milk); other ration ar-
ticles will not be demanded from the civil authorities.
The Police Station 615

(ii) When the assistance of the civil authorities is necessary, if any in the case of pre-
arranged marches, i.e., when marches are not due to a sudden emergency, the General
Officer Commanding concerned will detail an advance party consisting of personnel of
the supply service, or of the unit marching, to go ahead of the troops and associate them-
selves with the civil officials in the purchase of supplies. The Civil authorities should be
informed that an advance party is being sent to assist in the necessary purchases.
(iii) All indents on the civil authorities, for the class and quantity of articles which they
are required to supply, should be preferred on them a fortnight before they are actually re-
quired. Any charges in dates, routes or quantities of supplies must be communicated at
once to all concerned. Losses due to these circumstances will only borne by the State
when the competent financial authority is satisfied that they were unavoidably due to cir-
cumstances beyond the control of the responsible authority or unit. Losses due to
excessive estimates will be borne by the unit responsible.
(iv) To enable the civil officials to purchase supplies, the military authorities, when
submitting their indents for supplies will arrange to pay in advance to the responsible civil
authorities a sum to cover the cost of the supplies requisitioned. This advance will be
obtained from the Controller of Military Accounts concerned. If time does not permit of
an advance being obtained from the Controller of Military Accounts, it should be ob-
tained from the civil treasury on the authority of a station order as provided for in
paragraph 16(viii) or Pay and Allowance Regulations, Part II.
(v) The advance party is responsible for the actual acceptance of supplies, the passing
on of which should be done in the presence of the civil official. The military authorities
will then be responsible for the payment of the demand made by the civil official for the
above accepted supplies. Rejections should only be made when the articles tendered are
unfit for consumption owing to their being below the standard usually consumed by the
persons or animals for whom they are intended. Supplies which have been accepted by
the advance party will not be subject to further passing in the decision of the officer com-
manding the advance party being final. If the supplies become unfit for consumption
owing to the late arrival of the unit or to causes outside the control of the supplier, a re-
ceipt for the supplies must be granted by the officer commanding the troops to the civil
official concerned.
(vi) The military officer who takes over supplies from the civil official will furnish the
latter with a receipt for the supplies actually received and will send a duplicate of this re-
ceipt to the military authority responsible for the submission of the original indent.
(vii) When supplies of a quality inferior to that which might reasonably have been ex-
pected are provided, a report to this effect will be made by the officer commanding the
troops to the district civil officer.
(viii) If shops are, or can be established on or near the camping around, articles such as
sheep, fowls, eggs, milk, etc., will be retailed by the shop-keeper; if shops neither exist nor
can be arranged for, these articles will be supplied in the usual way and arrangements
made for their retail issue and the subsequent disposal of any surplus.
(ix) In the case of marches due to sudden emergencies when sufficient notice of the ar-
rival of a unit in a district cannot be given, or an advance party sent ahead of the troops,
and the supplies have consequently to be arranged by the civil authorities in a hurry, the
Indian Army Service Corps officer or, in his absence, the officer commanding the troops
should bear in mind the following factors before rejecting supplies arranged for by the
civil authorities :-
(a) The notice given and the circumstances in which the supplies were purchased.
(b) The quality which might reasonably be expected in the district traversed.
(c) Whether the supplies are fit for consumption though below the usual standard.
If it is necessary to reject supplies on account of unfitness for consumption, the of-
616 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

ficer commanding the troops will furnish the civil official concerned with a
statement showing the nature and quantity of supplies so rejected, and will fur-
nish a duplicate copy of this statement to the military authority originally re-
sponsible for making the demand, who will arrange with the Controller of
Military Accounts concerned to obtain a refund from the civil authorities in re-
spect of such supplies.
(x) The officer commanding will be responsible that whenever any article is taken with-
out payment, or when dasturi is enacted, the responsible person is severely dealt with. He
will cause the officer of the day to visit the bazaar frequently to see that the guard or
military police, which should be posted thereon, are doing their duty and that no irregu-
larities are permitted. The officer commanding will ensure that he is readily accessible
to any civil official or inhabitant who may be desirous of lodging a complaint.

(xi) The civil supply official should report to the officer commanding each evening
whether any claims remain unsettled, and, if so, the latter will personally see to their im-
mediate settlement. The civil official should endorse all receipts given for payments
made, and the officer commanding should not accept receipts unless so endorsed.

(xii) Individuals or small parties will ordinarily purchase their own supplies from ba-
zaars. If any assistance is required, they will apply to the local police officer.

3. (i) The Collector or Deputy Commissioner is responsible (except in the case of


Baluchistan where the Military Engineer Services authorities will be responsible), for the
maintenance in good order of all established camping grounds outside cantonments
within his jurisdiction.

(ii) He will be responsible that they are not cultivated, and that jungle growth is re-
moved, also that boundary pillars are kept in repairs, that the wells are in good order, and
also incinerators are provided.

(iii) When troops are to march through his district, the officer commanding the unit
concerned has orders to send him a copy of the itinerary in good time to enable him to
make all arrangements for the wells to be cleaned out if they have not been in regular use.

4. When any special arrangements for troops are required at ferries, the Brigade Com-
mander concerned has orders to give the civil authorities concerned ample notice.

5. Unless prevented by urgent business in another part of the district, the Collector or
Deputy Commissioner should make a point of being present at his headquarters to re-
ceive the troops with due honours.

6. The higher officers of the several departments serving in the district or present on
tour in it should be informed of the coming of the troops so that they may have an oppor-
tunity of participating in their reception.

7. The President and Councillors of the local municipality should be invited to meet the
troops at the entrance to the town.

8. The educational authorities should be directed to turn out schools on the line of
march.

9. The instructions in paragraphs 5, 6, 7 and 8 apply only in the case of those routes
which are infrequently used by troops and to occasions when the special object of the
march is to impress people with the strength and importance of the Military arm of Gov-
ernment.
The Police Station 617

PART II
RULES FOR THE SUPPLY OF CARRIAGE BY THE CIVIL
AUTHORITIES
1. Indents. - Indents on the civil authorities for hired carriage required for the move-
ments of troops or stores will be prepared on India Army Form S-1675, giving full details
of requirements and sent so as to reach the district or political officer concerned if possible
not less than 15 days (one month in Gwalior State and 21 days in cases of marches through
the desert talukas of the Thar Parkar District of Sind) before the carriage is required.
2. Collection and payments. - Hired carriage will not ordinarily be required to proceed
beyond the limits of the next civil district on the route, but will be exchanged, if possible,
at such stations as may be fixed by the local civil authorities.
It will be paid for a at authorized local rates from the date on which it is engaged for
the march to the date of its discharge, both inclusive. Half hire will be paid for the return
journey from the exchanging station to the place where the carriage was engaged. If the
carriage is taken beyond the exchanging station, full hire will be paid for the return jour-
ney, from the place where the carriage is released to the place where it was engaged
without any allowance for halts. If the carriage has to be collected before the date on
which it is required, the civil authorities will inform the indenting officer of the time re-
quired for collection before the start, and the probable extra expense that will be
incurred. Carriage which ordinarily plies for hire, and is on the list to be kept by the dis-
trict officer, will first be called upon and the balance will be made up by impressment.
Carriage indented for in excess of requirements, and discharged, will be paid for at the full
hire rate for reach day or part of a day for which it is retained. If carriage is declared un-
serviceable through deliberate fault or culpable negligence of the cartman by a committee
of officers (which will include the civil officer), it will not be paid for. When chaudhries
are engaged to collect carriage, their fees, at the local rates, will be paid for by the Army
Department.
3. Advances and handing over of carriage. - On engagement of the carriage, the civil
or political officer will advance to the owners half the estimated hire for the full journey,
and obtain a receipt for the same. To enable the civil official to make these advances, the
indenting officer when submitting his requisition for carriage will remit to the civil offi-
cers concerned a sum sufficient to cover the amount which the latter will be required to
advance. A receipt will be obtained for this advance which will be subject to adjustment.
The carriage will be sent to the place required in charge of a tahsil or durbar official who
will hand to the indenting officer a detail of the composition of the carriage, authorized
loads, owner’s name, amount advanced and the receipt for the same, and intimation as to
the station at which the carriage should be exchanged (See India Army Forms S-1675).
The advance remitted to the civil officials will then be adjusted at once.
4. Exchanging station. - The civil officer supplying the carriage will at the same time
warn the civil officer at the first exchanging station of the transport requiring exchange,
and the date and place at which it will be required. A copy of this should be furnished to
the indenting officer to enable an advance to be remitted. The civil officer at the first ex-
changing station will then proceed as in paragraph 3 and warn the next exchanging
station. Similar action will be taken at each exchanging station on the route.
5. Change in original transport requirements. - If any change is required en route in
the original quantity and description of transport supplied, the officer commanding the
troops will give the civil officer at the exchanging station concerned as much notice as
possible.
6. Unserviceable carriage. - Carriage breaking down between exchanging stations
should be replaced on the spot in communication with the local civil officials and paid
618 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

off. If the advance received has not been liquidated, the owner must refund the amount
then due.
7. Discharge of carriage. - On arrival at an exchanging station or at destination the
carriage will be at once released and paid off by the Indian Army Service Corps Officer,
if there is one, otherwise by a British officer of the marching unit in the presence of the
civil official attached to the troops, the acquittance roll being signed by both and coun-
tersigned by the Officer Commanding. Any disputes will be referred to, and settled by,
the district civil officer at the place at which the transport is released.
8. Detention of transport. - If carts are brought from a distance and detained at a camp
of exercise, etc., the full hire will be paid for each day of such detention. Carriage will
not, however, be detained at a camp which lasts for five days or over, except in every spe-
cial circumstances.
9. Protection certificate. - When a carriage is discharged, a certificate in English and
the vernacular should be given by the civil officer at the exchanging station, or by the civil
officer accompanying the troops, to each person in charge thereof, to protect the carriage
from being taken for the use of troops while on its return journey unless such troops are
marching in the direction of the owner’s home. If so employed, the full hire rate will be
paid.
APPENDIX 22.68(2)
Powers and duties of Police Officers under the Indian Arms Act,
Excise Laws, Explosives Act, Petroleum Act, Poisions Act and
Sarais Act.
I - THE INDIAN ARMS ACT, NO. XI OF 1878.
1. Since section 5 of the Act requires a person who sells arms or ammunition lawfully
possessed by him for his private use, to a person other than a person exempted under Sec-
tion 27 of the Act, to give, without unnecessary delay, notice of sale with name and
address of the purchaser, to the officer in charge of the nearest Police Station, it shall be
the duty of such Police Officer to record such notice.
On receipt of such notice the Police Officer may make enquiries as to the correctness of
the purchaser’s name and address, if necessary obtain a report from the Superintendent
of Police of the district in which the purchaser lives, - vide Rule VIII of the Rules prom-
ulgated with Punjab Government notification No. 8408, dated the 5th March, 1929
(reproduced in Appendix No. 20.14).
2. All police officers not below the rank of an officer in charge of a police station are
empowered to detain arms, ammunition or military stores under section 6 of the Act. -
vide rule 1 of the Rules promulgated with Punjab Government notification No. 8408,
dated the 5th March, 1929 (reproduced in Appendix No. 20.14).
3. Under section 12 of the Act, any police officer may apprehend without warrant any
person found carrying or conveying any arms, ammunition or military stores, whether
covered by a licence or not in such manner or under such circumstances as to afford just
grounds of suspicion that the same are being carried by him with intent to use them, or
that the same may be used, for any unlawful purpose, and also take such arms, ammuni-
tion or military stores from him.
All persons so apprehended by, or persons apprehended (under section 12) by a person
not being a magistrate or a police officer and delivered to, a police officer, and all arms
and ammunition seized by or delivered to any such officer under this section, shall be
taken without unnecessary delay before a magistrate.
4. Under section 13 of the Act, any police officer may disarm any person who is found
The Police Station 619

going armed with any arms except under a licence and to the extent and in the manner per-
mitted thereby.
5. An officer in charge of police station shall receive any arms, ammunition or military
stores deposited by any person under the provisions of section 16 of the Act and will as
laid down in paragraph 22.69, Police Rules, and after seven days, if the owner has not
obtained a licence authorizing him to possess them, the arms, ammunition and military
stores shall be forwarded to the Headquarters of the district and kept in the Malkhana of
the District Magistrate or in the Police Magazine.
6. Under section 17 of the Act, the powers and duties of the police officers as regards
inspections of licenced premises and maintenance of registers under the Arms Act have
been detailed in paragraph 20.14 of the Police Rules.
7. Under section 19 of the Act, the Police has powers to arrest, without a warrant, those
persons who commit breach of sections 5, 6, 10, 13, 14, 16 or 17 as given in the said sec-
tion.
8. Under section 20 of the Act, the Police has powers to arrest, without a warrant, those
persons who commit secret breaches of sections 5, 6, 10, 14 and 15 as mentioned in
clauses (a), (c), (d) and (f) of section 19 of the Act.
9. Under section 25 of the Act, all police officers not below the rank of officer-in-
charge of a police station have been empowered (subject to the orders of a Magistrate)
to conduct searches by themselves or in their presence.
10. Under section 30 of the Act read with rule III of the Rules promulgated with Punjab
Government notification No. 8408, dated the 5th March, 1929 (reproduced in Appendix
No. 20.14), all police officers of rank not below that of officer-in-charge of a police sta-
tion have been appointed by virtue of their office to conduct searches for offences
punishable under section 19(f) of the Act.
II - EXCISE LAWS
(1) The Punjab Excise Act No. 1 of 1914.
Under section 11, read with notification No. 5708-E. &S., dated the 27th October,
1932, the following officers of Police have been invested with the powers of an Excise Of-
ficer of the Ist Class:-
(i) All Superintendents, Assistant Superintendents and Deputy Superintendents of
Police.
(ii) All Inspectors, Sub-Inspectors and Assistant Sub-Inspectors of Police.
(iii) All Head Constables.
All constables of Police have been invested with the powers of the Excise Officer,
3rd Class.
Under section 10(b) of this Act, the powers of Excise Officers of the classes speci-
fied below have been declared to be as follows :-
A - Powers of an Excise Officer of the 3rd Class -
(i) Powers under section 47 to arrest without a warrant any person found commit-
ting an offence under section 61(1)(a) or (c) or section 61(2) (a), (c) or(e).
(ii) Powers under section 47 to seize and detain excisable or other articles liable to
confiscation in connection with any of the aforesaid offences and to detain and
search persons upon whom and any vessel, raft, vehicle, animal package, recep-
tacle or covering in or upon which he may have reasonable cause to suspect
any such article to be.
B - Powers of an Excise Officer of the 2nd Class -
(i) All the powers of an Excise Officer of the 3rd Class.
620 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

(ii) All powers not included in the foregoing and conferrable under section 47.
(iii) Power to enter and inspect places of manufacture and sale, and to examine and
seize accounts and registers, test measures, weight and seize any materials,
stills, utensils, implements, apparatus or excisable article as provided in sec-
tion 45.
C - Powers of an Excise Officer of the 1st Class -
(i) Power to investigate under section 46.
(ii) Power to search without warrant as provided in section 49(1) and to seize, de-
tain, search and arrest as provided in section 49(2).
(iii) Power to grant bail under section 73.
Under section 50 of this Act, any offence under this Act may be investigated by an of-
ficer empowered under section 46.
Whenever any police officer makes any arrest, seizure or search, he shall within 24
hours thereafter make a full report of all the particulars of the arrest, seizure or search to
his immediate official superior and shall unless bail be accepted under section 73, take
or send the person arrested or the articles seized, with all convenient despatch to a Mag-
istrate for trial or adjudication.
Under section 51 all Police Officers are required to aid the Excise Officers in the due
execution of this Act, upon a request made by such Excise Officers.
Under section 53 every officer in charge of a Police Station shall take charge of and
keep in safe custody, pending the orders of a Magistrate or of the Collector or an officer
empowered under section 46(1) to investigate the case, all aticles seized under this Act
which may be delivered to him, and shall allow any Excise Officer who may accompany
such articles to the Police Station, or may be deputed for the purpose by his superior of-
ficer to affix his seal to the articles and to take samples of and from them. All samples
so taken shall also be sealed with the seal of the Officer-in-charge of the Police Station.
Offences under sections 61 and 63 are cognizable by the Police as also their attempts
and abetments. The powers of arrest have been detailed above.
Under section 73, the Police Officers not empowered to take security (i.e., constables),
should take or forward the person arrested under this Act, otherwise than on a warrant,
to the officer empowered under section 10(b) or to the Officer-in-charge of a Police Sta-
tion whoever is nearer.
(2) The Opium Act, I of 1878. - Under section 9, read with section 14 of and notification
No. 5708-E. & S., dated the 27th October, 1932, a Police Officer of and above the rank
of Head Constable may, if he thinks proper, arrest any person whom he has reason to be-
lieve to be guilty of any offence relating to opium under this or any other law for the time
being in force.
Under the same section read with section 15, any Police Officer may detain and search
any person whom he has reason to believe to be guilty of any offence against this or any
other such law, and if such person has opium in his possession, arrest him and any other
person in his company.
Since Section 11 requires that in any case in which an offence under section 9 has been
committed:-
(a) the opium in respect of which any offence under the same section has been com-
mitted,
(b) where in the case of an offence under clause (b) or (c) of the same section, the
offender is transporting, importing or exporting any opium exceeding the quan-
tity which he is permitted to transport, import or export, as the case may be, the
whole of the opium which he is transporting, importing a exporting.
The Police Station 621

(c) where in the case of an offender under clause (d) of the same section, the of-
fender has in his possession any opium other than the opium in respect of which
the offence has been committed, the whole of such other opium, and
(d) the vessels, packages and coverings in which any opium liable to confiscation
under this section is found and the other contents (if any) of the vessel or pack-
age in which such opium may be concealed, and the animal and conveyances
used in carrying it, are lible to confiscation, it shall be the duty of the Police to
take all these articles into possession.
Under Section 14, read with Government notification No. 5708-E. & S., dated the 27th
October, 1932, any Police Officer above the rank of Constable, who has reason to be-
lieve, from personal knwledge or from information given by any person and taken down
in writing, that opium liable to confiscation under this Act, is kept or concealed in any
building, vessel or enclosed place may, between sunrise and sunset -
(a) enter into any such building, vessel or place;
(b) in case of resistance, break open any door and remove any other obstacle to
such entry;
(c) seize such opium and any other thing which he has reason to believe to be liable
for confiscation under section 11 or any other law for the time being in force re-
lating to opium; and
(d) detain and search, and if he thinks proper, arrest, any person whom he has rea-
son to believe to be guilty of any offence relating to such opium under this or any
other law for the time being in force.
Under Section 5 of the Act, any Police Officer may :-
(a) seize in any open place or in transit, any opium or other thing which he has reason
to believe to be liable to confiscation under Section 11 or any other law for the
time being in force relating to opium;
(b) detain and search any person whom he has reason to believe to be guilty of any
offence against this or any other such law, and, if such person has opium in his
possession, arrest him and any other person in his company.
Under Section 16, all searches under Sections 14 and 15 shall be made in accordance
with the provisions of Criminal Procedure Code.
Under Section 17, it is the duty of all Police Officers, upon a notice given or a request
made, to assist all officers mentioned in Section 14 in carrying out provisions of this Act.
Under Section 20, every person arrested and thing seized, by a Police Officer under sec-
tion 14 or Section 15 shall, if he is not an Officer-in-charge of the Police Station, be
forwarded without delay, to the Officer-in-charge of the nearest Police Station; and every
person arrested and thing seized under Section 19 shall be forwarded without delay by
the Police Officer to the Officer by whom the warrant has issued.
The Officer-in-charge of Police Station to whom any person or thing is forwarded un-
der this section shall, with all convenient despatch, take such measures as may be
necessary for the disposal, according to law, of such person or thing.
Under Section 21 of the Act, when any arrest or seizure is made under this Act by any
Police Officer, he shall within 48 hours next after such arrest or seizure, make a full re-
port of all the particulars of such arrest or seizure, to his immediate official superior.
(3) The Punjab Opium Smoking Act, No. VI of 1923. - Under Section 14, every officer
of the Police shall be bound to give reasonable aid to any Excise Officer in carrying out
the provisions of this Act upon notice given and request made.
(4) The Dangerous Drugs Act No. II of 1930. - Offences under Sections 10 to 15, the
attempts and abetments thereof described in Sections 20 and 21 are cognizable by Po-
622 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

lice, Section 23 and Government orders thereunder empower all Police Officers of and
above the rank of Head Constables to arrest, if they think proper, any person whom they
have reason to believe to have committed an offence punishable under Chapter III, relat-
ing to a dangerous drug, whereas section 24 empowers any Police Officer to arrest any
person who is found to be in unlawful possession of a dangerous drug.
Under Section 18, the Police can recommend, for the persons sent up under Sections
10, 12, 13 and 14 that security for abstaining from the commission of offences punish-
able under those sections be taken from them.
Under Section 23 any Police Officer above the rank of constable, who has reason to
believe, from personal knowledge or from information given by any person and taken
down in writing, that any dangerous drug in respect of which an offence punishable under
Chapter III of this Act has been committed is kept or concealed in any building, vessel or
enclosed place may, between sunrise and sunset -
(a) enter into any such building, vessel or place;
(b) in case of resistance, break open any door and remove any other obstacle to such
entry;
(c) seize such drug and all materials used in the manufacture thereof and any other
article which he has reason to believe to be liable to confiscation under Section
33 and any document or other article which he has reason to believe may fur-
nish evidence of the commission of an offence punishable under Chapter III re-
lating to such drug; and
(d) detain and search, and, if he thinks proper, arrest any person whom he has reason
to believe to have committed an offence punishable under Chapter III relating
to such drug.
Provided that if such officer has reason to believe that a search warrant cannot be
obtained without affording opportunity for the concealment of evidence or fa-
cility for the escape of an offender, he may enter and search such building, ves-
sel or enclosed place at any time between sunset and sunrise, after recording
the ground of his belief.
Under sub-clause 2 of this section, such officer, where he has recorded information un-
der sub-section 1, or recorded grounds of his belief under the proviso thereto, shall
forthwith send a copy thereof to his immediate official superior.
Under section 24, any Police Officer may -
(a) seize in any public place or in transit any dangerous drug in respect of which he
has reason to believe an offence punishable under Chapter III has been commit-
ted, and along with such drug, any other article liable to confiscation under sec-
tion 33, and any document or other article which he has reason to believe may
furnish evidence of the commission of an offence punishable under Chapter III
relating to such drug;
(b) detain and search any person whom he has reason to believe to have committed
an offence punishable under Chapter III, and, if any such person has any dan-
gerous drug in his possession and such possession appears to him unlawful, ar-
rest him and any other person in his company.
Under Section 26, it is the duty of all Police Officers upon a notice given or a request
made to assist all officers mentioned in section 23 in carrying out the provisions of this
Act.
Under Section 27, whenever any Police Officer makes any arrest or seizure under this
Act, he shall, within 48 hours next after such arrest or seizure make a full report of all
the particulars of such arrest or seizure to his immediate official superior.
Under Section 29, every person arrested and article seized under a warrant issued under
The Police Station 623

Section 22 shall be forwarded without delay to the authority by whom the warrant was
issued; persons arrested and articles seized under Sections 23 and 24 shall be forwarded
without delay to the officer-in-charge of the nearest Police Station to the nearest officer
of the Excise Department empowered under Section 30.
The officer-in-charge of the Police Station to whom any person or article is forwarded
under this section shall, with all convenient despatch, take such measure as may be nec-
essary for the disposal according to law of such person or article.
Since Section 33 requires that whenever any offence has been committed which is
punishable under Chapter III, the dangerous drug materials, apparatus and utensils in re-
spect of which or by means of which such offence has been committed, shall be liable to
confiscation and also any dangerous drug lawfully imported, transported manufactured,
possessed or sold along with, or in addition to, any dangerous drug which is liable to con-
fiscation under sub- section 1 of that section, and the receptacles, packages and
coverings in which any dangerous drug, materials, apparatus or utensils lible to con-
fiscation under sub-secion 1 of that section is found, and the other contents, if any, of
such receptacles or packages and the animals, vehicles, vessels and and other conveyance
used in carrying the same, shall be liable for confiscation, it shall be the duty of every Po-
lice Officer acting under the provisions of this Act, to tkae into possession all the things
enumerated above.
III - THE INDIAN EXPLOSIVES ACT, IV OF 1884.
1. Under rule 106 of the rules made under Section 7 of the Indian Explosives Act, IV
of 1884, promulgated by the Government of India notification No. M- 1217, dated the
30th November, 1940, all Police Officers of the rank not below that of Sub-Inspector are
authorized within their respective areas to enter, inspect and examine the licensee’s
premises, check the stores with the Stock and Sale Register and report the result of such
inspection to the District Magistrate through the Superintendent of Police.
2. They are also authorized to search any place in which an explosive has been or is be-
ing manufactured, possessed, used or sold illegally and to seize, detain and remove any
such explosive found theirin. All such searches and seizures shall forthwith the reported
to the District Magistrate through the Superintendent of Police, by telegram, if necessary.
3. They may take samples of the explosive found therein on payment of the value
thereof, if such payment is demanded at the time.
4. The shops, premises, and stocks of all licensed manufacturers and dealers shall be
inspected once a month by the Sub-Inspectors of Police and once in every quarter by the
Inspectors and Gazetted Officers in supervisory charge of the Illaqa in which the prem-
ises are situated. At least one inspection in each year shall be performed by the
Superintendent of Police.
Surprise visits to these places shall also be made by the Police officers especially on the
eve of festivals when stocks of fire-works are likely to exceed the limit prescribed in the
license.
5. Section 13 of the Act empowers any Police Officer to arrest, without a warrant, any
person who is found committing any act punishable under the Act, or the Rules under the
Act, which tends to cause explosion or fire in or about any place where explosive is
manufactured or stored, etc.
IV - THE PETROLEUM ACT, XXX OF 1934.
Under Section 13, read with Central Government notification No. M-826(1), dated the
22nd March, 1937, as amended by notification No. M-826(4), dated the 15th September,
1936, all Police officers of or bove the rank of Inspector of Police have been authorized
by virtue of their office to enter any place where petroleum is being imported, stored, pro-
duced, refined or blended, or is under transport and inspect all receptacles, plant and
appliances used in connection with petroleum in order to ascertain if they are in accord-
624 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

ance with the provisions of Chapter I of this Act and the Rules made thereunder; within
the respective areas over which their authority extends.
Under Section 14, read with Central Government notification No. M-826(2), dated the
22nd March, 1937, as amended by notifications Nos. M-826, dated the 26th August,
1937, and M-826(5), dated th 15th September, 1937, all Police Officers mentioned in
the above paragrpah may enter any place where petroleum is being imported, trans-
ported, stored, produced, refined or belended and inspect and take samples for testing of
any petroleum found therein, within the respective areas over which their authority ex-
tends.
Under Section 26, read with Central Government notification No. M-826(3), dated the
22nd March, 1937, as amended by notification Nos. M-826(7), dated the 15th Septem-
ber, 1937, all Police Officers of rank not below that of Sub-Inspector in the respective
areas over which their authority extends have been authorized by virtue of their office to
enter and search any place where he has reason to believe that any pertroleum is being im-
ported, transported, stored, produced, refined or blended otherwise than in accordance
with the provisions of this Act and the rules made thereunder, and to seize, detain or re-
move any or all of the petroleum in respect of which in his opinion an offence under this
Act has been committed. The searches under this Act shall be made according to the
Code of Criminal Procedure, 1898, so far as they are applicable.
V - THE POISONS ACT, XII OF 1919
Under rule XII of the Rules framed under Section 2 of the Act a Police Officer of or
above the rank of Sub-Inspector may at any time visit and inspect the premises of a li-
cence-holder where poison is kept for sale and may inspect all poisons found therein and
the registers of sale of poisons and stock of poisons maintained under rules X and XI.
VI - THE SARAIS ACT, XXII OF 1867.
Since under rule 2 of the Rules framed under section 13 of the Act, - vide Government
notification No. 177, dated the 15th February, 1911, the District Magistrate may refuse
to accept as the keeper of a Sarai any person who does not produce a certificate signed
by the Officer-in-charge of the Police Station in whose jurisdiction the Sarai is situated,
to the effect that, to the best of his belief, the applicant’s character is not such as to pre-
clude his being permitted to keep a Sarai, it shall be the duty of the Officer-in- charge of
the Police Station to verify and furnish a certificate accordingly.
On being authorized by the District Magistrate under section 7(2) of the Act, any Police
officer not less in rank than a Sub-Inspector may visit and inspect at any time of the day
or night any Sarai so registered or any part thereof.
The Police Station 625

FORM No. 22.40


CHARGES FOR MAINTENANCE OF ANIMALS
POLICE STATION ______________ DISTRICT____________

F.I.R. No. ________________ Date ______________


Number of animals *Kind of animal Rate per day Number of days Total REMARKS

Grant Total
complainant.
The above charges are due to __________________________________________
surety
*1. Buffalo.
2. Bullock or cow.
3. Horse.
4. Pony.
5. Camel.
6. Donkey.
7. Sheep or goat

FORM No. 22.43(3)


Date ____________
No. _____________
VOUCHER ENGAGING ACCOMMODATION BY MOTOR-VEHICLE
Certified that ____________ seats(s) _______ has/have been engaged for the journey
from ______ to ________ on motor omnibus owned/driven by ___________ on account
of prisoners/constables.

Purpose of journey ____________________________________________

No. and date of entry in Police Station Daily Diary __________________

Amount of fare due for payment Rs. ______________________________

Signature of Police Officer engaging accommodation


(Signature) _______________________
Rank ____________________________
Date of payment and signature of gazetted officer signing the bill
(Signature) _______________________
626 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

FORM No. 22.48(1)


REGISTER No. II. - THE STATION DAILY DIARY.
STATION _____________ DISTRICT ____________
The following officers were present at morning roll-call ____________________ Sub-
Inspector______________ Assistant Sub-Inspectors __________________ head
constables ________________ constables___________ mounted head constables
______________________ mounted constables. The remaining staff were _________
on duty ____________ sick. The station is _________ under/.over sanctioned strength.
Remarks ____________
Diary of the above station station commencing at _______o’clock on the __________
and ending ____________ o’clock on the _______________
Serial No. Name of reporter Substabce of report

Signature of officer incharge of police station.

FORM No. 22.54(a) Part I


POLICE DEPARTMENT _________ DISTRICT
PART I - Absconders in cases registered in the home police station
(Residents of the home police station to be written in red ink)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Se- Name, Residence Offence, Reward Clues to Action taken to procure Signature Date of
rial parentage, , i.e., F.I.R. offered probable arrest, details to be given as of arrest,
No. caste and village, No. and whereabo to : gazetted death,
description police date, uts (a) Police Station of the officer cancellatio
of station places home district to which n or
absconders. and and notices sent. removal
district date of (b) Police Station of other to
offence district to which notices sent. proclaime
(c) Date on which notices d
sent for publication in "C.I. offender’s
Gazette". list
(d) If a P.R. - convict, date of
intimation of F.P. Bureau.
(e) Action taken under
Sections 512/87/88, Code of
Criminal Procedure with
dates.
(f) Details of any other action
taken, with dates and name of
court.
(g) Has History Sheet been
opened in home district and
name entered in Register No.
X?

Note . - This register is to be printed on foolscape folio size ruled paper


The Police Station 627

FORM No. 22.54(a) Part II


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______ DISTRICT
PART II. - Absconders in cases registered in other police stations, but residents of,
or likely to visit, this police station.
(Residents of the home police station to be written in red ink)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Serial Police Parentag Residenc Offence, Reward Clues Action taken to Signature Date of
No. station e, caste e, i.e., F.I.R. offered. to procure arrest, of arrest,
or and village, No. & probable details to be given gazetted death,
district descripti police date, where- as to :- officer cancellatio
submitting on stations place abouts (a) Action taken n or
notice, and and date under Sections 512, removal
Name of district of 87/88, Code of to
absconder offence. Criminal Procedure, proclaime
with date. d
(b) Details of any offender’s
other action taken, list.
with dates and name
of Court.

Note. - This Register is to be printed on foolscape folio size ruled paper.

FORM No. 22.54(b)


ABSCONDING MEMBERS OF REGISTERED CRIMINAL TRIBES
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Serial Name, If Tribe or Residence Reference to Associates Places he is
No parentage proclaimed caste or where police station likely to
and full under last settled register No. 8 visit.
description section 87,
Code of
Criminal
Procedure,
number and
date of court

(To be drawn by hand)

FORM No. 22.55


REGISTER No. V. - REGISTER OF CORRESPONDENCE
STATION _____________ ____________DISTRICT
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
No. Date of order, etc. By whom issued Substance of No. Date of report Substance of
order or letter report or letter
received despatched

Note. - To be drawn by hand. The heading to be written on the first page only.
628 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

FORM No. 22.56(1)


CHARACTER ROLLS OF GOVERNMENT SERVANTS OR APPLICANTS FOR
GOVERNMENT EMPLOY, VERIFIED BY THE POLICE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Annual Date of From Where Name Village How, when, Date of return REMARK
Serial No. receipt whom employed and of which and by whom of roll S
of roll received or service parentage resident character
for which of tested, and re-
applying, applicant sult of
i.e., enquiries
Railway,
Police,
Military, &
c.

FORM No. 22.58(a)


District
Register of adult criminal tribes residing in ________________ Settlement
(Prepared in accordance with sections 4, 5, 7 and 8 of Act VI of 1924)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Serial Name Caste Residence Date of Number Area to Signature Conviction Sub- Left
No. with and at time of birth, and date which of officer s giving sequent thumb-
aliases sub- registration height, of movemen preparing sections orders, impression
and caste with distinctiv notification ts are register of law, date of of person
father’s Police e under restricted under places transfer, registred
name Station physical Section or place section or and dates Cancellat with
and features 11 or 12 in making and ion of District
District of Act which an entry sentences registrati serial No.
and date under settled or (entries on, of Finger
of which erasure after death, Print slip
registration restricted, under registration remarks, and
with No. Section 7 to be etc. signature
of or 8 and shown in of
Governme date red ink) recorder
nt with date
notification

FORM No. 22.58(b)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _______ DISTRICT
Register of male children of members of Criminal Tribes
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
AREA TO WHICH THE
GANG OR TRIBE IS
RESTRICTED
Serial No. Name Father’s name Tribe Date of birth Village Police Station REMARKS
The Police Station 629

FORM No. 22.58(c)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ________ DISTRICT
REGISTER OF BOYS OF CRIMINAL TRIBES TO BE MAINTAINED AT THE
DISTRICT POLICE OFFICE
(Entries to be made strictly by date of birth, irrespective of caste and residence)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Serial Police Village Name Name of Date of Tribe Date Date Whether Date of Subsequen
No. Station of birth of boys his birth on of he is exemption t
or father according which father’ complyin under remarks
present and to registrat s g with Rule regarding
residence grand- Christian ion death, Rule 42 4(b) orders of
father Era will if with registratio
become orphan reference n or
due to change
District of
Magistrate residence,
’s order & c.

FORM No. 22.59(1) A


VILLAGE CRIME NOTE BOOK OF VILLAGE ___________________________
POLICE DEPARTMENT ___________ DISTRICT

PART I
Male
Population by census of 19 . Female
No. of houses _________________________
Names of outlying hamlets with number of houses in each
Revenue
Market days, fair and festivals
Principal castes and tribes
Headmen Other leading men Village watchmen

B - PART II
FORM No. 22.59(1) B.
PART II - Crime Register
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial No. in Date of Section of Name, Place where Name’s and Result of case
First Informa- occurence law, nature parentage, property was particulars of
tion Report and name of of offence caste and recovered persons suspected
Register complainant and class of residence of and where of having helped to
property accused or criminals conceal property or
attached suspect were found the criminals by
furnishing ball or
otherwise.
630 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

Note. - This register is to be printed in duplicate on foolscap folio size ruled paper and to be written
by carbon copying process, duplicate copy being perforated.

FORM No. 22.59(1)-C


Part III - Cases traced to the village during the year 19
1 2 3 4 5 6
Serial No. Police Station, Section of law, Name Name parentage, caste and address Results of
village and nature of parentage of all criminals implicated in the the cases
district, Number offence and and caste case whether convicted, acquitted against each
of First class of property of accused or suspected of committing the man
Information attached offence, and of harbourers, mentioned
Report, with date receivers or other helpers of the in column 5
accused

Note. - This Register is to be printed in duplicate on foolscap folio size ruled paper and to be written
by carbon copying process, duplicate copy being perforated.

FORM No. 22.59(1)(C)


Part III-A - Visits to the Village
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial Name, parentage, Name, Brief Object and Number and date of bad REMA
No. caste and parentage, caste reasons for dates of visit character roll or RKS
relationship, if any, and address of suspecting information sheet
of person visited visitor visitor received

Note. - This form shall be maintained -


(1) for the visits to villages of (a) history sheeters in bundles (a) and (b) persons es-
tablished through information sheets (Strangers roll) to be of doubtful character;
and
(2) for persons arrested in villages under sections 55/109, Criminal Procedure
Code, provided that they are places on security.
In the case of persons in class (2) the names of their sureties and the reason for standing
surety should be entered in the "Remarks"column.
Note. - This register is to be printed in duplicate on fullscape folio size ruled paper and to be writ-
ten by carbon copying process, duplicate copy being perforated.

FORM No. 22.59(1)(D)


PART IV
Notes on crime in the village with special reference to factions, land or water disputes,
presence of criminal tribes or gangs, occurrence of obstructions on or damage to railway
lines within the village, special outbreaks of crime in the village, etc., in accordance with
Rule 23.15.
The Police Station 631

FORM No. 22.59(1)(E)


REGISTER IX
POLICE STATION (NAME) NAME OR TOWN OR VILLAGE
PART V. - Names of residents who have been convicted of certain offences
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Serial Name of Parentage, Section Name Date Whether Signature Place REMARKS
No. convicted caste and and Act of of entered of of (Names,
persons occupation under Court, release in Book Police crime, parentage, caste
and age with which district, X officer if and address of
on date description, convicted sentence (Surveillan making committ convicts and co-
stated in particular and and date ce the ed suspects, places
column 5 marks and nature of Register) entry outside where arrested
P.R. No., if of the convictio with No. and the and property
any offence n of date of village recovered and
History making residences of
sheet, if it persons who
any stood bail)

Note. - This register is to be printed on foolscap size ruled paper with the heading on first page only.
FORM No. 22.59(1) - E
PART V
POLICE STATION (NAME) NAME OR TOWN OR VILLAGE
NAMES OF RESIDENTS WHO HAVE BEEN CONVICTED OF CERTAIN OF-
FENCES
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Serial Name Parentage Occupat Section Name of court Date of Whether Signatur Place REMARK
No. of and ion and convicting, release entered e of of S
convicted caste Act with name of in Book Police crime,
persons with under the presiding X, Officer if
and age descriptio which officer of such surveillan making committ
on date n and convicte court, district ce the ed
stated particular d in which the register, entry outside
in marks, trial was held, with and the
column and the powers number date of village
6 P.R. exercised by of making
No., if the court and History it
any whether the Sheet, if
case was tried any
summarily or
otherwise,
sentence and
date of
conviction
632 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

FORM No. 22.67(a)


Police Station Register, No. XVI. Part I
LIST OF VILLAGE WATCHMEN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial No. of vil- Name of village Distance and Number of Name, Residence Date of
lage according direction watchmen parentage and appointment
to the Index to from police sanctioned caste of
Register No. IX station watchmen

8 9 10 11 12 13
Age when ap- Rate of pay Population of Number of Date of week fixed for REMARKS
pointed village houses attendance at Police Station
(vide Rule 22.67, Police
Rule)

FORM No. 22.67(b)


Police Station Register No. XVI. Part II
LIST OF POLICE OFFICERS ATTACHED TO THE POLICE STATION
(Officers, head constables and constables to be shown on separate pages)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
RESIDENCE
Serial No. Constabulary Name Village Police Station District Date of Date of Literate or
No. enlistment posting to the illiterate
Police Station

8 9 10 11 12
DATES OF BEING SENT TO HEADQUAR-
TERS FOR TRAINING
For the Ist time For the 2nd time For the 3rd time Date of transfer Where Reason of REMARKS
transferred to transfer
The Police Station 633

FORM No. 22.68(a)(1)


(FORM E)
___________DISTRICT
REGISTER OF LICENSES TO MANUFACTURE, CONVERT, SELL OR KEEP
FOR SALE ARMS, AMMUNITION OR MILITARY STORES
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
INSPECTIONS BY
Assistant or Deputy
Superintendent of Inspector of
Police
Tehsil Number Name Father’s Place Date Ist 2nd. 3rd. 4th. By REMAR
of name, of Magistra KS
licensee caste and business te of
residence District,
or
Superinte
ndent
of
Police

FORM No. 22.68(a)(2)


(FORM F)
Is the same as Form E., except that in heading for "licensed to manufacture,"& c., read
"licenses to keep and sell."
________

FORM No. 22.68(a)(3)


(FORM G)
REGISTER OF LICENSES TO POSSESS ARMS, AMMUNITION OR MILI-
TARY STORES GRANTED UNDER RULES 31.
DISTRICT __________
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Tehsil No. Date Name of Father’s Residence Number Place Terms for REMARKS
license- name, and where which
holder caste, etc. description arms are license is
of to be kept valid
weapons
634 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

FORM No. 22.68(a)(4)


(FORM H)
REGISTER OF LICENSES TO POSSESS ARMS AND AMMUNITION AND TO
GO ARMED FOR THE PURPOSES OF SPORT, PROTECTION OR DISPLAY.
(A SEPARATE PART OF REGISTER TO BE RESERVED FOR EACH DESCRIP-
TION OF WEAPON, i.e., SHOT GUN, RIFLES, REVOLVERS, SWORDS, ETC.),
THE REGISTER TO BE PERMANENT
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Serial Tehsil Number Name of Father’s Residence Number Period Date of REMARKS :-
No. and license- name, and date for which renewal Action taken
description holder caste, etc. of license license is of when license
of available license expires, loss of
weapons weapon
licenced, sale
etc., etc.

FORM No. 22.68(a)(5)


(FORM I)
REGISTER OF LICENSES GRANTED UNDER RULES 35 AND 36 TO POS-
SESS ARMS AND AMMUNITION AND TO GO ARMED FOR THE PURPOSE
OF DESTROYING WILD ANIMALS WHICH DO INJURY TO HUMAN BE-
INGS, CATTLE OR CROPS
IN ___________________________ DISTRICT
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Tehsil Form and No. Date Name of Father’s Residence Place for Weapon Date of
license- name and which license expiry of
holder caste is valid license

10 11
INSPECTION BY MAGISTRATE OF WEAPON AND LICENSE
1st year 2nd year 3rd yar 4th year 5the year REMARKS

FORM No. 22.68(A) (6)


(FORM J)
_________DISTRICT
REGISTER OF LICENSES TO POSSESS ARMS AND AMMUNITION OR MILI-
TARY STORES, IN A DISTRICT WHICH HAS NOT BEEN DISARMED
Columns 1 - 7. - The first seven columns as in Form.
Columns 8. - Place where the arms are to kept.
Columns 9. - Term for which license is valid.
Columns 10. - Remarks.
The Police Station 635

FORM No. 22.68(b)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _________ DISTRICT
Register of linces granted under Excise and Opium Acts for vend in the Police Station
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Period Withing
Which License
is Valid
Se- No. of Name and Locality Articles Whether Amount of From To REMARK
rial license address of of shop which the licensed to license fee S
No. license- licensee is sell whole- for the year
holder authorised to sale or by
stock and sell retail

FORM No. 22.68(c)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _______ DISTRICT
Register of licenses to manufacture, possess and sell explosives in the District/Police
Station ___
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
PERIOD FOR
WHICH LICENSE
IS VALID
Serial Name, Place of Maximum Descriptio Description From To Date of REMARK
No. parentage business, quantity n and and inspection S
and factory of quantity quantity of made by
place of or shop explosives of explosives police
residence to be explosives to be officers of
of possessed to be possessed and above the
licensee at any manufactu and sold rank of Sub-
one time red during the Inspector
during year
the year

FORM No. 22.68(d)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______ DISTRICT
Register of Licences to possess petroleum under the Petroleum Act
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
PERIOD FOR INSPECTION
WHICH LICENCE
IS VALID
No. of Object of Name Description Place and From To Date By whom REMARK
license license and and full details S
address quantity of of storage
of petroleum shed
licensee to be
possessed
636 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

FORM No. 22.68(e)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ________ DISTRICT
Register of licenses under the Poisons Act, No. 1 of 1904

1 2 3 4 5 6 7
No. of li- Name and Place of Description PERIOD FOR INSPECTION REMARKS
cense address of business of poisons WHICH LICENSE IS
licensee to be VALID
possessed From To From To

FORM No. 22.68(f)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _______ DISTRICT
_______ POLICE STATION
Register of sarais registered under Act XII of 1867
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Serial Name and Residence Name of Situation of Date of Date of entry in REMARKS
No. parentage of Sarai Sarai Registration this Register
keeper of Sarai

FORM No. 22.69


POLICE STATION ______ DISTRICT
Police Register No. XVIII
Receipts for arms, ammunition or military stores deposited in the above Police Station
under the Indian Arms Act, XI of 1878
Serial No. __________ Date _________
Nature of arms, ammution or military stores and condition in which received ____
Name, father’s name address of depositor __________________________________
_________________________________________________________________
I certify that I have received the above-mentioned articles and have deposited them in
the station store room after labelling them. The articles will be forwarded to headquarters
if the owner has not obtained a license to possess them within seven days from date.
(Sig.) ________________________________
Station Clerk
The Police Station 637

FORM No. 22.70


POLICE STATION _________ _______ DISTRIST
Register No. XIX. - Store-Room Register (Part I).
Column 1. - Serial No
2. - No. of first information report (if any), from whom taken (if taken from a per-
son), and from what place.
3. - Date of deposit and name of depositor.
4. - Description of property.
5. - Reference to report asking for order regarding disposal of property.
6. - How disposed of and date.
7. - Signature of recipient (including person by whom despatched._
8. - Remarks.
(To be prepared on a quarter sheet of native paper).

FORM No. 22.79(1)(a)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ____ DISTRICT
DESCRIPTIVE ROLLS OF UNIDENTIFIED PERSONS FOUND DEAD

1 2 3 4 5
PLACE WHERE FOUND
Annual Se- District Name, parentage and Date on which found Village Police Station
rial No. residence of informant

6 7 8 9
DESCRIPTION
Sex Apparentag Height Complexion Particular Detail of Circumstances under REMARKS
e marks property which found and
found particulars likely to
afford a clue to be
identity of the deceased

(Standard Form)
Dated _________ 
 Superintendent of Police
The __________ 19 . 
638 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 22

FORM No. 22.79(1)(b)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______ DISTRICT
LIST OF PERSONS LOST OR MISSING

1 2 3 4 5 6 7
RESIDENCE
Annual Se- District Name of Name of Apparentag Cast Village Railway District
rial No. informant Police e Name Station
and his Station
relation to and
the person village of
missing person
missing

8 9 10 11 12 13
Date of disap- Place from Description Circumstances Detail of property REMARKS
pearance which missing of disappearance which the missing
person took with him or
which was worn by him
when last seen

(Standard form)
Dated _________ 
 Superintendent of Police
The __________ 19 . 

FORM No. 22.79(1)(c)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______ DISTRICT
PROPERTY
LIST OF UNCLAIMED CATTLE

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Annual Se- District Name, parentage PLACE OF Date of Circumstances List of REMARK
rial No. and residence of RECOVERY recovery under which articles S
person from Village recovered and
whom recovered Village Police particulars cattle
or by whom Station likely to afford with full
deposited clue to the description
owner and value
The Police Station 639

FORM No. 22.79(1)(d)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _____________ DISTRICT
PROPERTY LOST
LIST OF CATTLE STRAYED
OR STOLEN

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Annual District Name of Date of Name,, Description Brief Reward REMAR
Serial Police Station loss of parentage and value particulars of offered KS
No. and No. and theft and of property the case and
date of first residence lost/cattle circumstances
information of strayed or likely in any
repot,, if any,, complainant/ stolen way to afford a
with owner clue to the
description of property/cattle
offence or the thief

(Standard Form)
Dated _______________ 
 Superintendent of Police
The ______________ 19 . 
640 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

CHAPTER 23
Prevention of Offences
Rule 23.1

23.1 Patrolling at rural stations. - (1) The officers in charge of police stations and as-
sistant sub-inspectors at those stations shall move about in their jurisdictions freely. They
shall pay special attention to villages where crime has occurred, or where registered bad
characters and suspects whose history sheets are on record live, but shall visit every vil-
lage occasionally, for the purpose of adding to their local knowledge, becoming known
to the people, collecting information, and checking the proper performance of their du-
ties in relation to crime by zaildars, inamkhors, lambardars and chaukidars.
(2) Information regarding the mode of livelihood of bad characters shall be obtained
mainly by personal visits and enquiry, but head constables and constables shall, from
time to time, be sent to village with definite orders to ascertain whether certain specified
bad characters are present or not, and trace and whereabouts of proclaimed offenders or
absconders.
Except to carry out definite orders constables shall not be deputed to visit villages, but
they may be deputed to visit serais, ferries, camping-grounds, motor vehicles stands
and other places of public resort for the purpose of collecting information, maintaining
order or other police purposes.
Rule 23.2

23.2. Co-operations with railway police at stations. - (1) Where possible, a con-
stable in plain clothes shall be deputed from the police station to each railway station
within its jurisdiction to meet all trains which halt there and to keep to look-out for bad
characters and suspicious persons.
Constables who have special knowledge of local bad characters shall be selected for this
duty.
(2) Particulars regarding the mode of livelihood of bad character observed taking a
ticket or travelling in a train shall be reported to the railway police, if any are on the plat-
form and also to the travelling constables.
(3) Any information received from the railway police regarding bad characters or sus-
picious persons alighting from a train shall be communicated to the officer in charge of
the police station.
Rule 23.3

23.3. Patrolling by villagers. - The organization of thikri pahra and naka- bandi,
whether under the provisions of the Village Patrol Act (VIII of 1918) or on a voluntary
basis, is one of the most important duties of the officer in charge of a police station. Such
an organization should be carefully planned, with the object of providing the best protec-
tion against criminals and securing that duties are allotted fairly and with as little
inconvenience to the individual as possible. Areas or locations of patrols and picquets
should be carefully selected and the available strength of police should be disposed to the
best advantage for assisting and supervising parties of villagers. Zaildars and other vil-
lage official should be encouraged to participate actively in this duty; their
responsibilities should be insisted upon, and energy and co-operation should be promptly
rewarded. Gazzeted officers and Inspectors are required to take a close personal interest
in this branch of preventive action.
Thikri Pahra and nakabandi shall on no account be regarded as a matter of routine. The
former can be enforced under the Act if necessary, but both systems are better worked on
a voluntary basis, through the goodwill of the communities concerned. These services
should be demanded temporarily and for special purposes only during epidemics of
crime.
Prevention of Offences 641
Rule 23.4

23.4. Surveillance Register No.X. - (1) In every police station, other than those of the
railway police, a Surveillance Register shall be maintained in Form 23.4(1).
(2) In part I of such register shall be entered the names of persons commonly resident
within or commonly frequenting the local jurisdiction of the police station concerned,
who belong to one or more of the following classes:-
(a) All persons who have been proclaimed under section 87, Code of Criminal Pro-
cedure.
(b) All released convicts in regard to whom an order under section 565, Criminal
Procedure Code, has been made.
(c) All convicts the execution of whose sentence is suspended in the whole, or any
part of whose punishment has been remitted conditionally under section 401,
Criminal Procedure Code.
(d) All persons restricted under Rules of Government made under section 16 of the
Restriction of Habitual Offenders (Punjab) Act, 1918.
(3) In Part II of such register may be entered at the discretion of the Superintendent -
(a) persons who have been convicted twice, or more than twice, of offences men-
tioned in rule 27.29;
(b) persons who are reasonably believed to be habitual offenders or receivers of
stole property whether they have been convicted or not;
(c) persons under security under sections 109 or 110, Code of Criminal Procedure;
(d) convicts released before the expiration of their sentences under the Prisons Act
and Remission Rules without the imposition of any conditions
Note. - This rule must be strictly construed, and entries must be confined to the names of persons
falling in the four classes named therein.
Rule 23.5

23.5. Entries in and cancellations from surveillance register. - (1) The surveillance
register shall be written up by the officer in charge of the police station personally or by
an assistant sub-inspector in a clear and neat script. No entry shall be maid in Part II ex-
cept by the orders of the Superintendent, who is strictly prohibited from delegating this
authority. No entry shall be make in part I except by the order of gazetted officer. Entries
shall be made either under the personal direction of, or on receipt of a written order from,
an officer authorized by this rule to make them. In the latter case, original orders shall
be attached to the register until the entry has been attested and dated by a gazetted officer.
(2) Ordinarily, before the name of any person is entered in Part II of the surveillance
register, a history sheet shall be opened for such person.
If, from the entries in the history sheet, the Superintendent of opinion that such person
should be subjected to surveillance he shall enter his name in Part II of the surveillance
register; provided that the names of persons who have never been convicted or placed on
security for good behaviour shall not be entered until the Superintendent has recorded
definite reasons for doing so.
The record of such reasons shall be treated as confidential and the person concerned
shall not be entitled to a copy thereof.
Rule 23.6

23.6 Notice to headmen. - (1) When the name of any person has been entered in the
surveillance register a confidential notice in Form 23.6(1) shall be issued to the headman
of the village in which the surveille resides and the headman’s receipt shall be taken on
the foil.
When a name is removed from the register intimation shall be sent to the headman con-
cerned and a similar receipt obtained.
642 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

(2) It is most important that the notices referred to in this rule should be issued promptly
in respect of every person whose name is entered in the surveillance register in either Part
I or II, and that intimation of cancellation should similarly be sent. On the proof of issue
of such notices the enforcement of the responsibility of headman, both for ascertaining the
whereabouts and assisting in the capture of proclaimed offenders and for reporting the
movements of persons restricted or under surveillance, mainly depends.
Rule 23.7

23.7. Mode of surveillance. - (1) Police surveillance shall comprise such close watch
over the movements of the person under surveillance, by police officers, village headmen
and village watchmen as may be practicable without any illegal interference.
(2) Care shall be taken not to have under surveillance in any police station more person
than the police station staff can reasonably be expected to watch efficiently.
Rule 23.8

23.8 preparation of history sheets. - The initial preparation of a history sheet requires
great care, and should invariably be done by the officer in charge of the police station
himself or by a thoroughly experienced assistant sub-inspector under specific orders.
(1) The description of the criminal should be such as will enable the person reading
it to form for himself a picture of the individual described, special attention be-
ing given to peculiarities of appearance, gait, speech, etc., by means of which
the man may be distinguished.
(2) The space for ‘‘relations and connections’’ should be filled in with a view to
affording clues to those persons with whom the criminal is likely to harbour
when wanted by the police, including relations or friends loving at distances
from his home, and his associates in crime, abettors and receivers. The particu-
lar nature of each person’s connection should be noted against each, and, when
persons shown as connections themselves have history sheets, a cross refer-
ence with those sheets should be given.
(3) Under property, and mode of earning livelihood, such particulars should be en-
tered as will facilitate a judgment as to whether the criminal is at any time living
beyond his means; whether he is capable of furnishing a personal recogni-
sance of any value; whether he is an owner of property, a tenant or a wage-
earner, and so on.
(4) The ‘‘description of crime to which addicted’’ should be in some detail, show-
ing not merely the class of crime, but the particular type of that crime, methods
followed, localities chiefly frequented, weapons or instruments, used etc.
When these particulars have been carefully and concisely entered, the initial entry
on the reverse side of the form should be made in the form of a summary of the
individual’s criminal career up to the date of his history sheet being prepared,
and should include the particular reasons and authority for its being prepared.
Copies of history sheets prepared and published by the Criminal Investigation
Department and published in the Criminal Intelligence Gazette shall be filed
with the history sheets of the persons concerned in their home police stations.
The police station history sheets in all such cases will be endorsed wit the letters
C.I.D. and the criminal’s provincial numbers in red ink. The activities of all
such criminals subsequent to the publication of their provincial history sheets
must be communicated promptly to the Criminal Investigation Department
though the District Central Investigating Agency. Duplicate of the sheets of
criminal known or suspected to operate on the railway shall be supplied to the
nearest railway police station and the originals of such sheets shall be endorsed
with the letter ‘R’ in red ink. The District Police shall also supply the Railway
Police Station with copies of all subsequent entries made in such History Sheets,
so that the Railway Police copies may be kept strictly up to date.
Prevention of Offences 643
Rule 23.9.

23.9. History sheets when opened. - (1) A history sheet, if one does not already exist,
shall be opened in Form 23.9 for every person whose name is entered in the surveillance
register, except conditionally released convicts.
(2) A history sheet may be opened by, or under the written orders, of, a police officer
not below the rank of inspector for any person not entered in the surveillance register who
is reasonably believed to be habitually addicted to crime or to be an aider or abetor of
such persons.
(3) The Government Railway Police will maintain the history sheets of criminals known
or suspected to operate on the railway in accordance with Police Rule 23.8. They will
open history sheets themselves for criminals living in railway premises, who have been
absent from their original homes so long that the railway premises may be regarded as
their permanent residence. They may also open history sheets for wandering strangers
reasonably believed to be habitually addicted to crime on the railway, whose original
homes cannot be traced.
Rule 23.10

23.10. Custody of history sheets. - (1) The history sheets at each police station shall
be kept in three separate bundles as follows :-
(a) Bundle containing the history sheets of persons whose names are entered in the
surveillance register.
(b) Bundle containing the history sheets of persons whose names are not entered in
the surveillance register and which have not been removed to personal files un-
der rule 23.12. In this bundle should be recorded the history sheets of persons
who (1) have been removed from surveillance on probation owing to there be-
ing no recent complaints against them, but who cannot be said definitely to be
no longer addicted to crime, (2) have been the subject of action under rule
23.30, but have not yet been placed on security for good behaviour or under sur-
veillance.
(c) Bundle containing he history sheets of bad characters undergoing sentences of
imprisonment sufficiently long to justify the removal of their names from the
surveillance register until their release. These history sheets shall be put up by
he officer in charge of the police station before a gazetted officer for orders six
months before the nominal date of the release of the bad character concerned.
(2) In each bundle, the history sheets of each village shall be kept in a separate cover
on the inside of which a list of the history sheets pertaining to the village with their index
serial numbers shall be maintained. The prescribed covers for history sheets are obtain-
able from the Superintendent, Government Printing, Punjab.
Rule 23.11

23.11. Checking of history sheets. - Gazetted officers on tour and Inspectors shall
personally check the entries in history sheets by local enquiry, in the presence of the per-
sons concerned and their Zaildars and lambardars, and so far as possible, at their homes.
Such officers shall also carefully scrutinize the conviction register [rule 22.59(e)], in or-
der to see that history sheets are opened or properly kept up, as the case may be, for all
convicts, whose record justifies such action.
In checking history sheets of proclaimed offenders they shall make sure that constant
and recent enquiries have been made to ascertain the proclaimed offenders whereabouts
and to effect his capture, whether he be in the jurisdiction or elsewhere, and that all nec-
essary information about the proclaimed offender and his associates has been obtained
from or communicated to other districts and police stations.
Rule 23.12

23.12. Treatment of history sheets and personal files. - (1) the history sheet of a per-
son who is no longer addicted to crime shall be transferred to his personal file. Under no
644 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

circumstances shall the history sheet of a person who is undergoing sentence be relegated
to his personal file.
(2) The history sheet and personal file of a person who takes up his residence perma-
nently in another police station jurisdiction shall be transferred to such police station.
(3) The history sheet and personal file of a person who dies shall be destroyed.
(4) All disposal action referred to in this rule shall be taken in accordance with the or-
ders of gazetted officer.
Rule 23.13

23.13. Personal files Maintenance and disposal of. - (1) The starting of a personal file
should always be the first stage in compiling the record of suspect. As soon as suspicions
have come into record regarding an individual to an extent which indicates that he is ad-
dicted to crime or is the associated of criminals, such record should be tabulated to from
the foundation of a personal life. Subsequently, all information obtained about such per-
sons, whether in his favour or against him, shall be added to his file. The personal file
shall form the main material by which superior officers will be guided as to whether to
open a history sheet or not. It follows that a personal file must be maintained for every
person of whom a history sheet exists. On such file, bad character rolls, papers relating
to information sheets, etc., shall be recorded. See rule 23.7(B) in this connection.
(2) All personal files shall be pages and indexed.
(3)(a) the personal files of persons for whom history sheets have been opened shall be
given the same serial number as the history sheet and kept separately in a bundle.
(b) The personal files of persons for whom no history sheet exists shall be kept in a
separate bundle. These files shall not be numbered, but a list of them shall be kept in the
bundle and they shall be arranged according to villages.
(4) To prevent the undue accumulation of useless personal files, the Superintendent
may, at his discretion, order the destruction of the personal file of any person of whom
a history sheet does not exist when such person has been of good behaviour continuously
for seven years and the up-keep of his personal file appears unnecessary.
Rule 23.14

23.14. Index to history sheets and personal files. - (1) A register containing a general
index to history sheets and personal files shall be maintained in two parts.
Part I shall consists of a list in Form 23.14(1)(A) of the history sheets and personal
files in serial order as they are opened.
Part II shall be an alphabetical index in Form 23.14(1)(B).
(2) when a history sheet is opened it shall be given a permanent serial number and en-
tered in the general index. Such number shall not be altered when the history sheet is
transferred from one bundle to another, and shall not be re-allotted until the history sheet
is destroyed or transferred to another police station.
Rule 23.15

23.15. Part IV-Village Crime Register No. IX. - To ensure that the confidential notes
on village crime are kept up methodically and that information contained in them can be
readily referred, to, all entries should be classified under headings as follows :-
(i) Notes regarding influential individuals resident in or connected with the village,
who habitually abet or share in the proceeds of crime or shelter criminals.
(ii) Special types of lawlessness or crime to which inhabitants of the village are ad-
dicted.
(iii) Notes on gangs, with cross references in the books of other villages to which
Prevention of Offences 645

members of the same gangs belong, and particulars of the associates and meth-
ods of such gangs.
(iv) Notes on personal, land, communal and other fueds, which are liable to cause
breaches of the peace or to affect evidence in investigations.
(v) Notes on fair and similar occasions requiring the special attention of the officer
in charge of the police station.
(vi) Notes on individual criminal which supplement and facilitate reference to his-
tory sheets - for instance : lists of habitual railway thieves, cattle thieves, etc.,
with the localities they chiefly separate in; lists of criminals of other villages or
jurisdictions who commit crime in the village.
(vii) A list of convicts released under the Good Conduct Prisoners Probational Re-
lease Act (Punjab Act X of 1926), - vide rule 23.35.
(viii) A list of respectable inhabitants of the village who have migrated to colony ar-
eas and who can provide important information regarding proclaimed offend-
ers and absconders.
(ix) Convictions under sections 124-A and 153-A Indian Penal Code.
Rule 23.16

23.16. Bad character rolls. - (1) When a person who is under surveillance leaves his
home or residence, the village headman is, under sections 18 and 19 of the rules made
by Government under section 39-A of Act IV of 1872, required to send immediate in-
formation to the officer in charge of the police station regarding the departure and alleged
destination of such person. Under the same rules village headmen are required to report
immediately any information obtained by them regarding the whereabouts of proclaimed
offenders, whose names are entered in Part I(a) of register X, or regarding the absence
from the limits to which they are restricted of persons entered in Part I(b), (c) or (d) of
the same register, and the surveillance of these persons, and the verification of their
whereabouts, shall, thereafter, be effected in the manner prescribed in the following sub-
rules.
(2) Upon receipt of such information the officer in charge of the police station shall
send a bad character roll prepared by the carbon copying process in form 23.16(2) (Police
station register X-A), to the officer in charge of the police station to whose jurisdiction
such person is believed to have gone. A roll shall similarly be sent when credible infor-
mation is received of the presence of a proclaimed offender in another police station.
(3) The officer receiving the bad character roll shall acknowledge its receipt and shall
take steps to ascertain whether the bad character has arrived within his jurisdiction, and,
if so, shall arrange to have his movements watched, or , in the case of proclaimed offender
arrest him and take suitable action regarding his harbourers.
A note of the movements and doings of the bad character shall be made in the roll and,
if he moves on the another police station, the roll shall be forwarded to such police station
and the same procedure followed. An entry regarding each such roll received shall be
made in police station register X-B, Form 23.16(3).
(4) When the roll is received back in the police station from which it was originally des-
patched, a note of any useful information recorded therein shall be made in the history
sheet and the roll filed with the personal file, the acknowledgement referred to above be-
ing attached to the foil of the bad character roll the date and time of the bad character’s
return to his home shall be verified and noted on the back of the roll before it is finally
filed.
(5) If a notorious bad character or a convict, who has been classed P.R.T. under the
rules in the Police Finger Print Bureau Manual, absents himself and is likely to visit two
or more districts, a copy of his bad character roll shall be sent to the office of the Su-
646 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

perintendent and Form 23.16(5) completed and submitted to the Assistant Inspector-
General, Crime and Criminal Tribes, for publication in the Criminal Intelligence Gazette.
When necessary, information regarding the movements of such persons may be com-
municated by telegraph.
(6) The district police shall send information by the quickest means to the Railway Po-
lice Station concerned about the absence of a bad character for home the Railway Police
maintains a history sheet. Message should be sent by telephone or telegram where pos-
sible and bad character rolls should be forwarded without delay. Information should also
be given to the Superintendent of Police who will pass it on as quickly as possible to the
Assistant Inspector-General, Government Railway Police.
Rule 23.17

23.17 Information sheets. - (1) Information sheets in Form 23.17(1) shall be used by
an officer for the double purpose of obtaining and communicating information about
residents of other police station jurisdictions who are known or believed to have visited
his police station jurisdiction with criminal intent.
(2) Information sheets shall be issued by an officer in charge of a police station as
means of ascertaining the antecedents of persons :-
(a) who are genuinely believed to have committed an offence whether or not they
have been or are to be arrested;
(b) who have been arrested under section 55, Criminal Procedure Code;
(c) who are genuinely believed to be of suspicious character.
The officer in charge of police station shall send an information sheet in Form 23.17(1)
as soon as possible to the officer in charge of the police station of which such person
claims to be a resident, giving :-
(i) an account of the circumstances in which such person came to notice.
(ii) an account of the offence if any with which such person is believed to be con-
nected.
(iii) the names and a statement of the characters of the persons with whom such per-
son has been associating, and
(iv) any statement made by such person about his own reputation and status and as-
sociates in his own jurisdiction,
and enter its despatch in Police Station Register No. XII, Form 23.17(2).
(3) Continuation information sheets shall be issued whenever necessary as a means of
communicating information obtained or genuine suspicions formed after the issue of the
original information sheet.
(4) Final information sheets shall be issued as soon as possible after the conclusion of
the police investigation, or of the judicial trial, or of the magisterial proceedings. Such fi-
nal reports shall as far as possible be drafted by the officer in charge of the police station
himself and shall be summary of the whole matter, giving in detail the result of the inves-
tigation or trial or proceedings, the names of co-accused or associates, if any, the names
of sureties and of discredited defence witnesses, if any, the places if any where property
was recovered or absconders found, and any other facts that may be of value for criminal
intelligence records.
(5) Information sheets, original continuation and final, shall be issued in triplicate.
The officer in charge of the police station shall send one copy to the Superintendent of Po-
lice of his own district to enable the Criminal investigation Agency to extract any
information of value, and shall send the other two copies to the officer in charge of the po-
lice station addressed.
Prevention of Offences 647

(6) The officer in charge of a police station receiving an information sheet in duplicate
shall cause an entry to be made to register XII-A [Form No. 23.17(6)], the index of infor-
mation sheets received. He shall then record on the back of the copies all the information
about the person, such as his antecedents, relations and associates as may help the enquir-
ing officer in his investigation or in his search for absconders or for co-accused or for
stolen property. One copy shall then be returned to the enquiring officer and the other
copy shall be filed in the police station receiving the information sheet.
(7)(a) In the police station issuing the sheet, information sheets of persons finally con-
sidered to be of criminal suspect character shall be filed in bundles according to the
village visited by such persons, and within such village bundle according to the type of
crime to which they are suspected of addition.
(b) In the police station receiving the sheet, information sheets of persons finally con-
sidered to be of criminal or suspect character shall be filed with their personal files, if any,
if there is no personal file, and if none is started on receipt of the information sheet, it shall
be filed according to the village of residence and within the bundle relating to such vil-
lage according to the type of crime of which the person is suspected.
(c) In both issuing and receiving police stations informations sheets of persons finally
considered to be of good character shall be destroyed.
Rule 23.18

23.18. Hue and cry notices. - (1) Whenever it is required to have a search made for an
absconding suspect, or to issue warnings for precautions to be taken against a particular
type of offence or particular individuals, the officer in charge of the police station or the
investigating officer shall, in addition to such action as may be taken in accordance with
rule 26.5, issue a hue and cry notice in Form 23.18(1). The officer who decides to issue
such a notice shall personally complete the original form, recording all descriptive and
other information, which may assist the recipient of the Form to take effective action, pay-
ing particular attention to the specification of the routes and places to be watched. He
shall cause the original form to be conveyed as speedily as possibly to the police station,
with precise instructions as to where copies are to be sent after the necessary entry has
been made in Register No. IV. Hue and cry notices shall not be broadcasted indiscrimi-
nately, but shall be sent with the utmost despatch to those places, whether within or
outside the jurisdiction of issue, where special action is required. In all cases, when an ab-
sconder is likely to travel by railway, copies of hue and cry notices shall be sent to the
railway police stations and outposts concerned.
(2) A copy of every hue and cry notice of an absconder shall also be sent to the office
of the Superintendent of Police, in order that an entry may be made in the district register
of absconders (rule 23.20) and that, if the Superintendent of Police or head of the prose-
cuting branch thinks it fit, copies may be sent to other districts or to the Criminal
Investigation Department.
(3) In cases where the absconder is known to have associates, relatives, or resorts in
two or more districts and when the offender is not immediately arrested, a notice is Form
23.18(1) in English shall be sent to the Assistant Inspector-General, Crime and Criminal
Tribes, for publication in the Criminal Intelligence Gazette. In cases where a reward is
offered the amount should be stated on the form.
(4) Officers in charge of police stations receiving hue and cry notices shall take imme-
diate action, as the circumstances of each case may indicate to be necessary.
(5) Care shall be taken that, whenever the necessity for action asked for in a hue and cry
notice ceases to operate, a notice of cancellation shall be issued to all to whom the original
notice was sent.
Rule 23.19

23.19 Dissemination of intelligence of serious offences. - (1) In cases of murder by


648 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

dacoits or robbers, drugging with intent to rob, dacoity, serious robbery and serious of-
fences involving interference with the working of the railway, when the culprits are not
immediately apprehended, the officer in charge of the police station shall send written
notices or telephone or telegraph messages, to neighbouring police stations and to such
other police stations as are concerned, whether in the same district or not,giving all par-
ticulars likely to afford a clue to the offenders. He shall also arrange for the
dissemination of such intelligence throughout his jurisdiction.
(2) In order that this rule, and rule 23.18 above, shall be promptly complied with, of-
ficers in charge of police stations shall have ready a system by which intelligence can be
quickly disseminated. They shall use for this purpose any telephone and telegraph system
existing, the visits of chaukidars and other persons to police station, the post office and
any other existing local means.
Rule 23.20

23.20. District register of absconders. - (1) In each district a register of absconders in


Form 23.20(1) shall be maintained by the head of the prosecuting agency. The register
shall be divided into two parts :-
Part I - will contain the names of all absconders in cases of the home district, irre-
spective of their residence, about whom information in Form 22.54(a), or oth-
erwise, has been received.
Part II - will contain the names of absconders in cases of other districts who are resi-
dent of the home district or likely to visit it. All entries regarding residents of
the home districts shall be made in red ink.
The names in both parts shall be entered, as far as possible, according to the police sta-
tions of which the absconder is resident or from which he is absconding.
(2) As soon as an absconder has been proclaimed under section 87, Code of Criminal
Procedure, his name shall be entered in the Proclaimed Offenders register prescribed in
rule 22.22(1), a note being made in the column for remarks to this effect.
(3) Should action under section 87, Code of Criminal Procedure, not be taken against
an absconder for any reason, such a lack of evidence, etc., his name shall be struck out and
a remark added giving reasons in the column of remarks.
(4) When a person whose finger impression slip is on record absconds, information of
the fact shall be sent to the Finger Print Bureau. All re- arrests of such absconders shall
be communicated to the Finger Print Bureau.
(5) When a criminal tribesmen restricted under section 11 of the Criminal Tribes Act
absconds, information to the fact together with as many particulars of the individual as
possible, shall be communicated promptly to the Assistant to the Inspector General,
Criminal Tribes. All re-arrests of such absconders shall be communicated to that officer
in a monthly return to be submitted in the first week of each month.
Note (1). - The term absconder shall be held to mean a person of a cognizable offence against the
officer incharge of the police station concerned considers that there is sufficient evidence to
justify his arrest, but whose whereabouts are unknown.
Note (2). - A separate register shall be maintained for absconding member of criminal tribes
wanted in connection with offences under the Criminal Tribes Act.
Rule 23.21

23.21. Register showing progress of action against absconders and proclaimed of-
fenders. - In order that a proper check may be kept on the progress of action prescribed
in rule 21.5 and 26.5, the head of the persecuting agency, shall maintain a register in
Form 23.21. The register shall be examined at frequent intervals by the Superintendent
of Police, gazetted officers and inspectors in supervisory change of police stations and by
prosecuting officers, and the latter shall be held responsible that no delay in proclamation
Prevention of Offences 649

and attachment of property or perfunctory action in regard thereto, whether on the part
of police office or the court, is allowed to occur.
Rule 23. 22

23. 22. Register of proclaimed offenders. - (1) A register of proclaimed offenders in


Form 23.22(1) shall be maintained in each district by the head of the prosecuting agency.
The register shall being in two parts:-
Part I. - shall contain the names of all residents of the home district irrespective of
the district in which proclaimed. The names shall be entered according to the
police station of which the proclaimed offenders are resident.
Part II - shall contain the names of all offenders proclaimed in but not resident of the
district. These will be entered, as far as possible according to the district of
which they are said to be resident, residents of independent territory being
shown separately.
(2) In January of each year a statement in English in form 23.22(2) shall be submitted
to the Deputy Inspector-General, Criminal Investigation Department, showing the result
of action taken against proclaimed offenders during the past year. An abstract of such
a statement shall be prepared in the office of the Deputy Inspector-General, Criminal In-
vestigation Department, and published in the Police Gazette. The figures relating to
proclaimed offenders, who are registered members of the criminal tribes, shall be given
separately.
Rule 23.23

23.23. Revision of lists of proclaimed offenders. - (1) Every Superintendent shall


carefully revise his list of proclaimed offenders periodically and omit therefrom after
consultation with the District Magistrate and the Superintendent of the district in which
such person was proclaimed, the names of persons accused of trivial offences or con-
cerned in cases where from lapse of time, no sufficient evidence is on record or is
procurable.
(2) Due intimation of such omission shall be sent to the officer-in-charge of the police
station concerned; intimation shall also be sent to the Deputy Inspector-General, Crimi-
nal Investigation Department, in those cases in which intimation of proclamation was
given, or in which a notice issued in the Criminal Intelligence Gazette.
(3) A separate revised list shall be submitted for proclaimed offenders who are regis-
tered members of criminal tribes.
Rule 23.24

23.24. Procedure when person is proclaimed an offender. - (1) Immediately pro-


ceedings under section 87, Criminal procedure Code have been taken, intimation shall be
sent by the prosecuting agency to the police station initiating such proceedings and to the
police station of which the proclaimed offender is believed to be a resident. Such inti-
mation shall be sent through the Superintendent of Police concerned, if the person
proclaimed is a resident of another district. The primary responsibility for security the
arrest of such offender rests with the police of the station in which he is a resident. Im-
mediately on receipt of intimation of proclamation of a resident of the police station
jurisdiction a history sheet shall be opened , particulars being ascertained from the police
station, which has instituted proclamation proceedings, if necessary, and the offender’s
name shall be entered in Part I of the surveillance register.
(2) Thereupon intimation in Form 23.24(2) shall be sent to the headmen and watchmen
of the village of which the proclaimed offender is a resident, and intimation in the same
form shall be sent separately, and through the police stations concerned, to the headmen
and watchmen of all villages where the proclaimed offender is known to have relatives or
friends whom he is likely to visit. When the offender is a resident of a police station other
than that in which he is proclaimed, the officer-charge of the latter police station shall im-
650 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

mediately furnish the police station of the offender’s resident with all available informa-
tion for the completion of his history sheet and issue of notices.
(3) In the case of members of registered criminal tribes proclaimed solely for abscond-
ing from their area of restriction, intimation in form 23.24(2) shall be issued to places
where there is a likelihood of the offender being found, but names shall not be entered
in the surveillance register or shall history sheets be prepared unless specially ordered by
the Superintendent of Police.
(4) Whenever a proclaimed offender is arrested, intimation shall be sent direct to the
district and police station of which he was a resident. On receipt of such intimation a note
shall be made in the surveillance register of the date and place of arrest, and his name
shall be struck off and register, and intimation issued respecting him shall be withdrawn
and his history sheet submitted for orders of disposal.
Rule 23.25

23.25. List of Proclaimed offenders at police station. - (1) A list shall be hung up in
the office of each police station, and a duplicate thereof in a conspicuous place in the po-
lice station notice board, of all proclaimed offenders whose names have been entered
under rule 23.5 above in the surveillance register. Lists shall be similarly posted of all
proclaimed members of criminal tribes whose names have not been entered in the sur-
veillance register.
(2) Every police officer shall be instructed, as soon as possible after joining a police sta-
tion, in the names, descriptions and likely resorts of all proclaimed offenders included in
the lists prescribed above. Police officers shall be frequently tested by officers in
charge of police stations and inspecting officers in their knowledge of proclaimed of-
fenders and shall be required at all times, when moving about the jurisdiction, themselves
to obtain all possible information which may facilitate the arrest of such offenders and to
inform the public of the proclamation of arrest, and of any reward offered, and warn them
of the penalties of harboring.
Rule 23.26

23.26. Proposals regarding criminal tribes or classes. - (!) When there are indica-
tions that two or more persons are associated in the systematic commission of
non-bailable offences a proposal shall be submitted for their notification as a criminal
tribe under section 3 of the Criminal Tribes Act (VI of 1924) and for such further action
as may be considered desirable under sections 10, 11 and 12 of the Act. Such proposal
shall not be made until preventive action under section 110, Criminal Procedure Code,
and the Habitual Offenders Act has failed, and shall in the first instance, be prepared by
the Superintendent of Police and the Deputy Commissioner in consultation with the As-
sistant Inspector-General of Police, Crime and Criminal Tribes. The proposals shall be
framed on the lines prescribed in Chapter IX, section 4 of the Punjab Reclamation Man-
ual, 1932 and shall be forwarded, through the Deputy Inspector-General of the Range, to
the Commissioner for scrutiny and submission to Government through the Inspector-
General of Police.
(2) Before the submission of the case by the Superintendent of Police, a gazetted police
officer shall personally see every individual whom it is proposed to notify under section
3 and shall enquire into his or her means of subsistence and mode of livelihood.
Rule 23.27

23.27. Criminal Tribes Act, VI of 1924. - The rules made by the local Government un-
der the Act and the more important circulars dealing generally with the administration of
criminal tribes are contained in the Punjab Reclamation Manual, 1932, a copy of which
has been supplied to all district police officers. Gazetted officers and all upper subordi-
nates are required to make themselves thoroughly acquainted with the provisions of the
Act and the rules made thereunder.
Prevention of Offences 651
Rule 23.28

23.28. District criminal tribes register. - The form of the English register to be main-
tained by Superintendents of Police is given as Form A in the Rules made under the
Criminal Tribes Act and corresponds with Police Rule Form 22.58-A. As may register
shall be maintained as there are police stations in which criminal tribesmen reside or are
restricted. Each register shall be further sub-divided into parts according to tribes. En-
tries in column 7 when made shall be in red ink. A vernacular copy of each register shall
be supplied to the police station concerned which copies shall constitute police station
register No. VIII.
The Criminal Tribes register shall contain the names of all male children of members
of registered criminal tribes over the age of 12 years in the case of wandering criminal
tribes, and over the age of 18 years in the case of settled criminal tribes, unless exempted
by the District Magistrate under rule 4 of the rules made under the Act.
Rule 23. 29

23. 29. Criminal tribes-Supervision by gazetted officers. - Gazetted officers on tour


shall take with them those parts of the register which concern the police stations they in-
tend visiting, shall interview individual members of criminal tribes as frequently as
possible and shall satisfy themselves that the subordinate police are not abusing their
powers of granting leave to members of criminal tribes, and that the conditions of passes
are being strictly complied with. They shall enquire into the means of livelihood of the
criminal tribes and satisfy themselves that rule 42 of the rules made under the Act is being
enforced. They shall also enquire into the past conduct of members of criminal tribes
and make recommendations under past conduct of members of criminal tribes and make
recommendations under rule 24 to the District Magistrate for the cancellation of the reg-
istration of men who have reformed and for the registration of other who may have
reverted to crime.
Rule 23.30

23.30. Proceedings under section 110, Criminal Procedure Code or Act V of 1918.
- (1) When the history sheet of a bad character furnishes sufficient material, as report
shall be prepared in Form 23.30(1) which a view to his being called upon to furnish se-
curity under section 110, Code of Criminal Procedure, or restricted under the provisions
of the Habitual Offenders Act (V of 1918). The preparation of such reports shall not be
undertaken without the orders of a gazetted officers or inspector. When possible a num-
ber of such cases shall be prepared and collected for presentation to the magistrate of the
ilaqa on tour at some place near the home of the accused persons and witnesses.
(2) Proceedings under section 110, Criminal Procedure Code, against Zaildars, Lam-
bardars and Inamdars require the special order of the District Magistrate (Chapter 3,
paragraph 19 of High Court Rules and Orders, Volume III).
Rule 23.31

23.31. Surveillance records confidential. - All records connected with police surveil-
lance are confidential; nothing contained in them may be communicated to any person
nor may inspection be allowed or copies given, save as provided in Police Rules. The
rights of district and ilaqa magistrates to examine such records are governed by rules 1.15
and 1.21, and rules regarding their production in court are contained in Chapter XXVII.
Rule 23.32

23.32. Preventive action under sections 151 and 107, Code of Criminal Proce-
dure. - Section 151, Code of Criminal Procedure, empowers a police officer knowing of
a design to commit any cognizable offence to arrest the person so designing, if it appears
to such officer that the commission of the offence cannot otherwise be prevented.
These are the only circumstances under which the law empowers police officers to in-
terfere in disputes between individuals have interested parties, or the zail of village
officials, complain of apprehension of beach of the peace.
652 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

Police officers have no power to investigate formal/complaints under section 107, Code
of Criminal Procedure, except as provided in section 23, Act V of 1861. They shall, how-
ever, be on the constant look out for genuine information of disputes likely to lead to a
breach of the peace. Such information, whether collected direct or received by complaint
at the police station, shall be recorded in the daily diary, and a copy of the complaint for-
warded without delay to the magistrate of the ilaqa, unless an immediate breach of the
peace is anticipated, when the officer in charge of the police station shall act under sec-
tion 151, Code of Criminal Procedure, on his own responsibility. Government has held
that it is important that magistrates receiving such reports from the police should give im-
mediately to them their close and personal attention and take suitable action on the merits
of each report.
Complaints of this nature made to superior police officers shall not be endorsed for en-
quiry by officers in charge of police stations unless it is anticipated that action under
section 151, Code of Criminal Procedure, will be required and in no case shall endorsed
complaints be despatched to officers in charge of police stations by hands of the com-
plaints or informants or otherwise than through a strictly official agency. Complainants
in cases in which no action under section 151, Code of Criminal Procedure, appears nec-
essary shall be referred to the Magistrate of the ilaqa.
Rule 23.33

23.33. Convicts released before expiration of sentences under the Prisons Act and
remission rules. - The Government of India have decided that all remissions earned un-
der the remission rules by prisoners of any class in jail are to be considered absolute and
not to be made subject to the imposition of any conditions.
At it is desirable, however, for the police to be apprised of the release of such convicts,
a descriptive-roll in Form 23.33 of the all such convicts will be sent by the Superintendent
of Police of the Jail to the Superintendent of the district, of which the convict is a resident.
The Superintendent of Police shall, in an examination of all the relevant circumstances,
exercise his discretion as to whether any such convict shall be subjected to police surveil-
lance or not or whether preventive action is to be taken by the preparation of a history
sheet or a personal file.
Rule 23.34

23.34. Convicts conditionally released under section 401, Criminal Procedure


Code. - When a convict is to be conditionally released under section 401, Criminal Pro-
cedure Code, the Superintendent of Police will be supplied by the local government
through the District Magistrate with -
(a) A certificate copy of the order of conditional release with the date of release en-
dorsed on it, and
(b) A descriptive roll of the convict.
(2) If release is subject to conditions of police surveillance, the rules contained in Ap-
pendix 23.39(1) shall be applied.
(3) If release is subject to other conditions and the police are required to take measures
to secure the observance of those conditions, the Superintendent of Police shall issue suit-
able orders and instructions to subordinate officers concerned.
Rule 23.35

23.35. Conditional release under the Good Conduct Prisoners Probational Release
Act (Punjab Act, X of 1926). - (1) Under the terms of the Good Conduct Prisoners Pro-
bational Release Act, convicts, other than those specially excepted by rules made under
the Act, may be selected to serve the concluding period of their sentences outside jails
limits in licensed and paid employment. Such employment may be either under individ-
ual employers or in settlements managed by Government.
(2) The license under which convicts may be so employed is in a form prescribed un-
Prevention of Offences 653

der the Act; it provides for the fixing of the residence of the convict, the reporting of his
movements, the restriction of such movements, and for his good behaviour, and may be
revoked for breach of these conditions. A convict whose license is revoked is required to
return to jail for the rest of the period of his sentence, and, if he absconds he becomes
liable to additional imprisonment up to two years.
(3) The selection of convicts for probational release and their control in accordance
with the terms of the Act and of the license is vested in a Reclamation Officer and Pro-
bation Officers appointed by Government. The police have no powers or duties in this
respect. The Reclamation Officer is required, prior to the release of a prisoner, to inform
the Superintendent of Police of the district where he is to be employed. A list of such con-
victs shall be maintained by the officers in charge of police stations concerned in their
confidential note-books (rule 21.28). No surveillance shall be exercised by the police
over such persons who should be given every opportunity to take their places as respect-
able members of society, but officers in charge of police stations shall report, through the
Superintendent of Police, to the nearest Probation Officer, any reliable information re-
ceived regarding the commission of crime, absence or other breach of the conditions of
release by them.
(4) The Reclamation Officer or Probation Officers may call upon the Superintendent
of Police to enquiry into the conduct of convicts released on probation and to render as-
sistance in tracing, arresting and escorting to jail, persons who have contravened the
conditions of their license. Such requests shall be complied with.
(5) The release on probation and probable date of final release of P.R. convicts is re-
quired to be intimated by the Superintendent of the Jail to the Superintendent of Police of
the district in which such prisoner ordinarily resides.
(6) Offences under section 7 of the Act, viz., absconding from supervision or failing
to return to a jail on the revocation of a license are cognizable by the police.
Rule 23.36

23.36. Release notice of prisoners. - The following instructions regarding the disposal
of release notice shall be observed :-
(1) The release notices of prisoners classed P.R.T. shall be forwarded by the Super-
intendent of the Jail direct to the Assistant to the Inspector-General of Police
Crime and Criminal Tribes, Punjab, at least two months before the date of re-
lease.
(2) The release notices of prisoners classed P.R. shall be made over by the Super-
intendent of the Jail from which such prisoners are to be released to an officer
to be specially deputed for the purpose by the local Superintendent of Police. In
the case of persons to be released from the jail of the district in which they were
convicted, the release notices shall be made over to the police on the Saturday
preceding the dates of release. In the case of persons to be released in a district
other than that in which they are convicted, the release notices shall be made
over to the police at least one month prior to the dates of release.
Rule 23.37

23.37. Procedure when release notices are received. - (1) P.R.T. Convicts. - (a) On
receipt of the release notices of P.R.T. convicts, the Assistant to the Inspector-General
of Police, Crime and Criminal Tribes, Punjab, shall take such action as may be necessary
in his office and shall then forward the notices in original, by registered post, to the Su-
perintendent of Police of the district of which the criminal is a resident. The latter officer,
on its receipt, shall cause it to be entered to once in the district Finger Print Register pre-
scribed in rule 34(1) of the Police Finger Print Bureau Manual and shall cause translations
in Form 23.37(1) to be despatched to the police station of conviction, if the convict was
convicted in his district, and to the police station of residence as in accordance with rules
all convicts classed R.T. are required to be released from the jails of their home districts.
654 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

(b) If the convict is a resident of another province or an Indian State, an extract of the
release notice shall be forwarded by the Assistant to the Inspector-General of Police,
Crime and Criminal Tribes, Punjab, to the Criminal Investigation Department of the
Province or Head of the State Police concerned.
(c) If the criminal is a resident of the Punjab, but of a district other than that in which
he was convicted, the Assistant to the Inspector-General of Police, Crime and Criminal
Tribes, Punjab, shall also forward a copy of the release notice to the district of conviction.
(2) P.R. Convicts. - On receipt under rule 23.36(2) of release notices of prisoners
classed as P.R., the following procedure shall be observed :-
(a) In the case of a person to be released in the district, of which he is a resident and
in which he was convicted, necessary entries shall be made in the District Fin-
ger Print Register, information in Form 23.37(1) shall be sent to the Police Sta-
tion of residence without delay, and the release notice shall be filed.
(b) In the case of a person to be released in the district, of he is a resident on expiry
of a sentence inflicted in another district, the police station of residence shall be
informed in Form 23.37(1), a duplicate copy of the release notice shall be pre-
pared and forwarded without delay to the district of conviction for completion
of the District Finger Print Register, and the original release notice shall be filed.
(c) In the case of a person to be released in the district in which he was convicted,
but who is a resident of another district in the Province, or of Delhi, the North-
West Frontier Province or any of the Indian States referred to in Section 1(10),
Police Finger Print Bureau Manual, Part I, a duplicate copy of the release no-
tice shall be prepared, necessaries shall be made in the Finger Print Register,
and the original release notice sent to the district or State of residence to be filed.
If the convict is a resident of a Province other than that of the Punjab, Delhi, or
the North-West Frontier Province, or of an Indian State other than those men-
tioned in Section 1(10), Police Finger Print Bureau Manual, or is of unknown
residence, or has no fixed residence, the original release notice shall be retained
and filed. All such notices shall be kept together in a separate file.
The release notice of a prisoner who has died shall be forwarded by the Superintendent
of Police of the district of which the prisoner was a resident to the Finger Print Bureau for
disposal and the name of such person shall be erased from the conviction register.
Rule 23.38

23.38 Surveillance over released prisoners. - (1) Within ten days of a prisoner’s re-
lease the officer in charge of the police station of residence shall report whether or not he
has returned to his home.
(2) If the release notice refers to a convict classed ‘P.R.T.’ the Superintendent shall take
suitable measures to have such convict shadowed and shall note the substance of any or-
ders issued in this connection in Form 23.37(1) sent to the police station.
(3) Should a release notice refer to a person convicted of an offence on the Railway,
an extract shall be sent by the Superintendent of the district of which such criminal is a
resident to the Assistant Inspector-General, Government Railway Police.
Rule 23.39

23.39. Released convicts with regard to whom order under section 565, Code of
Criminal Procedure, has been made. - (1) The mode of surveillance over released con-
victs in regard to whom an order under section 565, Code of Criminal Procedure, has
been made is described in Appendix 23.39(2).
(2) Changes of residence of such convicts shall be entered in their history sheets and
reports thereof made in Form 23.39(2).
(3) On the expiration of the period for which the surveillance of a released convict is
Prevention of Offences 655

ordered the Superintendent shall exercise his discretion as to whether such prisoner’s
name shall be transferred to part II of the Surveillance Register or not.
Rule 23.40

23.40. Control of professional criminals. - (1) Files of important cases of a special


type shall be maintained in the Crime Branch of the Criminal Investigation Department,
together with History Sheets of important provincial criminals, and a brief account of the
offences for which convicted. The class of offences in which such records are to be
maintained are :-
(a) Administering stupefying drugs with intent to rob;
(b) Offences relating to coin, counterfeiting coin and the forgery of Government
Currency Notes;
(c) Professional cheating;
(d) Dacoities and offences committed by professionals, such as gang burglaries;
(e) Theft of arms and ammunition;
(f) Offences committed by criminal tribes;
(g) Offences indicating a special technique.
(2) Reports of such cases, containing all important particulars shall be forwarded by Su-
perintendents of Police to the Assistant Inspector-General, Crime and Criminal Tribes as
they occur.
Rule 23.41

23.41. Distribution of professional criminals. - On the conviction of a gang of pro-


fessional criminals the Superintendent shall, if he considers such a course advisable,
forward to the Superintendent of the Jail or submission to the Inspector-General of Pris-
ons a recommendation giving the names of members of the gang who should be separated
and confined in different jails.
A copy of such recommendation shall be forwarded to the Deputy Inspector- General,
Criminal Investigation Department.
Rule 23.42

23.42. Pathan immigrants. - Certain sections of Pathan immigrants to the Punjab are
addicted to crime; and such immigrants, whether nomadic or settled in towns and vil-
lages, should therefore, be observed, and either through the agency of their own
headmen, or the headmen of villages, where they are settled, enquiry should be made
with a view to ascertaining their antecedents. Should any such immigrants be suspected
of criminal propensities, information should be sent, as early as possible, to the Assis-
tant to the Inspector- General of Police, Crime and Criminal Tribes, who is in a
position to supply the district police with the services of an experienced officer.
Extracts from a note on Pathan immigrants, prepared in 1926, are printed as Appendix
23.42 for the guidance of district police officers.
Rule 23.43

23.43. Control of traffic - in police station jurisdictions. - Police officers attached


to police stations shall pay attention to the control of traffic on the roads of their jurisdic-
tion. It is part of the duty of officers present at police stations to take legal action in
respect of traffic offences committed by traffic passing the station house and similarly
themselves to take cognisance of or report all such offences, which may come to their no-
tice while travelling in their jurisdiction.
By constant warnings and prosecutions under the appropriate sections of the Indian Pe-
nal Code, or special laws, in flagrant or recalcitrant cases, the amenities of traffic can and
shall be ensured. The keeping of slow-moving traffic to the side of the road; the preven-
tion of obstructions of the road by gross overloading of carts; the prevention of cruelty
656 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

to animals and overloading of tongas; the enforcement of the rules under which public
motor vehicles are allowed to ply, especially in respect of authorized loads, display of the
required particulars on vehicles, validity of permits and driving licenses, and legibility
and correct position of registration plates are all parts of the duties of the staffs of police
stations. Supervising officers shall insist on the proper performance of these duties.
Rule 23.44

23.44. Conditions of colony tenancies. - Superintendents and other gazetted officers


serving in colony areas should acquaint themselves with the conditions regulating the
tenure of land in such areas. Under these conditions Government usually demands active
loyalty from all occupiers of land, and reserves powers of forfeiture of tenancies or re-
striction of rights as a punishment to individuals or communities, which fail to render
assistance in the suppression of crime. Details instructions on this subject are contained
in notifications published from time to time in the Punjab Government Gazette, or in or-
ders issued by the Financial Commissioners which are available in the offices of Deputy
Commissioners.
APPENDIX No. 23.39(1)
No. 7336 (H-Jails) dated Lahore, the 6th March, 1931
From - The Home Secretary to Government, Punjab.
To - All Commissioners of Divisions and Deputy Commissioners in Punjab.
Police surveillance over released convicts in regard to whom an order has been made
under Section 565 of the Code of Criminal Procedure.
I am directed to forward the accompanying rules framed by the Governor in Council un-
der the provisions of sub-section 3 of section 565 of the Code of Criminal procedure,
1898.
2. The following instructions are issued with a view to explain the procedure more
fully:-
(1) In every case in which a criminal court makes an order under section 565 of the
Code, directing that the person sentenced to imprisonment shall notify his resi-
dence and any change of residence after release, a copy of such order will be
transmitted by the court passing the sentence and order, with the warrant of
commitment issued under section 384 of the Code, to the officer-in-charge of
the jail or other place in which the prisoner is, or is to be confined. The Hon-
ourable Judges of the High Court have been asked to issue instructions regard-
ing this.
(2) Not less than fourteen days before any prisoner, in regard to whom an order un-
der section 565 of the Code has been made, is to be released, the officer-in-
charge of the jail or other place in which such prisoner is then confined shall
explain to the prisoner the nature of the order and the requirements of the rules,
and shall call upon him to state the place at which he intends, after his release,
to reside. The officer-in-charge of the jail or other place of confinement will
thereupon inform the Superintendent of Police of the district in which such jail
or other place of confinement is situated of the name and other particulars nec-
essary for the identification of the prisoner and also of the place at which such
prisoner intends, after his release, to reside.
(3) The District Superintendent of Police will cause intimation to be given-
(a) if the place at which the prisoner intends to reside is situate within his dis-
trict, - to the officer-in-charge of the police station within the local limits
of which such place is situate; and
(b) if such place is situated in any other district, - to the Superintendent of Po-
lice of that district, who will take action as in clause (a).
Prevention of Offences 657

(4) The rules provide that every released prisoner to whom they relate shall give not
less than one day’s notice of any intended change of residence to the officer-in-
charge of the police station within the local limits of which the place, at which
he is then residing, is situated. Within twenty-four hours of his arrival at his
destination the prisoner is further required to notify the fact of his arrival to the
officer-in-charge of the police station within the local limits of which the new
place of residence is situated.
(5) The intimations required to be given by rules II, III and IV are ordinarily to be
made personally by the released convict, at the proper police station. If any such
convict is for any sufficient reason at any time unable to do this, or if the District
Magistrate exempts a prisoner from personal attendance for this purpose, the
intimation may be made in writing or in such other manner as the District Mag-
istrate may prescribe in this behalf.
(6) Breaches of the rules are punishable under section 176 of the Indian Penal
Code.
(7) The Inspector-General of Police will issue detailed instructions for giving effect
to the rules in the Police Department.
3. This cancels Punjab Government circular No. 5-396, dated the 13th March, 1901.

9 Notification
The 6th March, 1931.
No. 7335. - In exercise of the powers conferred by sub-section (3) of section 565 of the
Code of Criminal Procedure, 1898, the Governor in Council is pleased to make the fol-
lowing rules regulating to notification of residence or change of or absence from
residence by released convicts in regard to whom an order has been made under sub-sec-
tion (1) section 565 of the said Code.
Punjab Government notification No. 395 (H-Judicial), dated the 13th March, 1901, is
hereby cancelled.
Rules
Released convicts to observe rules. - I. - When, at the time of passing sentence of trans-
portation or imprisonment on any person the Court or Magistrate also orders that his
residence and any change of residence after release be notified for the term specified in
such order, such persons shall comply with and be subject to the rules next following. In
these rules a person released subject to an order of the nature hereinbefore described is
called a ‘‘released convict’’.
Released convict to notify, at the time of release, intended place of residence to re-
leasing officer. - II. - Every convict in regard to whom an order has been made under
section 565 of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1898, shall, not less than fourteen days
before the date on which he is entitled to be released, notify the officer-in-charge of the
jail, or other place in which he may for the time being be confined, of the place at which
he intends to reside after his release.
Released convict to notify intention to change first residence at local police sta-
tion. - III. - Whenever any released convict intends to change his place of residence from
the place which be specified at the time of his release as the place at which he intended
to reside to any other place, he shall notify the fact of such intention and the place at
which he hereafter intends to reside, not less than twenty-four hours before he so
changes his residence, to the officer-in-charge of the police station within the jurisdiction
of which he resides at the time when he notifies his intention to change his residence.
Released convict to similarly notify all subsequent intentions to change residence.
- IV. - Whenever any released convict intends to change his place of residence from
658 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

any place at which he may, at any time, be residing, under the provisions of rule III, he
shall notify any intended change of residence in the manner in that rule provided.
Period to be appointed for making up residence. In default the convict to notify
his actual residence. - V. - The officer recording a notification under rule II, rule III or
rule IV, shall appoint such period as may be reasonably necessary to enable the convict
to take up his residence in the place notified. If the convict does not take up his residence
in such place within the period so appointed he shall, not later than the day following the
expiry of such period, notify in person his actual place of residence to the officer-in-
charge of the police station within the limits of which he is residing.
Released convict to notify the fact of his having actually taken up his residence at
the place specified under preceding rules. - VI. - Every released convict shall, within
twenty-four hours of his arrival at the place of residence notified under rule II or rule III
or rule IV, notify the fact of such arrival to the officer-in-charge of the station within the
jurisdiction of which such place of residence is situated.
Particulars of place of residence to be supplied. - VII. - In notifying places of resi-
dence under these rules released convicts shall -
(a) if the place of residence is in a rural tract - specify the name of the village, ham-
let, or locality of such place, and the zail, thana, tahsil and district within the
limits of which such place is situated;
(b) if the place of residence is in a town or city - specify the name of the town or
city and the street, quarter and sub-division of the town or city within the limits
of which such place is situated.
Manner of notifying changes of residence. - VIII. - Every notification to be made by
a released convict under rules III, IV and VI, respectively, shall be made by such convict
personally at the proper police station:
Provided that -
(a) the District Magistrate may, by order in writing, exempt any released convict
from the operation of this rule and may permit such convict to make such no-
tifications in writing or in such other manner as the District Magistrate may, in
such order, prescribe in that behalf.
(b) if from illness or other unavoidable cause, any released convict is prevented
from making any notification required by these rules personally at the proper
police station, he may do so by written communication addressed to the officer-
in-charge of the proper Police Station. Such communication shall state the
cause of his inability to attend in person at the police station, and shall before it
is transmitted to the proper police officer, be attested by a village headman or
other village officer.
Note. - These rules will also be applicable to special orders of police surveillance issued by the lo-
cal Government in the cases of prisoners conditionally released before the expiry of the term
of their sentence.
--------------
Subsidiary Rules issued in the Police Department.
1. In the case of wandering individuals with no fixed ‘‘abode’’, an absence of one
night or more will be considered to constitute a change of residence, except
when the absence is due to a summons issued by a Civil, Criminal or Revenue
Court, or to an order issued by a competent Civil authority. All other cases must
be decided on their merits and no hard-and- fast rule can be laid down. It will
be necessary to show that the change of residence is of a permanent or quasi-
permanent nature. Mere absence from home for day or two does not constitute
a change of residence is of a permanent or quasi-permanent nature. Mere ab-
sence from home for day or two does not constitute a change of residence.
Prevention of Offences 659

2. In cases in which at the time of notifying ‘‘change of residence’’, the released


convict reports his intention to return to the existing residence already notified
under Rule II, III or IV within a period of one month such change shall be
called ‘‘temporary change of residence’’.
3. When the Superintendent of Police receives an intimation from the officer-in-
charge of the jail of an intended place of residence notified to the latter under
Rule II, he shall at once forward a copy thereof to the officer-in-charge of the
police station within the jurisdiction of which such place is situated. This offi-
cer will, immediately upon the arrival of the released convict, report the date
thereof to the Superintendent of Police.
4. When a released convict notifies a change of residence or a temporary change
or residence to the officer-in-charge of the police station, the particulars re-
quired by Rule VII shall be entered in Form 23.39(2). The officer-in-charge of
the police station will deliver a copy thereof to the released convict and will for-
ward the original to the officer- in-charge of the police station within the juris-
diction of which the released convict has intimated his intention to reside. The
latter officer, on arrival of the released convict, will fill up column 6, and, in the
case of the residence being of a permanent character, will at once return the
form to the police station from which he received it. It case the residence is to
be of a temporary character, he will retain the form until the convict reports his
departure, when column 7 will be filled up and the form returned to the police
station of issue.
5. On arrival at the police station within the jurisdiction of which his new residence
is situated, the released convict will produce his copy of the form and get the
date of his arrival entered in column 6. In the case of a permanent change of
residence his copy will be returned to him at once. In the case of temporary
change of residence, it will be kept until the date of departure is verbally re-
ported. Column 7 will then be filled up, and the copy will be returned to the re-
leased convict to make over to the officer from whom he originally received it.
6. The names of such released convicts will be entered in the surveillance register
(Police Station Register No. X).
APPENDIX No. 23.42
NOTE ON THE CONTROL OF PATHAN IMMIGRANTS TO THE PUNJAB.
I. The temporary sojourn in the Punjab of large number of nomad or semi- nomad
Pathans results annually in crime, the importance of which is disproportionate to its ac-
tual amount. Such crime, if it remains unpunished, is bound to have a demoralising effect
on the criminal administration of the districts concerned.
II. The extent of the Pathan immigration. - The first step towards controlling the
criminal propensities of Pathan immigrants is to appreciate to extent and main compo-
nents of the annual influx. Exact figures are not available, but, from what is known of the
numbers of Afghan subjects entering British India by various Passes, it is safe to take
1,00,000 as a conservating estimate of the extent of this immigration alone. The whole
of this number does not come East of the Indus. The majority of families remain for the
winter in the districts or the North-West Frontier Province and a proportion of the able
bodied males also find employment in that Province. On the other hand a large number
of Pathans, not included in the estimate given, enter or pass through the Punjab every
year from the independent tribal territory and the settled districts of the NorthWest Fron-
tier Province. The number in this latter category probably fully equals that proportion of
Afghan nomads which remain west of the Indus; so 100,000 is a reasonable figure at
which to place the total of those with whom the Punjab is concerned.
It has been suggested, from time to time, that all these immigrants should be registered
by some means or another or entering British India. Such a measure could be put into
660 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

force at the cost of considerable special expenditure and special organisation on the part
of Government, and of wholesale interfere with the normal movements of the seasonal
migration. A study of the subject shows that registration would not lead to the desired re-
sults and is not necessary.
III. The composition of the immigration. - The main division of Pathans who habitu-
ally visit India may be briefly described as follows :-
A. Afghan subjects and residents of Independent Tribal Territory.
1. Northern Ghilzais, Ningraharis, & c.,who enter India via Khyber Pass and Kur-
ram Valley. These are mainly camel drivers or labourers, and the vast majority
of them give no trouble. Occasionally a gang of bad characters from this class
is formed, and, the crimes committed by such a gang are often of a particularly
violent nature.
2. The Southern Ghilzais or ‘‘Powindahs’’, who enter India mainly by the Tochi
and Gumal Valleys. These tribes usually leave their families in the Derajat,
while the men disperse over the length and breadth of India, trading in cloth or
other goods and, with their camels, acting as carriers on the large scale. From
the point of view of general public security in the Punjab, this very large class
may be classified as non-criminal. They dabble in the arms and forged note traf-
fic and are said occasionally to be addicted to misappropriation of goods en-
trusted to them as hired carriers. On rare occasions parties which have made
their permanent winter encampments in the Mianwali district instead of in the
Derajat, may be concerned in a dacoity. the control of such parties, however, is
a purely local problem, which the lines stereotyped by long unaged in the neigh-
bouring trans-indus districts.
3. Tribal contingents from Khost and other parts of the Afghan Province of ‘‘Simat-i-
Janubi’’. On the basis of information at present available this division of immigrants
appear to be one of the main causes of concerned from the point of view of crime. It in-
cludes various tribes, but the Jadrans (or Zadras) come in the greatest numbers to the
Punjab. These tribes have in the past given but nebulous allegiance to Kabul and have
been a perpetual source of trouble both to their own Government against which they were
in open rebellion in 1924 - and to the Frontier Province Administration. They are, for
the most part exceedingly poor and, compared with most Pathans, degenerate, but hardy.
those who come to the Punjab in the winter scatter all over the Province, but chiefly in
the North-Western Districts, in small parties, often with their families, and include a
high proportion of criminals. The nature of their activities and proposals for their control
will be discussed later.
4. Immigrants from among the Baluchistan Tribes. - There is record of occasional
crime by this class, and their habits and composition require study.
5. Immigrants from North-West Frontier Province Tribal Territory. - This class is dis-
tinct from the various categories of Afghan subjects, in that their influx into India is in
no sense tribal. Adult males from almost all the trans-border tribes come to or through
the Punjab in numbers which vary according to the characteristics of the various tribes
and to locally prevailing conditions, but they all come in their individual capacity in
search of a temporary livelihood. In the Punjab this class usually finds its way to the scene
of work on big contracts. The class includes many habitual criminals, whose control de-
mands special measures.
B. British subjects from the Districts of the North-West Frontier Province.
This second main division should, for purposes of applying suitable control be subdi-
vided into various categories, but it will suffice here to consider it as one, especially as
the greater number of immigrants belonging to it come from the Northern districts of Haz-
ara and Peshawar.
The main feature of this class is that it includes a large number or habitual offenders of
Prevention of Offences 661

two kinds; (a) men who desire to escape the attention of the Police at their homes, (b) men
who, to ensure immunity in a deliberately criminal career in the Punjab and other Prov-
inces, are scrupulously careful of their reputation at their homes.
There is one more category of Pathans which must not be overlooked in considering
this subject. In many of the large towns of the Punjab there is a considerable number of
Pathans permanently settled. Their status varies from that of substantial contractors to
tea-shopkeepers or tonga drivers. Their importance lies in their position as ‘‘contracts’’
between wandering Pathans and local people or local knowledge.
IV. The nature of crime attributed to Pathans. - The classes of crime committed by
Pathans may be summarised as follows :-
(1) Raids by gangs formed in independent territory and descending to commit a
specific offence, retiring thereafter back to independent territory. On the
grounds of the history of such cases it is an absolutely fair statement to say that,
if there are no Punjabi outlaws in tribal territory, there will be no raids of this na-
ture. Between 1915 and 1923, Mahsud gangs harried in the Isa Khel tahsil,
led by Kulu, an Isa Khel outlaw. The Attock district has suffered when its own
outlaws have been living with Kohat Pass Afridis and have led gangs from
there. Attock and Rawalpindi suffered inthe years before the War, when Sultan,
a Rawalpindi outlaw, was in the Black mountain and when Fazlo and his gang
were with the Gaduns. The recent Hassanabdal raid is a partial exception, but
the local ‘‘razdari’’ without which no raid is ever committed was provided in
that case by the employment of a Pathan (in fact an Afghan Shinwari) as
chowkidar - a form of imbecility which might well be prohibited. The preven-
tion of raids in the Frontier Province is mainly a matter of sustained activity
against outlaws. In the less complicated conditions in this respect in the Punjab,
similar action should provide an absolute preventive.
(2) Dacoities by gangs of Pathans residing temporarily in the Punjab. This is one
of the two classes of crime by Pathans, which most requires special measures
of prevention. The first stage in evolving such measures is to ascertain the cir-
cumstances in which and by whom this class of crime is committed and so to
concentrate preventive action where it can be effective.
(3) House breaking, animal theft and cognate offences committed by Pathans.
Crime of this type is usually due to large concentration of Pathan labour or to the
formation of a particular gang of expert criminals.
(4) Specialised crime carried on by Pathans alone or by Pathans and Punjabis in
combination. This now exists to a serious and dangerous extent, especially in
respect of the smuggling of excisable commodities and the traffic in arms, and
undoubtedly requires special measures of prevention.
V. Organisation. - The foregoing summary shows that the types of crime committed by
Pathans and the criminal element among the immigrants are readily defined. Control can
be obtained through concentration within these limits rather than by sweeping restric-
tions.
The primary need is to make generally available to the police in districts as much infor-
mation as possible in regard to this class of crime and to co- ordinate their methods of
dealing with it. The organisation to this end should be suited to the requirements of all
India and all that is needed is the development of existing machinery. Bombay and Cal-
cutta already have ‘‘Pathan Sections’’ in the Crime Branch of their Criminal Investigation
Departments. The Punjab has the embryo of a similar section. The North- Western
Frontier Provinces have a section which devotes intensive attention to the arms trade.
It has been mentioned that there is a class of criminals, having their homes in the North-
West Frontier Province Districts,who have clean records at their homes, but make
profession of crime in other Provinces. the record was published a few years ago of one
662 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

such individual against whom nothing was known at his home, though, when finally ar-
rested in the Central Provinces, some thirty serious crimes with violence were traced
against him; special attention is needed to ensure that, by the proper use of History
Sheets, Bad Character Rolls and Intimation Sheets, such cases are brought under strict
surveillance at their homes, and are treated precisely as if they were locally troublesome.
The not unnatural tendency, in the absence of special supervision is for the local police
to turn the blind eye to such cases.
So far as residents of the administered districts of the Frontier Province are concerned
effective control of wandering criminals is quite practicable, provided the normal po-
lice machinery for the interchange of information is efficiently worked and followed by
action in the ‘‘home’’ Police Station under the security sections of the Criminal Proce-
dure Code, and for restriction of movement under the Habitual Offenders Act (which is
in force in the North-West Frontier Province) or under section 36 of the Frontier Crimes
Regulation. The control of these British subjects covers quite half the danger field.
Where Afghan subjects and independent tribesmen are concerned direct control is not
easy, and wholesale scrutiny is almost impracticable in view of the fact that the migration
in the autumn and spring is compressed into a few weeks, during which, literally, a tor-
rent of humanity flows through the Passes. Friendly contact can be made with the
Maliks and leading men of the vast majority of well behaved immigrants, and,through
them, as much valuable information and assistance in controlling lawless elements can
be obtained. The Pathan is peculiarly amenable to friendly co-operation of this nature,
and nothing is likely to be so effective in isolating the criminals from the well behaved
and bringing them under effective control, as the provision of a sufficiency of officers
in the Punjab, who understand enough about Pathans to gain some measure of the confi-
dence of the well conducted, and to inspire some wholesome dread in the ill-disposed.
It appears essential that the Punjab Criminal Investigation Department should have a
Pathan section consisting of at least 1 inspector, 1 sub- inspector and 4 or 5 head consta-
bles, obtained on deputation from the Frontier Province with perhaps an element from
Baluchistan. Although the Pathan immigration is a matter of the winter months only, it
will be shown that the staff suggested could be most usefully and fully employed through-
out the year. This section of the Punjab Criminal Investigation Department (and similar
sections in other Provinces which suffer from pathan criminality should work in the com-
pletest co-operation with the Peshawar Criminal Investigation Department, by
exchanging information, by seeing that information is both made available to and used
by districts, and in devising and operating methods to meet different varieties of crime.
It is noticeable at present, both that ridiculously little information is generally available
on the subject of Pathan crime, and that what little has been made available is not acted
upon. The Criminal Intelligence Gazette should be much more freely used both or the
publication of particulars of individual suspects, for general information regarding the
habits and modus operandi of different gangs or classes of Pathans and for instruction in
regard to methods of prevention and detection. The Pathan experts in the Criminal Inves-
tigation Department should also be used, especially during the winter, in touring areas
where Pathans are settled either in villages or on big contracts, with the object of bringing
the local police into touch with the settlers, marking down and initiating action in respect
of bad characters among them, and assisting in the investigation of cases in which Pathans
are suspected to have been concerned.
To supplement this small body of experts it is suggested that selected sub- inspectors of
the Punjab Police might be sent in batches of 5 or 5 every year for a period of 3 months
attachments to the North-West Frontier Province. In this period they should cover as
many of the Frontier Districts as possible with the object of acquiring an elementary ac-
quaintance with the many different types of Pathans, and with their country and
language. Such selections would naturally be made chiefly from the North-Western Dis-
tricts of the Province, as these are most closely concerned. It would be advantageous
that these Punjab officers should be attached definitely to an experienced inspector in
Prevention of Offences 663

each Frontier District which they visit, so that one individual may be responsible for giv-
ing them the most comprehensive instruction and hints. In some instances in the past,
districts such as Sargodha have obtained the loan for one or more Pathan Non-commis-
sioned Officers direct from one of the Frontier Province District; this is a useful
supplement to other measures suggested. the object of the deputation to Frontier Dis-
tricts is to meet to some extent the present practical difficulty in Pathan cases. There is
often no single police official in a district who knows enough about Pathans to make
even the simplest inquires from them or to distinguish between a Powndah and
Peshawari. With the machinery improved on the lines suggested it would become pos-
sible systematically to tackle the various classes of crime and professional criminals
which have been described.
VI. Preventive measures. - Dacoities other than raids, are committed by two main
classes of Pathans, the poverty-striken labourers from Khost, who have been already de-
scribed, and bad characters mainly from the Peshawar or Hazara Districts. All such cases
should be regarded as requiring Criminal Investigation Department assistance in their in-
vestigation, in order that all the resources of ‘‘Intelligence’’ on the subject may be brought
to bear and that gang ramifications may be thoroughly sifted with a view not only to con-
victions in isolated cases, but comprehensive preventive action. Investigations now
proceedings the Western Range afford instances both of the benefit of Coordinated and
the defects of isolated action. From the pooling investigations in several districts it is now
clear - and there are good ground for hope that the case can be proved - that for years past
dacoities of a particular types have been committed, to the number of about a dozen an-
nually, by the ‘‘badmash’’ element of one or two small sections of the Jadran tribe from
Khost. The culprits probably amount to not more than 60 or 70 in all, from which total,
gangs 5 to 20 in number have been habitually formed for committing specific dacoities
at places previously spied out by individual members of the faternity. More than 40 ar-
rests have been made of persons suspected to belong to this criminal group, but, before
co-operation could be fully set going, several of these suspects had been released by in-
dividual districts, because in their own particular cases, evidence for prosecution was
lacking. The investigation is now being controlled by the Criminal investigation Depart-
ment, and special assistance has been obtained from peshawar. It is premature to
recommended any particular action, but apart from the possibilities of individual or gang
prosecutions, it seems probably that it will be possible to put forward a strong case for
excluding the particular Afghan-tribes concerned from India for a term of years, or for
registering it as a ‘‘Criminal Tribe’’ in the Punjab.
This investigation affords a clear indication of the process by which special staff of ex-
port should be able , by investigations into the habits of all classes of Pathan immigrants,
to eliminate the well behaved and concentrate on the genuine criminals. the action to be
taken where dacoities are being committed by Pathans of British territory is, as had al-
ready been indicated, merely the thorough application of normal police procedure.
The use of the provisions of section 109, Criminal Procedure Code and of the Foreign-
ers Act have repeatedly been advocated for controlling suspected Pathans. The former is
not a very valuable weapon when almost every Pathan around in the Punjab is able and
willing to earn his living by honest labour and can always produce evidence to that effect.
The use of the Foreigners Act is confined to Afghan subjects and independent tribesmen
and their deportation to the Frontier is of no avail if they return immediately to another
part of the Punjab, where the chances of their suffering the penalty of violation of the ex-
pulsion order are negligible. Where the Foreigners Act is used to seems advisable that
photographs, finger prints and descriptive rolls of the deportee should be widely circu-
lated. There appears to be no legal method of deporting from the Punjab, merely on
suspicion, a resident of one of the administered districts of the Frontier Province, but,
whenever a conviction,even under section 109, Criminal Procedure Code, or in a trivial
offence, has been obtained against such an individual, it is possible to get him back to his
home by classifying him for transfer to his home jail for release (i.e. P.R.T.). The Regu-
664 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

lations might will be amended, if necessary, to permit of this being done. Police co-op-
eration would ensure that a habitual criminal so transferred would be restricted on
release from jail.
The next category requiring attention is the gang labour under contractors. This
branch of the subject requires detailed study by the expert staff. It appears that these la-
bour gangs are on the whole well behaved - though if memory serves, Pathan labour gave
considerable trouble when the Upper Jhelum Canal was being dug. Lately they have
come chiefly to notice in connection with fairly petty thefts of cattle,contractor’s don-
keys and so on. there is no doubt, however, that dangerous criminals are likely to be
found among such gatherings. - both men who will commit skilled or violence crime and
men who desire to disappear from a serious hue and cry elsewhere. Labour contractors
- often themselves Pathans - or ‘Jemadars’ should be made to assist the police in shifting
the antecedents of their men, reporting suspicious absences, etc. Police activity of this
sort requires to be conducted with considerations for the requirements of the Public
Works Department or other authority responsible for the work; it would be as well for
general instructions, which would meet police requirements in the matter, to be worked
out inc consultation with the Public Works Department.

Sepcialised crime, in which pathans are prominently concerned, consists mainly of


traffic in arms and in Afghan opium and similar excisable commodities. Each such
branch of crime obviously requires special attention,for bestowing which the suggested
Pathan section of the Criminal Investigation Department is the most suitable agency. It
is impossible to discuss the details of this class of crime within the scope of this note,
but two special features of it may be noted. It exists because there is the Frontier a source
of supply to meet a Punjab demand,and there is a close association which does not exist
in other classes of ‘Pathan crime’ between Punjabis and Pathans to the extent that Punjabi
frequently visit the Frontier Province to make their illicit purchases. It is clear, therefore,
that while the co-operation of the Frontier Province Administration in controlling such
enterpots of illicit raid as the village of Jam in the Khyber Agency is called for, it is
equally necessary in the Punjab at attack the local traders in and purchasers of the goods
obtainable from these sources. A further point worth recording is that the extension of
this class of smuggling is natural consequences of the permanent location of Punjabi
troops in a large number of outposts and Cantonments beyond the Administrative Fron-
tier. Before 1915 all these areas were garrisoned solely by local irregular corps. troops
were all in Cantonments in British territory where any illicit traffic between Punjabi sol-
diers and local residents was bound to come to the notice of the district police before it
developed to any serious extent. Now-a-days there is absolutely no effective check on the
doings of the thousands of Punjabis cantoned in Wazirisan and the Khyber. They are in
continuous contract with local residents, who have access to camps and cantonments on
a hundred legitimate excuses; it is little more difficult for the sepoy to buy a revolver
or a seer of opium than it is for him to buy a seer of milk. The police are helpless; they
cannot except on the strongest of grounds and with the permission of the military authori-
ties, search sepoys going on leave through Bannu, Dera Ismail Khan, or Peshawar.

An important aid to the control of Pathan criminals generally is that the police (both the
special staff and the district police) should acquire as full a knowledge as possible of
Pathans who carry on permanent occupations in the Punjab and should cultivate such re-
lations, as will ensure access to all information of importance, with such local residents
as have special contract with Pathans. In many Punjab towns there are a considerable
number of Pathans settled both in respectable commercial positions and as tonga drivers,
tea-shopkeepers and so on; there are also numerous traders, both Hindu and Muham-
madans who have a regular Pathan clientele. It is not the houses or shops of the more
respectable of such persons that Pathans seeking work or passing through a town habitu-
ally resort for help, for news of their friends and for lodging. Respectable people of this
sort, and keepers of tea-shops or lodging houses are frequently used as accommodation
Prevention of Offences 665

addresses for correspondence between Pathans including those who are criminally asso-
ciated.
While friendly relations with the better class resident Pathan, and other ‘contracts’ such
as those mentioned, would open up many sources of valuable informations, the less re-
spectable resident Pathan community requires more direct supervision, both regard
personal character and associates and visitors. Some of these residence Pathan doubtless
commit crime themselves, but it is maintainly in connection with the disposal of property
stolen by ‘‘immigrants’ and harbouring the latter before the and after commission of of-
fences, that they are important.
Though the foregoing review shows that the criminal activities of Pathans in the Punjab
are not amenable to control by such a method, it is worthwhile to consider briefly the
available experience of wholesale- registration. Afghan Passport Regulations have been
in existence for some years, including a special from of passport for nomads and drivers
of wheeled or animal transport only. Theoretically, every emigrant from Afghanistan
who comes within these categories is bound to provide himself annually with such a pass-
port, which should contain his full description and other particulars and a record of the
dependents accompanying him. the fee is Rs. 2 and the passport includes the usual re-
quest to the officials of friendly Governments to afford the bearer assistance and
protection. A considerable proportion of Afghan subjects entering India now-a-days
possess these passport. Such persons, when asked, never mention the sum of Rs. 2 as the
fee; it is always from Rs. 3 to Rs. 5. The passports are signed by petty ‘Moharrirs’ they
are but little guarantee of identity and none whatever of character. The revenue which
they bring in may be of some value to the Afghan Government and to its servants. this
aspect of the matter is the only incentive to force them upon as many travellers as possible,
but whole classes, which do not pass the headquarters of a ‘Hakim’ on their way to India,
never receive a passport. On the other hand evidence is already appearing of a tendency
on the part of subordinate police, village headmen and even magistrates to regard these
Afghan passports as guarantees at lest of bona fides, if not of good character. when the
criminal elements among the immigrants wakes up to this state of affairs, they will take
good care to provide themselves with insurance policies against molestation, even
though the issuing Moharrir may raise the premium immoderately. Instructions might
well be issued that these Afghan passports are of no value whatever as a guide to the
character of the holder and confer absolutely no immunity. In point of fact the issue of a
passport is in itself of no value without the visa of the country to be traversed. No British
Indian visa is granted on the Afghan ‘Nomads passport’ and it is understood that the Gov-
ernment of India have definitely decided to exclude nomads entirely from any system of
passport control which may be enforced on the Indian side of the Afghan border.
J.M. EWART,
Superintendent of Police, on Special Duty.
666 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

FORM No. 23.4(1)

POLICE STATION __________ DISTRICT

SURVEILLANCE REGISTER No. X


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Serial No. Name Parentage Name and Number of Date of Brief reasons Date NAME
and caste serial No. of History entry for entry and STRUCK
village Sheet in a signature of OFF
bundle officer ---------------

Brief reasons
for striking
off, with
signature of
officer

(To be drawn by hand on both sides of a foolscape-size register, columns 1 to 6 being


on the right hand page and columns 7 to 9 on the left hand. the heading to be in big type.

FORM No. 23.6(1)


CONFIDENTIAL CONFIDENTIAL
POLICE STATION _____DISTRICT POLICE STATION ___________DISTRICT
Notice to headmen and Watchmen of vil- To the Headmen and Watchmen of village __________________
lage__________ of their duties under sec- Be informed that the person named on the reverse of this notice who
tions 18 and 19 of the rules of Govern- is a resident of your villave, is a bad character and suspicious person
ment made under Section 39-A of Act IV within the meaning of s-ections 18 and 19 of the Rules of
of 1872 with regard to ________, son Government made under Section 39-A of At IV of 1872, and has
____________, caste________, a resi- been entered, by order of the Superintendent of Police, in the
dent of their village. Surveillance Register of this Police Station. Under the said sections
you are bound to keep a watch on such person and his associates, and
Signature of to report to the Police his movements or his associating with
Headmen and watchmen individuals of bad repute or ceasing to obtain a livelihood by honest
means. You are further required to report forthwith the absence of
such bad character at night, and you are liable under Sections 43 and
44 of the said rules of Government, if headmen, to imprisonment
Signature of with or without hard labour for a term not exceeding three months or
Officer in charge of Station fine note exceeding Rs. 300, or with both; and if watchmen, to
imprisonment with or without hard labour for a period not exceeding
three months or with fine not exceeding three months’ pay, or with
both, on conviction for wilful neglect of these duties.
Dated _____________19 .

(By Order)
______________ Sub-Inspector
In charge of Police Station.

(To be printed in vernacular and bound in books of 100 pages)


Prevention of Offences 667

FORM No. 23.9


POLICE STATION ____________, ___________________ DISTRICT
History Sheet
Name ________________ alias ____________ son of__________ caste __________
resident of ________________ age _____________
Number of F.P. Slip (if prepared)
1 2 3 4
Serial Index No. in Register Date of entry Description Property and mode of earning
livelihood
Property (Houses, shops, land, etc.)
Means of livelihood (Trade,, shop-
keeping, labour, cultivation, etc.)

Names and addresses of relations and connections dependent on him _________


______ _______________________________________._______________
Names and addresses of associates.
____________________________________________________________________
In case the name has not been entered in Register No. X, column I will remain bank
____________________________________________________________________
Description of the crime to which believed to be addicted.
CONVICTIONS
Serial No. Name and residence of Reference to F.I.R. Law or Details of the convictions,, with
the complainant and name of Police Section of Law the dates convictions and the
Station names of courts deciding the cases

Signature of the officer preparing the sheet with date

PART I
Written or oral suspicions.
Serial No. Name and Law and Section of Reference to F.I.R. with Brief details of reasons
residence of the the Law date and name of the leading to the suspicion of
complainant Police State of F.I.R. of house search, e.g., track
any other case evidence, decision of
panchayat, enmity with
complainant, demand of
illegal gratification or any
other reason to be entered
in full.

PART II
Particulars of movements.
Every entry should be attested and dated by the officer making it.
Serial No. Suspicion whether Information regarding the particulars Remarks or orders by gazetted
written or oral of movements or general notes as officers or other officers duly
given by the Station House Officer authorized
668 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

FORM No. 23.14(1) A

Index to history sheets and personal files, Part I


1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial No. of Name and Village Date on which Whether History Date on which Initials of
History Sheet father’s History Sheet Sheet is in A or History Sheet gazetted officer
and Personal File name was opened B Bundle or on and Personal ordering transfer
Personal File File were or destruction of
transferred to History Sheet
another Police and remarks
Station or
destroyed

FORM No. 23.14(1) B


Index to history sheets and personal files, Part II
1 2 3
Name and father’s name Village Serial No. of History Sheet and Personal File.

FORM No. 23.16(2)

POLICE STATION BOOK No. X-A. - ROLL OF POLICE STATION BOOK No. X-A. - ROLL OF
ABSENT BAD ABSENT BAD
CHARACTERS CHARACTERS
Annual Serial No. Annual Serial No.
REPORT OF ABSENCE OR DEPARTURE OF REPORT OF ABSENCE OR DEPARTURE OF A
A BAD CHARACTER UNDER SURVEIL- BAD CHARACTER UNDER SURVEILLANCE
LANCE IN No. X. IN No. X.
POLICE STATION......... ........DISTRICT POLICE STATION...... .............DISTRICT
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
Se- Points to be reported on Serial Points Serial Points to be reported on Serial Points
rial No. reported No. No. report
No. on ed on
1. Name, parentage, caste and 1 Name, parentage, caste and
descriptive marks of bad descriptive marks of bad
character. character.
2 No. in Surveillance 2 No. in Surveillance Register
Register and number and and number and description of
description of previous previous convictions
convictions
3 Class of offences he 3 Class of offences he commits
commits
4 Place to which alleged to 4 Place to which alleged to have
have gone and for what gone and for what purpose,
purpose, with information with information as to his
as to his relations and relations and associates in such
associates in such places places
Prevention of Offences 669

5 Date and hour at which he 5 Date and hour at which he left


left his village and source his village and source of
of information, i.e., information, i.e., whether the
whether the absence was absence was reported by a
reported by a Lambardar, Lambardar, & c., or ascertained
& c., or ascertained by a by a police officer
police officer
6 Date and hour of despatch 6 Date and hour of despatch of
of this report and whether this report and whether sent by
sent by hand or by post. hand or by post.

Signature Signature with designation and date.

Designation
Acknowledge of receipt.
Date (To be torn off and returned immediately on
receipt of report)
Bad character No. X absence report No.
______ of Police Station ____ District
________ was received by me at _______
A.M., P.M., on the 19 Inquiries are being
made.
Signature, designation and date.
REVERSE OF COUNTERFOIL
_________________ DISTRICT
REVERSE OF FOIL Report on conduct and movements of the bad
character during his absence, specifying dates
and hours of arrival at and departure from
places visited, names and character of
Reference to subsequent reports received regard- persons visited and object of visit.
ing this absence

FORM No. 23.16(3)


POLICE STATION REGISTER NO. X-B - BAD CHARACTER ROLLS RE-
CEIVED
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
No. Number of bad Police Name, Details Date of Action taken, if
character roll and Station from parentage and contained in return of roll any, such as entry
date of receipt which residence of roll received with precis in history sheets or
received suspect as to visit of reply personal files of
confederates, & c.

FORM No. 23.16(5)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______________________DISTRICT
BAD CHARACTER ROLL FOR PUBLICATION IN CRIMINAL INTELLI-
GENCE GAZETTE
The bad character/Conditionally released convict whose description is given below
has been absent from his home since _______.
He is under police surveillance and it is likely that he will commit crime during his ab-
sence :-
670 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

I. Description
Name __________________, father’s name_________________, caste __________,
village ______________, police station _____________. Date of birth _________,
Height ___________ feet____________inches__________Build________complexion.
II. Convictions on record -
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
III. Probable associates, relatives and resorts -
(Names of police stations and districts to be given in large type and underlined).
(1) (2)
(3) (4)
(5) (6)
IV. Fom of crime to which addicted and modus operandi ___________________
Superintendent of Police,
______________ District
1
Form No. 23.17(1)
Police Station ................ District ..............
INFORMATION SHEET
No.............,
Dated..........
Information Sheet regarding...................
alias (give second name, if any....................,
son/daughter/wife of..................................,
resident of village/Mohalla..............................,
Police Station....................., District...................,
Year of birth.......................... Religion...........................................................
Caste..................., Tribe................ Educational qualification.............
Occupation.................,
Descrpitive Particulars :-
1. Built 2. Height (in Cms)
3. Beard 4. Complexion
5. Deformities 6. Eyes
7. Face 8. Hair
9. Moustaches 10. Nose
11. Teeth 12. Location of :
(a) Burn Mark (b) Leucoderma

1. Form 23.17(1) substituted vide Punjab Notification dated 24.8.1979


Prevention of Offences 671

(c) Mole (d) Scar


(e) Tattoo
13. Habits 14. Speech
15. Dress habits
(Sd/-)..........
Sub-Inspector,
Incharge of Police Station.
Note :- The reasons for believing that the person named is a habitual offender or a suspected per-
son, to be given on the lower half of the page and additional sheet to be attached, if necessary.
(This form is to be printed bilingual in triplicate for copying by the carbon process.)
FORM No. 23.17(2)
POLICE STATION _________________ ______________ DISTRICT
POLICE STATION REGISTER NO. XII
Information Sheets Despatched.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Date of Date of Name of Name, Full Details Date of Action taken,
issue issue of Police Station parentage, discription communicate return of such as
sheet in which issued caste and of suspect d in sheet preparation of
address of information personal file or
suspect sheet history sheets
etc.

FORM No. 23.17(6)


POLICE STATION _________ _____________DISTRICT
POLICE STATION REGISTER No. XII-A
INFORMATION SHEETS RECEIVED
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Date of Date of Name of Name, Full Details Date of Action taken
receipt sheet police station parentage, caste description communicat return of such as
from which and address of of suspect ed in sheet preparation of
received suspect information personal file or
sheet history sheet,
etc.

FORM No. 23.18(1)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ____________ _______________ DISTRICT
HUE AND CRY NOTICE
The Station House Officer of _________ Police Station gives notice that __________,
672 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

son of ___________________, alias ___________, caste ___________, resident of vil-


lage ________, Police Station ________________, District _____________, whose
description is given below (and whose photograph is attached)is evading arrest in a case
under Section ____________, is absent from his home and is likely to commit offences
of ________________ I.P.C.,, F.I.R. No. __________ of 19 _____________ of Police
Station _____________ District ____________.
Action under Sections 87/88 C.P.C., is being taken against this man and any person giv-
ing information leading to his arrest will be rewarded.
Reward offered ______________________
Description -
Name ________, age_______, years _______ build _______ height ____complexion.
Characteristics, Mannerisms, & c. _______________________________
District Serial No. of P.R. Slip if on record.
Probable associates and resorts -
He is reported likely to visit :-
1. ____________________
2. ____________________
3. ____________________
4. ____________________
5. ____________________
(Signature)
Station House Officer,
_________ Police Station.
FORM No. 23.20(1)
District Register of Absconders
POLICE DEPARTMENT ________ ___________ DISTRICT
PART I - ABSCONDERS IN CASE REGISTERED IN THE HOME DISTRICT
(Residents of the home district to be written in red ink)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Serial No. Name of Parentage, Residence, Offence F.I Report Reward Clues to Date of
absconder caste and i.e., village, No. and offened probable arrest,
descriptive Police date, place whereabo death,
roll Station and and date of uts cancellation
district offence or removal
to
proclaimed
offenders’list

PART II. - ABSCONDERS IN CASES REGISTERED IN OTHER DISTRICTS


BUT RESIDENT OF, OR LIKELY TO VISIT, THE HOME DISTRICT.
Prevention of Offences 673

(Residents of the home district to be written in red ink)


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Serial Police Name of Parentage, Residence Offence F.I. Reward Clues to Date of
No. station or absconder caste and , i.e., Report offered probable arrest,
district descriptive village, No. and whereabo death,
submitting roll Police date, place uts cancellation
notice Station and date or removal
and of offence to
district offenders’list

FORM No. 23.21


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______ _____ DISTRICT
REGISTER SHOWING PROGRESS OF ALL ACTION AGAINST ABSCON-
DERS AND PROCLAIMED OFFENDERS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial No. Name, F.I.R. No., Date of A.- Date of Date of Date of
parentage, offence and absconding application publication of publication of
caste and police station for warrant of proclamation proclamation
residence of arrest B-Date under Section under Section
the absconder of return of 87, C.P.C., 87, C.P.C.
warant of with name of and steps
arrest court ordered for
unexecuted giving effect
to
proclamation

8 9 10 11 12 13
Date of issue of at- Detail of Action of Police Property attached Date of removal REMARKS
tachment order un- attachable with date of order to proclaimed
der Section 88, property of the of court offenders’register
C.P.C., and name absconder and date
and designation of of attachment
officer to whom is-
sued

FORM No. 23.22(1)


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______ _____ DISTRICT
REGISTER OF PROCLAIMED OFFENDERS UNDER SECTION 87, CRIMINAL
PROCEDURE CODE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
674 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

Serial Descri Description Residence Section F.I.R. Police Detail of In the case of
No. ption of No. Station stolen conditionally released
offence and date property property who has been declared
proclaimed offender:-
(1) Offence in which
conditionally released
(2) Village in which
released
(3) Jail from which
conditionally released.
(4) Date of release

10 11 12 13 14
Names of Relations whom the
proclaimed offenders is expected
to visit or enter in communication
(1) Place In his own In outside district Reward offered District REMARKS
which the ac- district :- for arrest Serial No.
cused has vis- (1) Names (1) Names of P.R.
ited; (2) Relations (2) Relations slip
(2) or is ex- (3) Residence (3) Residence
peted visit

FORM No. 23.22(2)


District
POLICE DEPARTMENT ------------------------------------ Range
Statement showing the result of action taken against Proclaimed Offenders during
year 19 .
the month of
----------------------------------------
Serial No. Details
1 Class of proclaimed offenders
2 Number of proclaimed offenders residents of the district at the commencement of the
year/month ________
3 No. of persons proclaimed during the year/month___________.
4 No. of proclaimed offenders residents of the district arrested during the
year/month_________.
5 Percentage item 4 bears to items 2 and 3
6 No. of proclaimed offenders residents of the district struck off under the provisions of
rule 23.23.
7 No. of proclaimed offenders still at large at the end of the year/month, i.e., items 2+3-4-
6 were proclaimed
(a) Within three months of he close of the year/month.
(b) Between 3 to 6 months of the close of the year/month.
(c) Between 6 to 12 months of the close of the year/month.
(d) More than 12 months ago.
8 Rewards paid for the arrest of proclaimed offenders during preceding year/month
Prevention of Offences 675
.

Note. - Separate sheets will be prepared for proclaimed offenders who are members of registered
criminal tribes and others.
FORM No. 23.24(2)
Counter-foil No. __________ Foil No. ____________
POLICE STATION ________________________ POLICE STATION __________________________
DISTRICT ____________________ DISTRICT ____________________
Notice to headmen and watchmen of village To the headmen and watchmen of village _______.
_________________ of their duty under section 59, Be informed that the person named and described on the
C.P.C., and rule 28 of the rules framed under sec- reverse is a proclaimed offender and it is your duty to
tion 39-A Act IV of 1872 with regard to arrest him wherever found. It is further your duty and that
________________ son of __________ caste of every owner or occupier of land and of every person
_______________, a resident _____________ and employed in the collection of revenue to report
a proclaimed offender. immediately to the police any information which you or he
(Date and method of despatch, i.e., by post, by may receive as to the presence of such person. You are
hand, etc.) required to publish this fact and to warn all concerned and
take warning yourself that any person assisting the
proclaimed offender in any way to evade arrest or
withholding information about him renders himself liable
to severe penalty under the law.
By order,
Sub-Inspector
incharge of Police Station _______

Signature of Headmen and Watchmen.


Dated ___________________
Description of proclaimed offender.
Names and particulars of relatives and
others with whom the proclaimed offender
is likely to associate.
FORM No. 23.30(1)
POLICE REPORT WITH A VIEW TO THE INITIATION OR PROCEEDINGS
TO TAKE SECURITY TO BE OF GOOD BEHAVIOUR, SECTIONS 110 TO
118, CRIMINAL PROCEDURE CODE.
PAGE I. - Name, parentage, caste, age, occupation and residence of the person reported
on -
TABLE I. - Former convictions -
Column 1. - Serial No.
2. - Complainant’s name.
3. - No. and date of First Information Report and name of police station.
4. - Law and section of law.
5. Particulars of sentence, date of sentence, particulars of the court in which
the conviction was obtained.
TABLE 2. - Reference to cases in which the person reported about has been suspected
or in which his house has been searched -
Column 1. - Serial No.
2. - Name and residence of complainant.
3. - Law and section of law.
4. - Reference to the first information report, its date, the station to which be-
longing, or to other first report in the case.
676 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 23

5. Brief particulars of the reason for which suspicion was entertained or house
was searched, & c.
TABLE 3. - Names of persons of bad character with whom the person reported asso-
ciates.
PAGES 2 AND 3. - Name of witnesses who give evidence of the reputed bad character.
An abstract of their statements.
PAGE 4. - Report of the officer incharge of the police station.
(The report to include any material information given in the History Sheet prescribed
in Rule 23.9).

FORM No. 23.33


Descriptive roll of convict ________ released from the ________ Jail on the ______
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PERSONAL
DESCRIPTION
Jail Name, Religion Caste Father’s Village, Crime, (a) Features, (b) Height Conduct REMAR
Regis- sex, name and Police section complexion _______ in Jail KS
ter No. age trade or Station, of law and
and occupation Tehsil, with distinguishing Ft. Inch.
previous District term and marks
occupati date of
on sentence

FORM NO. 23.37(1)


REPORT OF ARRIVAL AT HIS HOME OF A.P.R. OR P.R.T. CONVICT ON RE-
LEASE FROM JAIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
RESIDENCE
District Name with Father’s Village Police Offence Date of Report of officer in Final
Serial aliases name Station release charge of police order of
No. of and caste and name station of convict’s Superinted
P.R. Slip of jail arrival at his home or ent
otherwise (to be
submitted within 10
days of date of release)


 Signature of F.P. Recorder
Dated the _______ 19 . 
Prevention of Offences 677

FORM No. 23.39(2)


POLICE DEPARTMENT POLICE STATION _______ DISTRICT ____
Report of change of residence of convict subject to surveillance under Section 565,
Code of Criminal Procedure
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
RESIDENCE CHANGE OR TO BE ENTERED REMARKS
TEMPORARY BY OFFICER IN
CHANGE OF CHARGE OF
RESIDENCE POLICE STATION
Name and Caste Village, Zail, Village, Zail, Police Date of Date of Date of Change of
father’s Police Station, Station, Tehsil, departure departure arrival residence
name Tehsil, District, District, or Town, permanent
or Town, Street, Street, Mohalla, Police or temporary
Mohalla, Police Station, District
Station, District
678 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

CHAPTER 24

Information to the Police


Rule 24.1

24.1 First Information how recorded. - (1) Sections 154 and 155, Code of Criminal
Procedure, provide that every information relating to an offence, whether cognizable or
non-cognizable, shall be recorded in writing by the officer incharge of a police station.
The distinction between the form of reports required by the above-mentioned two sec-
tions has been defined as follows by the Punjab Chief Court (now High Court) :-
Every information covered by section 154, Criminal Procedure Code, must be reduced
to writing as provided in that section and the substance thereof must be entered in the po-
lice station daily diary, which is the book provided for the purpose. It is only information
which raises a reasonable suspicion of the commission of a cognizable offence within
the jurisdiction of the police officer to whom it is given, which compels action under Sec-
tion 157, Criminal Procedure Code.
(2) With the exception of cases mentioned in rule 24.10 below, in every case in which
the officer in charge of a police station, from information or otherwise, has reason to sus-
pect the commission of an offence, which he is empowered under section 156, Criminal
Procedure Code, to investigate, he shall enter in full such information or other intelli-
gence as soon as practicable in the First Information Report Register, shall have each
copy signed, marked or sealed by the information, if present, shall seal each with the sta-
tion seal, and shall dispose of the copies in accordance with rule 24.5, and if he abstains
from investigation under either of the provisos to section 157 of the Code he shall submit
the copy intended for the magistrate through the Superintendent. At the same time a ref-
erence to such report shall be entered in the Station Diary, register No. II.
(3) All such entries shall, if possible, be made by the officer in charge himself, and,
if not so possible, by the station clerk under his direction. Short lists of property stated
to have been transferred by the offence may be entered in the report, as also details of
any property recovered without search under section 103, Criminal procedure Code, but
detailed lists of property so transferred or recovered on search shall be entered in the first
case diary submitted in the case.
(4) When it is necessary to question a person bringing information of the commission
of an offence, special attention shall be paid to the following matters and the results of
the inquires shall be clearly recorded in the first information report :-
(a) The source from which the information was obtained and the circumstances un-
der which the informant ascertained the names of the offenders and witnesses
(if any are mentioned).
(b) Whether the informant was an eye-witness to the offence.
Rule 24.2

24.2 Written reports by village headmen. - (1) With a view to encouraging written re-
ports, village headmen shall be furnished with a supply of printed copies of Form 24.2(1)
for written reports of cognizable offences. The substance of the form shall be explained
to them, and they shall be instructed to give a form to every person who requires one for
use, and if so requested by the complainant to send the form by post ‘‘service unpaid’’ or
by the village watchman to the police station after it has been filled up and signed, sealed
or attested by the thumb-impression of the complainant and by the signature or seal of the
lambardar. Opportunity shall be taken to bring to the notice of the public, verbally and
by means of notices affixed to the police station notice boards, the facilities which exist
for making reports of offences in writing. It shall be explained that it is not compulsory
on any complainant to make a written report, if he prefers to make a verbal one.
Information to the Police 679

(2) Whenever a written report of a cognizable offence is received at a police station, it


shall be attached to the copy of the First Information Report which is retained in the police
station and copies shall be attached to the duplicates, provided that only the check receipt
prescribed by the form need be sent to the complainant. The original written report shall
be detached from the police station copy of the First Information Report and attached to
the charge sheet or final report when the investigation is completed. When a case is sent
up on an incomplete charge-sheet the original report shall be similarly attached.
(3) A notice in Urdu shall be prominently displayed in every police station in the prov-
ince, drawing the attention of the public to the fact that the payment of gratuities by the
public to police officials for recording complainants is strongly disapproved by Govern-
ment. The notice shall state as briefly as possible that police officials are the servants of
the public and paid by it, and that acceptance of gratuities is strictly forbidden by the
rules of the police department and renders defaulters liable to serious penalties. The no-
tice shall conclude with an admonition that demands for such gratuities should be
invariably resisted and reported to the Superintendent of Police.
Rule 24.3

24.3. Action on report of non-cognizable offence. - Where the information relates to


a non-cognizable offence, it shall be briefly but intelligibly recorded in the station diary,
shall be signed, sealed or marked by the person making it on both foil and counterfoil, and
all particulars required by section 44 of Act V of 1861 shall also be noted. A copy of the
entry in the diary made by the carbon copying process and signed and sealed with the sta-
tion seal by the recording officer, shall be made over to the informant who shall be
referred to the Magistrate in accordance with section 155, Code of Criminal Procedure.
Rule 24.4

24.4. Action when reports are doubtful. - (1) If the information or other intelligence
relating to the alleged commission of a cognizable offence is such that an officer in charge
of a police station has reason to suspect that the alleged offence has not been committed,
he shall enter the substance of the information or intelligence in the station diary and shall
record his reasons for suspecting that the alleged offence has not been committed and
shall also notify to the informant, if any, the fact that he will not investigate the case or
cause it to be investigated.
(2) If the Inspector or other superior officer, on receipt of a copy of the station diary,
is of opinion that the case should be investigated, he shall pass an order to that effect, and
shall, in any case, send on the diary or an extract therefrom to the District Magistrate for
his perusal and orders.
(3) When a counterfeit currency note is found in circumstances which indicate that ow-
ing to absence of guilty knowledge no offence under section 489-B, Indian Penal Code,
or cognate section has been committed, the information shall be recorded under section
154, Criminal Procedure Code, in the station diary; the special report required by rule
24.16 shall be submitted and enquiry shall be made to trace the point in the movements
of the note at which a cognizable offence appears to have been committed. When reason-
able suspicion of such commission arises a First Information Report shall be recorded in
the police station concerned and investigation under section 157, Criminal Procedure
Code, shall be made.
Rule 24.5

24.5. First Information Report Register. -


[(1) The first Information Report Register shall be a printed book in Form 24.5 (1) con-
sisting of 500 pages and shall be completely filled before a new one is commenced. Cases
shall bear an annual serial number in each Police Station for each calendar year. Every
five pages of the register shall be numbered with the same number and shall be written at
the same time by means of the carbon copying process.
680 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

The original copy shall be a permanent record in the Police Station. The other four cop-
ies shall be submitted as follows :-
(a) One of the Senior Superintendent of Police or any other Gazetted Officer nomi-
nated by him.
(b) One of the Magistrate empowered to take cognizance of the offence as is required
by section 157, Criminal Procedure Code. In murder cases, the following pro-
cedure shall be followed :-
(i) The FIR shall be sent to the Magistrate concerned immediately in his court
during court hours and at his residence thereafter.
(ii) In case the Magistrate concerned is out of station, the FIR shall be submit-
ted to the Duty Magistrate.
(iii) If the Magistrate is not available after court hours, the copy of the FIR
shall be left at his house by the messenger noting the date and hour of de-
livery on the cover with the contents.
(iv) If on account of difficulties of communication or other cause the delivery
is delayed, the reasons and delay shall be noted on the cover.
(v) As soon as the FIR is received by a Magistrate, he shall affix his initials
therefore and note thereon the date and hour at which the report has been
received by him. In the case of a delayed FIR, if he disagree with the rea-
sons given by the Police Officer for such delay, he shall also give his own
reason for the same, if any.
(vi) In casess where the Police Station is not situated in the same place where
the Magistrate resides or where the Police Station is situated in an out of the
way place, the carbon copy of the FIR after it has been recorded, shall be
posted at once at the nearest post officer, addressed to the Magistrate by
name before the first clearance of the dak. In such cases the Magistrate
shall check that the FIR has been dispatched by the earlier post after its reg-
istration in the Police Station as shown by the time recorded on it.
(c) One to the complainant unless a written report in Form 24.2(1) has been received
in which case the check receipt prescribed will be sent.
(d) One legible copy shall be submitted to the District Crime Record Bureau at Dis-
trict Headquarters concerned where necessary codes relating to FIR will be
filled in for Computerisation purposes.]1
(2) In cases relating to cognizable offences triable by Panchayat one extra copy of the
first information report shall be prepared on plain paper bearing the seal of the Police Sta-
tion, and shall be sent to the Panchayat concerned for information, mention being made
in the copy of the F.I.R. that his action is being taken.
Note :- The cognizable offence triable by Panchayat are detailed in appendix 24.5.
(3) In the case of the railway police, the copy intended for the Magistrate empowered
to take cognizance of the offence shall be submitted through the Superintendent of the dis-
trict police; Provided that at railway police stations, other than district headquarter
stations, where there is a magistrate having jurisdiction, one copy shall be sent to such
magistrate direct, one to the Deputy Superintendent of the railway Police and another to
the Superintendent of district police. The extra copy required in such cases will be made
by inserting an extra sheet of paper and carbon paper and afterwards filling in the printed
headings, etc., by hand.

1. Substituted vide Punjab Govt. Notification No. G.S.R. 20 -/C.A.V./1861/S. 46/Amd. (23)/2003,
dated 6.3.2003.
Information to the Police 681

(4) All information required by the form shall be filled in, and thereafter the serial
number of each case diary submitted shall be noted on the reverse of the original copy
which is to remain at the police station.
(5) On the conclusion of the case the particulars contained in the charge sheet slip shall
be filled in on the reverse of the original copy and the slip returned to the Superintendent’s
office.
Rule 24.6.

24.6. Railway cases. - Every offence shown in the returns of the railway police shall
also be shown in the returns of the district police of the district in which it was either re-
ported or tried.
Rule 24.7

24.7. Cancellation of cases. - Unless the investigation of a case is transferred to an-


other police station or district, no first information report can be cancelled without the
orders of a Magistrate of the Ist class.
When information or other intelligence is recorded under section 154, Criminal Proce-
dure Code, and, after investigation, is found to be maliciously false or false owing to
mistake of law or fact or to be non-cognizable or matter for a civil suit, the Superinten-
dent shall sent the first information report and any other papers on record in the case with
the final report to a Magistrate having jurisdiction and being a Magistrate of the first class,
for orders of cancellation. On receipt of such an order the officer in charge of the police
station shall cancel the first information report by drawing a red line across the page, not-
ing the name of the magistrate cancelling the case with number and date of order. He
shall then return the original order to the Superintendent’s office to be filed with the re-
cord of the case.
Rule 24.8

24.8. Register of Cognizable Offences. - (1) Each Superintendent shall maintain a


register of cognizable offences in Form 24.8(1), styled for English Register of Cognizable
Offences. It shall be sent on each working day to the District Magistrate when such of-
ficer is at the district headquarters.
(2) The serial number in column one shall commence and end with the calendar year.
Cases cancelled or transferred shall be erased by ruling a red line through them, and shall,
at the end of the year, be deducted from the total.
Rule 24.9

24.9. Register of Petty Offences. - (1) A book to be called the register of Petty Of-
fences, consisting of one hundred blank pages with printed headings,in Form 24.9 shall
be kept up as a permanent record at each police station where there is a resident magistrate
having power to entertain complaints of the offences hereinafter mentioned, and whose
headquarters is either :-
(i) a town to which Act III of 1911 (the Punjab Municipal Act) has been extended;
(ii) a town to which section 34 of Act V of 1861 has been extended;
(iii) a military cantonment;
(iv) a place outside the limits of a military cantonment to which any of the rules and
regulations for such cantonment have been lawfully extended.
(2) The register of Petty Offences as mentioned in sub-rule, shall also be kept at each
Government Railway Police Station and Out Post.
Rule 24.10

24.10. Register of petty offences-Classes of offences to be entered. - The offences


which may be recorded in the register mentioned, and which are referred to in the last, pre-
ceding rule, are :-
(1) cognizable offences under municipal bye-laws;
682 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

(2) offences under section 34 of Act V of 1861, committed in the view of a police
officer;
(3) cognizable offences under cantonment rules and regulations;
(4) cognizable offences under section 112 of the Railways Act, 1890.
Rule 24.11

24.11. Register of Petty Offences-procedure. - (1) the Register of Petty Offences


shall be sent daily, whenever offences are reported and when the courts are open, to the
magistrate, empowered to take cognizance of them, and afterwards, in the case of head-
quarters police stations, to the Superintendent of Police for scrutiny.
No first information report, case diary or charge sheet shall be submitted in such cases.
(2) A return shall be submitted from such police stations as maintain the register at the
end of each year showing the entries in the register.
Such return shall be recorded by the return-writer in the general crime register.
Rule 24.12

24.12. Special reports from Police stations. - (1) Every officer in charge of a police
station shall, as soon as possible after the receives information of the commission within
his jurisdiction of an offence mentioned in the subjoined table, submit a vernacular spe-
cial report in Form 24.12(1) to the officer, or officers, mentioned in the third column of
the table: provided that if a first information report containing the same information is re-
quired by law to be sent to any such officer, and is sent with equal despatch, no special
report need be sent to the officers who receive first information reports.
(2) Vernacular special reports and first information reports sent in lieu of them shall be
enclosed in red envelopes.

Serial No. Offences Officers to whom reports


are to be made

1 Administering drugs or poison for hurt or robbery. 


2 All offences committed by Europeans or any class. 
3 Unnatural or sudden death of an American or European 
4 Counterfeiting coin. 
5 Loss or theft of firearm, whether Government or private property, 
component parts of such arms, or ammunition; and all recoveries 
of the same 
6 Dakaiti 
7 Escapes from, and deaths whilst in police custody. 
*7-A Assault on Police Officers..............................................................  Superintendent of
 Police
8 Grievous hurt when the person hurt is a European.  Superintendent of
 Police
9 Murder. 
10 Attempt to commit murder when the person hurt is a European. 
11 Theft or robbery of government treasure, or of property in the possession 
of the Post Office, when the property exceeds Rs. 500 in value.
12 All serious charges against the police. 
Information to the Police 683

13 All cases in which an Indian dies, or is reported to have died,, of injuries 


inflicted by a European of any class or by the police; and the occurrence
of all collisions between Europeans of all classes and Indians whether
alleged to be accidental or intentional.
14 Damaging the telegraph with intent to prevent transmission to tap, or to Nearest Telegraph
commit mischief within the meaning. Master and
Superintendent of Police
15 Wilful act or omission endangering of section 25 of Act XIII of 1885, Nearest Station Master
person or railway, under section 128 of Act IX of 1890 and Superintendent of
Police
16 Rioting Tahsildar
17 Offences under Chapter XII and XVII of the Indian Penal Code by 
members of notified criminal tribes and arrests of nomad gangs
irrespective of the Punjab or not.
18 Arrest of women-whether with or without warrant, bailable or non-  Superintendent of
bailable,- vide Police Rule 26.18-A(1). Police
19 All cases in which a person in police custody or under police 
interrogation becomes seriously ill or sustains injury.

*Vide C.S. No. 107.


Rule 24.13

24.13. Despatch of special reports. - Officers in charge of police station shall be held
responsible for communicating special reports with the greatest possible despatch to the
officers concerned and in serious cases shall make free use of the telegraph and telephone.
Rule 24.14

24.14. Special reports for Superintendents. - (1) Every Superintendent shall, as soon
as possible after he receives information of the occurrence within his jurisdiction of a
case mentioned in the table subjoined to rule 24.15, submit special reports in Form 24.14
to :-
(i) the District Magistrate;
(ii) the Deputy Inspector-General of the Range;
(iii) the officer mentioned in the third column of the table; and
(iv) any neighbouring Superintendent, or police officer, whom he considers should
be informed of the occurrence:
Provided that, in the case of the railway police, the copy intended for the District
Magistrate shall be sent through the Superintendent of the district concerned.
(2) The officers to whom special reports are forwarded, in accordance with this rule
shall be detailed on each of the report.
(3) Gazetted officers shall be responsible that special reports are concisely and intelli-
gently written and that developments of the case and important stages in its progress are
promptly reported by continuation special report.
Rule 24.15

24.15. Special reports-cases when reported and to whom. - District Magistrates and
Deputy Inspectors-General shall at their discretion forward copies of special reports is
cases to Commissioners and to the Inspector- General, respectively, for information. The
Inspector-General shall send copies to Government and heads of departments in any cases
which he considers are of sufficient importance to be brought to their notice. Commis-
sioners should only send copies to Government when they have any particular comment
to make on the case.
684 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

Serial Offences Officers to whom reports are to be


No. made
1 Culpable homicide, or attempt to commit culpable homicide, or Deputy Inspector- General,
grievous hurt, or attempt to commit grievous hurt, when the Criminal Investigation Department.
offence is committed by a religious fanatic, or and also when the
person assaulted is an American or European whether the
offender is a fanatic or not.
2 Deaths whilst in police custody Ditto Ditto
3 Escapes from police custody, Ditto Ditto
3-A Assault on Police Officers Ditto Ditto
4 All serious charges against the police including strictures on the Ditto Ditto
conduct of Police Officers by the Courts
5 Theft or robbery of Government treasure. Nil
6 Serious cases of rioting .,Nil
7 Administering drug or poison for hurt or robbery Deputy Inspector- General,
Criminal Investigation Department,
and Assistant Inspector- General,
Government Railway Police.
8 Dakaiti Deputy Inspector-General, Criminal
Investigation Department
9 Serious cases of robbery Ditto Ditto
10 Robbery of European travellers of any class Ditto Ditto
11 Unnatural or suspicious death of an American or European. Ditto Ditto
12 Counterfeiting coins or any offence committed in respect of Ditto Ditto
counterfeit coins, forgery of Government currency notes of Rs. 10
or more in value and new forgeries of Government currency
notes of any value,, forgery of Government stamps, or fraudulent
alteration or re-use of the same,, when the circumstances are
novel or important.
13 Loss, theft or recovery or arms and important component parts, By telegram whenever there is
and ammunition (see Appendix 24.15) falling under the following prima facie evidence or reasonable
category :- suspicion of a recent theft,,
otherwise by letter:
(a) Machine guns,, Light automatic, Grenades and article of (a) When losses are sufficiently
Royal Air Force armaments. serious to be brought to the notice
of Government of India
(b) Riffles, revolvers and pistols, Government or private property. (b) When the theft appears to be the
work of Ut. Khela or other
professional thieves,and
(c) Barrels and bolts of .303 bore (c) when the loss appears to
indicate that standing rules for the
custody of arms and ammunition,,
either in possession of regiments or
individuals or during transit by rail
or otherwise are defective and
should be amended, telegraphic
information should be sent.
(d) Ammunition for cannons, machine guns and high velocity
rifles.
(e) High explosives, whether in bulk or in made up charges
including fuses and detonators.
14 All serious cases of professional crime, especially when the Deputy Inspector-General,,
offenders are believed to be professionals from other provinces Criminal investigation Department.
and all serious cases in which offenders are believed to be
residents of Independent Territory or of the North-West Frontier
Province.
15 All Offences of a particularly startling or atrocious nature, or Ditto Ditto
which are likely to attract public interest or to be discussed in the
public press
15-A All crimes of violence against money-lenders where there is Ditto Ditto
reason to suppose that debtors are concerned either in the
commission or abetment of the offence.
Information to the Police 685

16 Cases in which an Indian dies, or is reported to have died of Ditto Ditto


injuries inflicted by Europeans of all classes or by the police; and
the occurrence of all collisions between Europeans of all classes
and Indians, whether accidental or intentional, except when there
is no confirmation or, when they are of a positively insignificant
character.
17 All offences committed by residents of the Punjab outside the Ditto Ditto
limits of the province of which Superintendents receive
information and which, if committed in the Punjab, would be
specially reported.
18 Murder Nil
19 Damaging the telegraph with intent to prevent transmission, to When no report has issued from the
tap, or to commit mischief within the meaning of section 25 of the police station, a copy also to be sent
XIII of 1885. nearest Telegraph Master.
20 Robbery of the mail. The Postmaster-General and in
serious cases to the Deputy
Inspector-General, Criminal
Investigation Department.
21 Maliciously wrecking or attempting to wreck a train, and Where no report has issued from the
endangering safety of persons travelling by railway by wilful act police station, a copy also to the
or omission (vide sections 126, 127 and 128 of Act IX of 1890) nearest Station Master.
22 Any Offence or occurrence resulting from religious or political Commissioner, Deputy Inspector-
excitement affecting the peace of a town or of the district. General, Criminal Investigation
Department and officer
Commanding Station.
23 All cases of disturbances between the military and the civil Ditto Ditto
population
24 Robbery of the British mail in foreign territory. Commissioner and Deputy
Inspector-General,, Criminal
Investigation Department.
25 Serious Railway accidents .Nearest Station master (when
report has not been made direct by
the officer in charge of the station).
Agent or Manager of the Railway,
Deputy Inspector-General,,
Criminal Investigation Department.
26 Other serious accidents resulting in the loss of more than three Chief Engineer, Public Works
lives. . Department, Buildings and Roads
Branch and Secretary, Provincial
Transport Authority in case of road
accidents
27 Cases of defalcations or fraudulent loss of Government money or Inspector-General of Police, Punjab,
stores in the Police Department (vide Article 29, Civil Account Lahore (two copies,, one of which
Code). See also rule 10.172 will be forwarded when necessary
to the Accountant-General, Punjab).
28 All important cases of smuggling of opium, cocaine and drugs. Financial Commissioners, Punjab,
through the Collector of the district
29 All cases in which a person in Police custody or under Police Deputy inspector- General of
interrogation becomes seriously ill or sustains injury. Police, Criminal Investigation
Department.
30 Calamities such as floods or earthquakes, which causes serious Commissioner and Deputy
damage to life or property. Inspector-"General, Criminal
Investigation Department.
31 Convictions of all Non-Asiatics for offences which render them Deputy Inspector-General of Police,
liable to have their finger print slips prepared in accordance with Criminal Investigation Department,
paragraph 25 of the Finger Print Manual. Punjab

Note. - (i) Matters referred to in Serial Nos. 14, 22 and 23 shall ordinary be reported by letter and
telegram to the officers mentioned. The other matters may be reported by letter or telegram
at the discretion of the Superintendent.
(ii) A Note of all arms, etc., loss, stolen or recovered,--vide serial No. 13 should be maintained
by the Criminal Investigation Department, Punjab, and a return sent in annually to the Direc-
tor, Intelligence Bureau.
Rule 24.16

24.16. Forgery of currency notes and coining cases. - (1) In special reports of for-
686 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

geries of stamps, fraudulent alterations and re-use stamps, full particulars of the case
shall be given, and specimens of the fraudulent stamps shall, if possible, be sent with
such reports.
(2) In cases of counterfeiting coin, the reports should contain full information on the
following points :-
(i) The represented value of the coins which are counterfeits, i.e., counterfeits of a
rupee, and eight, four or two-annas pieces;
(ii) The date on the counterfeit coin;
(iii) Whether cast in a mould; or
(iv) Struck between dies;
(v) Good, bad, or indifferent - if bad or indifferently, why so considered, i.e., want
of sharpness, ring different from that of a true coin, or other cause;
(vi) Metal of which made and percentage of silver;
(vii) Is Superintendent of opinion from the facts before him that any person arrested
is an habitual dealer in false coin?
Explanation. - The information under sub-rule (2)(vi) above will be obtained from
personal conservation, a local inquiry from a silver-smith, or otherwise, as may be prac-
ticable. In all cases where the coins appear to have been struck from a die and are good
imitations, a specimen of the counterfeit coin or coins should, if possible, be sent to the
Officer-in-charge, His Majesty’s New Mint at Baghbanpura, Lahore, for report, and
when his report is received, a copy should be sent by continuation special report. All
coins to be assayed should be sent direct to the Mint Master, Calcutta, and not through the
Inspector-General.
(3) On the appearance in any district of any forged currency note of Rs. 10 or more in
value, or of any new forgery of a currency note of any value, the Superintendent shall send
a copy of the special report required by the rules above to the Currency Officer, Lahore.
Such reports shall state whether the note is process made or hand drawn and give the de-
nomination of the forged note, the circle, the date, the serial letters, the number, and the
consecutive number. Continuation and final reports shall be submitted to the Criminal In-
vestigation Department, in duplicate, giving particulars of the notes passed and the modus
operandi of the forgers or utterers and of other persons concerned. On the completion of
the police enquiry, the note shall be sent to the Currency Officer, Lahore, through the
Criminal Investigation Department, together with a report explaining the facts. Special
reports of forgeries of currency notes, or of the appearance of forged currency notes, of
less than Rs. 10 in value are not required in the case of old forgeries which have come
to notice before and have appeared in the lists printed in the Criminal Intelligence Ga-
zette, but a list of the presentation of all such forgeries of notes of less than Rs. 10 in value
should be submitted on the first of each month, together with the notes in question, to
the Currency Officer, lahore, through the Criminal Investigation Department.
Rule 24.17

24.17 Continuation and final reports. - (1) Each successive special report in the same
case shall bear the same number as the first report and shall be distinguished by the ad-
dition of a capital Roman letter in the order of the alphabet.
Illustration. - The first special report of the murder of X is No. 20. The next special re-
port shall be numbered 20-A, the next 20-B and so on.
(2) Successive special reports shall be submitted whenever there is matter of impor-
tance to communicate.
(3) A final report shall be submitted without delay in all cases when (a) the investi-
gation is dropped or (B) the case is finally decided in court.
Information to the Police 687
Rule 24.18

24.18. Record of special reports. - (1) Three general files of special reports shall be
maintained as follows :-
(a) Murders.
(b) Dacoities.
(c) Other offences.
(2) A special file may be opened if necessary for any particular case.
Rule 24.19

24.19. The duties of the Police as Excise Officers. - (1) Co-operation between the ex-
cise and police forces is necessary for the detection and investigation of excise offences.
The Inspector-General of Police and the Financial-Commissioner lay stress upon this
co-operation as one of the principal secrets of successful working. Any case of jealous
or obstructive working will be severely dealt with.
(2) When an officer in charge of a police station becomes aware of an excise offence,
he shall at once register it as a police case and inform the District Excise Officer, who
with respect to such cases shall be regarded as the magistrate in charge of the police sta-
tion. The excise sub-inspector concerned shall also be informed and his co-operation
invited, but no delay shall be allowed to occur merely in order to obtain his presence.
(3) All excise inspectors and sub-inspectors are required to maintain a First Information
Report Register for the registration of complaints and reports of excise offences. In all
cognizable cases a copy of the First Information Report shall be sent to the police station
in whose jurisdiction the offence is reported. In return the excise inspector or sub-inspec-
tor will be given a copy of the Police First Information Report as a report.
(4) An excise inspector or sub-inspector shall not ordinarily attempt a search or make
an arrest by himself. He shall always obtain the assistance of the police sub-inspector.
If, however, delay is likely to defeat the ends of justice, the excise inspector or sub-in-
spector shall make the arrest or search himself, and at the same time send to the police
sub-inspector for assistance.
(5) The prevention of illicit distillation of spirit is one of the most important of the du-
ties of the police. This will not be effected by isolated seizures. It involves careful and
sustained enquiry and a complete knowledge of his jurisdiction by the officer in charge
of the police station. As a rule the manufacture of elicit spirit is confined to certain castes
which are habitual consumers of spirit. The most probable localities of illicit traffic
should thus be easily ascertainable by the officer incharge of the police station. It is im-
possible for an elicit still to be regularly worked in a village without the knowledge of the
chaukidars and lambardars. The trade betrays itself by the resulting smell, the accumu-
lation of refuse, and the occurrence of drunkenness, where no means of elicit supply
exist. If these things happen and the village officials make no report, it is obvious that they
are conniving at the offence. In such cases the officer in charge of the police station must
at once take steps, to have these rural officials punished. Where it is notorious that il-
licit stills are worked, the officer in charge of the police station neglects his duty if he
does not arrange to put in operation the provisions for search, seizure, and prosecution
contained in the Excise Act.
(6) If it is found that illicit manufacture of country spirit has been extensively carried
on in a police station jurisdiction, and preventive action has not been taken by the police,
neglect of duty on the part of the officer in charge of the police station will be presumed.
(7) Attention must also be paid to the unlicensed sale of spirit in large towns by so-
dawater sellers and others, and to the smuggling of country spirit in thanas adjoining
Indian States.
(8) Any charas coming into the Punjab by any other routes than those sanctioned
should at once be detained under section 61 of the Excise Act, and the orders of the Col-
688 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

lector taken. Charas smugglers generally travel by rail and can easily be captured in co-
operation with the railway checking staff, who while examining their tickets can also
examine their luggage.
(9) The use of cocaine, except for medical and surgical purposes, is altogether prohib-
ited in the Punjab. The principal places in the Punjab into which it is smuggled are
Lahore, Amritsar, Rawalpindi, Ambala and Karnal.
(10) offences against the opium law vary in their nature with various districts: the most
important offences, viz., smuggling and illicit sale of smuggled opium (whether con-
trived by licensed vendors themselves or by private individuals) being common or
uncommon according to the geographical position of districts with reference to Rajpu-
tana, Afghanistan and the Hill States, or even railway communication with Nepal.
(11) No opium can be imported into a district without a pass; and any police officer can,
therefore, detain bulk opium if there is no pass. He can also search a person whom he be-
lieves to be guilty of having excess quantities of opium in his possession. Any police
officer above the rank of head constable may search premises in which he believes smug-
gled or illicit opium is stored.
The legal limit of possession of opium is two tolas and any person bringing it from any
Indian State in excess of this amount is liable to arrest and prosecution under section 9 of
the Act.
(12) the sale of all preparations of opium for smoking of illegal. There is need of con-
tinued activity in tracing out and prosecuting proprietors of chandu and madak dens in
which sales occur, the object being to make indulgence in opium smoking so difficult and
disreputable that the younger generation will be unlikely to acquire it.
Under the Opium Smoking Act, 1923, members of opium smoking assemblies as well
as proprietors of houses used for opium smoking are liable to prosecution. Under section
14 of the Act every officer of the police department is required to give reasonable aid to
an excise officer making any arrest or search under the Act. The police have no powers
of search, seizure or arrest under the Punjab Opium smoking Act; but they have such pow-
ers under sections 14 and 15 of the Opium Act, 1978, against any individual in possession
of more than the half tola of preparations of admixtures of opium used for smoking which
is the limit of legal possession under section 9 of the Act.
(13) The Financial Commissioner has impressed upon all Deputy Commissioners the
necessity of granting liberal rewards both to informers and to arresting officers in all ex-
cise cases. Rewards to sub-inspectors and officers of lower rank may be sanctioned by
the Deputy Commissioners up to Rs. 200, but the sanction of the Financial Commissioner
is required for larger rewards and for rewards to officers of higher rank.
Information to the Police 689

APPENDIX No. 24.5(2)


The following cognizable offences are triable by Panchayat :-
Section Offence
269 Negligently doing any act known to be likely to spread infection of any disease dangerous
to life.
270 Malignantly doing any act known to be likely to spread infection of any disease dangerous
to life.
277 Defiling the water of a public spring or reservoir.
288 Causing danger, obstruction or injury in any public way or line of navigation.
289 Omitting to take order with any animal in possession so as to guard against danger to human
life, or of grievous hurt, from such animal.
291 Continuance of nuisance after injunction to discontinue.
294 Doing of obscene acts or singing obscene songs, etc., in a public place to the annoyance of
others.
336 Doing any act which endangers human life or the personal safety of others.
341 Wrongfully restraining any person.
379 Theft.
411 Dishonestly receiving stolen property knowing it to be stolen.
Provided, that (1) a Panchayat shall take cognizance of offences under Sections 379 and 411, Indian
Penal Code, only where the value of the property stolen does not exceed Rs. 100 and the accused is
named in the complaint.
(2) A Panchayat shall not take cognizance of any complaint under Sections 379 or 411, Indian Penal
Code, if the accused :-
(i) has been previously convicted of an offence under Chapter XII or XVII of the Indian Penal
Code punishable with imprisonment of either description for a term of three years or upward,
or
(ii) has previously been fined for theft or receiving or possessing stolen property by any
Panchayat, or
(iii) is a registered member of a criminal tribe under section 4 of the Criminal Tribes Act, 1911,
or
(iv) has been bound over to be of good behaviour in proceedings instituted under Section 109 to
110 of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1898, or
(v) has had an order of restriction passed against him under the Restriction of Habitual
Offenders (Punjab) Act, 1918 -
Section Offence
447 Criminal Trespass.
448 House Trespass.
461 Dishonestly breaking open or unfastening any closed receptacle containing or supposed to
contain property
-----------
APPENDIX No. 24.15
Circular No. 17/A and A/481, dated 25th May, 1949 from Government of India, Intel-
ligence Bureau, Ministry of Home Affairs, New Delhi.
1. In supersession of the existing orders on the subject, the following instructions re-
garding the reporting of losses and thefts of Government and private fire-arms
and ammunition capable of being used of military purposes are issued with ap-
proval of the Government of India.
690 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

2. Under Military Regulations, Officers Commanding detachments report the loss


or recovery of arms, important components or ammunition to the Superinten-
dent of Police, or, if the loss or recovery takes place in an Indian State or a Union
of States, to an appropriate officer of the Government of the State or Union des-
ignated in this behalf. The Superintendent of Police or the Officer of the State
or Union so designated, as the case may be, is then responsible for all further ac-
tion for tracing and recovery of the lost or stolen articles.
3. Reports should be made by the Superintendents of Police or the Officers of the
States or Unions, as the case may be, to the Provincial Criminal Investigation
Department of the loss, theft or recovery of arms, important components and
ammunition coming under the following category, of which they may receive
information from any source whether military, civil or private -
(i) Machine Guns, Light automatics, Grenades and articles of Royal Air Force
armaments.
(ii) Rifles, Revolvers and Pistols, Government or private.
(iii) Barrels and bolts of .303 bore.
(iv) Ammunition for cannon, machine guns and high velocity rifles.
(v) High explosives, whether in bulk or in made-up charges including fuses
and detonators.
4. (a) Reports concerning items of the above category should be made by telegram
wherever there is prima facie evidence or reasonable suspicion of a recent theft. In other
cases reports should be made by letter. In all cases every effort must be made to include
either in the initial report or in a very early continuation report the fullest possible details
both for the identification of the missing arms, components or ammunition and as re-
gards the methods and identity of the thieves.
(b) Provincial Criminal Investigation Departments on receipt of reports according to
the above instructions will be responsible for the direction of suitable action for detection
and recovery. If in any case there may appear grounds for suspecting the agency of pro-
fessional arms thieves from the North-West Frontier, Telegraphic information giving
the fullest available particulars should be sent to the Deputy Inspector- General of Police,
Criminal Investigation Department, East Punjab (telegraphic address ‘CIDEAST,
SIMLA’).
5. A return of all identification arms, etc., lost or stolen or recovered should be main-
tained by the Provisional Criminal Investigation Department and should be sent in
annually to the Director, Intelligence Bureau.
6. All reports of losses, thefts and recoveries of arms, etc., should be published by Pro-
vincial Criminal Investigation Department in their Criminal Intelligence Gazettes or
Confidential Supplements. Such reports must invariably include all details necessary
to establish the identity of any particulars weapon, or component part.
7. When losses are sufficiently serious to be brought to the notice of the Government
of India, or to rank as matters of public interest, as well as in the following cases :-
(a) when the theft appears to be the work of Ut Khels or other professional rifle
thieves.
(b) when the loss appears to indicate that standing rules for the custody of arms and
ammunition, either in possession of regiments, or individuals or during transit
for rail or otherwise, are defective and should be amended,
intimation of such losses should be telegraphed to the Director, Intelligence Bureau,
New Delhi, by the Provincial Criminal Investigation Department, and copies of all sub-
sequent reports submitted by the Superintendent of Police should also be sent to him.
Information to the Police 691

8. In the particular case of revolvers, rifles, and pistols, all losses, thefts and recoveries
of such weapons as bear the manufacturer’s number should be reported to the Director,
Intelligence Bureau, by the Provincial Criminal Investigation Departments. The reports
regarding recoveries should include information, if possible, as to where, when and form
whom the weapon was obtained by the person from whom it is recovered. All reports
should be submitted as soon as convenient after the loss, theft or recovery.

9. No report need be made under these rules in the case of the loss or theft of smooth
bore weapons, ammunition for such weapons, swords, bayonets, or accutrements. Con-
verted Martini-Hanries and Sniders are classed as smooth bore weapons.

10. Deliberate attempts to smuggle arms and ammunition into India, by land or sea or
air, should promptly be reported to the Director, Intelligence Bureau. Similarly the dis-
covery of fire-arm which appear to have been deliberately smuggled into India should
also be reported to the same quarter.

In all instances, full particulars of the articles seized, such as the maker’s name, place
of manufacture, number, bore and other distinguishing marks in the case of fire-arms, and
maker’s name, bore and distinguishing marks in the case of cartridge, should be commu-
nicated at the time the report is made or as soon afterwards as possible. Information, if
available, obtained from the smugglers or otherwise, as to where, when and from whom
the weapons, etc., were obtained should also be given. Whenever a prosecution is initi-
ated with respect to a reported case of smuggling or, or attempt to smuggle, arms and
ammunition, the result should also be communicated to the Director, Intelligence Bureau.
‘These instructions do not affect the quarterly returns of arms and ammunition
seized by the customs, which should continue to be submitted by the Criminal
Investigation Departments of maritime provinces and the provinces having air
ports in their jurisdictions’.
---------------
FORM No. 24.2(1)
FIRST INFORMATION REPORT BY A COMPLAINANT
Name, parentage and residence of complainant or
informant
Date and time of writing the slip and delivery to
Chaukidar.
Date and time of receipt of Police Station

Substance of complainant or information which shall be attested by the signature, seal


or thumb-impression of complainant or informant, and signature or seal of lambardar as
witness.
(Check receipt to be sent to the complainant)
Received a written complaint from_______ of village ______ dated _____. First In-
formation Report No. _____ under Section ____ I.P.C. has been registered this day.
Name of Police Station________ 
 Signature of Officer-in-charge
Date ______________________ 
If a First Information Report has not been registered then these words should be struck
out and a brief note given below of the action taken.
692 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

FORM No. 24.5(1)


FIRST INFORMATION REPORT
FIRST INFORMATION OF A COGNIZABLE CRIME REPORTED UNDER
SECTION 154, CODE OF CRIMINAL PROCEDUREABLES
Police Station _________ District _______
No. ________________________ Date and hour of occurrence
1 Date and hour when reported
2 Name and residence of information and complainant
3 Brief description of offence (with section) and of property carried off, if any
4 Place of occurrence and distance and direction from Police Station.
5 Steps taken regarding investigation; explanation of delay in recording information
6 Date and hour of despatch from Police Station

Signed _________
Designation __________
(First information to be recorded below)
Note. - The signature, seal or mark of the informant shall be affixed at the foot of the information
and shall be attested by the signature of the officer recording the "first information".

(REVERSE OF POLICE STATION COPY OF FIRST INFORMATION REPORT)


(NOT TO BE PRINTED ON REVERSE OF OTHER COPIES)
INDEX OF CASE DIARIES
(To be filled in immediately on receipt of case diaries)
Serial Date of case Name of Serial Date of case Name of Serial Date of case Name of
No. diary investigating No. investigating No. diary investigating
officer officer officer

Information to be filled in when the charge-sheet or final report is submitted


Date and hour of submis- Names of witnesses Name and residence of accused Property (including
sion of Charge-sheet or fi- A. - Sent in custody for trial weapons) found
nal Report and section un- B. - On bail or recognizance
der which accused are sent C. - Not sent for trial
for trial

Information to be filled in as soon as received


Date of receipt of chalan in Court Offence according to which Result of the case (In case of
convicted or acquitted conviction or acquital, the name of
court, date and details of the order)
Information to the Police 693

FORM No. 24.8(1)


POLICE STATION ________ _______ DISTRICT
ENGLISH REGISTER OF COGNIZABLE OFFENCES
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
DATE OF CASES REPORTED ON DATE
Annual Entry Commiss Police Place Number Section Cases PROPERTY
Serial in this ion of station where of first of law not
number registe offence submittin offence informatiooffended investigat Stolen Recovere Persons
g report was n report against ion d arrested
committe under
d section
157, (b),
C.P.C.
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20

CASES DECIDED ON DATE


PERSONS
Serial Cases Arrested Released Sent for Discharge Acquitted Convicted Remarks by
Number can on bail trial d or Superintendent of
of for- celled or ordered Police
mer re- recogniza to find
port in nce security
this reg-
ister

FORM No. 24.9


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______DISTRICT
Register of Petty offences
Under Section 154, Cr. P. Code, intimidation under Section 157, Cr. P. Code, diary
under Section 172 Cr. P. Code and final report under Section 173, Cr. P. Code of of-
fences against cantonment and municipal bye-laws and under section 34 of Act V of
1861.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
NAME,
PARENTAGE ACCUSED HOW
AND FORWARDED
RESIDENCE OF
Offence, Substance ComplainAccused Date and Names of the On On In Finding
section of ant time at persons who bail recognizan custody and
and law information, which appear to be ce and the sentence
offended date when informatio acquainted with reasons
against and place n the circumstances why
where reached of the case and
offence Police details of any
was Station property sent in
committed the case
694 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 24

FORM No. 24.12(1)


POLICE STATION ___________ _______ DISTRICT

VERNACULAR SPECIAL REPORT ON AN OFFENCE

No. of 19 Dated 19
1 2 3 4 5 6
NUMBER OF PERSONS VALUE OF PROPERTY
Offence and section of Supposed to Arrested Taken Recovered Statement of the case,
law offended against; have been conduct of the Police
distance and direction concerned and steps taken by them
of place from Police
Station, and name of
Sub-Inspector in charge
Date and time of
occurrence. Date and
time of report to Police

Signature of Officer-in-charge of Police Station

FORM No. 24.14


POLICE DEPARTMENT _________ DISTRICT

SPECIAL REPORT OF AN OFFENCE

No. of 19 Dated 19
1 2 3 4 5 6
NUMBER OF PERSONS VALUE OF PROPERTY
Descriptin of offence Supposed to Arrested Taken Recovered Statement of the case,
and section of law of- have been conduct of the Police, steps
fended against; also dis- concerned taken by them
tance and direction of
place from Police Sta-
tion and name of Sub-
Inspector in charge
Date and time of occurrence.
Date and time of report to
Police

Superintendent of Police
------------

Copy sent to
(1) District Magistrate __________________
(2) Deputy Inspector-General _____________ Range
(3) __________________________________
(4) _________________________________
Investigation 695

CHAPTER 25
Investigation
Rule 25.1

25.1. Powers to investigate. - (1) An officer in charge of a police station is empowered


by Section 156, Criminal Procedure Code, to investigate any cognizable offence which
occurs within the limits of his jurisdiction.
(2) He is also empowered under Section 157(1), Criminal procedure Code, to depute a
subordinate to proceed to the spot to investigate the facts and circumstances of the case,
and if necessary, to take measures for the discovery and arrest of the offenders. Any po-
lice officer may be so deputed under this section, but where a police officer under the rank
of assistant sub-inspector is deputed the investigation shall invariably be taken up and
completed by the officer in charge of the police station or an assistant sub- inspector at the
first opportunity.
(3) An officer in charge of a station shall also render assistance whenever required to all
officers of the Criminal Investigation Department working within his jurisdiction.
Rule 25.2

25.2. Powers of investigating officer. - (1) The powers and privileges of a police of-
ficer making an investigation are detailed in Sections 160 to 175, Criminal Procedure
Code.
An officer so making an investigation shall invariably issue an order in writing in Form
25.2(1) to any person summoned to attend such investigation and shall endorse on the
copy of the order retained by the person so summoned the date and time of his arrival at,
and the date ad time of his departure from, the place to which he is summoned. The du-
plicate of the order shall be attached to the case diary.
(2) No avoidable trouble shall be given to any person from whom enquiries are made
and no person shall be unnecessarily detained.
(3) It is the duty of an investigating officer to find out the truth of the matter under in-
vestigation. His object shall be to discover the actual facts of the case and to arrest the real
offender or offenders. He shall not commit himself prematurely to any view of the facts
for or against any person.

Rule 25.3

25.3. Action when offence occurring in another police station is reported. - When
the occurrence of a cognizable offence in another police station jurisdiction is reported,
the fact shall be recorded, in the daily diary and information shall be sent to the officer in
charge of the police station in the jurisdiction of which the offence was committed.
Meanwhile all possible lawful measures shall be taken to secure the arrest of the offender
and the detection of the offence.

Rule 25.4

25.4. Where offence appears to have occurred in other police station. - (1) If a po-
lice officer after registering a case and commencing an investigation discovers that the
offence was committed in the jurisdiction of another police station he shall at once send
information to the officer in charge of such police station.
(2) Upon receipt of information such officer shall proceed without delay to the place
where the investigation is being held and undertake the investigation.
Rule 25.5

25.5. Disputes as to jurisdiction. - Should the officer who is thus summoned to the
spot dispute the jurisdiction, both officers shall jointly carry on the investigation under the
696 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

orders of the senior officer and neither shall leave until the question of jurisdiction has
been settled and acknowledged. The case record shall be kept at the police station where
the information was first received until the question of jurisdiction has been decided.
Rule 25.6

25.6. Relieving and relieved officers to sign case diaries. - When a police officer is
relieved in the course of an investigation he shall record a report of all that he has done
in a case diary and sign it, giving the date and hour of his relief. Such case diary shall
be made over to the relieving officer, who shall certify thereon that he acknowledges the
case to have occurred within his station limits, or to be one which he is empowered to in-
vestigate, as the case may be.
Rule 25.7

25.7. Cancellation of a case in one police station and registration in another. -


When a case is transferred from one police station to another, the offence registered in the
original police station shall be cancelled by the Superintendent and a first information re-
port shall be submitted from the police station in the jurisdiction of which the case
occurred.
Rule 25.8

25.8. Cases which may be lawfully investigated in more local areas than one. - (1)
If the case is one which the officer in charge of the police station may lawfully investigate,
but which may also be lawfully and more successfully investigated in another police sta-
tion, such officer while continuing his investigation, shall refer the matter to the
Superintendent, who shall transfer the case or not as he sees fit.
(2) If it is desired to transfer the case to a police station in another district, the Superin-
tendent shall refer the matter to the District Magistrate and move him to act according to
the orders contained in Chapter 26, Volume III, of the Rules and Orders of the High Court.
(3) When an investigation has been transferred from one district to another the police
files with original first information report shall be forwarded to the Superintendent of the
district to which the transfer is made.
Rule 25.9

25.9. Optional investigation. - (1) Section 157(b), Criminal Procedure Code, gives
wide powers to an officer in charge of a police station to refrain from investigation in un-
important cases. It is the duty, however, of every officer receiving a report to consider not
only the intrinsic importance of the offence alleged and the expressed wishes of the com-
plainant but the bearing which the report has or may have on the detection of other cases
or on the prevention of crime and the control of criminals. Very many cases which ap-
pears trivial in themselves may, if investigated furnish a clue to the operations of
professional criminals or afford valuable material at a later date for preventive action. In
practice it is seldom advisable for an officer-in-charge of a police station to avail himself
of the power to refuse investigations, which the law gives him.
(2) When, at the time when a report of a cognizable offence is received, the investigating
staff of the police station concerned is already occupied with more important cases, the
investigation of which would suffer by being interrupted, such report shall be duly re-
corded and investigation may be dispensed with. Such action not be held to limit the
discretion of the officer-in-charge of the police station to investigate the case at a later
date, if he thinks it desirable to do so.
(3) If the informant is present when the first information report is recorded, he shall be
informed forthwith that no investigation will be made, and, after noting this fact in the first
information report, his signature or thumb-mark shall be taken to it. If the informant is
not present, he shall be informed in writing by post card, or by the delivery of a notice by
hand, and the fact that this has been done shall be noted in the first information report.
(4) When investigation is dispensed with, a note shall be made in the first information
Investigation 697

report stating whether the complainant desires an investigation or not and full reasons
shall be given for abstaining from investigation. All such cases shall be brought to the no-
tice of the Superintendent of Police personally, who shall pass such orders on them as he
may think fit in accordance with the principle embodied in this rule.
Rule 25.10

25.10. Immediate despatch of an officer to the spot. - When a report of a cognizable


case is recorded and it is decided not to dispense with investigation under Section 157(b),
Criminal Procedure Code, a police officer shall proceed to the scene immediately. The
officer who first proceeds to the spot shall, if he be not competent to complete the inves-
tigation, take all possible steps to preserve the scene of the crime from disturbance, to
record particulars of and secure the presence of potential witnesses, obtain information re-
lating to the case and arrest the culprit.
Rule 25.11

25.11. Investigation in non-cognizable cases. - (1) No police officer shall investigate


a non-cognizable offence unless ordered to do so by a competent magistrate under Sec-
tions 196-B or 202, Criminal Procedure Code.
(2) When an investigation in a non-cognizable case is thus ordered and is taken up by
the police under Section 155(3), Criminal Procedure Code, it must be carried through in
the same manner as if the offence were cognizable, except that no arrest shall be made
without a warrant. In every such case a police officer making an investigation shall day
by day enter his proceedings in a case diary and submit them daily as prescribed for cog-
nizable cases in Police Rule 25.53. Case diaries shall be submitted through the gazetted
officer concerned to the court which has ordered investigation. No copies shall be pre-
pared or kept by the police.
(3) The High Court has ordered that only serious cases, and cases in which there are spe-
cial reasons to do so, shall be referred to the police under Section 202, Criminal Procedure
Code (Rule 4, Chapter I-B of Rules and Orders of the High Court of Judicature at Lahore,
Volume III-1931). Superintendents of Police shall decline to accept for action references
in which provisions of Section 202, Criminal procedure Code, itself, and the instructions
of the High Court referred to above have not been strictly complied with.
Rule 25.12

25.12. Orders in writing. - All orders in writing made in a case, i.e. order to arrest, to
search and to summon, etc., shall be attached to the case diaries, or their absence shall be
satisfactorily accounted for.
Rule 25.13

25.13. Plan of scene. - (1) In all important cases two plans of the scene of the offences
shall be prepared by a qualified police officer or other suitable agency one to be submitted
with the charge sheet or final report and the other to be retained for departmental use.
(2) The following rules shall govern the preparation of maps or plans by patwaris or
other expert :-
(i) Pursuant to paragraph 26 of the Patwari Rules, the Financial Commissioner, with
the concurrence of the Inspector General of Police, issues the following instruc-
tions concerning the preparation by patwaris of maps needed to illustrate police
inquiries.
(ii) In ordinary cases no demands for such maps will be made upon patwaris.
(iii) In the case of heinous crime, especially in cases of murder or riots connected
with land disputes, the police officer investigating he case will, if he considers
an accurate map is required, summons to the scene of the crime the patwari of
the circle in which it occurred and cause him to prepare two maps, one for pro-
duction in court as evidence and the other for the use of the police investigating
agency. In the former reference relating to facts observed by the police officer
698 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

should be entered while in the latter references based on the statement of wit-
nesses which are not relevant in evidence may be recorded. He will be careful
not to detain the patwaris longer than is necessary for the preparation of maps.
(iv) It is necessary to define clearly the responsibility of the patwari and police of-
ficer in respect of these maps.
(v) The police officer will indicate to the patwari the limits of the land of which he
desires map, and the topographical items to be shown therein. The patwari will
then be responsible for drawing the maps correctly, by tracing, if necessary, the
second copy, for making accurately on maps all these items and for entering on
the maps due distances. He will not write on the map, intended for production
as evidence in the court any explanations. The police officer may write any ex-
planations on the traced copy of the map.
(vi) It is for the police officer himself to add to the second copy of the map such re-
marks as may be necessary to explain the connection of the map with the case
under inquiry. He is also responsible equally with the patwaris for the correct-
ness of all distances, but on the copy of the map drawn by the patwari for pres-
entation, in court he will make no remarks or explanations based on the
statements of witnesses.
(vii) It will be convenient if all the entries made by the patwari are made in black ink,
and those added by the police officer in red ink.
(viii) Patwaris will not in any case be required by a police officer to make a map of
an inhabited enclosure or of land inside a town or village site.
Rule 25.14

25.14. Technical assistance in investigation. - (1) Investigating officers are expected


to take steps to secure expert technical assistance and advice, whenever such appears de-
sirable in the course of an investigation for purposes of evidence or for demonstration in
court.
(2) The Criminal Investigation Department is able to obtain expert technical assistance
on many subjects and should be freely consulted in that connection by investigating of-
ficers through their Superintendents of Police. When such assistance is required a full
report shall be sent to the Assistant Inspector General, Crime and Criminal Tribes, so that
he may be in a position to decide whether it is essential to send an expert to the scene of
the crime or whether the material to be dealt with should be sent to the expert. In making
such reports use should be made of telegraphic and telephonic facilities.
(3) The Criminal Investigation Department, in conjunction with the Finger Print Bu-
reau, undertakes photographic and some other varieties of technical work. In addition it
is in contact with technical experts on may subjects, whose services can frequently be ob-
tained for work in connection with criminal investigation. In respect of the examination
of handwriting, investigating officers can obtain the services of the Examiner of Ques-
tioned Documents with the Government of India, through the Criminal Investigation
Department. That department is also the channel for obtaining the services of the Inspec-
tor of Explosives for Northern India who, as well as advising on explosives generally, can
give expert opinion as to whether a weapon has been recently fired, whether certain matter
is gunpowder or not, and all questions generally savouring of chemical analysis.
Rule 25.15

25.15. Hand-writing. - (1) The above rules do not apply to references to the Finger
Print Bureau and the Chemical Examiner to the Punjab Government, to whom, under the
rules applicable, Superintendents of Police are required to make references direct. The
Criminal Investigation Department is, however, in direct contract with both these techni-
cal officers and investigating officers should enlist its co-operation when any specifically
intricate work is required of them.
Investigation 699

(2) Nothing in the preceding sub-rule shall debar a Superintendent of Police or inves-
tigating officer from availing himself of any expert technical assistance, when may be
directly available to him, for the purpose of investigation. If expert evidence is to be
given in court, however, it should be provided by Government experts only, when such
experts exist.
(3) In connection with the examination of arms and ammunition, arsenal officials
should only be required to report, and if absolutely essential, give evidence (i) on techni-
cal factory points, e.g., whether a weapon is in serviceable condition; whether a particular
part of a weapon is factory or mistri made, and the like; (ii) on the type of ammunition in-
tended to be used (not can be used as experience shows that there is practically no limit
in this respect) in a particular weapon; and (iii) whether a cartridge has been reloaded, na-
ture of load, and the like. Arsenal experts shall not be used for elaborate and definite
sworn testimony as to whether a particular missile was or was not fired from a particular
weapon. Should districts desire opinions of this nature they may apply to the Criminal In-
vestigation Department for assistance but such references should be confined to cases of
major importance only.
Rule 25.16

25.16. Cases against Government servants. - When a Government servant is accused


or is suspected of the commission of an offence in the course of his official duties his im-
mediate departmental superior shall, as far as may be wise and practicable, be kept
informed regarding the course of the police investigation.
Rule 25.17

25.17. Supervision by gazetted officers. - (1) In all important cases gazetted officers
are required personally to supervise the investigation so far as is possible and when nec-
essary to visit the scene of the offence.
(2) A record of investigations by gazetted officers shall be kept in the prescribed column
of the register of cognizable offences and an abstract thereof shall be shown in the quar-
terly Inspection Statement and in the Annual Provincial Statement.
(3) Every gazetted officer shall maintain a running note-book of offences, in which he
shall enter the salient points of the first information report and case diaries as he hears
them. The following are some of the points that should be entered in his note-book :-
First Information Report :- (a) Police station, village, section, date and time of of-
fence;
(b) Distance of village from police station and date and time of investigation open-
ing;
(c) Name and rank of investigating officer, who should always be the senior officer
available. Reasons for junior officer taking up cases should be most carefully
checked; and
(d) Salient features of the case.
Case Diaries :- (a) Dates of case diaries;
(b) By whom written and where; and
(c) Salient features.
All unnecessary delays in the course of investigation, in chalaning successful cases or
in submitting final reports in untraced cases should be carefully observed and stopped.
Deputy Inspectors-General shall call for these note-books at their inspections and insist
on their being intelligently used for the purpose of efficient supervision of investigations.
(4) Gazetted officers shall interest themselves in the chalans of cases in their charge as
they come in and discuss them with the prosecuting inspector, and if possible, with the of-
ficers who investigated them; and shall keep in touch with the proceedings in court.
700 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

(5) Every gazetted officer in headquarters should see daily the English register (27.36)
of cognizable offences, with special reference to columns 14 to 17 in register to cases in
his charge, and he should bring to the notice of the District Magistrate through the proper
channel, any unnecessary delays that occur in dealing with cases in courts, instances in
which witnesses come up with chalans and are sent back unheard, and delays in framing
charges, hearing arguments or pronouncing judgments.
(6) Gazetted officers should follow closely the progress of cases in their charge through
the courts and they should ascertain, as soon as possible, the grounds for all discharges
and acquittals. If the grounds for the discharges or acquittals appear to be unreasonable,
they should at once bring the cases prominently to the notice of the District Magistrate
through the Superintendent of Police.
Rule 25.18

25.18. Statement recorded under Section 161, Code of Criminal Procedure. -


Statements recorded by an investigating officer under Section 161, Code of Criminal Pro-
cedure shall not form part of the case diary prescribed by Section 172, but shall be
recorded separately and attached to the cse diary, the necessary number of copies being
made by the carbon copying process on case diary continuation sheets [form 25.54(1)].
The number of statements attached to a particular case diary, and the number of pages in
each statement, shall be noted in the case diary. An investigating officer, after examining
a person orally or recording a statement under section 161, Code of Criminal Procedure,
shall make a brief note of the fact in his case diary.
Rule 25.18-A

25.18-A. Communications of official documents or information. - (1) It is a univer-


sally recognised and fundamental principle of police procedure that the identity of sources
and agents from whom secret information is obtained shall be known only to the officer
who employs them and that every precaution shall be taken to protect them from expo-
sure. Except by direction of the Governor, a Police officer shall on no account disclose
the identity of a source or agent to any officer or person outside the Force. Within the
Force he shall disclose it only to or as ordered by the superior officers mentioned below.
In the Criminal Investigating Department this superior officer is the Deputy Inspector
General in the case of the whole department and the Superintendent of Police, Political
and Assistant to the Inspector-General for Crime and Criminal Tribes as regards the Spe-
cial and Crime Branches, respectively. In a district it is the Superintendent of Police or
the gazetted officer immediately under whom the police officer employing an agent or
source is working. When information obtained from an agent has to be transmitted to oth-
ers, the greatest care shall be exercised to avoid the exposure of such agent. The original
report, or an exact copy of the original report, shall not be transmitted but the substance
or a paraphrase shall be sent.
(2) All sources of police information are protected in judicial trails by Sections 124 and
125 of the Indian Evidence Act which provide respectively that no public officer should
be compelled to disclose communications made to him in official confidence and that no
Magistrate or police officer shall be compelled to say whence he obtained any informa-
tion as to the commission of any offence. Instructions regarding the production of police
records as evidence are contained in Rule 27.24.
(3) The Governor’s Rules to secure the protection of sources of information under Sec-
tion 58 of the Government of India Act, 1935 and the Inspector- General’s directions
framed under those Rules will be found in Appendix 25.18-A.
Rule 25.19

25.19. Medico-legal opinion. - (1) When a medical opinion is required in police cases,
the persons to be examined shall be produced before the highest medical authority avail-
able on the medical staff of the district. Persons requiring examination at the
headquarters of a district shall be taken to the Civil Hospital and not to a branch dispen-
Investigation 701

sary; similarly in rural areas, where a hospital is accessible, medico-legal cases shall be
sent there and not to a rural dispensary.
(2) Medical Offices of the Irrigation Department are prohibited from undertaking med-
ico-legal work and officers in charge of district board dispensaries may only be called
upon to do such work, for which they must be qualified in other respects, in cases of emer-
gency. Medical officers may not be called upon to proceed to the scene of an occurrence
to examine injured persons except in cases of real urgency and when it is impossible to
convey the injured person to the nearest dispensary or hospital.
(3) Police officers cannot legally compel injured persons to submit to medical exami-
nation, and such persons have a right to be examined privately at their own expense by
medical practitioners. ‘‘Injury Statements’’ [form 25.39(1)], are intended solely for the
use of the Civil Surgeon of the district or any medical officer subordinate to him, on whom
the police may call for a report. Such forms must not be given to injured persons for the
purposes of examination at their private choice, nor must they be sent with injured persons
to Government medical officers of another district.
All medical officers-in-charge of hospitals and dispensaries are required to report to the
nearest police station within 24 hours all cases of serious injury or of poisoning admitted
by them for treatment, whether such cases have been brought in by the police or not.
(4) Medical officers of Government, or those employed by local bodies, are entitled to
charge fees for medico-legal work performed in their private capacities for parties to
cases, but no fees whatsoever are leviable by Government medical officers for work in
cases in which the Crown is the complainant, including all post mortem examinations,
such work being part of their regular duties. The rules under which medical officers,
other than those subordinate to the Civil Surgeon, may charge fees for medico-legal work
on behalf of Government are given in the Punjab Medical Manaul; in certain cases fees
may also be charged by medical officers employed by district boards. In no case, how-
ever, are such fees debitable to the police department; any claim submitted to
Superintendents should be passed on, with the necessary information, to the District Mag-
istrate.
(5) Police officers should refrain from sending persons whose injuries are obviously
slight for medico-legal examination, and should exercise their discretion in obtaining a
medical opinion as to whether injuries received by complainants constitute a cognizable
offence.
(6) Medico-legal cases not requiring urgent attention should be sent for examination
during hospital hours only.
Note :- This rule does not entitle the medical officer concerned to refuse to examine a case out of
hours because in his opinion it is not an urgent one.
(7) The unnecessary summoning as witnesses of medical subordinates, to the detriment
of their proper activities, shall be avoided as far as possible, and, when the attendance of
such an officer is necessary, as much notice as possible shall be given him. When the nec-
essary evidence can be given by the investigating officer or by another medical witness
stationed at the place where the case is being prosecuted a medical subordinate should not
be summoned from a distance merely to give corroborative evidence.
Rule 25.20

25.20. Wounded complaints and witnesses. - (1) When a complaint or a witness of


importance in an important case is seriously ill or is wounded, but does not appear to be
dying, the police officer making the investigation shall prepare a charge-sheet in accord-
ance with Rule 25.56(1) if this has not already been done and shall either -
(a) with such persons’ consent, send him or her, for medical treatment to the station
of the magistrate having jurisdiction and invite such magistrate to take such per-
son’s deposition in the presence of the accused person or,
702 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

(b) if such complainant or witness cannot be moved, or refuses to be sent, such of-
ficer shall apply for an order of detention in respect of the accused person if he
is in custody and such order is necessary, and invite the magistrate having juris-
diction to record the deposition of such complainant or witness in the presence
of the accused person at the place where the former is lying.

Rule 25.21

25.21. Dying declarations. - (1) A dying declaration shall, whenever possible, be re-
corded by a Magistrate.
(2) The person making the declaration shall, if possible be examined by a medical of-
ficer with a view to ascertaining that he is sufficiently in possession of his reason to make
a lucid statement.
(3) If no magistrate can be obtained, the declaration shall, when a gazetted police officer
is not present, be recorded in the presence of two or more reliable witnesses unconnected
with the police department and with the parties concerned in the case.

(4) If no such witnesses can be obtained without risk of the injured person dying before
his statement can be recorded, it shall be recorded in the presence of two or more police
officers.

(5) A dying declaration made to a police officer should, under Section 162, Code of
Criminal Procedure, be signed by the person making it.

Rule 25.22

25.22. Medical examination of women. - No examination by a medical officer of a


living woman’s person shall be made without her consent and without a written order
from a magistrate, addressed to the medical officer, directing him to make such examina-
tion.
In all cases in which the police consider such an examination to be necessary, the
woman shall be taken a magistrate for order. This rule shall also apply to similar exami-
nations by dhais or any other persons.
The word ‘‘person’’ applies only to those parts of the body, to expose which would vio-
late a woman’s modesty.
Female Assistant or Sub-Assistant Surgeons in Government service shall only be re-
quired to do medico-legal work on behalf of Government when the woman or girl
concerned refuses to be examined by a male doctor. When a female doctor is summoned
by a Court she must attend.
(Punjab Government endorsement No. 558-M-36/9932, dated the 25th March, 1936).
Rule 25.23

25.23. Searches by police officers. - [(1) The rules regarding searches by Police Of-
ficers are contained in sections 165 and 166 of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1973.
Notices of search under section 165, summons to persons to witness search under sub-sec-
tion (4) of section 100 of the said Code and search lists under sub-section (5) of the said
section 100 shall be prepared in property search and seizure Form appended to in chapter
XXI. One carbon copy of the same shall be submitted for record to the District Crime Re-
cord Bureau of the concerned District Head Quarters.]1
(2) An officer-in-charge of a police station receiving a requisition to search, under Sec-
tion 166 of Criminal Procedure or other law applicable, shall comply without unnecessary
delay and shall take all necessary precautions to ensure a successful search.
Investigation 703

A police officer making such requisition may attend personally and assist in such search
or may send one or more of his subordinates for that purpose.
(3) Gazetted officers supervising investigations and inspecting officers shall take disci-
plinary action against investigating officers who carry out searches under Section 165,
Code of Criminal Procedure, without sufficient justification.
Rule 25.24

25.24. Records in custody of the post office. - The law regarding the production of
documents or things in the custody of the Postal or Telegraph Department is contained in
Section 95, Code of Criminal Procedure.
The instructions issued by the Director-General of Post Offices (paragraph 152 of Vol-
ume V of the Posts and Telegraphs Manual) regarding production of records in the
custody of the post office are as follows :-
Records of a post office or mail office should be produced and information available in
them should be given on the written order of any police officer who is making investiga-
tion under the Code of Criminal Procedure; but only those entries in the records should
be disclosed which relate to the person or persons accused of the offence under investi-
gations or which are relevant to that offence. In any other case the official-in-charge of
the office should without delay refer for orders to the Postmaster-General, who will de-
cided whether or not under Section 124 of the Indian Evidence Act, I of 1872, the
information asked for should be withheld. When the information asked for by a police of-
ficer is not available in the records of the post office, the police officer should be informed
accordingly, irrespective of the question whether the information, if available, might or
might not be given under the foregoing rule.
Rule 25.25

25.25. Track law. - Provisions of law regarding tracking are contained in Sections 41
and 42 of Act IV of 1872 (Punjab Laws Act).

Rule 25.26

25.26. Importance of foot-prints and track evidence. - (1) Footprints are of the first
importance in the investigation of crime. For this reason all officers-in-charge of police
stations shall instruct their subordinates as well as all lambardars and chaukidars that,
when any crime occurs all footprints and other marks existing on the scene of the crime
should be carefully preserved and a watch set to see that as few persons as possible are
permitted to visit the scene of the crime.
1
[(2) When it desired to produce evidence of the identity of tracks found at the scene of
or in connection with a crime, the procedure for securing the record of such evidence shall
be similar to that prescribed in Rule 26.32 for the identification of suspects. The atten-
dance of a Magistrate of the highest available status, shall be secured, but if no Magistrate
is available and the case is of great urgency, independent and literate witnesses of reliable
character like Sarpanches or Panches or Lambardars, shall be requested to conduct pro-
ceedings, but before they hold the parade, the rule regarding the holding of parades shall
be explained to them. In the presence of the Magistrate or other persons conducting the
test and in conforming with any reasonable directions which they may give, ground shall
be prepared for the tests. On this ground the suspect or suspects and not less than five
other persons, for each suspect, shall be required to walk. The Magistrate or the person
conducting the test shall record the names of all these persons and the order in which they

2. Substituted vide Punjab Govt. Notification No. G.S.R. 20 -/C.A.V./1861/S. 46/Amd. (23)/2003,
dated 6.3.2003.
1. Substituted vide correction slip No. 135 dated 13.7.1961
704 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

enter the test ground. The suspect shall, of course, be given option to take any place of
his choice in the Parade and a note to this effect shall be recorded in the Memo of proceed-
ings which will also indicate whether he has availed of this option. While these
preparations are proceeding the tracker of other witness who is to be asked to identify the
tracks shall be prevented from approaching the place or seeing any foot-prints of the per-
sons joining the test parade. When all preparations are complete, the tracker or the
identifying witness shall be called up and required to examine both the original tracks
whether lifted on the moulds or otherwise and those on the test ground and hereafter to
make his statement. The Magistrate or the person conducting the test, shall record the
statement of the tracker or the identifying witness as to the grounds of his claim to identify
the tracks, and shall put such other questions as he may deem proper to test his bona-fides.
Neither any Police Officer nor any person connected with the case shall be allowed to take
any part in the conduct of the test. The persons other than the Magistrate conducting the
test may, however, associate with them one or more independent witnesses of reliable
character.
If the tracks of culprits found at the scene of crime are shortfooted, the Magistrate or the
other person conducting the parade, shall be requested to take the shoes into possession,
paste their signed paper slip on the shoes and seal them after the parade. When admitting
the accused or suspect whose track parade is to be held, in Jail a request in writing shall
be made to the Jail authorities to see that the accused or suspect does not change the soles.
At the time of arrest in such cases, the Police Officer making or ordering the arrest will
take the shoes of the accused in possession, paste a chit signed by himself and witness on
it and seal them. The parcel will be opened by the Magistrate or other person conducting
the parade and resealed after the parade as above.
If, however, the tracker, for any reason such as inefficiency, carelessness, confusion or
adverse influence of the suspect, fails to correctly identify the tracks, the matter should not
be left there. It is still open to the Investigator, if another more efficient and reliable
tracker is not available, to get the moulds for foot-prints found at the scene of crime and
those prepared and duly initialled by the Magistrate or other person holding the parade at
the time of the tracks identification parade, compared by the Director, CID, Scientific
Laboratory, Phillaur, and obtain his expert opinion as to whether the foot impressions in
both the moulds tally.
Tracks which it is desired to test by comparison as above, shall be protected immedi-
ately on discovery, and their nature, measurements and peculiarities shall be recorded at
the time in the case diary of the investigating officer.
The details of the preparation of the test ground and the actions required of the suspect
and those with whom his tracks are mixed must vary according to the circumstances of
the case. The person conducting the test shall so arrange that the identifying witness may
be given a fair chance, but under the strictest safeguards, of comparing the original tracks
with other track, made on similar ground and in similar conditions.
Before inviting person other than the Magistrate to conduct the proceedings, the Police
Officer concerned will ensure that he is not interested in or against the suspect or accused.]
(3) The evidence of a tracker or other experts described in the foregoing rule can be sub-
stantiated by the preparation of moulds of other footprints of the criminal or criminals
found at the scene of the crime. The method of making moulds of footprints by means
of plaster of Paris or a composition of two parts of resin to one part of wax or paraffin is
taught to all students at the Police Training School but requires practice before an officer
can become proficient. The only advantage in the first method (plaster of Paris) is the
quickness with which the material sets. Resin and wax are cheap and can be used more
than once.
In making moulds for production as evidence the following precautions should be ob-
served :-
Investigation 705

(a) The footprints found on the scene of the crime must be pointed out to police wit-
nesses at the time and these same witnesses must be present during the prepa-
ration of the moulds.
(b) The latter must also be signed or marked by the witnesses and the officer prepar-
ing them while still setting.
(c) After the procedure described in sub-rule (2) above has been completed a mould
should be prepared in the presence of the magistrate or witnesses of one of the
foot-prints of the suspect made in their presence. This mould should be signed
by the Magistrate or witnesses when still setting.
(d) Both moulds should be carefully preserved for production in court for identifi-
cation by witnesses and comparison by the Court.
Methods of recording footprints. - (1) by tracking through glass footprints found on the
ground or other surface, and (2) by taking impressions of feet direct on to paper, as in the
case of finger impressions, are taught at the Police Training School. Such records shall
utilized in the case of notorious criminals for comparison with footprints found at the
scene of offence. They may also be used to check the reliability of local trackers.
Rule 25.27

25.27. Confessions. - The orders of the High Court by which magistrates are bound in
respect of the record of statements or confessions are contained in Appendix No. 25.27.
All supervising and investigating police officers must familiarise themselves with these
instructions and conform strictly to them in producing accused persons for the record of
their statements.
Rule 25.28

25.28. Statements recorded by magistrates. - (1) The circumstances under which po-
lice officers may require a statement to be recorded by a magistrate are as follows :-
(a) The statement, made in the course of an investigation by a witness or an accused
person, and not amounting to a confession, may be recorded by a magistrate un-
der Section 164, Code of Criminal Procedure, in order that it may be available
as evidence at a later stage. Such statements may be recorded in any of the man-
ners prescribed for recording evidence.
(b) A confession may be recorded under Section 164, Criminal Procedure Code, ir-
respective of the tender of a pardon, and of whether it involves more persons
than the individual accused making it.
(c) In the classes of offences specified in Section 337, Criminal Procedure Code, a
police officer may, at any stage of the investigation, inquiry or trial, move a
magistrate empowered under that section to tender a pardon to an accused per-
son.
(d) In cases in which a pardon cannot be tendered under Section 337, Criminal Pro-
cedure Code, but in which it is desirable to obtain the evidence of a suspect
against his accomplices, a police officer may recommend to the District Mag-
istrate that the local Government be moved to give a promise not to prosecute
an offender, subject to his fulfilling whatever conditions might be imposed in
giving such promise. Action of this nature can only be taken before the case
has been sent for trial.
Note. - The original orders on which this paragraph is based are contained in Punjab Government
Circular 2/117 of 27th April, 1898 as qualified by circular No. 426 of 30th September, 1906,
and were reproduced as Appendix 25.41(3) of Punjab Police Rules, Edition, 1915.
(2) If a professional offender is convicted and sentenced to imprisonment or transpor-
tation and it appears that he belongs to a gang of offenders and is willing to do everything
in his power to bring the members of such gang to justice, or to give valuable information
leading to the discovery of stolen property, the Superintendent may apply to the State
Government for suspension or remission of the sentence of such prisoner under Section
706 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

401, Criminal Procedure Code. Such application shall be made through the District Mag-
istrate.
Rule 25.29

25.29. Confessing accused and approvers. - (1) The Criminal Procedure Code sup-
plemented by the High Court instructions quoted in Appendix 25.27 prescribe a number
of precautions which are intended to give to a court conducting a trial the maximum as-
surance that a confessing accused has not been subjected to such pressure or inducements
as to invalidate this evidence under Section 24, Indian Evidence Act. All police officers,
who exercise any authority in connection with investigations, are required to have a thor-
ough understanding of these provisions. The departmental instructions here given merely
supplement and in no sense replace them.
(2) The main requirements, in so far as the police are concerned, are :-
(a) No police officer may offer a pardon. An accused person desirous of making a
statement with a view to obtaining a pardon, shall be told that no promise what-
soever can be made, but that, if a statement is made and verified and found to
be of sufficient importance to merit such action, the facts will be reported to a
magistrate, who has power to offer a pardon. No steps may be taken in this con-
nection by subordinate police officers without the previous sanction in writing
of a gazetted police officer.
(b) Statements, whether under Section 164 or 337, Criminal Procedure Code, shall
be recorded by the magistrate, other than the District Magistrate, having the
highest powers, who can be reached within reasonable time. Save for special
reasons, which must be explained by the investigating officer, such statements
shall never be recorded by 2nd class magistrates unless they have been specially
empowered to record such statements.
(c) The magistrate is required to make enquiries as to the circumstances leading up
to the confession; and police officers shall invariably furnish, so far as is in their
power, information required of them in this respect.
(d) Police officers connected with the investigation shall not be present while the
confession is being recorded.
(e) Magistrates are required to give orders, when remanding to custody persons who
have made a confession, that they shall be kept separate from other prisoners.
(f) Approvers shall remain under arrest until the conclusion of the trial.
(g) When more than one person confesses or turns approver in a case, their confes-
sions shall, if possible, be recorded by different magistrates and they shall not
be allowed to meet one another till their evidence has been recorded in court.
(h) Magistrates shall be moved to record statements of confessing persons in full de-
tail; in political cases and those in which professional criminals whose activities
extend over a large field are suspected, copies (in English) of approvers’ state-
ments and confessions shall be sent to the Deputy Inspector General, Criminal
Investigation Department.
(3) It must be remembered that the prosecution of a gang case, even without an ap-
prover, in a Section 30 magistrate’s court, is a very lengthy and difficult task owing to the
large number of witnesses and the numerous linked individual cases. If, however, the
prosecution relies upon an approver, the length and difficulty of the task is at least doubled
as, in accordance with Section 337(2-A), Code of Criminal Procedure, the case has to be
committed to the Sessions or High Court. Therefore, before launching a gang case under
Section 400 or 401, Indian Penal Code, with an approver, the District Magistrate and Su-
perintendent of Police should first satisfy themselves that it is not possible to secure
satisfactory results by proceeding in individual cases without resort to Sections 400 and
401, Indian Penal Code. If, however, it should still appear expedient to conduct a gang
case, they should ascertain whether the district resources are equal to the strain of both
Investigation 707

committal proceedings and trial in the Sessions or High Court without outside assistance.
If the district resources appear to be inadequate, the case should then be referred through
the Deputy Inspector General of the range to the Deputy Inspector General of Police,
Criminal Investigation Department, for decision whether the case should or should not be
undertaken.
Rule 25.30

25.30. Place of trial. - With regard to the place of trial of cases falling under Sections
179-183, Code of Criminal Procedure, police officers shall act solely with reference to the
public convenience.
Ordinarily such cases shall be sent up for trial in the district in which the witnesses can
attend with the least inconvenience to themselves.
Rule 25.31

25.31. Inquests. - - (1) An officer in charge of police station shall, upon receipt of in-
formation of the sudden or unnatural death of any person, when the body of such person
is within the local jurisdiction of his police station, immediately send information to the
nearest magistrate authorized to hold inquests and shall proceed to the place where the
body is and hold an investigation in the manner prescribed by Section 174, Code of Crimi-
nal Procedure. When the Sub-Inpector-in-charge of the Police Station through illness or
absence from the station house, is himself unable to carry out the investigation, he shall
at the first convenient opportunity proceed to the place where the body of the deceased
person was found, and shall personally verify the results of the investigation.
(2) In cases where the body is not found, or has been buried, there can be no investiga-
tion under Section 174, Code of Criminal Procedure.
In such cases, if there are reasonable grounds for suspicion that a cognizable offence has
been committed, the police shall register a case and commence investigation :
Provided that the following cases shall be exceptions to this rule :-
(a) When the death of any person is caused by injuries unlawfully inflicted by a sol-
dier or camp follower, or occurs within the limits of a military cantonment, the
inquest shall be conducted by the Cantonment Magistrate, under Section 176,
Code of Criminal Procedure, or by the nearest competent Magistrate if the post
of Cantonment Magistrate is held by an officer not specially empowered to hold
inquests or if the scene of death is outside cantonment limits.
If the magistrate invited to hold the inquest fails to do so, the Superintendent or other
gazetted officer shall make an investigation under the combined provisions of
Sections 174 and 551, Code of Criminal Procedure, and if no gazetted officer is
available such investigation shall be made by the officer in charge of the police
station concerned.
Such inquest or investigation under the Code of Criminal Procedure shall be held in
addition to any military court of inquest which may be held.
(b) In the case of the sudden or unnatural death of a European soldier, non-commis-
sioned officer, or officer the inquest shall be held under Section 176, Code of
Criminal Procedure, by the nearest magistrate duly authorized to hold inquests.
(c) In the case of a death by violence occurring within the walls of a military prison
or civil jail the police shall not make an investigation into the cause of death
when an inquest has been held by a competent magistrate.
(e) Upon receipt of information of a sudden or unnatural death within the walls of
a prison the officer-in-charge of the police station concerned shall send imme-
diate intimation to the senior magistrate present at headquarters and shall pro-
ceed to the prison and place a guard over the body and shall allow neither the
body nor anything which may have caused the death of the deceased to be
moved until the arrival of a magistrate.
708 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25
Rule 25.32

25.32. Investigations under Section 174, Code of Criminal Procedure. - The re-
spectable inhabitants who are required under Section 174, Code of Criminal Procedure,
to take part in any investigation into a sudden or unnatural death shall be selected with ref-
erence to any special attainments they may possess with are likely to be of use in such
investigation.
Rule 25.33

25.33. Investigating Officer - action of at scene of death. - On arrival at the place


where the body of a deceased person is lying, the police officer making the investigation
shall act as follows :-
(1) He shall prevent the destruction of evidence as to the cause of death.
(2) He shall prevent crowding round the body and the obliteration of foot- steps.
(3) He shall prevent unnecessary access to the body until the investigation is concluded.
(4) He shall cover up footprints with suitable vessels so long as may be necessary.
(5) He shall draw a correct plan of the scene of death including all features necessary to
a right understanding of the case.
(6) If no surgeon or other officer arrives, he shall, together with the other persons con-
ducting the investigation, carefully examine the body and note all abnormal appearance.
(7) He shall remove, mark with a seal, and seal up all clothing not adhering to, or re-
quired as a covering for, the body, all ornaments, anything which may have caused or
been concerned in the death of the deceased and shall make an inventory thereof.
In the inventory shall be described the position in which each thing was found and any
blood-stain, mark, rent, injury or other noticeable fact in connection with such thing. The
number and dimension of such stains, marks, rents, injuries, etc., shall also be given in the
inventory.
A counterpart of the mark and seal attached to such thing or to the parcel in which it has
been enclosed shall be entered in, or attached to, the inventory.
Such inventory shall form part of the inquest report.
(8) He shall take the finger prints of the deceased person if the body is unidentified.
(9) The photographing of the body in situ and of the scene of the occurrence may prove
of great evidential value.
Rule 25.34

25.34. Disinterment of bodies. - The following rules relate to the disinterment of bod-
ies :-
(1) An officer in charge of a police station and any superior police officer lawfully
making an investigation into the unnatural or sudden death of any person shall,
on learning that the body of the deceased person has been formally buried, re-
cord in writing the information which has reached him and the grounds on
which he considers it necessary that the body should be disinterred.
(2) He shall forward the information so recorded to the nearest magistrate empow-
ered to hold inquests and ask for an order under Section 176(2), Code of Crimi-
nal Procedure, and in the meantime shall guard the grave.
(3) On receipt of such order, if the magistrate himself does not attend the disinter-
ment, such police officer shall, in the presence of two or more respectable in-
habitants of the neighbourhood, cause the body to be disinterred. Such police
officer shall then comply with the provisions of Section 174, Code of Criminal
Procedure.
Investigation 709

(4) Police officers shall invariably examine witnesses to prove the identity of disin-
terred bodies before commencing their investigation.
(5) When a body has lain in the grave for a period exceeding three weeks no disin-
terment shall be made by any police officer until the opinion of the Civil Sur-
geon has been obtained, and then only with the concurrence of the District
Magistrate.
Rule 25.35

25.35. The Inquest Report. - (1) When the investigation has been completed the in-
vestigating officer shall draw up a report, in duplicate by the carbon copying process, in
Forms 25.35(1) A, B or C, according as the deceased appears to have died :-
A. from natural causes.
B. by violence.
C. by poisoning.
(2) Such report shall state the apparent cause of death, give a description of any mark
or marks of violence which may be found on the body and describe the manner in which
and the weapon or instrument with which such marks appear to have been inflicted.
(3) The report shall be signed by the police officer conducting the investigation and by
so many of the persons assisting in the investigation as concur therein and shall be for-
warded without delay through the Superintendent to the District Magistrate or, if the
District Magistrate has so directed, to the Sub-Divisional Magistrate.
(4) The following documents shall form part of such report :-
(a) The plan of the scene of death.
(b) The inventory of clothing, etc.
(c) A list of the articles on and with the body, if the body is sent for medical exami-
nation.
(d) A list of articles sent for medical examination, if any.
(5) In cases of death by hanging, the report shall give particulars as to the height and suf-
ficiency of the support and the nature of the thing used to bear the weight of the body.
In drowning cases the depth of the water shall be stated.
(6) The carbon copy of such shall be filed in the police station register No. VI.
(7) A copy of all reports relating to deaths caused by railway accidents shall, when made
by a police officer other than a railway police officer, be forwarded to the Assistant In-
spector-General, Government Railway Police.
Rule 25.36

25.36. Post-mortem examination - when and by whom held. - (1) The legal require-
ments in respect of post-mortem examination by a qualified surgeon are contained in
Section 174(3), Code of Criminal Procedure. In every case where death appears to have
been due to suicidal, homicidal, accidental or suspicious causes and where any doubt ex-
ists as to the exact cause of death, or if it appears to the officer conducting the investigation
- whether under Section 157 or Section 174, Code of Criminal Procedure - expedient to
do so, the body shall be sent to the nearest medical officer authorized by the Local Gov-
ernment to conduct post-mortem examinations. The sending of bodies for examination
may only be dispensed with, where such action is otherwise required when conditions ex-
ist, such as advanced putrefaction, which would clearly make examination useless.
(2) An investigating officer is empowered by law with the discretion to dispense with
a surgical examination of the body - (a) if he is fully satisfied that the cause of death is es-
tablished beyond doubt, (b) in the circumstances described at the end of the preceding
sub-rule. In regard to the former condition, it must be remembered that the existence of
710 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

an apparently fatal wound does not necessarily establish the cause of death. In cases
where investigation establishes the accidental nature of the event which led to the death
and the history of the deceased and of the case suggests no reason to suspect that expert
examination of the body will reveal any cause of death other than the apparent one, such
examination may be dispensed with. In all cases where suspicion exists that the death was
due either to suicide or to an act rendering the perpetrator thereof liable to a criminal
charge the body must be examined by a qualified medical officer, if possible.
(3) The law requires that the body shall be sent to the nearest qualified medical officer,
and the orders of the Local Government prohibit the summoning of such officer to con-
duct his examination at or near the scene of the death save in exceptional cases. These
may occur, where, owing to advanced putrefaction or the circumstances in which the
corpse was found, movement of corpse may make it impossible for the medical officer to
form a correct opinion as to the nature of the injuries or the exact cause of death. In such
cases if the investigating officer considers expert post-mortem examination essential in
the interests of justice, he shall report the facts by most expeditious means available to the
Superintendent of Police or gazetted officer in charge of the case, with a request that a
qualified officer shall be sent to the spot. If the officer receiving this report endorses the
opinion of the Investigating Officer, he shall request the District Magistrate or the next
senior Magistrate in the absence of District Magistrate from headquarters to give orders
for the medical examination of the body at the scene of death.
(4) In cases where it is impossible either to send a body to a qualified medical officer
or to have it examined by such officer on the spot, the investigating officer may, at his dis-
cretion, request the nearest Government medical officer, even though such officer be not
authorized to conduct post- mortem examination, to assist him with his anatomical and
other expert knowledge in estimating the effects and causes of injuries, etc. Such medical
officers are not empowered to perform any operation on the body. Medical Officers of
the Irrigation and Public Health Departments and of local bodies cannot be called on in
this connection unless they have been specially authorized by the Local Government to
undertake the medico-legal work (vide rule 25.19).

Rule 25.37

25.37. Post-mortem examinations - action to be taken by police. - When corpses are


sent for medical examination the following rules shall be observed :-
(1) The result of the investigating officer’s examination of the body shall be care-
fully recorded in form 25.39(1). Clothing found on the body, foreign matter ad-
hering to it and any instrument likely to have caused death remaining in a wound
or on the body shall be secured in the position in which found, if possible, or,
otherwise, shall be carefully packed separately, according to the instructions
contained in rule 25.41.
(2) To counteract decomposition as far as possible the body shall be sprinkled with
Formalin diluted to 10 per cent and shall also be so used with strong solution of
chloride of lime in water. Bodies which have to be carried long distances should
be sprinkled with the dry powder of chloride of lime or with carbolic powder
sold commercially in tin boxes with a perforated lid specially constructed for
sprinkling purposes. The use of powdered charcoal is prohibited, as the stains
caused thereby may complicate the task of post- mortem examination.
(3) The body shall be placed on a charpoy or other light litter and protected from the
sun, flies and exposure to the weather. The litter shall be transported to the place
appointed for the holding of post-mortem examinations by such means as the in-
vestigating officer may consider most expedient in the circumstances of
weather, distance to be covered and conditions of the body. If necessary and ex-
pedient conveyance, including a motor vehicle, may be hired to carry the corpse
and those who are required to accompany it as escort or witnesses.
Investigation 711

(4) All police officers along the route are required to give immediate assistance to
expedite the transportation of dead bodies for medical examination.
(5) Two police offices who have seen the dead body in the position in which it was
first found, and are competent to detect any attempt at substitution or tampering
with the body or its coverings, shall accompany the body to the mortuary, and
remain in charge of it until examination is complete. If necessary an additional
guard shall be supplied by the Lines Officer to place a sentry on the mortuary,
but the officers who have accompanied the body from the spot shall hand it over
personally to the medical officer conducting that post-mortem examination to-
gether with all reports and articles sent by the investigating officer to assist the
examination and shall receive and convey to the investigating officer the post-
mortem report.
(6) As soon as the Civil Surgeon has intimated that his examination is complete, the
police shall, unless they have received orders from a competent authority to the
contrary, make over the body to the deceased’s relatives or friends or, if there
are no relatives or friends, or they decline to receive it, the police shall cause the
body to be buried or burnt according to the rules framed in this behalf by the Dis-
trict Magistrate.
Rule 25.38

25.38. Unidentified bodies. - If a body is unidentified, the officer making investiga-


tion shall record a careful description of it, giving all marks, peculiarities, deformities and
distinctive features, shall take the finger impressions and, in additional to taking all other
reasonable steps to secure identification shall, if possible, have it photographed, and, in
cases where such action appears desirable, a description published in the Criminal Intel-
ligence Gazette.
Unidentified corpses should be handed over to any charitable society which is willing
to accept them, and if no such society comes forward, they should then be buried or burnt.
Rule 25.39

25.39. Form to accompany body or injured person. - When an injured person or a


body is sent to a medical officer, Form 25.39 shall, in addition to any other report pre-
scribed, be prepared by the carbon copying process and given to the police officer, in
duplicate, who accompanies the injured person or goes in charge of the body. The form
shall be prepared in English, if possible.
Rule 25.40

25.40. Articles for medical examination - how sent. - (1) Articles sent for medical ex-
amination, together with a body or injured person, shall be sent under the charge of the
escort which accompanies such body or person.
(2) When no body or injured person is sent, such articles shall be sent in the charge of
an escort which shall take them to the Civil Surgeon without relief.
Rule 25.41

25.41. Chemical Examiner - Channel of communication with. - (1) Superintendents


of Police are authorised to correspond with and submit articles for analysis to the Chemi-
cal Examiner direct in all cases other than human poisoning cases. Any references in
relation to human poisoning cases shall be made through the Civil Surgeon.
(2) Articles for chemical examination. - With regard to the packing of articles sent for
chemical examination, the following rules shall be observed :-
(i) Liquids, vomit, excrement and the like, shall be placed in clean wide-mouthed
bottles or glazed jars, the stoppers or corks of which shall be tied down with
bladder, leather or cloth, the knots of the cord being sealed with the seal of the
police officer making the investigation.
712 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

Such bottles or jars shall be tested, by reversing them for a few minutes, to see
whether they leak or not.
(ii) Supposed medicines or poisons, being dry substances, shall be similarly tied
down in jars or made up into sealed parcels.
(iii) All exhibits suspected to contain stains should be thoroughly dry before being
packed and despatched for examination. The safest way of drying exhibits is to
expose them to the sun. In cases of exhibits that become brittle on drying, they
should be carefully packed in cotton wool and then in a wooden box.
(iv) Blood-stained weapons, articles or cloth, shall be marked with a seal and made
up into sealed parcels. The entire article shall be sent.
(v) Sharp-edged and pointed exhibits like swords, spears, etc., should be packed in
boxes and not bound up into cloth packages. In their transit through the post
they are liable to cut through the packing material and the exhibit is exposed.
(vi) On each bottle, jar and parcel and also on each article or set of articles contained
therein, the separate identification of which has to be proved, shall be affixed a
label describing the contents, giving full particulars and stating where each ar-
ticle was found.
On such label shall be impressed a counterpart of the seal used to secure the fastening
of the bottle, jar or parcel. A copy of each label, and a counterpart impression
of the seal shall be given in the inquest report, and, in the case of cattle poison-
ing, in the case diary.
(vii) As far as possible no letters should be glued on to exhibits as they interfere with
analysis.
(viii) Exhibits such as clods of search should be packed carefully in wool and placed
in a wooden box.
Notes. - (1) Cases in which death is clearly due to natural causes should not be referred to the
Chemical Examiner. Medical Officers must accept the responsibility of deciding such cases.
(2) In no case should the Medical Officer attempt to apply tests for himself. Any such procedure
is liable to vitiate the subsequent investigation of the case in the laboratory of the Chemical
Examiner.
(3) Exhibits in connection with cases of murder by hurt or violence may be sent direct to the
Chemical Examiner. This saves time and relieves the office of the Civil Surgeon of the dis-
trict of unnecessary correspondence.
(4) Endeavour to send all the exhibits in a case of murder by hurt or violence under one covering
letter thereby reducing the cost of examination, etc.
(5) Nail clippings are poor exhibits to send for the detection of blood in murder cases. No court
of law could be expected to attach much weight to the finding of human blood on the nails
of the accused.
(6) Stomach tubes in hospitals are frequently kept in a solution of mercury. They should be care-
fully washed with water before use. Traces of mercury found along with another poison in
stomach contents might produce such complications as would handicap the successful prose-
cution of a case.
(7) Carbon copies of reports are sometimes very difficult to read and should be prepared clearly.
(8) Articles of which return is required for production in court or otherwise should be distinctly
specified in the forwarding letter sent with articles for chemical examination.
(3) Any document purporting to be a report from the Chemical Examiner or his assis-
tants is admissible as evidence under Section 510, Code of Criminal Procedure. No
summons can be issued to the officers of this department in their official capacity without
the permission of the Hon’ble Judges of the High Court. Any question or explanation on
a certain report should be done by letter or by a personal interview.
Investigation 713

(4) Attention is also directed to the further directions for, and precaution to be taken in
forwarding articles to the Chemical Examiner for examination report and the rules for
preserving and packing exhibits contained in Appendix 25.41(4).
Rule 25.42

25.42. Explosives. - (1) Substances or objects suspected of being explosive shall be


sent for examination to the Inspector of Explosives, Northern India Circle, whose address
is care of the Chemical Examiner, Punjab, Lahore (telephone number - Lahore 2248).
(2) Instruction for dealing with substances or objects suspected of being explosive are
published in Appendix 25.42(2).
Rule 25.43

25.43. Procedure in poisoning cases. - (1) A police officer making an investigation in


a case in which poison has been administered shall record in his report all information
likely to be of value in assisting the Civil Surgeon or the Chemical Examiner to form an
opinion as to the precise poisons employed.
(2) When treatment has been adopted before the death of the individual, the duration and
nature of such treatment shall be communicated to the Civil Surgeon for the information
of the Chemical Examiner.
(3) If the body of the deceased person has been burnt, the ashes of the funeral pyre shall
be collected and sent in a closed vessel to the Civil Surgeon, accompanied by a statement
of the circumstances which rendered this course of action advisable.
(4) The ordinary symptoms caused by common poisons are described in Appendix
25.43(4).
Rule 25.44

25.44. Procedure in cases of poisoning of animals. - When, in the investigation of a


cognizable offence relating to the unlawful killing of an animal, it is necessary to obtain
a professional opinion as to the cause of the death of such animal -
(i) If the animal appear to have been poisoned in the ordinary way and there are no
signs of puncture on the carcass the mouth shall be examined and anything ab-
normal found in it secured and placed in a clean glazed jar or bottle.
(ii) The carcase shall be opened and the stomach removed.
The stomach shall be cut open, and its appearance observed, as to whether it is con-
gested or not.
A piece of the stomach, the most congested part, about a pound in weight, the reticu-
lum, and a portion of the liver, about two pounds in weight, shall be cut off and
placed in a clean glazed jar or bottle.
Rectified spirit shall be poured into the bottle in sufficient quantity to cover the con-
tents completely in whatever position the vessel may be held.
The quantity of spirits shall be at least one-third of the bulk of the object in the bottle.
(iii) Water shall be gently poured over the remaining portion of the stomach, and any
arsenic or any white or yellow particles found shall be carefully collected.
The poison particles, or pebbles, so collected or otherwise found, shall be enclosed
in a sealed parcel.
(iv) If the animal appear to have been poisoned by means of needles, the carcase
shall be flayed and the flesh near the puncture examined.
If the flesh appears inflamed, a portion near the puncture shall be cut off and secured
in the manner prescribed in sub-section 2. Any needle found shall likewise be
secured.
(v) If the animal has been poisoned by being caused to inhale fumes of arsenic, etc.,
714 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

a portion of the lining membrane of the nostrils and windpipe and in addition,
the animal’s lungs shall be secured.
(vi) Jars or bottles shall be carefully corked or stoppered and the corks or stoppers
tied down with bladder, leather, or cloth.
The knots of the cord shall be sealed with the seal of the police officer making the
investigation.
Jars and bottles shall be tested, by reversing them for a few minutes, to see whether
they leak or not.
(vii) On each bottle, jar or parcel shall be affixed a label describing the contents and
giving full particulars and on such label shall be impressed a counterpart of the
seal used to secure the fastening of the bottle, jar or parcel.
A copy of each label and a counterpart impression of the seal shall be given in the
case diary accompanying the despatch.
(viii) The jars, bottles and parcels and any supposed poison found shall be des-
patched to the Superintendent of Police for transmission to the Chemical Exam-
iner with the information required by form 25.44(viii).
Rule 25.45

25.45. Matter how forwarded to Chemical Examiner. - (1) If the Superintendent of


Police considers that there are prima facie grounds for believing that the animal was poi-
soned, the bottles, jars or parcels shall be enclosed in a soldered tin case with an outer
wooden cover and despatched, carriage paid, to the Chemical Examiner. If the box is to
be sent by post, or as prepaid freight by rail, the additional precautions described in Ap-
pendix 25.41(4) shall be taken. A label bearing a reference to the number and date of the
letter intimating despatch shall be placed inside the box. Such letter shall contain an in-
ventory of the jars, bottles and parcels despatched with counterparts of their labels and
seals. A thin layer of cotton wood shall be placed on each side of the seal impression to
prevent its being broken in the post.
(2) An English translation of the material parts of the case diary relating to the poisoning
of the animal shall be forwarded with the letter intimating the despatch of the box.
(3) The owner of the carcase of a poisoned animal shall be encouraged to destroy it by
cutting up the hide in small pieces, breaking up the horns and bones and buying the whole
at considerable depth. Cattle are sometimes poisoned by hide dealers with a view to ob-
taining their hides at a cheap rate. The destruction of the hide removes this motive.
(4) Bills for all costs incurred in the transmission of substances for medical examination
whether connected with the death of human beings or of animals shall be paid from the
budget head ‘‘Carriage of corpses and transmission of substances for medical examina-
tion connected with the death of human beings or of animals under ‘‘29-Police-Other
Contingencies.’’
Rule 25.46

25.46. Imperial Serologist Calcutta - articles sent to. - The following rules regulate
the circumstances under which articles suspected to bear human blood-stains shall be sent
to the Imperial Serologist, Calcutta through the Chemical Examiner :-
(a) In cases in which the evidence of the blood-stained articles is, relatively to the
whole body of the evidence, of small importance, the articles shall be sent direct
to the Chemical Examiner, Lahore, for examination.
(b) In cases in which the establishment of the fact that blood-stains are of human
blood, as distinct from the general classification of ‘‘Mammalian’’ is material
to the prosecution and has a really important bearing on the case, the blood-
stained articles shall be sent direct to the Chemical Examiner, who will deter-
mine which of such articles he will forward to the Imperial Serologist with the
Investigation 715

necessary sketches, etc. In sending articles for the serological test, the Super-
intendent of Police shall specifically ask for examination to determine the
source of the blood. The Imperial Serologist will, after examining the articles
sent to him by the Chemical Examiner, return them with a copy of his report di-
rect to the Superintendent of Police concerned.
(c) When blood-stained clothing is concerned, the stained portion only shall be cut
out by the Chemical Examiner and sent. In the case of weapons and other solid
articles the entire article may have to be sent.
(d) All articles shall be accompanied by a complete medico-legal history of the case.
(e) No article shall be sent direct to the Chemical Examiner except under the express
orders of the Superintendent.
Rule 25.47

25.47. Report of medical officer. - (1) The medical officer having completed his ex-
amination of the person, body, or article shall record in full the result arrived at, and, in
the case of a post-mortem examination, his opinion as to the cause of death. He shall also
record a list of any articles which he may intend to send to the Chemical Examiner. The
repot shall be written on the back of, or attached to form 25.39(1) and shall contain such
reference to the person or object examined as will leave no possible doubt as to which case
the remarks apply.
(2) The report shall be placed with the police file of the case and may be used by the
medical officer to refresh his memory when giving evidence.
Rule 25.48

25.48. Maintenance and disposal of stolen cattle during investigation and trial. -
(1) In cases in which cattle or other animals alleged to be stolen are exhibits, the inves-
tigating officer shall, if the court of the magistrate having jurisdiction is so distant from
the place where the cattle or other animals are kept that evidence of identification is likely
to be prejudiced or the cattle are likely to suffer in condition by being driven to and fro,
send information to the prosecuting branch that the case is ready for trial, and request that
it may be heard at or near the place where the cattle have been seized or found. On receipt
of such report the head of the prosecuting branch shall, subject to the orders of the Super-
intendent of Police, represent the facts to the District Magistrate and move him to arrange
for the case to be tried on the spot.
(2) When a chalan is actually laid before the magistrate, the stolen cattle should properly
be in the custody of the police, but as soon as the identification evidence has been com-
pleted, the police prosecuting agency should at once approach the magistrate under
Section 516-A of the Criminal Procedure Code with a request that the cattle may be made
over to an independent surety or to the complainant on security pending the conclusion
of the case.
(3) With the object of mitigating the injury and inconvenience caused to owners of sto-
len cattle during the investigation and trial of cattle-theft cases, the prosecuting branch
shall move courts trying such cases to award punishment of fine as well as imprisonment
and direct such fine to be paid to the owner of the cattle concerned in the case in proportion
to the loss or injury he may have suffered by reason of his association with the investiga-
tion and trial, as provided by Section 545(1)(b) and (c) of the Code of Criminal Procedure.
(4) Complainants in cattle-theft cases or sureties to whom cattle have been made over
for safe custody and production as and when required during the investigation and trial are
entitled to receive the cost of maintaining such cattle. Expenses incurred under this rule
during the investigation of a case shall be paid from the allotment at the disposal of the
Superintendent of Police under ‘‘Rewards to private persons (Supplies and Services)’’,
and claims shall be made by officers in charge of police stations in Form 25.48(4). Pay-
ment may be made direct to the person entitled to receive it from the permanent advance
allotments of police stations, if the Superintendent of Police by general order so directs.
716 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

Otherwise the sum claimed shall be drawn by contingent bill as expeditiously as possible
and sent to the police station concerned for disbursement. Expenses of maintenance dur-
ing the pendency of the case in court shall be paid from judicial funds, and the prosecuting
branch shall be responsible for recovering amounts due on this account together with and
in the same manner as diet and journey money.
(5) The rates authorized for payment under sub-rule (4) above will be notified by the
District Board in each district from time to time.
Rule 25.49

25.49. Property not required to be returned. - On the conclusion of an investigation


the investigating officer shall make over to the proper persons all property which he may
have taken into his charge in the course of the investigation and which is not further re-
quired in connection with the case. A receipt for property so made over shaol be taken
on the inquest report.
Rule 25.50

25.50. Seizure of property in extradition cases. - In any proceedings against any per-
son under the Extradition Act (XV of 1903) or any treaty for the extradition of offenders,
property in the possession of such person or of other persons, and required in connection
with the case, may be seized and disposed of under the provisions of the Code of Criminal
Procedure relating to the seizure and disposal of property required in case occurring in
British India (Government of India Notification No. 362-I of 22nd July, 1925).1
Rule 25.51

25.51. Recognizances from witnesses. - (1) If the facts disclosed by the investigation
indicate the commission of a cognizable offence and the person who appears to be guilty
of such offence is arrested, the investigating officer shall, when he has completed the in-
vestigation, take recognizances from the witnesses as provided by law.
(2) The charge-sheet and its preparation and submission are dealt with in Chapter
XXVII. To facilitate compliance with Rule 27.1(4) investigating officers shall, when
possible, intimate to the prosecuting inspector some days in advance the date when the
chalan and witnesses will reach headquarters.
Rule 25.52

25.52. Dissemination of intelligence and hue and cry notices. - (1) Every officer pro-
ceeding on an investigation shall have with him a supply of blank hue and cry notices
(form 23.18) and, shall utilise them as directed in Rule 23.18.
(2) Nothing in this rule, or in Rule 23.18, shall affect the taking of prompt action under
Sections 87 and 88, Code of Criminal Procedure, as required by rule.
Rule 25.53

25.53. Case diaries. - (1) Section 172(i), Code of Criminal Procedure requires that a
case diary shall be maintained and submitted daily during an investigation by the inves-
tigating officer. In such diary shall be recorded, concisely and clearly, the steps taken by
the police, the circumstances ascertained through the investigation and the other informa-
tion required by Section 172(i), Code of Criminal Procedure.
(2) Case diaries shall be as brief as possible; shall not be swollen with lengthy explana-
tions and theories, and shall be written either in English or in simple Urdu.
Only such incidents of the investigation shall be included as have a bearing on the case.
(3) Detailed lists of stolen property, or of property seized in the course of a search, shall

1. Rule 25.50 not printed in 1977 Edition of Punjab Police Rules and all subsequent Rules in chpater
25 renumbered accordingly.
Investigation 717

be entered in the first case diary submitted after the facts relating to such property were
reported to, or discovered by, the investigating officer.
(4) The fact that copies of the record prepared under the provisions of section 165 or
166, Code of Criminal Procedure, have been sent to the nearest Magistrate empowered to
take cognizance of the offence shall also be noted.
Rule 25.54

25.54. Record of case diaries. - (1) Case diaries shall ordinarily be submitted in Form
25.54(1) and each sheet shall be numbered and stamped with the station stamp. Two or
more copies, as may be ordered, shall be made by the carbon copying process by the of-
ficer conducting the investigation. The officer writing a case diary shall enter in such
diary a list of the statements, recorded under section 161, Criminal Procedure Code,
which are attached to such diary and the number of pages of which each such statement
consists.
(2) They shall be sent from the scene of investigation to the police station without delay.
(3) On arrival at the police station the number and date of each case diary shall be re-
corded on the reverse of the police station copy of the first information report, and the date
and hour of receipt shall be entered on each copy of the diary.
(4) The original shall be despatched with as little delay as possible to the inspector or
other superior officer as may be ordered, after the time of despatch has been entered in the
space provided in the form on both the original and the copy or copies. Orders for the dis-
posal and record of case diaries in the headquarters office are contained in Rule 11.70.
Also see Rule 27.38.
(5) A copy of every case diary shall be retained at the police station, a separate file being
maintained for each case. Such files shall be destroyed in accordance with the periods
fixed in sub-rule 27.39(5).
(6) Copies of all orders received at a police station in connection with case diaries and
the replies thereto shall be made on blank sheets of paper and shall be attached to the case
diary to which they refer.
Rule 25.55

25.55. Files of case diaries. - (1) When a case is sent for trial the police station file of
case diaries shall be forwarded with the chalan to the magistrate, and on completing of the
trial shall be returned to the police station for record.
(2) Such files when received back at the police station also files of other cases in which
the final report has been submitted, shall be filed at the police station in an annual bundle
A in accordance with the serial number of their first information report.
(3) Copies of case diaries in pending cases shall be kept in files at the police station in
a separate bundle B in accordance with the numbers of their first information reports.
(4) A list shall be kept in each bundle A and B of all the files contained therein, merely
quoting the numbers of their first information reports. Should it be necessary to remove
a file from the bundle the fact will be noted in the list.
Rule 25.56

25.56. Incomplete charge sheet. - (1) When an investigating officer requires author-
ity to detain an accused person in police custody beyond the limits prescribed in section
61, of the Code of Criminal Procedure, he shall make an application therefor in accord-
ance with the provisions of section 167, Code of Criminal Procedure, on an incomplete
charge sheet in Form 25.56(1) to which he shall attach the case diaries or copies thereof.
The Magistrate will record his order on the incomplete charge sheet which will not be
returned to the Police, but will form part of the Magisterial proceedings. Applications for
remand on incompletecharge sheets shall be prepared in duplicate by the carbon copying
718 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

process, and a copy of the Magistrate’s order will be made by the Police Officer on the
carbon copy of the application, which will then be attached to the Police file of the case.
The copy will be attached to the incomplete charge sheet when the case is finally sent for
trial. Case diaries will not form part of the Judicial file. The orders of High Court in con-
nection with the granting of remands to the police custody are contained in Appendix No.
25.56(1).
(2) No application for remand to police custody shall be made on the ground that an ac-
cused person is likely to confess. Grounds for such an application should be of the
following nature :-
(a) That it is necessary to take the accused to a distance that he may be shown to per-
sons likely to identify him as having been seen at or near the scene of the of-
fence.
(b) That it is necessary to have his footprints compared with those found on or near
the scene of offence.
(c) That the accused has offered to point out stolen property or weapons or other ar-
ticles connected with the case.
(d) Any other good and sufficient special reason.
(3) Provided that in all serious cases, when the accused has been arrested and prima fa-
cie evidence has been produced, it shall be incumbent on the investigating officer to send
the case for trial without delay, whether the investigation in complete or not. Witness
should invariably accompany such chalans, and the Court should be asked to take up the
case at the earliest possible moment in accordance with High Court Rules and Orders,
Chapter 3(10) Volume IV, in order to record the evidence and thereafter to grant such de-
tention or remand under the provisions of Section 167 or 344, Criminal Procedure Code,
as may be found necessary. Evidence obtained subsequently shall be produced before the
Court by a subsidiary chalan. Superintendents should call up investigating officers for an
explanation in all cases where the provisions of this rule appear to have been disregarded.
Rule 25.57

25.57. Close of investigation and final report. - (1) If on any day, or days, a police
officer in charge of the investigation of a case makes no investigation, he shall enter a
statement to this effect in the case diary of the day on which he next does something to-
wards the completion of the case.
(2)[(i) When the police are unsuccessful, after taking all the measures in their power and
it is considered advisable to suspend the investigation, a final report in Form 25.57(2)
shall be submitted as required by Section 173, of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1973.
One carbon copy of final report shall be submitted to the District Crime Record Bureau
of concerned District Headquarters for record by the concerned Station House Officer.]1
(ii) In cases in which a final report is submitted under sub-rule (2)(i) above and in which
a copy of the first information report has been sent to a Panchayat as required by Police
Rule 24.4(2), a final report shall also be sent to the Panchayat containing information on
the following points :-
(a) Whether or not an offence has been proved.
(b) Whether or not the offence proved is triable by the Panchayat and explaining that
the case has not been sent for trial.
(3) If the informant is present when the final report is prepared, he shall be informed ver-
bally of the result of the investigation and, after noting this fact in the final report, his

1. Substituted vide Punjab Govt. Notification No. G.S.R. 20 -/C.A.V./1861/S. 46/Amd. (23)/2003,
dated 6.3.2003.
Investigation 719

signature or thumb mark shall be taken on it. If the informant is not present, he shall be
informed in writing by postcard or by the deliver of a notice by hand, and the fact that this
has been done shall be noted in the final report.
In final (untraced or cancelled) reports the facts of the case which the investigating of-
ficer believes to be correct should be summarised, together with the grounds, for his
belief. Information so recorded should be utilised for the completion of preventive re-
cords.
Rule 25.58

25.58. Provision of Investigation bag to the investigating officer. - The investigating


officer shall be provided with an investigation bag of approved pattern containing :-
(1) One bottle of grey powder. 
(2) One bottle of graphite powder. 
(3) One camel hair brush. 
(4) Folien paper. 
(5) Finger print forms.  Finger print material
(6) Finger print ink. 
(7) Appliance for finger printing dead bodies. 
(8) One magnifying glass. 
(9) One finger print impression pad and roller. 
(10) One electric torch.
(11) One knife.
(12) One pair of scissors.
(13) One measuring tape 60’ long.
(14) One foot-rule 2 feet long.
(15) Sealing wax and candles.
(16) Formalin diluted to 10 per cent together with
chloride of lime to counteract decomposition of
corpses.
1
(17) Cotton wool and 1 yards cloth for packing
exhibits. 2

(18) Case diary book with plate, pencil or pen,


carbon paper and the usual forms required in
investigation.

APPENDIX 25.18-A
RULES FOR THE PROTECTION OF SOURCES OF
INFORMATION
In exercise of the powers conferred in him by section 58 of the Government of India Act,
1935, the Governor of the Punjab acting in his discretion is pleased to make the following
rules :-
1. Except as hereinafter provided a police officer or other servant of the Crown shall
not disclose nor be compelled to disclose the source from which or the channel
through which any information with respect to the operations of persons com-
mitting, or conspiring, preparing or attempting to commit such crimes as are
mentioned in sub-section (1) of section 57 of the Government of India Act,
1935, has been or may be obtained; and a police officer or other servant of the
Crown shall not communicate nor be compelled to communicate any matter
720 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

whether contained in records or otherwise which discloses, or in his opinion


might in conjunction with other circumstances or matters result in the disclosure
of, or permit to be inferred, the source from which or the channel through which
any such information as aforesaid has been or may be obtained.
Note. - Section 58 and this rule project also sources of information relating to past acts of commis-
sion of such crimes, and to past conspiracies, preparations, and attempts to commit such
crimes.
2. The provisions of rule 1 shall not apply to a disclosure or communication by a po-
lice officer to another member of the same force who is authorized by the In-
spector-General of Police either by a general or special direction in this behalf
to require or receive such disclosure or communication. In giving general or
special direction the Inspector-General of Police shall be under the general con-
trol of and comply with such instructions as may from time to time be given to
him by the Governor in his discretion.
3. The provisions of rule 1 shall not apply to a disclosure or communication by a po-
lice officer to any person (not being a member of the same force) who is author-
ised by the Governor in his discretion either by a general or special direction in
this behalf to receive such disclosure or communication.
4. The provisions of rule 1 shall not apply to a disclosure or communication by a ser-
vant of the Crown (not being a police officer) to any person who is authorized
by the Governor in his discretion either by a general or special direction in this
behalf to receive such disclosure or communication.
5. The provisions of rule 1 shall not apply to a disclosure or communication by any
servant of the Crown (not being a police officer) of acts ascertained by himself
made to a Superintendent of Police or District Magistrate of a district or to an
officer of Criminal Investigation Department of or above the rank of Sub-In-
spector or to any police officer conducting an investigation under the Code of
Criminal Procedure, 1898.
6. The provisions of Rule 1 shall not affect the procedure followed by a police of-
ficer making an investigation under Chapter XIV of the Code of Criminal Pro-
cedure, 1898.
7. The Inspector-General of Police shall, with the previous approval of the Gover-
nor in his discretion give directions as to the custody of the records or any other
documents containing such information as is referred to in rule (1), and the per-
son or persons in whose custody such records or documents are kept shall not
disclose them to any person except in accordance with these directions.
8. If in the interests of the administration it is considered necessary by any police of-
ficer in possession of any such record or information that such record or infor-
mation should be disclosed or given to any person other than a police officer
serving under the Punjab Government, he shall refer the matter to the Governor
through the Inspector-General of Police, and the decision of the Governor in his
discretion shall be final.
9. If any person in the service of the Crown in the province other than a police of-
ficer considers it necessary in the interests of the administration that such record
or information should be disclosed or given to any person, he shall refer the mat-
ter to the Governor, and the decision of the Governor in his discretion shall be
final.
10. A servant of the Crown who is in doubt whether in any particular case he is com-
pelled by, or permitted under the provisions of these rules to make a disclosure
or communication may before making the disclosure or communication require
that the matter be referred for direction by the Inspector General of Police or the
Governor in his discretion, as the case may be.
4. The above principles apply equally to Council questions. The great majority of these
Investigation 721

can be disposed of without reference to local officers. Sometimes when a question con-
sists of several parts, a reference to local officers is necessary only in regard to one or two
of these parts. Where a reference is made, it should be stated in regard to which parts in-
formation is required. Further, where a question asks for information which will require
considerable time and labour for its collection, local officers should not be asked to supply
this information, unless the Secretary concerned is satisfied that the information may rea-
sonably be given in spite of the time and labour involved. Where he does not think that
this is the case, he should obtain the orders of the Member or Minister concerned before
starting inquiries which may later prove unnecessary. When it is decided not to collect
information required to answer a council question the proper answer is - ‘‘It is not in the
public interest to collect this information.’’
5. In order to secure that the above orders are observed, the following procedure is pre-
scribed :-
(i) Except in purely routine matters, no reference to Commissioners or Deputy Com-
missioners should be made without the approval of a gazetted officer. Impor-
tant reference should receive the approval of the Secretary or the Head of the
Department concerned, unless they are of an immediate nature and the approval
of the Secretary or Head of the Department cannot be obtained without delay.
(ii) Commissioners of Divisions should bring to the notice of the Chief Secretary by
demi-official letter cases in which unnecessary references are made or inade-
quate time is given for the disposal of unnecessary references. The Chief Sec-
retary will submit the reference of the Commissioner to the Member or Minister
concerned, who will no doubt wish to satisfy himself that the orders of Govern-
ment have been obtained.
6. The above orders relate primarily to references to Commissioners and Deputy Com-
missioners. They will also apply mutatis mutations to references by the Secretariat and
Heads of Departments to another administrative and executive officers, e.g., in the Irri-
gation Branch of the Public Works Department they will apply to references by the
Secretariat to Superintending and Executive Engineers; in the Agriculture Department
they will apply to references by the office of the Director of Agriculture to Deputy Direc-
tors of Agriculture and to Extra Assistant Directors of Agriculture, and so on.
7. In order that the foregoing instructions are not lost sight of, they should be embodied
in departmental Manuals.

Yours sincerely,
F.H. PUCKLE,
Chief Secretary to Government, Punjab.
To
(i) All Heads of Departments in the Punjab.
(ii) The Registrar, High Court of Judicature at Lahore.
(iii) All Commissioners of Divisions, Deputy Commissioners and District and Ses-
sions Judges in the Punjab.

APPENDIX No. 25.27

50. Instructions as to statements and confessions of accused persons. - The follow-


ing instructions (contained in Rules and Orders of the High Court, Volume III) on the
722 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

subject of taking and recording statements and confessions of accused persons should be
observed :-
Confessions and statements of accused persons
The provisions of Sections 164, 342 and 364 of the Criminal Procedure Code with re-
gard to the confessions and statements of accused persons should be carefully studied.
Section 164 deals with the recording of statements and confessions at any stage before the
commencement of an enquiry or trial. Section 342 deals with the examination of accused
persons during the course of the enquiry or trial. Section 364 prescribes the manner in
which the examination of accused persons is to be recorded.
2. The object of section 164, Criminal Procedure Code, is to provide a method of se-
curing a reliable record of statements or confessions made during the course of the police
investigation, which could be used, if necessary, during the enquiry or trial. Under Sec-
tion 25 of the Indiana Evidence Act, a confession to a police officer is inadmissible in
evidence, and hence when an accused person confesses during police investigation the
police frequently get it recorded by a Magistrate under Section 164, Criminal Procedure
Code, and it can then be used to the extent to which it may be admissible under the Indian
Evidence Act.
3. Under section 80 of the Indian Evidence Act, a Court is bound to presume that a state-
ment of confession of an accused person taken in accordance with law and purporting to
be signed by any judge or Magistrate is genuine, and that the certificate or note as to the
circumstances under which it was taken, purporting to be made by the persons signing it,
are true, and that such statement or confession was duly taken. The words ‘‘taken in ac-
cordance with law’’ occurring this section are very important and it is essential that in
recording a statement or confession under section 164, the provisions of that section
should be strictly followed. Some important changes were made in the section in 1923
and the form of the certificate to be attached to the statements and confessions was also
altered. The evidential value of a confession depends upon its voluntary character and the
precision with which it is reproduced and hence the section provides safeguards to secure
this end. These safeguards are of great importance as confessions are often retracted at
a later stage and it becomes necessary for the Court to ascertain whether the alleged con-
fession was actually and voluntarily made. The mere fact that a confession is retracted
does not render it inadmissible in evidence, but the Court has to scrutinise any such con-
fession with the utmost care and accept it with the greatest caution. Experience and
common sense in fact show that in the absence of some material corroboration it is not
safe to convict merely on a retracted confession, unless from the peculiar circumstances
under which it was made and judging from the reasons, alleged or apparent, of retraction
there remains a high degree of certainty that the confession, notwithstanding its having
been resiled from, is genuine (cf.30 P.R. 1994 (Cr.)).
4. Some important features of section 164 as it stands now are :-
(a) Statements or confessions made in the courses of an investigation can be re-
corded only by a magistrate of the first class or a magistrate of the second class
who has been specially empowered by the Local Government.
(b) Confessions must be recorded and signed in the manner provided in Section 364.
(c) Before recording any such confession the magistrate shall explain to the person
making it that he is not bound to make a confession, and that if he does so it may
be used in evidence against him.
(d) No magistrate shall record any such confession unless upon questioning the per-
son making it, he has reason to believe that it was made voluntarily; failure to
question has been held to vitiate the confession (I.L.R. 2 Lah. 325).
(e) The memorandum set forth in Section 164(3) must be appended at the foot of the
record of the confession.
Investigation 723

(f) It is not necessary that the magistrate receiving or recording a confession or state-
ment should be a magistrate having jurisdiction in the case.
5. The annexed form for recording confessions taken under section 164 has been pre-
scribed and should invariably be used.
6. Unless there are exceptional reasons to the contrary confessions should be recorded
in open court and during court hours, Police officers investigating the case should not be
present.
7. An accused person who has been produced for the purpose of making a confession
and has declined to do so, or has made a statement which is unsatisfactory from the point
of view of the prosecution, should, in no circumstances, be remanded to police custody.
8. Section 342 of the Code empowers to the Court to put questions to the accused at any
stage of enquiry or trial to enable him to explain any circumstances appearing in evidence
against him. The questions put under this section must be confined to the points brought
out in the evidence and should not be in the nature of cross-examination of the accused
person. Nor should the power given by the section be used to elicit information from the
accused to fill up gaps in the prosecution evidence (cf. I.L.R. 4 Lah. 55). For the convic-
tion of an accused person can only be based on the evidence produced by the prosecution.
No oath can be administered to the accused and the answers given by him can only be
taken into consideration in explanation of the prosecution evidence.
8-A. The magistrate is allowed by section 342 of the Code of Criminal Procedure to ex-
amine the accused at an early stage of the case for the purpose of enabling him to explain
any circumstances appearing in the evidence against him. This provision is intended for
the benefit of the accused, and must not be used to elicit his defence before the prosecution
evidence is complete. Magistrates sometimes question the accused generally on the case
as soon as a prima facie case has been made out, but before the prosecution evidence is
complete. This is incorrect. According to the second part of clause (1) of section 342, it
is only after the completion of the prosecution evidence that the accused can be ques-
tioned generally on the case. The necessity for postponing such examination is not
avoided by framing a charge at an early stage.
Even when a charge has been framed, the magistrate should wait until the prosecution
evidence is concluded before making a general examination of the accused.
9. Section 342 makes it obligatory for Court to examine the accused generally on the
case after the witnesses for the prosecution have been examined and before the accused
is called for his defence. Even when an accused person has been examined at an earlier
stage the Court must examine the accused generally after the close of the prosecution case
(i.e., after the examination and cross-examination of prosecution witness and their further
cross-examination, if any, after the charge is framed) and before the accused is called
upon to produce his defence so as to give him an opportunity to explain any points which
were not included in the questions put to him at earlier stages. Failure to examine the ac-
cused at the close of the prosecution evidence has been held to be an illegality which
vitiates the trial (vide 7 I.L.R. Lah. 564).
10. Under section 256 of the Code, if the accused person puts in a written statement, it
should be filed with the record. But a written statement of this kind does not relieve the
Court of the duty of examining the accused in Court after the close of the prosecution evi-
dence as laid down in section 342.
11. Section 364 provides the mode in which the examination of an accused person is
recorded. The questions put to the accused and the answers given by him should be dis-
tinctly and accurately recorded. The examination of the accused should be recorded in
the language in which he is examined, and, if that is not practicable, in the language of the
Court or in English. In cases in which examination is not recorded by the magistrate or
Judge himself he must record a Memo. thereof in the language by the Court or in English
724 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

if he is sufficiently acquainted with the latter language. The examination must be read
over to the accused and made conformable to what he declares to be the truth. The Mag-
istrate or Judge must then certify under his own hand that the examination was taken down
in his presence and hearing, and that the record contains a full and true account of what
was stated.
12. Under Section 533 of the Code, if any court, before which a confession or other
statement of an accused person recorded or purporting to be recorded under section 164,
or section 364, is intended, or has been received in evidence, finds that any of the provi-
sions of either of such sections have not been complied with by the magistrate recording
the statement it must take evidence that such person duly made the statement recorded and
such a statement may then become admissible in evidence notwithstanding the provisions
of Section 91 of the Indian Evidence Act, provided the error has not prejudiced the ac-
cused as to his defence on merits.
-------------------
Investigation 725

RECORD OF A CONFESSION MADE BY AN ACCUSED PERSON.

(SECTION 264 OF THE CODE OF CRIMINAL PROCEDURE)


__________________Division
In the court of ___________________________________________________
THE CROWN

versus

The Confession of _________________ taken by me _________ a Magistrate of the


____________________ District, this ____________day of _________________ 19 .

Memorandum of Enquiry

(The magistrate shall first, as required by section 164(3), Code of Criminal Procedure,
explain to the accused person that he is not bound to make a confession, and that if he does
so, it may be used as evidence against him, and shall then put and record answers to the
following questions. If the answers are of such a character as to require him to do so, he
should put such further questions as may be necessary to enable him to judge whether the
accused person is acting voluntarily. In arriving at his conclusion on this point the Mag-
istrate should consider inter alia the period during which the accused person has been in
police custody and make sure that the confession is not the result of any undue influence
or ill treatment. Special care should be taken when women or children are produced by
the police for their confession being recorded) :-
Q. - Do your understand that you are not bound to make a confession ?
A. -
Q. - Do you understand that your statement is being recorded by a magistrate, and
that if you make a confession, it may be used as evidence against you ?
A. -
Q. - Understanding these two facts, are you making a statement before me voluntar-
ily ?
A. -
Statement of accused.
(Mark or signature of accused)
Magistrate.
I have explained to ________________ that he is not bound to make a confession, and
that if he does so, any confession he may make may be used as evidence against him and
I believe that this confession was voluntarily made. It was taken in my presence and hear-
ing, and was read over to the person making it, and admitted by him to be correct, and,
it contains a full and true account of the statement made by him.
Magistrate.
Dated ________________
726 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

Appendix 25.41(4)
DIRECTIONS FOR AND PRECAUTIONS TO BE TAKEN IN FORWARDING
ARTICLES TO THE CHEMICAL EXAMINER FOR EXAMINATION AND
REPORT
All articles should, as far as possible, be sent by registered parcel post. If this cannot be
done and the articles are important, they should be sent by hand. Only very heavy and un-
important articles should be sent by rail.
Human poisoning cases.
I. FATAL -
The following articles should be forwarded in all cases :-
(1) Stomach with contents. The stomach should be securely tied at both ends.
(2) A piece of the small intestine (about 3 feet) securely tied at both ends.
(3) A portion of the liver (not less that 16 ounces), one kidney and a piece of spleen.
(4) Urine or stomach washing if available.
(5) A sample of the preservative fluid used.
Note. - (I) Rectified spirit should be used in all cases unless alcohol, phosphorus or carbolic acid
poisoning is suspected. In such cases normal saline solution should be used.
(II) In suspected coal-gas (charcoal) poisoning, a sample of the blood should be sent in a small bot-
tle properly corked. Add two drops only of formaline to prevent decomposition if available.
(III) Ashes and burnt bones should only be sent where a metallic poison is suspected. Vegetable
poisons are destroyed during cremation.
Documents which should be forwarded :-
A. - By post -
(1) Post-mortem Report.
Note. - Information on the following toxicologically important points should invariably be sup-
plied:-
(a) Date and hour of onset of symptoms ; (b) date and hour of death; (c) in cases where the body
has been exhumed, dates of burial and of exhumation should be entered in column headed
‘‘Death’’; (d) in cases of suspected irritant poisoning, the condition of the gastro-intestinal
tract, as regards emptiness or otherwise as well as any abnormal appearance of the mucous
membrances should be specially noted.
The following information should also be given :-
(a) note of symptoms observed by the Medical Officer if the case has been seen during life by him,
(b) note of nature and duration of treatment, if any, adopted by the Medical Officer, Police,
or friends of deceased.
(2) Statements of symptoms [Police form 25.35(c)] supplied by the Police to the for-
warding Medical Officer. (This form should be carefully filled in by the Police, noting
particularly the early or first systems observed).
(3) Certified copy of the Police Reports (vernacular or otherwise) sent with the case to
the forwarding Medical Officer.
(4) Forwarding memo and invoice list of articles forwarded for examining to the Chemi-
cal Examiner.
(5) Impression or imprint of seal used to seal the packages.
Note. - (1) The seal should be a private one, and the same seal should be used throughout. The im-
pression should be attached to the forwarding memo. (No. 4), and should be protected by a
thick layer of cotton wool to prevent its being broken in transit.
Investigation 727

(2) An imprint of the seal on a piece of paper is better than an impression of the seal.
B. - Under cover of the box containing the articles for examination -
(1) Duplicate copies of forwarding memo., invoice list of articles sent for analysis.
(2) Duplicate impressibly imprint of seal used in the case.
Note. - Make sure that the bottles are properly corked and packed otherwise leakages stain the
documents inside.
II. - NON-FATAL -
Vomit, stomach washings, purged matter, urine and suspected articles of food
should be sent whenever available.
Documents which would be forwarded :-
A. - By post -
(1) Statement of symptoms [Police form 25.35(c)].
(2) Note of symptoms observed by the Medical Officer.
(3) Note of treatment, if any, adopted by the Medical Officer, Police, or patient’s
friends.
(4) Forwarding memo. (original) and invoice list of articles forwarded for examina-
tion. The nature of the preservative fluid used, if any, should be stated.
(5) Impression or imprint of seal used to seal the packages.
B.- Under cover of box containing the articles for examination -
(1) Duplicate copy of forwarding memo., and invoice list of articles sent for analysis,
and of police form No. 25.35(c).
(2) Duplicate impression or imprint of seal used in the case.
Abortion cases.
I. Fatal. - As in fatal human poisoning cases, but, in addition, the uterus and upper part
of the vagina should invariably be sent, along with any foreign bodies found in the genital
tract.
II. Non-fatal. - As in non-fatal poisoning cases, but, in addition, any foreign bodies ex-
pelled or removed from the vagina or uterus should be sent.
Blood-stain cases.
The entire garments or other articles suspected to be stained with blood should be sent
if possible, not portions removed or cut from them. A label with number and description
of the articles should be stitched or tied (not gummed or pasted) to each separate article,
care being taken that the labels correspond with the invoice list of articles. When the label
is tied to the articles the string should be sealed.
Note. - (1) Take care that the stains are quite dry before being packed for examination. Wet stains
readily decompose.
(2) Do not make a circle with ink or indelible pencil around the suspected stains. In wet weather
or during examination such circles run into the stain and interfere with the tests.
(3) Wet blood stains on a culprit’s body should be removed with a clean cotton swab and properly
dried before being sent for analysis. Dry blood stains on a culprit’s body may be gently
scrapped into an envelope and then despatched for analysis.
Documents which should be forwarded :-
A. - By post -
(1) Forwarding memo. and invoice list of articles for examination.
(2) Impression or imprint of seal used in the case.
B. - With the articles -
(1) Duplicate copy of forwarding memo. and invoice list.
728 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

(2) Duplicate impression or imprint of seal used in the case.


Semen cases.
This entire garment, etc., should be sent. The cloth should not be folded at the stained
portion. The stain should be kept quite flat, and should be protected by a thin layer of cot-
ton wool on each surface.
Note. - It is better to send swabs from the vaginal mucus than mounted slides. These swabs should
be first dried and then forwarded in a small box or phial carefully labelled.
Rules for preserving and packing exhibits for transmission to the
Chemical Examiner.
1. The suspected organs or other exhibits should be placed in a clean glass bottle or jar
having a good fitting stopper or cork. Wide mouthed bottles or jars of sufficient size must
be used, otherwise the contents readily decompose. It is also difficult to empty narrow-
mounted bottles or jars that are tightly packed.
II. Materials that are liable to decompose should be preserved by one of the following
methods :-
(1) In cases of suspected human poisoning other than alcohol, phosphorus, carbolic
acid and some of the lesser known volatile poisons, the material sent should be
immersed in rectified spirit. The spirit should be sufficient to cover the material
immersed in whatever position the vessel containing it may be held. On no ac-
count use common bazar spirit. A separate four ounce bottle of the rectified
spirit added should be sent for independent analysis as a control.
(2) In those cases mentioned above where rectified spirit should not be added, the
preservative used should be salt solution and the same precautions for immer-
sion of material should be exercised. A salt solution is made by adding a full ta-
blespoonful of salt to about a pint of fresh clean water. A separate four ounce
bottle of this salt solution should be sent for independent analysis as a control.
(3) If two or more examinations have to be made on the same occasion, the medical
officer should complete one and label and seal the articles connected with it be-
fore commencing a second examination, otherwise there is risk of the viscera,
etc., of one case getting mixed with those of another. He should clean his instru-
ments and vessels before commencing the second case.
(4) In cases of suspected cattle poisoning, the viscera or other material should be pre-
served in rectified spirit with the same precautions as those exercised in human
poisoning cases (item 2).
(5) It is advisable to keep a sample of the preservative added under lock and key in
case the bottle containing the sample sent to the Chemical Examiner should ar-
rive broken.
III. Great care should be taken that the stopper or cork of the bottle or jar fits tightly;
especially is this necessary during the hot weather, when rectified spirit is added as a pre-
servative. The stopper may first be candle-waxed and then carefully tied down with
leather or water proof and sealed.
IV. To secure identity, the bottles or jars should be properly labelled with a list of the
contents.
V. The bottles or jars should then be placed in a strong wooden box with plenty of pack-
ing material to ensure against any breakages during transit. Saw dust, cotton wool, and
dried grass are suitable for this purpose. Old office papers, etc., should not be used as the
copies of the forwarding documents enclosed in the box are liable to be thrown away with
this waste paper packing material. Keep these documents well away from the bottles as
breakages or leakages are apt to stain them.
VI. The box itself should be covered with common garha cloth properly sewed and
Investigation 729

sealed. Seals should be at short intervals of three inches along each line of sewing. All
the seals must be similar and preferably the wax should be of the same kind. The seal used
should be the ordinary office seal and must be kept under lock and key. Current coins,
or a series of straight, curved or crossed lines must not be used as seals. The box should
be properly addressed and sufficient stamps added to cover postage; the box must also be
franked.
VII. Under no circumstances should viscera from different cases be included in the
same parcel.
VIII. The despatching officer who is invariably the Civil Surgeon or another medical
officer authorised to conduct post-mortem examination, is personally responsible that
these instruction are carefully followed.
Note. - In order to minimise the chances of parcels being lost in transit between the office of the
Chemical Examiner and the Railway Station at Lahore, all articles for medico-legal exami-
nation should be sent by post as far as possible or better still by hand.
IX. In cases where the police send a closed parcel through the medical officer and the
latter has no occasion to open it in transmission, the parcel should be packed in a second
cloth cover and the forwarding memo., should also be enclosed. This procedure is nec-
essary and prevents cases getting mixed up on receipt of the Chemical Examiner’s office.
X. The labelling and numbering of articles should not be in the vernacular but in Eng-
lish.
XI. A declaration of the contents to the Postal authorities is unnecessary.
APPENDIX 25.42(2)
INSTRUCTIONS FOR DEALING WITH SUBSTANCES OR OBJECTS SUS-
PECTED OF BEING EXPLOSIVE
Introduction.
Explosive substances or objects which may cause explosion may be met within the fol-
lowing forms :-
A. Liquids. - For example nitro-glycerine. These will rarely have to be dealt with.
The possession of a liquid explosive is generally illegal.
B. Solids -
(1) Blasting explosives. - Dynamite, Gelatine Dynamite, Blasting Gelatine,
Gelignite, etc. These are usually made up in cylinder form about two
inches long in waterproof paper wrappers, stamped with the maker’s name.
They vary in consistency, from a tough leathery material to a soft one like
ordinarily stiff jelly.
(2) Gunpowder. - May be black, brown or grey and is made up in cylinder
form, cubes, pebbles, grains and powder.
(3) Gun cotton. - Is white and is supplied in slabs or cylinders or loose like ordinary
cotton wool.
(4) Gun, rifle and shot gun powders. - These are generally in cords, tapes or grains,
but are found as small cubes or flakes. In colour they may be white, pink, yel-
low, blue or black.
(5) Fulminates. - These are white or grey powers. They are extremely dangerous.
Their possession is generally illegal.
(6) Picric acid and picrates. - These are crystalline or may be in powder form.
They have a brilliant yellow colour if pure. A license is required for their pos-
session.
(7) (a) Ammonal. - This is a mixture of tri-nitro-toluene, ammonium nitrate alu-
minium powder and charcoal. It is a silvery brown paste.
730 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

(b) Amatol. - Is s mixture of tri-nitro-toluene and ammonium nitrate. In appearance


it is a brown paste.
(8) Chlorate of potash. - May be found in clear tabular crystals or as a white pow-
der.
(9) Sulphide of arsenic. - Is generally found as a yellow or orange powder.
(10) Carbide or phosphide of calcium. - Under certain circumstances these may
cause violent explosion.
(11) Detonators and caps. - These are explosives made up in metal tubes or small
metal caps. Military detonators, friction tubes and time fuzes are made in a
great variety of forms. All detonation should be handled with the utmost care.
(12) Fuse. - This is slow burning gunpowder rolled up in cloth or paper in the form
of long cards. Military fuses are made up in metal bodies in great variety of
forms.
(13) Cartridges. - Thee are either commercial, military or sporting and generally
contain their own means of ignition in the form of a cap or primer. Cartridges
for big guns generally consist of explosives made up in silk cloth or shalloon
bags or bundles.
(14) Bombs. - These are explosives contained in receptacles such as bottles, jars, co-
conut shells, cloth, jute or hemp, balls or bundles, books letters tins, metal shells,
bamboo tubes, water cistern floats, chatties, etc., the whole being designed to
explode by percussion, fuse, trigger, by being inverted, etc.
(15) Fireworks. - Fireworks are provided with a fuse of touch papers or slow match.
Throwdowns, crackers, explosives, corks, or objects designed to explode by
percussion, provided they are not detonators, caps or cartridges are not fire-
works, but bombs.
(16) Rockets. - Some rockets are not fireworks. Life saving, signal and military
rockets are dangerous and should be handled with care.
(17) Signals. - These may be ships-flares, signal lights, etc. They are not fire-
works.
C. Gases. - Liquid or compressed gases (ammonia, oxygen, hydrogen, acetylene,
carbon-di-oxide) in cylinders, sparklets, etc., may under certain circumstances
cause violent explosion.
Instructions.
A local police officer should communicate at once with the Superintendent of Police,
who will himself proceed, or depute some responsible officer to proceed, to the place to
carry out the following instructions :-
1. If you have any reason, however slight, to suspect that the substance or object with
which you, are dealing is dangerous then regard it as being Highly Explosive until such
time as it is proved to be otherwise.
2. * * * * * * * * * *
3. During the removal, guarding or examination of any substances or object suspected
of being explosive, all unnecessary persons whether police or otherwise should be sent
away.
4. If the substance you are examining is -
Liquid, proceed as in paragraphs 6 or 7.
Solid, proceed as in paragraphs 8, 9 or 10.
Gas, proceed as in paragraph 11.
5. If the object you are examining is a -
Investigation 731

Detronator or cap., 
Fuse, 
Cartidge,  proceed as in paragraph 12
Firework, 
Rocket, 
Signal light 
Bomb, proceed as in paragraph 13.
6.(1) If the substance is a liquid in an open vessel -
Carefully dip into the liquid a pencil or thin piece of stick and allow one drop to fall on
a small piece of blotting paper or tin foil (silver paper). Remove this ten yards or more
from the vessel or vessels containing the bulk of the liquid, place it upon a flat surface or
iron or stone and strike it a sharp glancing blow with a flat headed hammer. Repeat the
test three times with fresh drops and also by burning a fresh drip of the liquid on the blot-
ting paper in the flame of a spirit lamp or candle.
(A) The substance explodes or burns rapidly. Place about half an ounce of the liquid
in a small clean bottle, carefully cork it up (do not use a glass or metal stopper),
and after packing in cotton wool in a box or tin, send it by messenger to the In-
spector of Explosives, Northern India, with your report. The bulk of the liquid
should be locked up in an isolated place until instructions are received from the
Inspector of Explosives, Northern India, as to its disposal.
(B) The substance does not explode or burn rapidly. Place about half an ounce of
the liquid in a small clean bottle, cork up and after packing send by post to the
Inspector of Explosives, Northern India, with your report, the bulk of the liquid
should be locked up in any convenient place until the report of the Inspector of
Explosives is received.
7. (2) When the substance is a liquid in a closed vessel -
(1) If the vessel is a bottle and is not suspected of being a bomb and the stopper will
not come out when using only moderate power, do not attempt to open but send
it by messenger to the nearest Inspector of Explosives together with your report,
first having carefully packed the bottle upright in a box with straw, sawdust, or
paper, etc.
(2) If the vessel is a bottle and is not suspected of being a bomb and the stopper will
come out, then proceed as in paragraph 6.
(3) If the vessel is not suspected of being a bomb and is of metal or other hard ma-
terial and the stopper will not come out when moderate force is used, do not at-
tempt to open but remove the vessel very gently, and in such a manner as to
explose it to as little shanking as possible, and without turning it over in any
way, to such open place of safety in the vicinity as may be available, where its
ignition or explosion would be attended with a minimum of mischief, e.g, a yard
or a garden or other open space from which the public are or can be excluded.
The two pieces of strong cord to the vessel passing one cord round a hook or tree
and from round the corner of a building and after all persons have been removed
from within range, pull the cords backward and forward so that the vessel is up-
set and given as severe a shaking as possible, then leave the vessel alone for
twelve hours.
If explosion is not obtained and the vessel is not too large send it by messenger to
the Inspector of Explosives with your report.
If the vessel is a large one, try once more to open it using more force. If you cannot
open it, remove the vessel to a convenient place where it can be locked up and
send a copy of your report and all connected papers to the Inspector of Explo-
sives.
732 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

8. When the substance is a solid in an open vessel -


(1) Carefully take out with a piece of cardboard or flat stick a few grains of the solid
and after removing it ten yards, or more away from the vessel or vessels contain-
ing the bulk of the substance, place it upon a flat surface or iron or stone and
strike it a sharp glancing blow with a flat headed hammer. Repeat the test three
times with fresh substance and also try burning a small portion on blotting paper
in the flame of a spirit lamp or candle.
(A) The substance explodes or burns rapidly. - Take a very small amount of the
substance, add to it a little water and notice what happens. If the substance un-
dergoes no change and there is no sign of any gas being given off, or of heat be-
ing generated, place about half an ounce of the substance in a small clean bottle
and fill up with clean water. Cork the bottle carefully, taking the precaution not
to use a glass or metal stopper, and then pack it in cotton wool in a box or tin and
send it by messenger to the Inspector of Explosives with your report.
The bulk of the substance should then be covered with clean water and locked up in
a isolated place until instructions are received from the Inspector of Explosives
as to its disposal.
(B) The substance does not explode or burn rapidly. - Test a small amount of the
substance with water in exactly the same way as detailed in (A). If the substance
undergoes no change and there is no sign of any gas being given off, or of heat
being generated, place about half an ounce of the substance in a small clean bot-
tle and fill up with water. Cork the bottle carefully, and after packing, send it
by post to the Inspector of Explosives with your report.
The bulk of the substance should then be covered with clean water and locked up in
any convenient place until the report of the Inspector of Explosives is received.
(2) If you find that the substance under sub-paragraphs (A) and (B) does undergo a
change, etc., when water is added proceed exactly as before, except that the
sample in all cases should be sent dry, and the bulk also kept dry. Make certain
that your bottle is absolutely dry before you put the sample into it.
9. When the substance is a solid in a closed vessel -
(1) If the vessel is a bottle and is not suspected of being a bomb and the stopper will
not come out when only moderate power is used. Do not attempt to open it but
send it by messenger to the Inspector of Explosives together with your report,
first having carefully packed the bottle upright in a box with straw, sawdust, pa-
per, etc.
(2) If the vessel is a bottle and is not suspected of being a bomb and the stopper will
come out then proceed as in 8.
(3) If the vessel is not suspected of being a bomb and is of metal or other hard ma-
terial proceed as in 7(2).
10. When the substance is calcium carbide or calcium phosphide. - If it is desired to de-
stroy calcium carbide or calcium phosphide, this can be done by dropping them into deep
water, but not more than half a pound at a time, waiting until no more gas is given off be-
fore a fresh portion is destroyed.
11. When the substances is a gas. - Gases are generally found compressed in cylin-
ders, sparklets, etc. They should be kept cool and away from the direct rays of the sun.
If it is desired to know what gas is in any cylinder, the whole cylinder should be even up
in the coir matting and sent by train to the Inspector of Explosives together with your re-
port. Small cylinders or sparklets only a few inches long can be sent by post if well
packed in cotton wool in a wooden box.
12. When the object is a detonator, cap, fuse, cartridge, firework, rocket, light, these
should never, under any circumstances, be sent through the post. A few should be care-
Investigation 733

fully packed separately in cotton wool in a wooden box and be sent by hand to the Inspec-
tor of Explosives together with your report. The bulk should be locked up in an isolated
place.
13. When the object is a bomb -
(1) These may be met with in the following forms :-
A. Military grenades.
B. Copies of military grenades.
C. Bombs made up in soda bottles, jam tins, water cistern floats, chatties, coconut
shells, bundles of jute or hemp, bamboo tubes, etc.
D. Book bombs.
E. Letter bombs.
(2) Any of these may be designed to explode -
(a) when moved in any way,
(b) when turned over,
(c) when placed in water,
(d) when thrown down,
(e) by lighting a fuse,
(f) by clockwork,
(g) by chemical reaction.
(3) Before touching the bomb examine it where it lies and see if you can detect the ar-
rangement for firing. See if there is any trigger and, if so, if it is set or not. Do not move
the bomb, unless you are satisfied that it is safe to do so. If you are not satisfied, then place
a guard over the bomb and report to your senior officer.
A. Military grenades. - The first thing to do, is to see that the safety pin is in position,
that it is not broken or corroded and that the ends are well splayed out so that it
cannot be jolted out. See that the jaws of the laver are in good condition and
support the striker correctly. Being satisfied on these points, the base should be
unscrewed and, if the igniter set is present, it should be carefully removed. Pack
the igniter set and the bomb in cotton wool in separate wooden boxes and send
by hand to the Inspector of Explosives, together with your report.
If the safety pin and level are missing and the striker is inside the bomb, it will prob-
ably have to be destroyed in situ. Set a guard over it where it lies and report to
your senior officer.
B. Copies of military grenades. - These are generally something like a military gre-
nade but are of cruder finish. They must only be handled by persons who have
handled bombs before. It is generally possible to render them harmless by re-
moving an explosive cap or tuft of gun cotton. This should only be done with
you are satisfied that the trigger is safe. Do not put this type of bomb in water
but, provided the trigger has been made safe, it should be packed in cotton wool
in a wooden box and be sent by the hand to the Inspector of Explosives together
with your report.
C. Bombs made up in soda bottles, etc. - First arrange a string bag and strong cord
over a large bucket of hot water. Carefully remove the bomb keeping it in the
same position as found and place it in the bag and from round the corner of a
building, first having sent everybody present under cover lower the bomb into
the hot water and leave it there for 24 hours. The water will then be cold.
It may then be taken out and be carefully packed in wet straw or cotton wool in a
734 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

wooden box and be sent by hand to the Inspector of Explosives together with
your report.
If the bomb is well made and there is a possibility that the water may not have pene-
trated inside, it should be given the rough treatment described in paragraph 7(3)
before being sent away.
D. Book bombs. - These are bombs made up in book form and are generally de-
signed to explode when the book is opened or turned over. Such a bomb should
be very carefully taken to an isolated place, keeping it in the original position all
the time and be locked up. Send a report on the subject to the Inspector of Ex-
plosives.
E. Letter bombs. - These are letters containing explosives which are designed to ex-
plode when opened. Place the whole letter in a bucket of water. When the letter
is quite wet, pack it in a tin in wet cotton wool and send by hand to the Inspector
of Explosives, together with your report.
F. Booby Traps. -
1. ‘‘Booby Traps’’ are bomb generally designed to explode in the presence of
an officer who is engaged in searching suspected premises.

2. They may be designed to explode when the bomb is moved in any way or
electric contract is made by some action of the officer or by clock work or
chemical means.

3. The most prevalent procedure is to cause one bomb to explode in a house


by time fuse, such as a burning candle, leaving a second bomb which will
explode when the officer comes to investigate the first explosion, or the of-
ficer may be tempted to the house by a message, telephone call etc.

4. Another method is to leave the second bomb with an obvious means of ig-
nition such as a burning candle in the hope that the officer will extinguish
the candle and then consider the bomb as safe whereas it is really designed
to explode if moved in any way.

5. Never enter a house or room in which you suspect booby traps by the ob-
vious way. First smash a window or knock a hole in the wall with a crow-
bar opposite the door to se if the door can be safely opened.

6. Enter the house or room very slowly touching nothing until each object has
been carefully examined. Make a loop at the end of a long rope and drop
the loop over each object which might be a bomb without touching it.
These may be such things as tins, trunks, kettles, lamps, buckets, boxes,
clocks, etc. From outside the room or house jerk the object about by means
of the rope and do not enter the room or house again for some minutes in
each case. Open the lids of boxes or trunks by means of the rope from
round the corner.

7. If an unexploded bomb is discovered after this treatment proceed as in para-


graph C above.
--------------------
Investigation 735

APPENDIX No. 25.43(4)


MEMORANDUM OF THE SYMPTOMS PRODUCED BY THE
MORE COMMON POISONS
Poisons Usual symptoms
Arsenic Sammulfar Sankhia Vomittings; burning pain in the stomach; great thirst; sometimes cold
skin; cramps in the limbs, and sleepiness
Hartal and Mansil
Opium Afiun .. Sleepiness; pupils contracted; complete insensibility; skin sweating;
vomiting seldom occurs.
Afim ..
Aconite Bish .. Numbness, and tingling in the mouth and throat, afterwards in the
limbs; frothing at the mouth; sleepiness; occasionally convulsions or
delirium, or paralysis.
Dhatura Dhatura .. Pupils dilated; delirfum; insensibility; vomiting rare.
Nux vomica Kuchila .. Twitching in the limbs, followed by violent spams and often lock-jaw.
The spasms cease for a time and then gain returns, often without
evident cause; it usually affects the whole body. Shortest time before
symptoms - 15 minutes. Shortest time before death - 1 hour.

Note. - Any one of the above symptoms may be absent, though the poison by which they are caused
has been administered.
EFFECT OF COMMON POISONS
Poison Ordinary interval between taking the poison Ordinary time before death
and the appearance of symptoms
Arsenic Half to one hour 6 to 24 hours
Opium Half to one hour 6 to 12 "
Aconite 15 minutes 1 to 8 "
Dhatura 5 to 10 minutes 6 to 12 "
Nux vomica Half to one hour 1 to 6 "

APPENDIX No. 25.56(1)


REMANDS TO POLICE CUSTODY.
1. Remands to Police custody when to be granted. - Before making an order of re-
mand to police custody under section 67 of the Code of Criminal Procedure, the
Magistrate should satisfy himself that -
(1) there are grounds for believing that the accusation against the person sent up by
the police is well founded.
(2) there are good and sufficient reasons for remanding the accused to police custody
instead of detaining him in magisterial custody.
In order to form an opinion as to the necessity or otherwise of the remand applied for
by the police, the magistrate should ascertain what previous similar orders (if
any) have been made in the case, and the longer an accused person have been
in custody the stronger should be the grounds required for a further remand to
police custody.
The accused person must always be produced before the Magistrate when a remand
is asked for.
2. The following principles are laid down for the guidance of Magistrates in the matter
of granting remands, and District Magistrates are required to see that they are carefully
applied :-
(i) Under no circumstances should an accused person be remanded to police custody
736 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

unless it is made clear that his presence is actually needed in order to serve some
important and specific purpose connected with the completion of the enquiry.
A general statement by the officer applying for the remand that the accused may
be able to give further information should not be accepted.
(ii) When an accused person is remanded to police custody the period of the remand
should be as short as possible.
(iii) In all ordinary cases in which time is required by the police to complete the en-
quiry, the accused person should be detained in magisterial custody.
(iv) Where the object of the remand is merely the verification of the prisoner’s state-
ment, he should be remanded to magisterial custody.
(v) A prisoner, who has been produced for the purpose of making a confession and
who has declined to do so, or has made a statement which is unsatisfactory from
the point of view of the prosecution should in no circumstances be remanded to
police custody.
3. In any case when an accused person is remanded to police custody, the reasons must
be recorded in the order of remand, and when the Magistrate ordering a remand is not him-
self a Sub-Divisional or District magistrate, he must at once send a copy of his order, with
his reasons for making it, to the Sub-Divisional or District Magistrate to whom he is im-
mediately subordinate.
If the limit of 15 days has elapsed, and there is still need for further investigation by the
police, the procedure to be adopted is that laid down in section 344, Criminal Procedure
Code. The case is brought on to the magistrate’s file, and the accused, if detention is nec-
essary, will remain in magisterial custody. The case may be postponed or adjourned from
time to time for periods of not more than 15 days each, and as each adjournment expires
the accused must be produced before the magistrate, and the order of adjournment must
show good reasons for making the order.
Investigation 737

FORM No. 25.2(1)


ORDER TO REQUIRE ATTENDANCE AT INVESTIGATION UNDER SEC-
TIONS 160 AND 175, CRIMINAL PROCEDURE CODE
Name _____________ son of ____________ caste _________ Resident of ________
Whereas the presence of the aforesaid person is necessary for the purpose of enquiry
into the offence reported to have been committed under section at Police
Station; therefore the said person is hereby directed to appear before the
undersigned at (place hour date ) there to give such informa-
tion relating to the said alleged offence as he may possess.

Signature and Designation of issuing Police Officer.


Date Hour
NOTE -
............... mentioned in this order attended on ______________________at
at ___________________ and was permitted to leave on ___________________ at
at
Dated____________
Signature and Designation of issuing Police Officer.
FORM No. 25.23(1)(a)
________________ Police Station __________________ District. Notice of search in
the case of Crown versus _________________ F.I.R. No. ________________________
dated ________________________ , offence ________________________
Sections 165/166, Cr.P.C.
Date and place of Name, parentage, residence Articles to be searched for Reasons for which the
search and caste of the person to search is to be made
be searched
1 2 3 4

Officer−in−charge
Signature of Investigating Officer
______________
Endorsement in case the officer causing search to be made is unable to conduct in per-
son.
I hereby authorise ________________________________________________ to con-
duct the search as I am unable to conduct it in person for the following reasons :-

Officer−in−charge
Signature of Investigating Officer
738 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

FORM No. 25.23(1)(b)


Order under Section 103(1), Criminal procedure Code, requiring attendance of a wit-
ness at a search
________________________
F.I.R. No. ________________________, dated ________________________
Section ________________________ Police Station ________________________
To
________________________
________________________
WHEREAS, it is necessary to make a search in the above mentioned case of the
house/shop/place of________________________ situated in _____________________
therefore I, ________________________ call upon you to attend at the aforesaid
house/shop/place at ________________ O’clock on/forthwith ____________________
to witness the search.

N.B. - Failure to attend without reasonable cause is punishable under section 187, I.P.
Code.
Dated ________________,
Signature and designation of
the officer conducting the search
-----------------

FORM No. 25.23(1)(c)


Form of search list prescribed by Section 103(2), Cr.P.C.
F.I.R. No. _____________, dated ___________ Police Station _________________
The house of ________________________, son of ________________________
caste ________________________, resident of village, ________________________,
was searched in the presence of the undermentioned witnesses and the following articles
were recovered and taken into possession by the police on the statement and indication of
________________________, son of _______________, caste __________________,
village ________________________, accused in the abovementioned case.*
*Cross out if not applicable.
Articles Place from which recovered.
Name and signature Signature and designation of
the witnesses of the officer conducting the
search.

Date _____________
Investigation 739

FORM No. 25.35(1)(A)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _________________ DISTRICT
DEATH REPORT - SUDDEN DEATH FROM NATURAL CAUSES
DEATH REPORT No. POLICE STATION
Dated _____________
1. Name of place where death occurred.
2. Distance and direction from the police station in whose jurisdiction it is.
3. Date and hour of discovery of the death.
4. Name, parentage and residence of two or more persons who identify the body as son of
that of the deceased person named in this report. resident of
(Note. - Relatives of deceased, or two respectable witnesses to identification should son of
be obtained, if possible). resident of
5. Name of deceased

Parentage
Caste
Residence
Condition in life
6. Age and Sex Age
Sex
7. Condition of clothes, ornaments, & c., as not indicating an unnatural death.
8. Position of limbs, eyes and mouth
9. Expression of the countenance
10. Injuries or marks of violence the body may have received.
‘‘Wounds and bruises’’. Position, length and breadth.,
11. Blood, liquid or clotted; where oozed from and to what amount.
12. In what manner, or by what weapon or instrument, such marks of injuries or of
violence appear to have been inflicted.
13. Is the body well nourished and vigorous or emaciated and weak ?
14. Apparent cause of death.
15. Any signs of death having been caused by violence or poison, or any rumours
of such being the case ?
To be  16. Description of each article of clothing, ornaments, covering,
made out
on sepa-  weapons, etc., found on or near the body.
rate
sheets of  17. Sketch plan of the scene of death.
papers.
 18. Brief history of the case
 19. Signature of two or more respectable inhabitants present at
 investigation and of investigating officer with date and place of signing
740 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

FORM No. 25.35(1)(B)


DEATH REPORT :- UNNATURAL DEATH BY VIOLENCE
DEATH REPORT No. ___________ POLICE STATION ___________
Dated ___________
1. Name of place where the death occurred or where body was found (state which).
2. Distance and direction from police station in whose jurisdiction it is.
3. Date and hour of discovery of the death.
4. Names, parentage and residence of two or more persons who identify the body as that of
the deceased person named in the report.
(Note. - Relations of the deceased or two respectable witnesses to identification should be
obtained, if possible)
5. Name, parentage, caste, residence and condition in life of the deceased.
6. Age and sex.
7. Condition of the clothes, ornaments, & c., and marks of either having been forcibly
removed or of being stained with blood or other matter.
(Note. -If the Civil Surgeon or other Medical Officer is expected to attend to examine the
body this information should be filled in so far as can be seen and without touching or
removing any clothes, and in such case it should be completed after he has finished his
examination of the body)
8. Position of the limbs, eyes and mouth.
9. Expression of the countenance.
10. Injuries or marks of violence the body may have received.
Wounds and bruises. - Show position, length and breadth.
(Note. - Not depth. Be careful not to probe wounds.
If the Civil Surgeon or other Medical Officer be expected to attend to examine the body, this
information should be filled in after he has completed his examination)
11. Blood, liquid or clotted ? Where oozed from and to what amount ?
12. In what manner or by what weapon or instrument such marks of injuries or of violence
appear to have been committed ?
13. Was there any rope or other article round the neck, or any mark of ligature on the neck ?
14. Had such rope or article apparently been used to produce strangulation, and, if the body
had been suspended by it, could it probably have supported the body ?
In what mode was the either end of the rope attached to the support ?
15. Where there any foreign matters, such as weeds, straw &c., in the hair or clenched in the
hands of the deceased, or attached to any part of the body ?
16. Is the body well nourished and vigorous or emaciated and feeble ?
17. Is it stout, thin, or decomposed ?
18. Height by measuring from head to feet.
19. Distinguishing marks - Position and appearance of moles, scars, & c.
20. Apparent cause of death.
Investigation 741

To be  21. Are there any circumstances or rumours tending to show that


made
out on  deceased killed himself
separate  22. Description of each article found on body (to be labelled and sealed).
sheets of
papers  23. Description of each article found near body (to be labelled and sealed).
 24. Sketch plan of the place where body was found.
25. Signature of two or more respectable inhabitants present at investigation and of
investigation officer with date and place of signing.

FORM No. 23.35(1)(C)

DEATH REPORT - UNNATURAL DEATH BY POISONING


DEATH REPORT NO. ___________ POLICE STATION ___________
Particulars relating to the case, in addition to those given in Form No. 25.35(b)
1 Was deceased in good health previous to the attack ?
2 If not in good health, what was he suffering from ?
3 What medicine was he taking ?
4 What did the last meal consist of ?
5 What was the interval between the last meal and the commencement of the symptoms ?
6 What did the deceased last eat or drink before the commencement of the symptoms ?
7 What was the interval between the very last time he ate or drunk, and the
commencement of the symptoms ?
8 What were the first symptoms ?
9 Was he thirsty ?
10 Did he become faint ?
11 Did he complain of head ache or giddiness ?
12 Did he appear to have lost the use of his limbs ?
13 Did he sleep heavily ?
14 Was he at any time insensible ?
15 Did convulsions occur ?
16 Did he complain of any peculiar taste in his mouth ?
17 Did he notice any peculiar taste in his mouth ?
18 Was he sensible in the intervals between the convulsions ?
19 Did he complain of burning or ingling in the mouth and throat, or of numbness and
tingling in limbs ?
20 Was there vomiting ?
21 Was there purging ?
22 Was there pain in the stomach ?
23 Mention any other symptoms ?
24 Had the deceased ever suffered previously from a similar attack ?
25 How many other persons partook of the meal of food, or drink by which the deceased is
supposed to have been poisoned ?
26 How many were affected by it, and in what way ?
27 Did the deceased move from the place where the first symptoms were noticed; if so,
how far ?
742 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

(Signature
Dated . of officer
. 19 } conducting
the inquest)

(Signature of two or more Name


respectable inhabitants of the Rank
place present at the investigation)
A
B

FORM No. 25.39


POLICE DEPARTMENT _____________ DISTRICT

FORM TO ACCOMPANY BODY OF INJURED PERSON SENT FOR MEDICAL


EXAMINATION
1. Name of injured or deceased person, parentage, caste, residence and condition of life.
2. Sex and supposed age.
3. Report of Police Officer :-
(a) Description of any injuries or marks of violence received, wounds and bruises, position,
length and breadth.
(b) Brief report by despatching police officer stating the manner in which the injuries or death
is supposed to have been caused. If by poison, the poison suspected to have been used.
(c) Date and hour it was administered, and date and hour of commencement of symptoms, the
date and hour of death, and the nature and duration of treatment adopted by the police or
friends of the deceased.
4. Brief report and opinion in simple language dictated by the medical officer and followed by his
initials :-
(a) as to the means by which the injuries were caused.
(b) In the case of injuries, poisoning not causing death, the extent of the injuries or sickness,
and, in the latter case, the nature of the poison ascertained or suspected.
(c) In the case of death. - (1) whether death by violence is ascertained and cause of death and
(2) whether death is suspected from poisoning, the poison ascertained or suspected.

The following kinds of hurts only are designated as ‘grievous’ as stated in section 320,
Indian Penal Code :-
First Examasculation
Secondly Permanent privation of the sight of either eye.
Thirdly Permanent privation of the hearing of either ear.
Fourthly Privation of any member of joint..
Fifthly Destruction or permanent impairing of the powers of any member of
joint.
Sixthly Permanent disfiguration of the head or face.
Seventhly Fracture or dislocation of a bone or tooth
Eighthly Any hurt which endangers life or which causes the sufferer to be
during the space of twenty days, in severe bodily pain, or unable to
follow his ordinary pursuits...

Add the following on the back of Police Rule Form No. 25.39 - Injury Report Form :-
Investigation 743

FORM No. 25.44(viii)


INFORMATION REGARDING ANIMAL POISONING
POLICE DEPARTMENT _____________ DISTRICT _____________
F.I.R. No. __________ Dated _________ Section ________ Police Station _________
Points to be specially noted.

1. Class of animal (horse, buffalo or bullock etc.) 1


2. Age and general condition previous to poisoning. 2
3. The symptoms after the poison was given or be- 3
fore death.
4. How long after feeding the symptoms were in 4
coming on ?
5. What the prominent symptoms were ? 5
6. How long the animal lived after the symptoms 6
made their appearance ?
7. What poison was supposed to have been used ? 7
8. Appearance presented by the carcass after death. 8
9. Any other particulars likely to be of value. 9

Date _____________ 
 Officer-in-charge of Police Station
________________19 

FORM No. 25.48(4)


BILL FOR EXPENSES INCURRED IN MAINTAINING CATTLE DURING IN-
VESTIGATION
POLICE STATION ______________ DISTRICT
Bill No.
Case First Information Report No. _____________, dated _____________ 19
1 2 3 4 5
Date Name and Number and Full detail of cattle and the rate Amount
address of date of case of the amount to be paid
payee diary
Rs. nP.

(To be drawn by hand)


Total (in words) Rs. _____________
Station _______________________
Date _________________________
744 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 25

FORM No. 25.54(1)


CASE DIARY

POLICE STATION _________ DISTRICT


First Information Report No. of 19 Case Diary No.
Date and place of occurrence Time and date of receipt in Police Station.
Time and date of despatch from Police
Station
Offence :-
Date (with hour) on which action Serial No. of report Record of Investigation
was taken

CASE DIARY - CONTINUED

FORM No. 25.56(1)


CHARGE SHEET

District ___________ Charge Sheet No. ___________, dated _______ 19 __________,


Police Station ___________ in first information No. __________ dated _____________
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
NAME AND
ADDRESSES OF
ACCUSED
PERSONS SENT
FOR TRIAL
Name, ad- Name and In custody On bail or Property Names and Charge of
dress and oc- addresses of recognizance (including addresses information :-
cupation of accused persons weapons) found, of Name and
complainant not sent up for with particulars witnesses offence and
or informant trial, whether of where, when circumstances
arrested or not and by whom, connected with
arrested, found and it, in concise
including whether detail, and under
absconders, forwarded to what section of
(show Magistrate the law charged
absconders in red
ink)

A.M.
Despatched at P.M.
on _____________ 19

Signature of investigating officer


Investigation 745

FORM No. 25.57(2)


FINAL REPORT UNDER SECTION 173, CRIMINAL PROCEDURE CODE
District __________ Final report No. ________, dated _________ 19 _____________,
Police Station ________ in first information No. _____________ dated ________19 .
1. Name and address of complainant or informant.
2. Nature of charge or complaint.
3. Description of property stolen, if any.
4. Name and address of accused persons, if any.
5. If arrested, date and hour of arrest.
6. Date and hour of release and whether on bail or recognizance.
7. Property (including weapons) found, with particulars of
where, when and by whom, found and whether forwarded to
Magistrate.
8. Brief description of information or complaint, action taken by
police with result, and reasons for not proceeding further with in-
vestigation.

Despatched at A.M./P.M. on _____________ 19


Signature of investigating officer.
N.B. - The Magistrate should record his order on the back
746 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

CHAPTER 26
Arrest, Escape and Custody.
Rule 26.1

26.1. General power of arrest. - Section 54, Code of Criminal Procedure, authorizes
any police officer to arrest without a warrant any person who has been concerned in any
cognizable offence or against whom a reasonable complaint has been made, or credible
information has been received, or a reasonable suspicion exists, of his having been so con-
cerned. The authority given under this section to the police to arrest without a warrant is,
however, permissive and not obligatory. Whenever escape from justice or inconvenient
delay is likely to result from the police failing to arrest, they are bound to do so; but in no
other cases. The law allows a police officer to apply to a magistrate for a warrant or a
summons instead of making the arrest immediately, and this discretion shall be exercised
whenever possible and expedient.
The law also allows a police officer in any bailable case to take security under section
170 Criminal Procedure Code from an accused person to appear before a magistrate with-
out first arresting him.
Rule 26.2.

26.2. Power to defer arrest. - If the fact that suspicion rests upon a particular person
has been kept secret, and there is no risk of his absconding, the police shall defer making
the arrest until the investigation is sufficiently complete; but if any interference with the
liberty of the accused person is necessary to prevent him from absconding, and the facts
justify arrest, the police shall arrest him and shall not interfere with his liberty unless they
arrest him.
Rule 26.3.

26.3. Search of persons under arrest. - (1) All persons arrested by the police and not
admitted to bail shall, as soon after arrest as possible, be thoroughly searched; in the case
of female such search shall be conducted by a woman and shall in all cases be conducted
with due regard to decency.
An inventory of all articles taken into custody by the Police from such persons under
Section 51 of the Criminal Procedure Code shall be prepared in duplicate by the carbon
copying process and the carbon copy thereof shall be sent forthwith to a magistrate as re-
quired by section 523 of the said Code.
(2) Every prisoner in police custody shall be searched on first admission to and on every
occasion when he is re-admitted to a lock-up being taken anywhere beyond the precincts
of the police station. Sweepers, bhishtis and every other person other than a police officer
having access to a lock-up shall be searched before entering and on leaving. The search-
ing of women shall be done by a woman.
(3) Soldiers in police custody shall not be deprived of their shoulder titles, badges of
rank and medal ribbons but medals shall be taken into safe custody. Sikh prisoners shall
be permitted to retain their karas and Hindus their scared threads.
Rule 26.4.

26.4. Lock-ups. - (1) Outside every lock-up which is guarded by the police shall be dis-
played a notice showing, in English and Urdu the maximum number of prisoners which
the lock-up is authorised to accommodate. The authorised number shall never be ex-
ceeded; any excess shall be accommodated in a convenient building under an adequate
guard or transferred to the nearest available lock-up.
(2) The door of a lock-up shall not be opened except in the presence and by the direct
order of the officer commanding the guard, who shall take all possible precautions to pre-
vent a rush or escape. When the circumstances of the use of a particular lock-up are such
that prisoners are constantly being admitted or removed, special standing orders for the
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 747

safe conduct of the operation shall be framed by the Superintendent of Police and in-
cluded in the standing orders for the guard over such lock-up.
(3) When it is necessary to keep prisoners in a lock-up which is in an insecure state all
male prisoners, who would, under the provisions of rules 26.22 and 26.23, be liable to be
handcuffed under escort, shall be handcuffed while confined in such lock-up.
(4) Every under-trial prisoner in the lock-up unable to provide himself with sufficient
bedding shall be supplied with such beddings as may be necessary.
Ordinarily 1 blanket and 1 munj or bhabbar mat shall be issued to each prisoner in
the summer. In the winter 3 blankets shall be issued for each prisoner. For this
purpose a sufficient supply of blankets and munj or bhabbar mats shall be ob-
tained from the District magistrate and maintained for use in lock-ups. Blankets
and mats shall not be stored in lock-ups and issued when required.
Private bedding may be supplied by relatives or friends of the prisoner. All such
bedding shall be carefully examined by the Police Officer in charge who shall
return the same when the prisoner is released or remanded to judicial custody.
When private bedding is supplied, a report to this effect shall be entered in the
station daily diary.
Jail rules permit the use of beds and provide for special sanitary and bathing facilities
for A and B class convicts. Such facilities are not available in all Police Sta-
tions, but they should be provided for better class prisoners in Police custody so
far as is possible. Endeavours should be made to confine better class prisoners
in Police Stations which possess amenities of this kind and to segregate better
class from ordinary prisoners.’’
(5) An allowance for a sweeper and bhishti for each lock-up will be made by the Jail De-
partment.
Rule 26.5.

26.5. Warrants to be taken out when wanted persons abscond. - Permissive author-
ity is given to the police to arrest without warrant in certain cases, in order that they may
not be handicapped by having to obtain a magistrate’s warrant under Section 204, Code
of Criminal Procedure, when the arrest of a criminal or suspect who is present before them
is urgent. The law provides, however, no penalty for merely evading arrest by a police
officer, though it penalises resistance to, or escape from, such arrest. On the other hand
the law does provide a severe penalty or recalcitrance to an order in the form of a warrant
by a Court, entirely irrespective of the evidence of the guilt of the person against whom
the warrant is issued. For merely evading obedience to a warrant of arrest, a man is liable
to proclamation and the confiscation of his property and any one who harbours him, as de-
fined in section 52-A of the Indian Penal Code, can also be severely punished. Whenever,
therefore, a person is wanted, whose whereabouts are not immediately known, the notice
shall, before setting off in search of him, obtain a warrant of arrest from the Court having
jurisdiction. Unsuccessful search without such a warrant is merely waste of time. On the
other hand immediately it is found that, in spite of all reasonable effort, a warrant cannot
be executed, a proclamation order under section 87, Criminal Procedure Code, can be ob-
tained and, on proclamation being duly carried out, attachment under section 88, Criminal
Procedure Code, can immediately follow, and connivance by any person at the continued
absconding of the person proclaimed becomes punishable under section 216, Indian Penal
Code.
Note. - Under section 200, clause (aa), Code of Criminal Procedure read with section 204, Code
of Criminal Procedure, a police officer can obtain a warrant on a written complaint.
Rule 26.6.

26.6. Illness of persons under arrest. - When a person in police custody is suffering
from any illness or injury at the time of arrest, or becomes ill or sustained injury while in
such custody such a person shall be medically examined at the earliest opportunity so that
748 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

the nature and cause of the illness or injury may be ascertained and proper treatment
given.
Rule 26.7.

26.7. Identification of accused. - (1) Whenever there is doubt as to the correctness of


a statement made by an arrested person regarding his identity, residence or antecedents,
an attestation certificate in Form 26.7(1), shall at once be despatched to the officer-in-
charge of the police station in the jurisdiction of which such person claims to be resident;
such officer shall immediately make, or cause to be made, all necessary inquiries, and
shall ascertain if such person’s name is entered in the Village Conviction Register. The
certificate shall be returned completed with as little delay as possible and shall be attached
to the charge-sheet. This form of attestation certificate shall be used whether the person
arrested states he is a resident of the police station in which arrested, or of some other po-
lice station, and whether or not a search slip is despatched to the Finger Print Bureau.
(2) Detailed orders regarding the preparation of search slips and the finger print system
are published in the Police Finger Print Bureau Manual.
Rule 26.8.

26.8. Report of arrest. - (1) Under [Section 58 of the Code of Criminal Procedure,
1973]1, an officer in charge of a police station is required to report to the District Mag-
istrate, Sub-Divisional Magistrate, or such other Magistrate as the District Magistrate
may direct, all arrests without warrant made by himself or in his jurisdiction.
[(2) Reports of such arrests shall be made in Form Arrest/Court Surrender Form ap-
pended to chapter-XXI of Punjab Police Rules whether the person arrested has been
admitted to bail or not and may be sent by post. One copy of the same shall be submitted
to the District Crime Record Bureau of the District Concerned]2
Rule 26.9

26.9. Arrest on a telegram. - (1) In any case in which he has jurisdiction to arrest, a
police officer shall take action on a telegram from a police officer or magistrate requiring
him to arrest a person for a cognizable offence, but when such telegram is received from
a private person he shall not arrest unless the particulars given cover a cognizable offence
and afford reasonable suspicion that the person to be arrested is the offender.
(2) If a telegram is received by a police officer requesting him to arrest a person for an
offence which appears to such police officer to be non- cognizable he shall lay informa-
tion before a magistrate having jurisdiction with a view to the issue of a summons or
warrant.
If such magistrate declines to issue a summons or warrant the orders of the District Mag-
istrate shall be sought.
(3) A police officer who despatches a telegram to another police officer requesting him
to arrest a person without warrant shall be responsible that the information in his posses-
sion is sufficient to justify, and that the police officer addressed has jurisdiction to make
such arrest.
In all such telegrams sufficient particulars shall be given of the person to be arrested and
the offence of which he is accused.
Rule 26.10

3
[26.10. Co-operation with Police of Indian States. - (1) The procedure for securing

1. Substituted for "Section 62, Code of Criminal Procedure" vide Punjab Govt. Notification No.
G.S.R. 20 -/C.A.V./1861/S. 46/Amd. (23)/2003, dated 6.3.2003.
2. Substituted vide Punjab Govt. Notification No. G.S.R. 20 -/C.A.V./1861/S. 46/Amd. (23)/2003,
dated 6.3.2003.
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 749

the arrest and extradition of offenders in Indian States who are accused of having com-
mitted offences in British India is prescribed in Punjab Government Consolidated
Circular No. 20. The Indian Extradition Act XV of 1903 governs arrests and extradition
from British India to India States. Detailed instructions regarding the extradition of
criminals and foreign jurisdiction and the application of the Indian Extradiction Act are
contained in Chapter 16, Volume III, Rules and Orders of the High Court of Judicature
of Lahore.
(2) The powers of pursuit of offenders conferred by section 58, Criminal Procedure
Code do not cover pursuit into the territory of an Indian State; established custom and us-
age in respect of the relations between the British Government and such States, however,
permits such pursuit, and requires the authorities of the States concerned to render all pos-
sible assistance in investigating cases, following up offenders and effecting their
apprehension and detention pending the grant of extradition. Reciprocal arrangements
have, however, been made with Jammu-Kashmir, Patiala, Jind, Nabha, Kapurthala,
Faridkot, Malerkotla and Bikaner. Rules framed by the Governor-General in Council un-
der the Indian Extradition Act and stated in Foreign and Political Department Notification
No. 107-I, dated the 24th February, 1932, which appears as Appendix 26.10(2) of these
rules. Officers of the Punjab Police entering Indian State territory in pursuit of offenders,
or for purposes connected with an investigation, shall invariably inform the nearest police
or other official of the State and summon him to their assistance at the earliest possible
moment, and, pending the arrival of such assistance shall take only such action as is nec-
essary to prevent the escape of offenders or the removal of stolen property. Though the
right of pursuit is recognised by convention, no rights of search or arrest vest in police of-
ficers as such beyond the limits of British India. Searches for and arrests of persons and
searches for property must, therefore, be carried out by the State police having jurisdic-
tion, acting on the request of the police of British India.
(3) Section 54 seventhly, Criminal Procedure Code, and Rule 28 of the rules made under
section 39-A, Punjab Laws Act (IV of 1872), confer power upon police officers, village
headmen and village watchmen to arrest persons suspected of having committed extradi-
table offences in Indian States. These powers may be exercised upon information
received from any source including, the police of an Indian State. Persons so arrested
shall be taken before a qualified magistrate without delay with a view to steps being taken
for extradition.
(4) Searches for property may be conducted only in accordance with sections 165, 166
or 96, Code of Criminal Procedure. When the police of an Indian State require such a
search to be made in British India in connection with a case under their investigation, such
search can only be conducted if the information is such as to warrant the police of the Brit-
ish District concerned opening an investigation of an offence punishable under section
411, Indian Penal Code or any other extraditable cognizable offence or on the obtaining
by the police of the district of a search warrant under Section 96, Criminal Procedure
Code. Pending the receipt of such warrant the district police shall place a watch on the
house to be searched and take all other necessary steps to prevent the removal of the prop-
erty. State police shall not be permitted to take any such action independently of the
police of the district concerned.
(5) General Rules framed by the Punjab Government and the Durbars of certain Indian
States to secure co-operation between the police in adjoining jurisdictions are contained
in Appendix 26.10(5). In respect of matters not covered by those rules and the preceding
sub-rules, the principle that the police of Punjab districts have no jurisdiction in Indian
States and the police of such States have no jurisdiction in British Districts must be strictly

3. Rule 26.10 omitted by Haryana Vide Punjab Police Rules Volume 3 1977 Edition.
750 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

followed. The handing over of accused persons to the police not having such jurisdiction
is strictly prohibited. When it is essential for the purposes of an investigation that an ac-
cused person should be sent to any place for the purposes of investigation, he shall be
taken by the police who are legally entitled to his custody, and they shall be responsible
for him in every respect. The attendance of witnesses from one jurisdiction to an inves-
tigation in another cannot be enforced.
(6) All police officers shall at all times do all in their power to promote friendly relations
and a spirit of co-operation with the police of Indian States. In the absence of such rela-
tions the limitation of jurisdiction must inevitably have harmful effects on the control of
crime.
(7) Whenever the police of one jurisdiction demand assistance from the police of an-
other they shall cause an entry to be made in the dialy diary of the police station
concerned.
Rule 26.11

26.11. Cancelled.
Rule 26.12

1
[26.12. Communication with authorities outside India. - Should an occasion arise on
which a police officer desires to communicate with any authority outside India in re-
spect of the detection or apprehension of an offender he should report the facts to the
Deputy Inspector-General, Criminal Investigation Department.
Rule 26.13

26.13. Arrest of public servants. - Information of the intended arrest of a public ser-
vant shall, if possible, be given to such public servant’s immediate superior officer before
the arrest is made; otherwise information shall be given immediately after arrest.
Rule 26.14

26.14. Arrest of persons belonging to the Indian Army and instructions regarding
Military Criminal jurisdiction. - (1) On the arrest by the police of a person subject to
Military or Air Force law charged with the commission of an offence early intimation
shall be sent to the Officer Commanding the unit to which such person belongs.
(2) The general rules defining the procedure in the case of offences committed by per-
sons subject to the Army or the Indian Army Act (VIII) of 1911, which can equally be
tried by a court-martial or a criminal court, are contained in Appendix IX of the Regula-
tions for the Army in India. Extracts from this appendix are given in Appendix 26.14(2)
of these rules.
(3) The procedure governing the delivery of an offender to the Civil Power as laid down
in Regulations for the Army in India, is as follows :-
‘‘When a person subject to the Army Act commits an offence under conditions pre-
cluding trial by court-martial, or an offence of a grave nature, which could be
equally tried by a court-martial or a civil court, against the person or the property
of an individual unconnected with the army, his unit commander shall at once
inform the police and the nearest magistrate and under the orders of the brigade
commander the offender shall for an offence of the former class, and will ordi-
narily for an offence of the latter class, be handed over to the Civil Power for
trial. After a person, subject to the Army Act, accused of an offence such as is
referred to in proviso (a) to section 41 of the Army Act, has been handed over
to the Civil Power for trial, the competent authority (see Appendix IX, Part II)

1. Rules 26.12 to 26.32 Renumbered by Haryana as 26.10 to 26.30 Vide Punjab Police Rules 1934,
1977 Edition.
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 751

may instruct the Advocate General to apply to the High Court for the committal
or transfer of the case to the High Court under section 526-A of the Code of
Criminal Procedure, 1898. (Paragraph 227 Regulations for the Army in India).
Rule 26.15

26.15. Detention of sarwan or camel of a camel cadre. - Cases of detention by the po-
lice of a sarwan or of a camel belonging to a camel cadre shall be reported by the officer
in charge of the police station to the Commandant or nearest Indian Officer of the cadre
within 12 hours, the reason for such detention being given.
Rule 26.16

26.16. Arrest of deserters. - (1) Any police officer may, without an order from a mag-
istrate, arrest any person reasonably suspected of being a deserter from His Majesty’s
Army, Navy or Air Force.
(2) A European deserter shall, if possible, be arrested by a European police officer, oth-
erwise by a sufficient number of Indian Police Officers to discourage opposition.
(3) If a sufficient escort can be given and the deserter proceeds quietly he shall not be
handcuffed.
(4) Deserters shall not be taken unnecessarily through crowded streets, bazaars and thor-
oughfares.
(5) Upon arrest a European deserter shall be brought before a Justice of the Peace -
(Sections 154(1) and 190(35)(d) of Army Act and Section IX of Deserters from the Navy
Act 10 and 11 Vict., C. 62). An Indian deserter should be brought before the nearest Mag-
istrate or the nearest Military Commanding Officer when no Magistrate is readily
accessible. All deserters shall, as soon as possible after arrest, be handed over to military
custody.
(6) A register of deserters in English in Form 28.16(6) shall be maintained by the head
clerk in the office of each Superintendent of Police (See also Rule 22.54).
(7) Descriptive rolls of deserters shall, if necessary, be published in the Criminal Intel-
ligence Gazette in Form No. 26.16(7).
Rule 26.17

26.17. Arrests on warrants under Gambling Act. - Warrants issued under section 5,
Act III of 1867, shall be executed or if not executed, shall be retuned to the magistrate or
Superintendent who issued it, within a period of not more than 15 days from the date of
issue. The Magistrate or Superintendent will then cancel the warrant, but a fresh warrant
can be immediately applied for or issued, if necessary.
Rule 26.18

26.18. Arrests of civil prisoners. - Under the provisions of section 225-B, Indian Penal
Code, the police are bound to arrest a civil prisoner who offers any resistance or illegal
obstruction to his lawful apprehension, or who escapes or attempts to escape from lawful
custody when such resistance, obstruction, escape or attempt to escape is an offence.
Rule 26.18-A

26.18-A. Arrest of women. - (1) All arrests of women - whether without warrant or
with a warrant bailable or non-bailable - shall be carried out by police officers not below
the rank of assistant sub-inspector of police or, when no such officer can be made avail-
able, by a head constable in presence of responsible male relatives and village or town
officials. Such arrests shall be specially reported in the manner prescribed in police Rule
24.12 and, when the arrest has been made by an officer of rank lower than assistant sub-
inspector, the reason shall be clearly explained. Superintendents of Police shall forward
special reports as required by police Rule 24.15, and a copy shall be sent to the Deputy
Inspector-General of Police, Criminal Investigation Department, Punjab in those cases
only in which the women is not sent to judicial custody or released on bail immediately.
752 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

Where bail is admissible the woman should not be detained longer than is necessary for
the production of the bond or sureties. No applications for remand to police custody shall
be made without the special order of gazetted officer.
(2) No women in police custody shall be lodged even for a night in a police station ex-
cept in unavoidable circumstances. They shall be placed at once before a Magistrate for
remand to judicial custody, except where a remand to police custody is necessary and has
been obtained in accordance with (1) above. Women remanded to judicial custody shall
be immediately transferred to headquarters or properly equipped sub-divisional female
judicial lock-ups. All remands to judicial custody shall be reported immediately to the
District Magistrate. The gazetted officer supporting an application for remand to police
custody shall be responsible for the taking of necessary measures for the same and decent
custody of the prisoner. Where women in police custody have to be escorted about for the
purpose of investigation the officer-in- charge of the police party shall not be below the
rank of assistant sub- inspector; provided that, when no assistant sub-inspector is posted
to the police station concerned, a head constable may be placed in charge of the escort.
(3) Women attending police investigations and enquiries - as distinct from those under
arrest - shall on no account be detained in police stations or with the police any longer than
is necessary for the record of the information which they are willing to give. In no case
shall they remain with the police between sunset and sunrise. If it is necessary to take a
woman witness about the countryside for identification, etc., she shall be accompanied by
a responsible male relative or her zaildar, sufedposh, lambardar, mohalladar or other re-
spectable male neighbour. Gazetted officers hearing and passing orders, on such cases
shall take such steps as are necessary to ensure that the above orders are scrupulously ob-
served.
Rule 26.19

26.19. Arrest of drunken persons. - A drunken person may only be arrested by a po-
lice officer in a road, street or thoroughfare, in a town or notified area to which Act V of
1861 applies and only when such person is drunk within the view of the police officer and
behaves so as to cause obstruction, inconvenience, annoyance, risk, danger or damage to
residents and passengers.
Rule 26.19-A

26.19-A. Stoppage of trains at non-stop stations to arrest persons. - On receipt of


a requisition, in writing, from a magistrate or a police officer, not below gazetted rank a
train shall be stopped by a station master at a station at which it is not booked to stop, with
a view to effecting the arrest of a person or persons travelling by it. Such requests shall
be made only in special and urgent cases [Authority : Railway Board Letter No. 3334-T,
dated 29th July, 1932].
Rule 26.20

26.20. Transfer of arrested persons. - (1) If a police officer lawfully arrests a person,
without warrant, in a district in which the investigation, enquiry and trial cannot be held,
and the offence is non-bailable or such person cannot give bail, he shall take or send such
person before the District Magistrate or Ist Class Magistrate having jurisdiction over the
area and obtain an order for the transfer of the prisoner to the district in which the offence
was committed.
(2) No accused or convicted person shall be taken in custody from one district to another
or from one province to another, except under the written order or warrant of the magis-
trate or other lawful authority directing such transfer.
26.21. Bail and recognizance. - (1) When a person accused of a bailable offence can
give good and sufficient bail the police shall accept it unless the law requires such person
to be brought before the magistrate having jurisdiction.
(2) An officer in charge of a police station is empowered under Section 497(1), Code of
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 753

Criminal Procedure to release on bail a person accused of a non-bailable offence (not pun-
ishable with death or transportation for life) whom he has arrested or detained without
warrant. These powers are permissive and not obligatory and should be exercised with
caution. The police officer must satisfy himself that the release on bail is not likely un-
duly to prejudice the prosecution or to be followed by the absconding of a person prima
facie guilty.
(3) An officer in charge of a police station shall, in accordance with section 497(2),
Code of Criminal Procedure at any stage of an investigation release on bail or recogni-
zance a person accused of a non-bailable offence when it appears that there are no
reasonable grounds for believing that a non-bailable offence has been committed by him,
although sufficient grounds may exist for further investigation.
(4) Before any person is released on bail or recognizance due regard should be paid to
the provisions of sections 498 and 499, Code of Criminal Procedure.
(5) In every case of release on bail or recognizance, whether under section 169 or section
497, Code of Criminal Procedure, full reasons shall be recorded in a case diary, and the
police officer concerned shall preserve the bond [Form 26.21(5)] until it is discharged
either by the appearance of the accused person or by the order of a competent court.
(6) No police officer has power to re-arrest an accused person who has been released on
bail under section 497, Code of Criminal Procedure. When re- arrest is deemed neces-
sary, the police shall apply to a competent court for the cancellation of the bail bond and
the issue of a warrant in accordance with the provisions of section 497(5) Code of Crimi-
nal Procedure.
26.21-A. Classification of under-trial prisoners. - Under-trial prisoners are divided
into two classes based on previous standard of living. The classifying authority is the try-
ing court subject to the approval of the District Magistrate; but during the period before
a prisoner is brought before a competent court, discretion shall be exercised by the offi-
cer-in-charge of the Police Station concerned to classify him as either ‘better class’ or
‘ordinary’. Only those prisoners should be classified provisionally as ‘better class’ who
by social status, education or habit of life have been accustomed to a superior mode of liv-
ing. The fact, that the prisoner is to be tried for the commission of any particular class of
offence is not to be considered. The possession of a certain degree of literacy is in itself
not sufficient for ‘better class’ classification and no under-trial prisoner shall be so clas-
sified whose mode of living does not appear to the Police Officer concerned to have been
definitely superior to that of the ordinary run of the population, whether urban or rural.
Under- trial prisoners classified as ‘better class’ shall be given the diet on the same scale
as prescribed for A and B class convict prisoners in Rule 26.27(1).
Rule 26.22

1
[26.22. Conditions in which handcuffs to be used. - (1) Subject to the provisions of
sub-rule (2), a person who is to be escorted in Police custody, whether under police arrest
of on remand or under trial shall be handcuffed if there is material sufficiently stringent
to satisfy a reasonable mind that there is clear and present danger of escape by breaking
out of the police control and further that even by breaking out of the police control and
further that even by adding to the escort party or by adopting any other strategy he cannot
be kept under control :
Provided that no person shall be handcuffed -
If by reason of age or other infirmity he does not appear to be in health capable of
offering effective resistance;

1. Substituted vide Punjab Govt. Gazette LSP dated 31.8.1984.


754 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

(ii) in routine or merely for the convenience of the escort party;


(iii) on the vague surmises or general averments that he is a crook or desperado,
rowdy or maniac.
(2) The discretion to use handcuffs shall be exercised in a bona fide and judicious man-
ner and reasons for handcuffing shall be recorded in the Station Daily Diary and where
a person so handcuffed is produced in Court the escorting officer shall forthwith furnish
a copy of the reasons so recorded to the Presiding Officer of the Court.]
Rule 26.23

26.23. Conditions in which use of handcuffs may be dispensed with. - (1) Prisoners
shall not be handcuffed while confined in a lock-up except as provided in rule 26.4(3).
(2) The handcuffs of prisoners in court shall be removed only as provided in Rule
27.12(2).
(3) A prisoner who is charged only under Section 124-A or 153-A of the Indian Penal
Code shall not be handcuffed unless he is already undergoing sentence or the officer com-
manding the escort has definite reason for believing that such prisoner comes within the
category described in Rule 26.22(e) or (f).
Rule 26.24

26.24. Security of handcuffs. - When handcuffs are used, the senior officer present
shall be responsible that they fit properly and that the prisoner cannot get at the key.
Rule 26.25

26.25. Arrest of sick or wounded persons. - (1) If wounded, or seriously ill, and in
need of medical attendance, a person accused of a non-bailable offence, or unable to fur-
nish bail in a bailable offence, shall, if possible, be conveyed to the prison hospital at the
district headquarters or to a neighbouring dispensary.
(2) The police shall take measures to ensure his safe custody in hospital and the mag-
istrate having jurisdiction shall be asked to grant a remand, and, if necessary, to examine
such person.
(3) If such person cannot be moved without risk of his life, the magistrate having juris-
diction shall be asked to record his statement at the place where he is lying.
Rule 26.26

26.26. Production of accused before magistrate within 24 hours. - (1) The case of
an accused person sent in custody for trial shall be brought before the Court having juris-
diction as soon as possible after the arrival of the accused person at the station at which
the court sits.
(2) In no case shall an accused person arriving in custody on a close holiday, or after
the courts have risen, be placed in the police lock-up for more than 24 hours.
If the second day after arrival is a close holiday application for remand shall be made
immediately.
(3) If an accused person is in custody charged with an offence in which bail may be
taken by the police it shall be the duty of the police to facilitate any attempt to find bail
for such person.
Rule 26.27

26.27. Diet of accused persons. - (1) Officers in charge of police stations shall arrange
for the dieting of such accused persons arrested by the police as do not provide their own
diet. The sum expected on the diet of each individual shall not exceed the scale prescribed
from time to time by the local Government.
The police shall provide for dieting on, and from, the date of arrest to, and for, the date
on which the accused is placed in the magisterial lock-up.
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 755

Under-trial prisoners classified as ‘better class’ shall be given the diet on the same
scale as prescribed for A and B Class convict prisoners. Under-trial prisoners
classified as ‘ordinary’ shall be given diet on the same scale as prescribed for ‘C’
class convict prisoners. Under-trial prisoners in either class shall be allowed to
supplement this diet by private purchase through the Police authorities. The
dietary prescribed for A, B and C class convicts in jails is given in Appendix No.
26.27(1). It is recognised that all Police Stations may not be able to adhere
strictly to the dietary laid down, but efforts should be made to approximate to
it as nearly as possible. The cost should not exceed Rs. 0-8-6 per diem in the
case of vegetarians and Rs. 0-10-3 per diem in the case of meat-eaters.
When an under-trail prisoner in Police custody is being transferred from place to place,
his dietary in transit should be approximately of the same type as that laid down in Ap-
pendix No. 26.27(1) and the cost should not exceed annas 8 pies 6 or annas 10 pies 3.
(2) Diet money expended under this rule shall be recovered from the Judicial Depart-
ment in accordance with Rule 10.109 at the time of presenting the charge-sheet. If
expenditure is considerable owing to the number of persons arrested in a case, or owing
to remand in police custody being granted, intermediate applications for refund, sup-
ported by an explanation of the circumstances, may be made through the prosecuting
branch to the magistrate having jurisdiction in the case.
(3) All food brought for a prisoner by relatives or friends shall be made over to the police
station clerk or head constable in command of the guard and shall be examined for pro-
hibited or injurious articles. After such examination the food shall be given to the
prisoner by a police officer. The person bringing the food shall have no access to the pris-
oner.
(4) In the report in the station daily diary regarding the first admission of a prisoner to
lock-up, it shall be stated whether he is to be dieted at Government expense or by friends.
In the latter case the name of the person who undertakes responsibility for the prisoner’s
feeding shall be entered.
Rule 26.28

26.28. Interviews with prisoners. - (1) No person shall be allowed to communicate in


any way with a prisoner in a police lock-up without the permission of the officer-in-
charge of the police station (as defined in section 4(p), Criminal Procedure Code), or
written authority from a judicial or superior police officer.
(2) Authorized interviews shall take place in the presence and hearing of the police sen-
try and the interviewer shall stand sufficiently far from the bars of the lock-up to prevent
physical contact or the passage of prohibited articles between him and the prisoner.
When a lawyer wishes to consult and advise a prisoner confidentially as to the conduct of
his case, the prisoner may be removed from the lock-up and allowed to sit apart with his
lawyer, but within the precincts of the police station and in the sight of the sentry. At the
conclusion of such an interview the prisoner shall be searched as provided in sub-rule
26.3(2).
Rule 26.29

26.29. Orders to be hung up outside lock-ups. - A printed copy, in English and Urdu,
of Rules 26.3, 26.27 and 26.28 shall be hung up outside every police lock-up as a standing
order for sentries and for the information of the public.
Rule 26.30

26.30. Diet and expenses of witnesses. - The instructions regarding the advancing of
diet money and travelling expenses to witnesses contained in rule 27.28 shall be strictly
followed in all police stations.
Rule 26.31

26.31. Death in police custody. - (1) When any person dies while in the custody of the
756 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

police, the officer-in-charge of the guard, escort or police station, as the case may be, shall
make an immediate report of the fact to the nearest magistrate empowered to hold in-
quests (Section 176, Code of Criminal Procedure).
(2) For the purposes of this rule, a prisoner in a magisterial lock-up is considered to be
in the custody of the turn key and a prisoner in prison or prison camp in the custody of the
jailer.
Rule 26.32

26.32. Identification of suspects. - (1) The following rules shall be strictly observed
in confronting arrested suspects with the witnesses who claim to be able to identify them.
1
[(a) The suspects, who are to be subjected to an identification parade, shall be in-
formed about it at the time of their arrest to enable them to take necessary pre-
cautions by way of keeping their faces covered and a request shall be made to
the Magistrate to record a note in the remand papers regarding such precautions
having been taken by them so as to eliminate any subsequent objection by the
suspects that they had been shown to the witnesses before the identification pa-
rade was held. The proceedings shall be conducted by a Magistrate or, if no
Magistrate is available and the case is of great urgency then, by Sarpanch who
may summon one or two independent and literate, if possible, persons of reli-
able character, not interested in the case to assist him and to certify that the iden-
tification has been conducted under conditions precluding collusion. Such
proceedings shall not be conducted by a Police Officer. The Police Officer
concerned before inviting a Sarpanch to conduct the proceedings must ensure
that the Sarpanch is not biased or interested in or against the accused or suspect
and that he understands the rules of the proceedings. Every effort should be
made to secure the presence of a Magistrate and services of Sarpanch only se-
cured when absolutely necessary. In the absence of a Sarpanch, a Lambardar
may be invited to do the needful.]
(b) Arrangements shall be made, whether the proceedings are being held inside a jail
or elsewhere, to ensure that the identifying witnesses shall be kept separate from
each other and at such a distance from the place of identification as shall render
it impossible for them to see the suspects or any of the persons concerned in the
proceedings, until they are called up to make their identification.
(c) Identification shall be carried out as soon as possible after the arrest of the sus-
pects.
(d) The suspects shall be placed among other persons similarly dressed and of the
same religion and social status, in the proportion of 8 or 9 such persons to one
suspect. Each witness shall then be brought up separately to attempt his iden-
tification. Care shall be taken that the remaining witnesses are still kept out of
sight and hearing and that no opportunity is permitted for communications to
pass between witnesses who have been called up and those who have not. If it
is desired, through fear of revenge or for other adequate reasons, that witnesses
shall not be seen by the suspects, arrangements shall be made for the former,
when called up to stand behind a screen or be otherwise placed so that they can
see clearly without being seen.
2
[(e)The results of the tests shall be recorded by the Magistrate or other person con-
ducting the test in Form 26.32(1)(e) as each witness views the suspect. On con-
clusion, the Magistrate or the Sarpanch or the Lambardar and the witnesses, if
any, shall sign the form and certify that the test has been carried out correctly

1. Substituted vide correction slip No. 134 date 13.7.1961


2. Substituted vide correction slip No. 134 date 13.7.1961
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 757

and that no collusion between the police and witnesses or among the witnesses
themselves was possible. It is advisable that, whenever possible, an independent
and reliable person, un-connected with the Police, should be present throughout
the proceedings at the place where the witnesses are kept, and should be re-
quired to devote his attention to the prevention of collusion. It is important that
once the arrangements for the proceedings have been undertaken, no police of-
ficer whatsoever shall have any access whatever either to the suspects or to the
witnesses.]
(2) Proceedings of the nature described above are extra-judicial. It is not the duty of the
officer conducting them or of the independent witnesses to record statements or cross-ex-
amine either suspects or identifying witnesses, but they should be requested to question
the latter as to the circumstances in which they saw the suspect whom they claim to iden-
tify, and to record the answer in column 4 of the form. While every precaution shall be
taken to prevent collusion, the identifying witnesses must be given a fair chance, and con-
ditions must not be imposed, which would make it impossible for a person honestly
capable of making an identification to do so. In this connection attention is invited to
paragraph 814 of the Punjab Jail Manual, which strictly prohibits the alteration in any way
of the personal appearance of unconvicted prisoners, so as to make it difficult to recognise
them.
1
APPENDIX No. 26.10(2)
RULES FOR THE PURSUIT AND ARREST IN BRITISH INDIA OF PERSONS
ACCUSED OF OFFENCES COMMITTED IN INDIAN STATES.
Foreign and Political Department Notification No. 107-I, dated New Delhi, the 24th
February, 1932.
IN exercise of the powers conferred by section 22 of the Indian Extradition Act, 1903
(XV of 1903), and in suppression of the notification of the Government of India in the
Foreign and Political Department, No. 505-I, dated the 13the August, 1931, the Gover-
nor-General in Council is pleased to make the following rules to provide for the pursuit
and arrest in British India of persons accused of offences committed elsewhere :-
1. When a person accused of having committed in a State specified in the first schedule
hereto, an offence which, if committed in British India, would be punishable under a sec-
tion of the India Penal Code specified in the second schedule hereto, enters British India
with members of the police force of that State in pursuit, the pursuing party may, subject
to the provisions hereinafter contained, continue to pursuit into, and arrest the fugitive in
British India.
2. The authorisation conferred by rule (1) shall not be operative unless -
(a) the pursuing party includes at least one officer holding in the State police force
a rank not lower than the rank corresponding with that of a head constable of po-
lice in British India, and
(b) the circumstances are such that an application for the continuance of the pursuit
and the effecting of the arrest by the British Indian police would prejudice the
prospects of effecting the arrest of the fugitive.
3. If, when the pursuing party has continued the pursuit into British India under the
authority to clause (b) of rule 2, it becomes possible to communicate with the British In-
dian Police before the fugitive has been arrested and without prejudice to the prospects of
effecting his arrest, the pursing party shall forthwith communicate with the British Indian
Police.

1. Appendix 26.10(2) for Punjab only. Omitted by Haryana.


758 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

4. A person arrested by the State Police under the authority of these rules shall forthwith
be conveyed to the nearest place in which an officer of the British Indian Police is known
to be and shall be handed over to the British Indian Police in that place.
FIRST SCHEDULE
PART A.
States permanently included in the Schedule.
1. Hyderabad 2. Mysore.
3. Kashmir. 4. Gwalior.
5. Sikkim 5-A. Baroda.

Central India
6. Indore. 7. Bhopal.
8. Rewa. 9. Nagod.
10. Maihar. 11. Orchha.
12. Datia. 13. Samthar.
14. Panna. 15. Charkhari.
16. Ajaigarh. 17. Bijawar.
18. Baoni. 19. Chhatarpur.
20. Dewas Senior Branch. 21. Dewas Junior Branch.
22. Jaora. 23. Sitamau.
24. Sailana. 25. Rutlam.
25-A. Dhar. 25-B. Barwani.

Rajputana.
26. Alwar. 27. Bikaner.
28. Bharatpur. 29. Dholpur.
20. Kotah. 31. Jaipur.
32. Jodhpur. 33. Tonk.

Punjab
34. Patiala. 35. Jind.
36. Nabha. 37. Kapurthala.
38. Sirmoor. 39. Malerkotla.
40. Faridkot.

States of Western India.


41. Cutch. 42. Junagadh.
43. Nawanagar. 44. Bhavanagar.
45. Porbandar. 46. Dhrangadhra.
47. Palanpur. 48. Radhanpur.
49. Morvi. 50. Gondal.
51. Jafrabad. 52. Dharol.
53. Limbdi. 54. Wadhwan.
55. Lakhtar. 56. Vala.
57. Jasdan. 58. Manvadar.
59. Thana Devli. 60. Vadia.
61. Lathi. 62. Muli.
63. Virpur. 64. Malia.
65. Kotda-Sangani. 66. D.S. Vala Mula Suraj of Jetpur.
67. D.S. Vala Rawat Ram of Bilkha. 68.Patdi.
69. Tharad. 70. Wao.
71. M.S. Jorawarkhanji’s State Varahi. 72. Thana areas and the Civil Stations of
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 759

Wadhwan and Rajkot in the Western India


States Agency.

Madras.
73. Travancore.
74. Cochin.
75. Pudukottah.

Bombay.
76. Savantvadi.
77. Jath.
78. Savanur.
79. Cambay.
80. Janjira.
81. Kolhapur.
82. Mudhol.
83. Sangli.
84. Miraj (Senior).
85. Miraj (Junior).
86. Jamkhandi.
87. Kurundwad (Senior).
88. Kurundwad (Junior).
89. Ramdurg.
90. Idar.
91. Vijayanagar.
92. Danta.
93. Mansa.
94. Malpur.
95. Surgana.
96. Bhor.
97. Rajpipla.
98. Chhota Udepur.
99. Lunawada.
100. Sant.
101. Kadana.
102. Bhadarwa.
103. Sanjeli.
104. Jambughoda.
105. Aundh.
106. Phaltan.
107. Akalkot.
108. Khairpur.
109. Bansda.
110. Dharampur.
111. Jawhar.
112. Administered areas comprised in the
Thana Circles and Sadra Bazar.
113. Sankeda Mewas.
114. Pandu Mewas.

Bengal
115. Cooch Behar.
116. Tripura.
760 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

United Provinces.
117. Benaras.
118. Tehri.

Eastern State Agency :-


119. Athgarh.
120. Athmallik.
121. Bamra.
122. Baramba.
123. Bastar.
124. Baudh.
125. Bonai.
126. Changbhakar.
127. Chhuikhadan.
128. Despalla.
129. Dhenkanal.
130. Gangpur.
131. Hindol.
132. Jashpur.
133. Kalahandi.
134. Kanker.
135. Kawardha
136. Keonjhar.
137. Khairagarh.
138. Khandpara.
139. Kharsawan.
140. Korea.
141. Mayurbhanj.
142. Nandgaon.
143. Narsinghpur.
144. Nayagarh.
145. Nilgiri.
146. Pal-Lahara.
147. Patna.
148. Raigarh.
149. Rairakhol.
150. Ranpur.
151. Sakti.
152. Sarangarh.
153. Seraikela.
154. Sonepur.
155. Surguja.
156. Talcher.
157. Tigiria.
158. Udaipur.

Assam
158-A. Cooch Behar.
159-B. Tripura.
159. Nanipur.
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 761

Part B.
States included in the schedule for the period terminating on the
date specified against each.
State Date of termination

Baria Ist January

Ali-rajpur Ist October

SECOND SCHEDULE.
List of sections of the Indian Penal Code -
Sections 300, 302, 303, 304, 307, 308, 311, 382, 392, 393, 394, 395, 396, 397, 398, 399,
400, 401 and 402.
_________
1
APPENDIX No. 26.10(5)
RULES FOR SYSTEMATIZING CO-OPERATION BETWEEN THE BRITISH
POLICE AND THE POLICE OF THE JAMMU-KASHMIR, KAPURTHALA AND
MALERKOTLA STATES.
1. The office-in-charge of police stations of the Jammu Kashmir State and the above-
noted States and to British police stations bordering on the State shall pay periodical visits
to one another and exchanging information regarding crime and criminals, and afford
every assistance to parties pursuing offenders over the border.
2. The Jammu-Kashmir State and the above-noted States shall depute the Superinten-
dent of the State Police, or some other official engaged in the investigation of criminal
matters to meet the Superintendents of Police of adjoining British Districts on the border,
twice a year, to discuss arrangements for the prevention and detention of crime, and to
bring to notice any instances of neglect on the part of their subordinate police, to give
prompt and efficient assistance to the party requiring it. Should any serious fault be found
with any State Officer-in-charge of the police station or other official, the Superintendents
of Police shall address the State Vakil, if one exists, or the Political Secretary of the State.
3. With a view to keeping a check on their subordinates, the Superintendents of Police
of the British district, and the Superintendent of the State Police, or other officer ap-
pointed by the State, shall send intimation to one another direct of all cases in which the
subordinates of either party had occasion to call for assistance from the other.
4. Arrangements shall be made for watching the fords and ferries with a view to inter-
cepting cattle thieves and other criminals.
5. Lists of persons residing in the Jammu-Kashmir and above-noted States who are sus-
pected of committing offences in British territory shall be prepared by the British police,
and similar lists of British subjects suspected of depredating in the Jammu-Kashmir and
other above-noted territory shall be prepared by the State police.
6. In addition to the lists mentioned in 5 above lists of the names of persons of both sides
of the border, who are in the habit of demanding bhunga for the restoration of stolen prop-
erty shall be prepared.

1. Appendix 26.10(5) For Punjab only. Omitted by Haryana


762 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

7. The lists above referred to shall be revised at least once a year.


8. Every six months, lists of British subjects convicted in the Indian States shall be pub-
lished in the Police Gazette, these lists will be furnished by the Jammu-Kashmir State, and
other above-noted States and the Superintendent of Police of British districts concerned
shall similarly furnish the Indian States direct with lists of the subjects of such States who
have been convicted in British India.
9. Copies of the Punjab Police Gazette for every police station in the Jammu-Kashmir
and other above-noted States will be supplied by the Central Police Office, Punjab, direct
to the headquarters of such States.
10. Notices of proclaimed offenders and of other matters affecting the prevention and
detection of crime, which the State Officials desire to circulate, shall be sent direct to the
office of the Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, for publication in the Police Gazette.
11. The Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, and the Inspector-General of Po-
lice, Jammu and Kashmir State, shall meet once a year at such place as may be arranged
between them to discuss any difficulties experienced by the State in giving effect to the
system of co-operation above suggested, and to arrange any points of difference which
may arise between the British police and the police of the State.
Note. - Failure to co-operate on the part of the officials of Indian States should be brought to the
immediate notice of the District Magistrate, who will, when necessary, report the matter to
the Political Officer deputed to the State or to the Punjab Government, as the case may be.
RULES FOR SYSTEMATIZING CO-OPERATION BETWEEN THE BRITISH
POLICE AND THE POLICE OF THE THREE STATES OF PATIALA, NABHA
AND FARIDKOT.
Co-operation of Police.
1. The Sub-Inspectors of the Patiala, Nabha and Faridkot States and of the British po-
lice stations bordering on those States shall pay periodical visits to one another, and
exchange information regarding crime and criminals, and afford every assistance to par-
ties pursuing offenders over the border.
2. The Superintendents of Police of the three States and of the adjoining British districts
shall meet as may be arranged, at least twice a year, to discuss arrangements for the pre-
vention and detection of crime, and to bring to notice any instances of neglect on the part
of their subordinate police to give prompt and efficient assistance to the party requiring
it.
3. With a view to keeping a check on their subordinates, the Superintendents of Police
of the British districts and of the three States shall send intimation to one another direct
of all cases in which the subordinates of one party had occasion to call for assistance from
the other.
4. Arrangements shall be made in each territory for watching roads and railway stations
with a view to intercepting cattle thieves and other criminals.
5. Lists of persons residing in either British or State territory who (a) are suspected of
depredating in other territory, or (b) are in the habit of demanding ‘‘bhunga’’ for the res-
toration of stolen property, together with lists of witnesses against each offender, shall be
prepared by the police of the three States and of the adjoining British districts. These lists
should be supplemented by a brief summary of evidence against the persons entered
therein.
6. The lists referred to in rule 5 shall be sent once yearly before 1st November to the Su-
perintendents of the British districts direct by the heads of the Police Department of the
three States and to the Heads of the Police Department of the three States direct by the Su-
perintendents of Police of the British districts.
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 763

7. Every six months lists of British subjects convicted in the three States shall be pub-
lished in the Police Gazette. These lists will be furnished by the Heads of the Police
Departments of the three States, and the Superintendents of Police of adjoining British
districts shall similarly furnish the three States direct with lists of the State subjects who
have been convicted in British India.
8. Every effort shall be made by the police of each jurisdiction to secure the attendance
in the other jurisdictions of witnesses whose evidence is required in investigations in pro-
gress therein.
9. Copies of the Gazette for the use of every police station in the three States will be sup-
plied by the Central Police Office, Punjab, direct to the headquarters of the State.
10. Notices of offenders proclaimed for extraditable offences and other matters affect-
ing the prevention and determination of crime, which the State officials desire to circulate,
shall be sent direct to the Superintendents of Police of the British districts especially con-
cerned, and shall also be sent to the office of the Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, for
publication in the Police Gazette.
11. The Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, and the administrative officers
controlling the Police Departments of the three States shall, if any of them desire it, meet
once a year at such place, as may be arranged between them, to ascertain any difficulties
experienced by the three States in giving effect to the system of co-operation above pre-
scribed, and to endeavour to arrange any points of difference which may arise between the
British and the State police.
Co-operation of Magistrates.
12. A Ist class Magistrate deputed by the Deputy Commissioner of the district con-
cerned and a Ist class Magistrate deputed by the State concerned shall meet once a year
during the touring season at a place to the settled between them by direct correspondence
with a view to taking security from the persons named in the lists referred to in rule 5. The
Magistrate deputed by the Deputy Commissioner of the British district shall previously
issue orders to the sub-inspectors to bring before his court the persons accused in the State
lists and residing in British territory, together with the witnesses, and the State Magistrate
shall similarly procure the presence of persons named in the British list and residing in the
State, and after meeting each Magistrate shall within his own jurisdiction try such persons
with a view to taking security from them.
13. At these meetings the Magistrates will discuss any pending question and will decide
such as are within their powers.
___________
RULES FOR SYSTEMATIZING CO-OPERATION BETWEEN THE BRITISH
AND THE BAHAWALPUR STATE POLICE
Co-operation of Police.
1. The sub-inspectors of the Bahawalpur State and of the British police stations border-
ing on that State shall pay periodical visits to one another, and exchange information
regarding crime and criminals, and afford assistance to parties pursuing offences over the
borders.
2. The Superintendent of the State Police and the Superintendent of Police of the British
district shall meet on the border at least once a year to discuss arrangements for the pre-
vention and detection of crime and to bring to notice any instances of neglect on the part
of their subordinate police to give prompt and efficient assistance to the party requiring
it.
3. With a view to keeping a check on their subordinates, the Superintendents of Police
of the British districts and of three States shall send intimation to one another direct of all
764 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

cases in which the subordinates of one party had occasion to call for assistance from the
others.
4. Arrangements shall be made in each territory for watching the fords and ferries with
a view to intercepting cattle thieves and other criminal.
5. Every six months lists of British subjects convicted in the State shall be published in
the Police Gazette. These lists shall be furnished by the Bahawalpur State, and the Su-
perintendent of Police shall similarly furnish the State direct with the lists of the subjects
of the State who have been convicted in British India.
6. Every effort should be made by the police of each jurisdiction to secure the atten-
dance in the other jurisdiction of witnesses whose evidence is requisite in investigations
in progress therein.
7. Copies of the Gazette for every police station in the Bahawalpur State will be sup-
plied by the Central Police office direct to the headquarters of the State.
8. Notices of proclaimed offenders, and other matters affecting the prevention and de-
tention of crime which the State officials desire to circulate, shall be sent direct to the
Superintendents of Police of the British districts especially concerned, and shall also be
sent to the office of the Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, for publication in the Police
Gazette.
9. The Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, and the administrative officer con-
trolling the Police Department of the State shall, if either of them desires it, meet once a
year at such place as may be arranged between them to ascertain any difficulties experi-
enced by the State in giving effect to the system of co-operation above prescribed and to
endeavour to arrange any points of difference which may arise between the British police
and the police of the State.
10. On or before December 1st in each year the Superintendents of Police of Dera Ghazi
Khan and the Bahawalpur State shall send to the District Magistrate of Sukkur or the Up-
per Sind Frontier, as the case may be, a list of persons residing in Sind territory who are
accused of habitually committing crimes over the border or of taking or demanding
money for the restoration of property stolen over the border. With this list they shall send
a brief summary of the evidence against each person. The Superintendent of Police, Suk-
kur and Upper Sind Frontier, shall send similar lists and summaries by the same date to
the District Magistrate, Dera Ghazi Khan, and the Foreign Minister, Bahawalpur State.
11. The District Magistrates of the Sukkur, Upper Sind Frontier and Dera Ghazi Khan
and the Foreign Minister of Bahawalpur State shall every year, depute a first class Mag-
istrate to hold a court in February as near as possible to the border for the trial of the
persons so accused. Magistrates on the opposite sides of the border shall arrange to hold
their courts as near as possible to one another. Cases which cannot be otherwise disposed
of should be discussed at meetings between the Magistrates involved, but other cases
should be disposed of as promptly as possible by the Magistrate principally concerned.
12. The police on either side of the border shall be responsible for the production of any
accused persons or witnesses residing within their jurisdiction after due issue of warrants
or summons by the trying Magistrates.
13. The provisions of Rules 10 to 12 will also apply mutatis mutandis to the other Brit-
ish districts concerned and the Bahawalpur State.
__________________
RULES FOR SYSTEMATIZING CO-OPERATION BETWEEN THE BRITISH
POLICE AND THE POLICE OF THE KAPURTHALA AND MALERKOTLA
STATES.
1. The officers-in-charge of police stations of the Kapurthala and Melarkotla States and
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 765

of British police stations bordering in those States shall pay periodical visits to one an-
other and exchange information regarding crime and criminals, and afford every
assistance to parties pursing offenders over the border.
2. The Kapurthala and Malerkotla States shall depute the Superintendent of the State
Police, or some other official engaged in the administration of criminal matters, to meet
the Superintendents of Police of adjoining British districts on the border twice a year, to
discuss arrangements for the prevention and detection of crime, and to bring to notice any
instances of neglect on the part of their subordinate police, to give prompt and efficient
assistance to the party requiring it; and should any serious fault be found with any State
officer-in-charge of the police station or other official, the Superintendent of Police shall
address the State Vakil, through the Deputy Commissioner of the district.
3. With a view to keeping a check on their subordinates, the Superintendents of Police
of the British district, and the Superintendent of the State Police, or other officer ap-
pointed by the State, shall send intimation to one another direct of all cases in which the
subordinates of either party had occasion to call for assistance from the other.
4. Arrangements shall be made for watching the fords and ferries with a view to inter-
cepting cattle thieves and other criminals.
5. Lists of persons residing in the Kapurthala and Malerkotla States who are suspected
to committing offences in British territory shall be prepared by the British police, and
similar lists of British subjects suspected of depredating in the abovenoted States territory
shall be prepared by the State police.
6. In addition to the lists mentioned in 5 above, lists of the names of persons of both
sides of the border who are in the habit of demand bhunga for the restoration of stolen
property shall be prepared.
7. A special Magistrate and a special police officer shall be deputed from the British
district concerned, and from the State to make enquiries regarding the persons mentioned
in the lists alluded to in 5 and 6 above, with a view to their taking security from such per-
sons.
8. The lists above referred to shall be revised at least once a year, and every cold
weather the measures ordered in 7 shall be repeated.
9. Every six months list of British subjects convicted in the above-mentioned States
shall be published in the Police Gazette; these lists will be furnished by States, and the Su-
perintendent of Police shall similarly furnish the Indian States direct with lists of the
subjects of such States who have been convicted in British India.
10. Copies of the Police Gazette for every police station in the above-noted States will
be supplied by the Central Police direct to the headquarters of such States.
11. Notices of proclaimed offences and of other matters affecting the prevention and
detection of crime, which the State officials desire to circulate, shall be sent direct to the
office of the Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, for publication in the Police Gazette.
12. The Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Punjab, and the Foreign Minister of the
State shall meet once a year at such place as may be arranged between them to ascertain
any difficulties experienced by the State in giving effect to the system of co-operation
above suggested, and to endeavour to arrange any point of difference which may arise be-
tween the British Police and the police of State.
Note. - Failure to co-operate on the part of the officials of Indian States should be brought to the
immediate notice of the District Magistrate, who will, when necessary, report the matter to
the Political Officer to whom the State is, subordinate, or to the Punjab Government, as the
case may be.
766 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

APPENDIX No. 26.14(2).1


Extract from appendix ix to the regulations for the army in india.

PART I.
CIVIL OFFENCES COMMITTED BY PERSONS SUBJECT TO
MILITARY LAW.
1. The following are triable exclusively by civil court (except on active service, etc.) :-
Civil offences which a court-martial is debarred from trying under the provision of
the Army Act or Indian Army Act (of section 41, Army Act and 41, Indian
Army Act).
2. The following should preferably be tried by civil court (except on active service,
etc.):-
(a) Civil offences (which may also be military offences e.g., thefts, frauds) commit-
ted in conjunction with persons not subject to military law;
(b) Civil offences not suitable for trial by court-martial on account of the special na-
ture of the case (e.g. complicated frauds) or on account of difficult legal tech-
nicalities being involved; and
(c) Civil offences in which military interests are not directly involved (e.g., burglary
in a civil establishment).

PART II.
Initiation Oo Criminal Proceedings in Civil Courts.
1. Criminal proceedings against persons subject to military law may be initiated by :-
(a) the police on the compliant of a civilian or on arrest by them for a cognizable of-
fence :
(b) the military on reporting to the police or to a Magistrate that a civil offence has
been committed;
(c) a Magistrate taking cognizance suo motu or on the complaint of a private indi-
vidual.
In cases (a) and (c) the military may (i) decline to interfere with the course of the civil
law or (ii) claim the accused for trial or, if the offender is already in military custody, order
trial, by court-martial, if the accused is legally liable thereto.
In a case failing under (b), the military will not take any further action unless in their
opinion -
(a) the complaint is wrongly dismissed or the accused is wrongly discharged by the
civil court, or
(b) the accused is acquitted by the civil court but is liable on the same alleged, facts
to be tried for a purely military offence for which he could not have been tried
by the civil court.
In any of these cases it will be open to the military to bring the accused before a court-
martial.
During the investigation stage, the military may in suitable cases intervene, with the
concurrence of the police and magistrate and claim the accused for trial by court-martial.

1. Read Appendix No. 26.12(2) For Haryana.


Arrest, Escape and Custody. 767

See also Home Department Notification No. F.465-28, dated the 17th June, 1928, in
Part III below.
If the case is one that must or should be tried by civil court (vide Part I above), it should
be handed over to the civil power at the earliest possible stage.
2. Criminal proceedings against persons not subject to military law must be initiated in
accordance with the provisions of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1898, by report to the
police or complaint to a magistrate.
(The above instructions must not be interpreted as forbidding or discouraging that close
and personal co-operation between military and civil officials which is essential in mat-
ters involving the discipline and welfare of the Army).

PART III.
procedure in cases of civil offences committed by persons subject to
the Army Act.
Home Department Notification No. F. 102/35, dated the 12th March, 1935.
In exercise of the powers, conferred by sub-section (1) of section 549 of the Code of
Criminal Procedure, 1898 (Act V of 1898), and in supersession of the Notification of the
Government of India in the Home Department, No. F./465/28, dated the 27th June, 1928,
the Governor-General in Council is pleased to make the following rules as to cases in
which persons subject to military, naval or air force law shall be tried by a court to which
the said Code applies, or by a Court-Martial, namely :-
1. Where a person subject to a military, naval or air force law is brought before a Mag-
istrate and charged with an offence for which he is liable to be tried by a court-martial,
such Magistrate shall not proceed to try such person, or to issue orders for his case to be
referred to a Bench, or to inquire with a view to his commitment for trial by the Court of
Sessions or the High Court for any offence triable by such Court, unless -
(a) he is of opinion, for reasons to be recorded, that he should so proceed without be-
ing moved thereto by competent military, naval or air force authority, or
(b) he is moved thereto by such authority.
2. Before proceeding under clause (a) of rule 1 the Magistrate shall give notice to the
Commanding Officer of the accused and, until the expiry of a period of five days from the
date of the service of such notice he shall not -
(a) acquit or convict the accused under Sections 243, 245, 247 or 248 of the Code
of Criminal Procedure, 1898, (Act V of 1898), or hear him in his defence under
section 244 of the said Code; or
(b) frame in writing a charge against the accused under Section 254 of the said Code;
or
(c) make an order committing the accused for trial by the High Court or the Court
of Sessions under Section 213 or sub-section (1) of Section 446 of the said
Code; or
(d) issue orders under sub-section (1) of Section 445 of the said Code for the case to
be referred to a Bench.
3. Where within the period of five days mentioned in Rule 2, or at any time thereafter
before the Magistrate has done any act or issued any order referred to in that rule, the
Commanding Officer of the accused gives notice to the Magistrate that, in the opinion of
competent military, naval or air force authority as the case may be, the accused should be
tried by a court-martial the Magistrate shall stay proceedings and, if the accused is in his
control, shall deliver him with the statement prescribed by Section 549 of the said Code
to the authority specified in the said section.
768 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

4. Where a Magistrate has been moved by competent military, naval or air force author-
ity as the case may be, under clause (b) of Rule 1, and the Commanding Officer of the
accused subsequently gives notice to such Magistrate that in the opinion of such authority,
the accused should be tried by a court-martial, such Magistrate, if he has not before receiv-
ing such notice done any act or issued any order referred to in Rule 2 shall stay
proceedings and, if the accused is in his power or under his power or under his control,
shall in the like manner deliver him, with the statement prescribed in Section 549 of the
said Code to the authority specified in the said section.
5. Where an accused person, having been delivered by the Magistrate under Rule 3 or
4, is not tried by a court-martial for the offence of which he is accused, or other effectual
proceedings are not taken, or ordered to be taken, against him, the Magistrate shall report
the circumstances to the Local Government.
6. In these rules ‘‘competent military authority’’ means the Brigade Commander,
‘‘competent naval authority’’ means the Flag Officer Commanding, Royal Indian Navy,
and ‘‘competent Air Force in India’’.

PART IV.
Procedure in Cases of Civil Offences Committed by Persons Subject
to Indian Army Act.
1. An offence committed against the person or property of a civilian cannot as a rule be
tried by court-martial.
2. Offences under the Indian Army Act, Sections 27(d), 35(a), (b), 39(b), (d), 41 and
42, as well as most offences under Section 31, can be tried by a court-martial or a civil
court.
3. The procedure in a case where there is dual jurisdiction is laid down in the Indian
Army Act - sections 69 and 70; the prescribed military authority being the General Officer
Commanding-in-Chief, District, brigade or station commander.
If the offender is in Military/Civil custody the Unit Commander/Magistrate will take
steps to request the prescribed military authority to decide before which court proceedings
shall be instituted; but in those cases falling under the Indian Army Act, sections 41 and
42, in which death has resulted, the decision shall rest with the district commander or Gen-
eral Officer Commanding-in-Chief.
_____________________
1
APPENDIX No. 26.14(3)
PROCEDURE FOR DEALING WITH BRITISH SOLDIERS FOR CIVIL
OFFENCES
Circular Memorandum from the Adjutant-General in India to all Commands and
Burma District No. B.6802/2 (A.G.-8), dated Simla, the 1st August, 1930.
(Copies to all formations and units having British soldiers on their strength).
I AM directed to draw your attention to the position of British soldiers who, having been
convicted by a Civil Court for a civil offence, undergo their sentences in Civil Jails.
This matter has been under consideration at Army Headquarters, in view of the adverse
effect which the revised Civil Jail Classification Rules may have on the welfare of such
British personnel.

1. For Punjab only. Omitted by Haryana


Arrest, Escape and Custody. 769

The legal factors, which effect the possibility of such personnel undergoing in military
prisons imprisonment awarded by Civil Courts, are as follows :-
Although it is within the competence of a local Government, under section 541 of the
Code of Criminal Procedure, to declare a Military Prison a place where any person liable
to be imprisoned or committed to custody under the Code of Criminal Procedure shall be
confined, it is not possible under the Army Act for soldiers convicted by Civil Courts to
be legally received in a Military Prison constituted under section 132 of the Act for the
purpose of serving their sentences, as no power exists under section 70 of the Army Act
to make rules for carrying into effect sentences other than those awarded by Court- Mar-
tial. No Warrant of Committal similar to Form ‘C’ could, therefore, be prescribed.
In these circumstances amendment of the Army Act would be necessary before the re-
ception into a Military Prison of British personnel sentenced by a Civil Court could be
made legal under the Act.
The question at issue has been represented to the Home authorities in the past, but al-
teration of the existing law has always been opposed by them. It is not therefore proposed
to approach the Army Council at this juncture with a view to the necessary amendments
to the Army Act being carried out.
However, it is essential to safeguard British soldiers charged with civil offences, whose
discharge from the Army is not applied for, from the contaminating influence of civil
criminal associates while in jail. His Excellency the Commander-in-Chief therefore di-
rects that in all cases in which British soldiers are charged with civil offences the
following procedure shall be adopted.
On receipt of information from the civil authorities that a British soldier is charged with
a civil offence the Officer Commanding of the unit in which the man concerned is serving
will decide at once whether, in view of the character of the accused and of the crime com-
mitted, he will, if the accused is convicted apply for his discharge from the army under
King’s Regulations, paragraph 370(x).
If the Officer Commanding decides that discharges shall not be applied for, he will
claim the accused for trial by Court-Martial, unless such trial is barred by the provisions
of Army Act, section 41(5)(a) or is inadvisable, - vide Regulations for the Army in India,
Appendix IX, part I, paragraph 2(a) and (b).
When the Officer Commanding decides that, if convicted, the discharge of the accused
shall be applied for, he will allow the civil law to take its course and not claim the accused
for trial by Court-Martial.
Application for discharge will be submitted as soon as possible after the sentence passed
by the Civil Court has become absolute either by an appeal not being preferred within the
period allowed by law or by the appeal being dismissed.
Should the circumstances of a civil offence committed by a British soldier disclose the
fact that the crime was probably committed with the object of the accused obtaining his
discharge from the Army trial by Court-Martial will invariably be resorted to unless the
crime committed falls under the restrictions quoted above.
The adoption of the above procedure will ensure, as far as is legally possible, that sol-
diers, charged with civil offences whose discharge from the Army is not desired, will not
be subjected to the evil influences associated with life in a civil prison.
The attention of all officers empowered to confirm Courts-Martial is drawn to the im-
plication contained in paragraph 652(h) of King’s Regulations.
Although detention is lower in the scale of punishment than imprisonment, the work and
military training carried out by soldiers undergoing detention are of more professional
benefit to men returning to their Units than the harder but less technical programme laid
770 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

down for military prisoners sentenced to imprisonment. Therefore when a soldier


charged with a civil offence has been claimed from the Civil Authorities for trial by Court-
Martial, the desirability of commuting a sentence of imprisonment to one of detention
must be carefully considered.
Note. - The above instructions have been supplemented by A.H.Q. Letter No. B/21379 (A.G.-8),
dated the 22nd June, 1993, directing that the British soldier shall be left for trial by a Civil
Court, i.e., all such be claimed for trial by court-martial, unless the offence with which the
soldier is charged is one of those which a court-martial is not empowered to try, viz., treason,
murder, man-slaughter, treason-felony and rape.
APPENDIX No. 26.27(1)
SCALE OF DIET FIXED FOR A AND B AND BETTER CLASS UNDER-TRI-
ALS ACCUSTOMED TO THE WESTERN MODE OF LIVING [PUNJAB GOV-
ERNMENT LETTER NO. 14424 (H.-JAILS), DATED THE 23RD APRIL, 1930]
Name of article Quantity Remarks
Bread .. 8 chs.
Butter .. 1⁄2 ch.
Mutton .. 4 chs.
Potatoes .. 3 chs.
Onions .. 2 chs.,
Mixed condiments .. 1⁄4 ch.
Sugar .. 2 chs.
Cocaa .. 1⁄8 ch. (B) class prisoners will receive during
the summer one chattak of sugar in lieu
of 1⁄8 ch. of cocoa per diem)
Ghee .. 1⁄2 ch.
Tea .. 1⁄8 ch.
Milk .. 2 chs.
Rice .. 2 chs.,
Porridge .. 2 chs.,
Firewood .. 2 seers,
Fresh vegetable from the jail gardens .. 4 chs.
The above diet will be issued in 3 meals.
Scale of diet ‘A’ and ‘B’ and better class under-trials accustomed to the Eastern
mode of living
Name of article Quantity Remarks
Flour .. 10 chs.,
1
Dal .. 1 chs.,
41
Ghee .. 1 chs.,
2
Potatoes .. 2 chs.,
1
Salt .. chs.,
41
Condiments .. chs.,
4
Sugar .. 1 ch.,
Tea .. 1⁄8 ch.,
Vegetables .. 4 chs.,
Milk .. 6 chs. or Dahi 4 chs.,
Milk .. 2 chs. for tea,
Firewood .. 2 seers,
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 771

For meat-eaters. - The above diet will be issued, except that on five days of the week
4 chattacks of meat or 4 chattacks of fish or 4 eggs costing about 2 annas will be issued
in lieu of 6 chattacks of milk.
Note. - This diet will be spread over thee meals during each day.
Scale of diet for ‘C’ class and ordinary under-trials
Name of article Quantity Remarks

1
 Dal Urd 1 chs.,
4
1
Twice of week  Dal Masur ordinary 1 chs.,
4
1
 Dal Rawan Red 1 chs.,
4

1
Once a week Dal Gram 1 chs.,
4

 Wheat 8 chs. (labouring 10 chs.),


 Gram for parching 1 chs. (Labouring 2 chs.),
 Salt 1⁄
4 chs.,
Daily  Condimnets 1⁄
8 ch.,
 Vegetables 4 chs.,
 Sarson or Toria oil 1⁄
4 chs.,
 Wood 6 chs.,
 Gur (Labouring 1 chatack daily)

FORM No. 26.7(1)


CERTIFICATE REGARDING IDENTITY OF AN ACCUSED
From Police State ____________________, district ___________________ To Sub-
Inspector of Police Station ___________________, district ___________________
ACCUSED___________________________, son of___________________, caste
____________ age ___________________, description ___________________, resi-
dent of Mohalla ___________________, district, __________has to-day been arrested in
connection with first information report No. ___________________ under section
___________________. He gives his name and residence as noted above, and states that
he is known to ___________________ and ___________________ lambardars and re-
spectable men of the village. Kindly answer the questions written on reverse of this
certificate.
Dated __________________ Signature of Station House Officer
(REVERSE)
Questions No. Answers
1. Are his name,, address and residence as given by him, correct ?
2. Can the lambardars and respectable men identify the man of this name, address
and residence and do they give the same description as given by me on reverse ?
3. If already classed ‘‘P.R.’’ convict, the district serial No. of the ‘‘P.R.’’ slip
should be noted.
4. If he is not a ‘‘P.R.’’ convict, should he be recommended to be declared a
‘‘P.R.’’ or ‘‘P.R.T.’’ convict now ?
5. Give his previous convictions in detail, if any.
772 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 26

Reply
From Police State ___________________, district ___________________ To Sub- In-
spector of Police Station ___________________, district ___________________
The history of this man has been ascertained through ___________________ of
___________________ and your questions have been answered.
Dated ___________________ Signature of Station House Officer

FORM No. 26.8(2)


POLICE STATION (NAME) ________DISTRICT
REPORT OF ARREST
(Under Section 62 Criminal Procedure Code)
Has the honour to report that ___________________, son of ___________________,
caste ___________________, resident of ______________, has been apprehended (or
detained, as the case may be) this day at _________________________ o’clock, as he is
accused of ___________________.
Dated ___________________
The ___________________
Sub-Inspector
To be lithographed on a post-card.

FORM No. 26.16(6)1


POLICE DEPARTMENT ______________ DISTRICT
REGISTER OF DESERTERS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Serial Date of Name,, Residence Date of Reference Date of Name and Remarks
No. entry in parentage,, desertion to letter arrest Rank of showing
this register caste and and intimating officer action
description regiment information arresting taken to
of deserter or corps of regarding deserter secure
deserter deserter arrest

To be drawn by hand in an open foolscap size register maintained in the office of Su-
perintendent in English according to police stations. Vernacular counterpart to be
maintained in each police station.
FORM No. 26.16(7)2
DESCRIPTIVE ROLL OF A DESERTER
POLICE DEPARTMENT ___________________ DISTRICT

1. For Haryana Read Form No 26.14(4)


2. For Haryana Read Form No 26.14(5)
Arrest, Escape and Custody. 773

___________________ District Annual Serial No.


1. Name,

2. Father’s name.

3. Caste
 Village

4. Residence  Police Station


 District

5. Description.,

6. Regiment to which belonging

7. Date of desertion

8. Place of desertion.

9. Remarks.

FORM No. 26.21(5)1


BAIL BOND
(Vernacular form in terms of form XXV in schedule V, Criminal Procedure Code)
---------------
FORM No. 26.32(1)(e)2
POLICE DEPARTMENT __________ DISTRICT
Identification of suspects
Note. - Whenever it is necessary to submit any person suspected of having been concerned in any
offence for identification, particular care should be taken, pending the arrival of the identi-
fying witnesses to keep the suspect in some place where they cannot have access to him. On
their arrival the suspect should be placed with 8 to 9 men similarly dressed, and of the same
religion and status, and the identification carried out whenever possible in the presence of a
Magistrate or independent witnesses who should be asked to satisfy themselves that the iden-
tification has been conducted under conditions precluding the possibility of collusion. Care
must be taken that the identification by each witness is done out of sight and hearing of the
other identifying witnesses.
1 2 3 4 5 6
Date and place Name of Name of Description of Signature of Signature of Police
of identification witness suspects he manner in which Magistrate or other Officer in charge.
identifies the rule regulating witnesses in whose
such identifications presence the test is
were complied with carried out

1. For Haryana Read Form No 26.19(5)


2. For Haryana Read Form No 26.30(1)(e)
774 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

CHAPTER 27

Prosecution and Court Duties.


Rule 27.1.

27.1. Charge-sheets - preparation and scrutiny of. - (1)(i) When an accused person
is sent for trial the charge-sheet (form 25.56(1) shall form the final report required by Sec-
tion 173, Code of Criminal Procedure. Loose forms of charge sheets shall be kept at each
police station to enable investigating officers to prepare and submit them even when away
from their police stations.
(ii) In cases in which a charge sheet is submitted under sub-rule 1(i) above and in which
a copy of the first information report has been sent to a Panchayat as required by Police
Rule 24.5(2), (a) report shall also be sent to the Panchayat containing information on the
following points :-
(a) Whether or not an offence has been proved.
(b) Whether or not the offence proved is triable by the Panchayat.
(c) The Court in which, and the date on which, the charge sheet is to be presented.
(2) Except where it is necessary to present charge sheets before a magistrate on tour or
elsewhere than at the headquarters of a district or sub-division, they shall be submitted
through the Superintendent, Assistant Superintendent or Deputy Superintendent of Police
in-charge of the crime of the police station concerned.
(3) Charge sheets shall be thoroughly scrutinised by an officer of the prosecuting branch
not below the rank of prosecuting sub-inspector, who shall be responsible for seeing that
carbon copies of incomplete charge sheets together with the copies of orders passed by
Magistrates thereon and other necessary papers are attached; that the identity and pre-
vious convictions of the accused persons have been established; that in cases when an
accused person is on security and such security will be liable to confiscation in the event
of conviction, the fact is duly noted in the file so that the attention of the court may be
drawn to it; that witnesses are according to the list entered in the charge sheet; that the po-
lice file is complete and that no papers belonging to it are attached with the charge sheet,
and that no omissions or defects in the investigation remain unrectified or unexplained.
After completing his scrutiny as above, the officer of the prosecuting branch shall lay the
charge-sheet and files before the gazetted officer referred to in sub-rule (2) above, or, in
his absence, before such other available gazetted officer or senior non-gaztted officer as
the Superintendent of Police may have nominated for the purpose, and shall explain the
case to him, and take his orders as to whether it shall be put into court or withheld for fur-
ther police action. Such gazetted officer or senior non-gaztted officer shall satisfy
himself that the prosecution case is presented in the best possible manner that all material
evidence is produced, including evidence calculated to rebut probable lines of defence.
(4) The practice of requiring prosecution witnesses to appear at headquarters simulta-
neously with the chalan has received the approval of the local Government and of the
High Court (See Chapter 3-A, paragraph 5(10), of Volume IV of High Court Rules and
Orders). Before sending a charge-sheet to headquarters the investigating officer should
collect all witnesses, whom it has been decided to produce in court, and take personal re-
cognizances from them to appear on the same date as that on which the charge-sheet will
reach the court. The chalan should, however, reach headquarters not less than one day
before the date fixed for hearing of the case. It shall be the duty of the prosecuting branch
to facilitate the working of this system and the prompt disposal of police cases by arrang-
ing with magistrate that a special period be set apart daily for dealing with fresh chalans
and by giving magistrates as much warning as possible of the anticipated presentation of
a chalan [vide rule 25.51]. This period should be so fixed as to allow time for witnesses
to reach the police office and for chalans to be thoroughly checked and at the same time
to permit to all new police cases being taken up by Magistrates at such an hour that it may
Prosecution and Court Duties. 775

be possible for the bulk of the prosecution evidence to be recorded before the Court rises
for the day. When there are a large number of prosecution witnesses in a case, only the
more important ones, whose evidence is necessary to facilitate the early framing of
charges, shall be sent with the chalan.
(5) In all serious cases, when the accused has been arrested and prima facie evidence has
been produced, the investigating officer shall send the accused for trial without delay,
whether the investigation is complete or not. Witnesses should accompany such chalans
and the same arrangements for the prompt recording of evidence as laid down in sub-rule
(4) above should be observed. When available evidence has been recorded remands or
adjournments under section 167 or 344, Code of Criminal Procedure, shall be arranged as
may be necessary. Evidence obtained subsequently shall be produced before the Court
by subsidiary chalan.
Rule 27.2

1
[27.2 Charge Sheet Slip and Road Certificate - (1) With every charge sheet the fol-
lowing documents be sent :-
(a) A charge sheet ship in Form 27.2 (1)(a) ;
(b) A road certificate in Form 10.17; and
(c) In the case of charge sheets against members of Criminal Tribes who on convic-
tion are liable to be sent to the Reformatory Settlement, a report in Form 27.2(2).
(2) On the completion of the case in court, the charge sheet slip shall be filled in under
the order of the Criminal Court trying the case and returned to the office of the Senior Su-
perintendent of Police. The result of the case shall then be entered in the General Crime
Register and the English Register of Cognizable Offences and communicated to the Po-
lice Station concerned. One carbon copy of the charge sheet slip in Form 27.2 (1)(a) shall
be submitted to the District Crime Record Bureau of the concerned District Headquarter
for record by the Prosecution Branch concerned.
(3) A list of any weapons, articles or property sent to the Magistrate’s court in connec-
tion with the case shall be entered into the Road Certificate. If such articles are received
correct the Deputy District Attorney or Assistant District Attorney shall sign a receipt for
them on the Road Certificate and return it to the Police Station.
(4) For Form No. 27.2(1)(a) the following form shall be substituted, namely :-
"Court Disposal Form" - Annexure VI]
27.3. Duties of Public Prosecutors. - (1) Government Pleaders, who are ex- officio
Public Prosecutors, are bound by the rules contained in Part I, Section II, Law Department
Manual. They may not appear or advise against the Crown in criminal cases. They are
allowed to undertake private civil practice, but are under the direct orders and supervision
of District Magistrates and may be appointed to work continuously at any particular case.
They are required to appear for the Crown in :-
(a) All Sessions cases.
(b) All section 30 cases at headquarters and, when required by the District Magis-
trate, at out-stations.
(c) All commitment cases where his appearance is necessary at headquarters, and at
out-stations when required by the District Magistrate.
(d) All criminal appeals when required by the District Magistrate or Sessions Judge.
(e) All original cases when required by the District Magistrate.

1. Substituted vide Punjab Govt. Notification No. G.S.R. 20 -/C.A.V./1861/S. 46/Amd. (23)/2003,
dated 6.3.2003.
776 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

(2) It is part of the duty of Public Prosecutors to give advice to Government officers on
legal questions. A scale of fees for consultation is authorized, but the payment of such
fees should only be recommended where an opinion has been obtained on a matter of es-
pecial complexity (Law Department Manual, Section I, Chapter I, paragraph XV).
Rule 27.4

27.4. Police Officers as Public Prosecutors. - (1) All Superintendents, Assistant and
Deputy Superintendents of Police are, with reference to Sections 270 and 492 of the Code
of Criminal procedure ex-efficio public prosecutors in respect of all cases committed from
their respective districts for trial before the court of Sessions. Where no Government
Pleader (Public Prosecutor) has been appointed, or when the services of the Government
Pleader are not available, one of the police officers above-mentioned may conduct the
prosecution sessions trials, but the District Magistrate has power in such circumstances to
appoint any other person to be public prosecutor for the purpose of a particular case.
(2) Prosecuting inspectors and prosecuting sub-inspectors of police are appointed pub-
lic prosecutors in the local areas specified in the list below for all cases which may be
enquired into or be tried by a magistrate including a magistrate having powers under Sec-
tion 30 of the Code of Criminal Procedure.
Officers. Local areas.
Every prosecuting inspector of police. The district in which the prosecuting inspector is
stationed.

Every prosecuting sub-inspector of police stationed The district at the headquarters of which the
at the headquarters of a district. prosecuting sub- inspector is stationed.

Every prosecuting sub-inspector of police station at The sub-division at the headquarters of which the
the headquarters of a sub-division. prosecuting sub-inspector is stationed.

(3) When the complainant in a criminal case instructs a legal practitioner to conduct the
prosecution, such practitioner shall act under the instructions of the Public Prosecutor as
defined in the above sub-rules and rule 27.3.
Rule 27.5

27.5. Security to be given by prosecuting staff. - Each prosecuting inspector and sub-
inspector shall furnish security of no less value than Rs. 500. Security shall be furnished
in any of the ways permitted for accountants in Rule 10.7(2).
Rule 27.6

27.6. Prosecution of railway cases. - The district police prosecuting staff shall render
every assistance which may be required of them in the performance of court duties in con-
nection with the prosecution of railway cases, and shall take all necessary measures to
promote the efficient prosecution and expeditious disposal of such cases in the courts.
Rule 27.7

27.7. Prosecution of cases under section 110, Code of Criminal Procedure. - (1)
Prosecutions under section 110, Code of Criminal Procedure, shall, as far as possible, be
arranged to take place before a Magistrate in camp in the neighbourhood frequented by
the persons so prosecuted.
(2) Proceedings of cases under section 110, Code of Criminal Procedure, against
zaildars, lambardars and inamdars require the special order of the District Magistrate
(Rule 19, Chapter 3 Volume III of Rules and Orders of the High Court of Judicature at La-
hore).
Rule 27.8

27.8. Action on breach of terms of security bond or conditions of restriction. - (1)


Whenever a person on security of any kind is prosecuted for an offence implying a breach
of the terms of his bond, special application shall be made, at the time of presentation of
Prosecution and Court Duties. 777

the charge-sheet that the court may, in the event of conviction, order the confiscation of
the security.
(2) When a person violates the conditions of an order passed against him under the Ha-
bitual Offenders Act, or violates any rule made under the Act, he shall be prosecuted
under Section 17 of the Act.
(3) It is the duty of the prosecuting branch to watch the progress of realisation of for-
feited security. When the head of the branch finds that, either generally in the district or
in a particular case, undue delay or laxity in realisations is taking place, he shall bring the
matter to the notice of the Superintendent, in order that the attention of the District Mag-
istrate may be invited to it.
Rule 27.9

27.9. Police Brief. - (1) In all important cases sent for trial, the investigating officer
shall, whenever possible, attend and personally instruct the prosecuting inspector or pub-
lic prosecutor. In such case he will also prepare a ‘‘Police Brief’’ in Form 27.9(1) and
shall mention therein all matters connected with the case including the probable line of the
defence, which in his opinion, should be specially brought to the notice of the prosecutor.
(2) In unimportant simple cases no ‘‘Police Brief’’ need be prepared.
(3) In cases of more than usual importance gazetted officers are required to prepare
‘‘Police Briefs’’ themselves.
Rule 27.10

27.10. Proof of previous convictions. - (1) Previous convictions shall be proved as laid
down in section 511, Code of Criminal Procedure.
(2) Requisitions for particulars of previous convictions when required by the police
shall be made in Form 27.10(2).
(3) It is the duty of the police, in conducting the investigation, to take proper steps to es-
tablish the identity of an accused person and to obtain and produce evidence of previous
convictions against him (High Court Rules and Orders, Volume III Chapter 23-B, Para-
graph 9).
The duties of the Magistrate and of the police in this matter are given in the decision of
the Chief Court in the case, Empress versus Sham Singh, reported as criminal judgment
No. 36 in the Punjab Record of 1884 and especially in the remarks of Mr. Justice Plowden
at page 70 of the record. Requisitions for particulars of previous convictions should
therefore be made early during the investigation, but if there be sufficient grounds, prose-
cuting officers may apply to the magistrate for a remand under section 344, Criminal
Procedure Code, so as to produce evidence of previous convictions.
Rule 27.11

27.11. Appeal and access to judicial records. - (1) Application for the representation
of the Crown in criminal cases, for the institution of appeals against orders of acquittal or
for the exercise of its powers of revision by the High Court, shall be made through the Dis-
trict Magistrate. Rules framed by Government in this respect are given in Law
Department Manual, Part I, paragraph IX(6).
(2) As regards revision of orders of discharge, application shall be made to the District
Magistrate under section 437, Code of Criminal Procedure.
(3) Under the standing order of the High Court, Superintendents of Police are entitled
to peruse the judicial record in all cases where a police officer is convicted or, though ac-
quitted, is left under suspicion or censured. The object of this is to enable departmental
action to be taken where necessary. Copies of judgments, and translations of the same
where necessary, in such cases, will be supplied free of charge.
The Inspector-General of Police or any Deputy Inspector-General may, on giving rea-
778 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

sons, call for the record of any decided case, in which the police are affected. Unless there
are grave reasons to the contrary, in which case the Sessions Judge will decide the point,
the request will be complied with. The Inspector-General of Police has a right to call for
the records in all cases of professional crime.
Courts are required to send to the Inspector-General of Police for record copies of such
confessions as may be of value of the police.
All modifications of original decisions made in appeal, revision or reference are re-
quired to be communicated by the District Magistrate to the prosecuting branch of the
office of Superintendent of Police. (Rule 3, Chapter 11-E, of Volume III, HIgh Court
Rules and Orders).
Copies of judgments and depositions required by police officers in the course of their
duties are exempted from the charges authorized under the Court Fees Act, but not from
copying fees. Gazetted officers and all prosecuting inspectors and prosecuting sub-in-
spectors, within the limits of their jurisdiction as public prosecutors (rule 27.4) can obtain,
free of all charges copies of any part of the record of a case which they may require in their
capacity as public prosecutor, the cost being met by District Magistrates or the courts con-
cerned.
With the exceptions noted above, police officers are not entitled either to have original
judicial records handed over to them for perusal or to obtain copies free of charge. On the
frequent occasions when it is necessary for a Superintendent of Police, in the discharge
of his duties, to study the evidence and decisions recorded at a trial, the proper channel for
obtaining access to such records is through the authority of the District Magistrate. The
latter is head of the prosecuting agency, of which the Superintendent of Police is in direct
charge, and that agency requires constant access to judicial records, in order to fulfil its
duty of assisting the District Magistrate through the Superintendent of Police, to keep in
close touch with the work of magistrates’ courts and the results of cases.
When a perusal of the original record will suffice, copies should be dispensed with, as
fees for them have to be paid in every case, whether from police or judicial funds. It is
the practice of the High Court to print the proceedings in all cases in which the death sen-
tence is inflicted, and it is sometimes possible in such cases to obtain spare copies of the
printed records on application, through the Deputy Inspector-General of Police, Criminal
Investigation Department, to the Registrar of High Court.
Rule 27.12

27.12. Maintenance of order and watch over prisoners in court. - (1) On every day
when the courts are sitting, a sufficient number of police shall be provided in the precincts
of the courts to guard prisoners, take into custody persons who surrender to their bail,
whose bail bonds are cancelled, or who may otherwise be arrested by the order of a Court,
and to preserve order in and in the neighbourhood of courts. The guard in court shall be
strengthened, when prisoners are of a desperate and dangerous character, or when a case
is being heard which is likely to cause public excitement or demonstrations.
(2) All prisoners under arrest shall invariably be thoroughly searched before being taken
into court, the police officer-in-command of the party furnishing guards for prisoners
shall be personally responsible that this is done. If, in accordance with the rule 26.23,
prisoners have been brought to the court in handcuffs, the handcuffs shall not be removed
in court unless this is specially ordered by the presiding officer.
Rule 27.13

27.13. Compounding of cases under Section 420, Indian Penal Code. - Under orders
contained in letter No. 1336 (H.-Judl.) of 12th January, 1927, from the Home Secretary
to Government, Punjab, the Provincial Government has directed that sanction to compro-
mise in cases under section 420, Indian Penal Code, should be resisted, where habitual
cheats and professional swindlers are concerned, and also in all cases which show features
Prosecution and Court Duties. 779

of danger to a wider public than the complaint in the individual case before the court. A
case coming into the latter category would be one in which the method by which the crime
has been committed is or is likely to be widely employed.
Rule 27.14

27.14. Prosecuting Agency - Composition of. - (1) The police prosecuting agency in
each district shall consist of such number of gazetted officers, upper and lower subordi-
nates as may, from time to time, be sanctioned by the local Government and the
Inspector-General of Police.
(2) A constable shall be attached as court orderly to the court of every magistrate,
whether stipendiary or honorary, having first class or superior powers. The senior offi-
cers of the prosecuting branch shall arrange for the duty of court orderly in courts or
benches of honorary magistrates, which sit only for short periods or at irregular intervals,
to be performed by members of their staff, who may be available at the time required.
Clerks or assistant clerks of police stations may be employed, when necessary, to perform
the duties of court orderly at tehsil courts.
(3) In each district one of the head constables of the prosecuting staff shall be appointed
as the direct assistant of the prosecuting inspector for the purpose of maintaining the reg-
isters of case property, prescribed in rule 27.16 and, under the immediate supervisions of
the prosecuting inspector or a prosecuting sub-inspector, nominated by him, receiving,
checking, cataloguing and issuing to court orderlies, exhibits and other property kept in
the prosecuting agency’s store-room in connection with cases and unclaimed property.
The duties of this head constable are purely subordinate and his assistance in a routine ca-
pacity in no degree relieves the prosecuting inspector and the prosecuting sub-inspectors
of their personal responsibility, as laid down in Rule 27.18 for the correctness and security
of the contents of the malkhana.
Rule 27.15

27.15. Duties of head of prosecuting agency. - The duties of the head of the police
prosecuting agency whether he be of the rank of Deputy Superintendent of Police or In-
spector shall be as follows :-
(i) Thoroughly to scrutinise chalans and intermediate references and applications
from police stations in connection with the prosecution of cases, the arrest of of-
fenders, the confiscation of bail of security bonds, and other matters in which his
advice or the orders of a court are required. The prosecution for court and prose-
cution of all security cases, including security for keeping the peace (vide Rule
23.32), should receive as much attention from the district prosecuting staff as is
practicable.
(ii) To prosecute, watch or direct the prosecution of cases in the courts of the district.
In this connection it must be realised that his duty embraces not only the pres-
entation of the prosecution case but contesting the claims of the defence
and ensuring the observance of conditions and restrictions imposed by the law on the
discretion of courts to pass orders in certain circumstances, and the observance of all High
Court orders issued with the object of expediting decisions and preventing abuses.
(iii) To supervise and distribute the work of prosecuting officers subordinate to him
and of the police personnel attached to his office or to the courts.
(iv) To take charge of and deal with, articles and property received in connection
with cases, as well as of unclaimed and suspicious property received from police
stations for orders of magistrates.
(v) To supervise the transmission of warrants and summons to the executive police
under the orders of the criminal courts, and to see that returns to such processes
are made without delay.
(vi) To keep the District Magistrate and the Superintendent of Police informed of all
important matters in connection with criminal cases under trial, to bring to no-
780 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

tice cases requiring to be specially reported to him, and to submit a daily diary
in Form 27.15(vi) showing cases sent for trial, convicted, discharged and pend-
ing in court on that particular day. The instructions of the High Court as to the
duties of the prosecuting agency towards the District Magistrate are contained
in Appendix 27.15(vi).
(vii) To see that the instructions in connection with the diet money and travelling ex-
penses of witnesses are duly observed.
(viii) To see that payments for bills submitted through him for all judicial expenses
incurred by officers-in-charge of police stations are made promptly, either by
the Nazir or from his own permanent advance. For this purpose he will main-
tain a register in Form 27.15(Viii). For all sums of money received from the
Nazir a receipt must be given in form 10.14(1).
Note. - One combined receipt for all sums received from the Nazir on any one day may be given.
(ix) To see that the results of cases in court are promptly communicated to police sta-
tions concerned according to rule, and especially to bring to the notice of the Su-
perintendent, together with an abstract or copy of the judgment if necessary,
orders of acquittal or discharge or other orders of courts, which either reflect in
any way on the conduct of the police or indicate that the theory on which the
case was prosecuted has broken down.
(x) To keep in view the orders regarding the formation of a criminal museum at the
Police Training School, Phillaur, and to take the orders of the Superintendent for
the acquisition of such weapons, instruments or other articles connected with
cases sent up for trial as may be considered useful as exhibits of educational
value, and to forward them with a brief account of their use or object to the Prin-
cipal, Police Training School, Phillaur.
(xi) To supervise the work of the Vernacular office of the Superintendent of Police
and to exercise a close and constant check on the maintenance of the registers
pertaining to the prosecution branch. In these respects the prosecuting Deputy
Superintendent or inspector is directly responsible as assistant to the Superin-
tendent of Police.
(xii) In the execution of these functions, the head of the prosecuting agency may dis-
tribute work and delegate his duties among and to prosecuting inspectors and
sub-inspectors subordinate to him, to such extent as may be approved by the
Superintendent of Police as is not inconsistent with any Police Rule or other or-
der of a competent authority.
Rule 27.16

27.16. Registers to be maintained by prosecuting Deputy Superintendent or In-


spector. - The head of the police prosecuting agency shall, with the help of his assistants,
maintain the following registers :-
(1) Register of case property and unclaimed property in Form 27.16(1). This reg-
ister may be destroyed three years after being completed.
(a) This register shall be in the same form as register No. 1, and shall contain
copies of any entries in register No. 1 referring to property which has been
in the custody of the police for over three years. Property in cases in which
the accused are absconding, and the retention of which is necessary for pur-
poses of evidence, may be transferred to this register as soon as proceed-
ings under section 512, Code of Criminal Procedure, are complete.
This register is a permanent record.
(2) Register of issue from and return to the prosecuting agency’s store-room of case
property daily produced in courts and pending cases, - vide Rule 27.18(1).
(3) Register of warrants of commitment of jail, and of orders for the reception of lu-
natics into asylums, in Form 27.16(3).
Prosecution and Court Duties. 781

(a) Register of receipt and despatch of undertrial prisoners in Form


27.16(3)(A).
This register may be destroyed ten years after being completed.
(4) Register of warrants and summonses received for execution and service by the
police in Form 27.16(4).
This register may be destroyed two years after being completed.
(5) Register of intermediate orders in Form 27.16(5).
This register may be destroyed two years after being completed.
(6) Register of reasons on security under the provisions of the Code of Criminal Pro-
cedure, or local and special Laws, in Form 27.16(6).
This register shall be divided into separate parts from each police station in the dis-
trict.
At the end of each year the names of those persons remaining on security shall be re-
written in the order in which their securities are timed to expire.
(7) Register of exercise cases occurring during the year in which police officers have
been directly concerned, in Form 27.16(7).
(8) Permanent advance account of all judicial expenses in Form 10.52(b).
This register may be destroyed three years after being completed.
(9) Register of absconders, in English in Form 23.20(1).
(10) Register showing progress of action against absconders in Form 23.21.
(11) Register of proclaimed offenders who are members of criminal tribes in Form
22.54(b).
This register shall contain the names of all members of criminal tribes who have
been proclaimed under section 87, Code of Criminal Procedure, for offences
against the Criminal Tribes Act.
Rule 27.17

27.17. Duties in connection with property. - (1) At headquarters the head of the
prosecuting agency, with the assistance of his staff, shall take charge of weapons, articles
and property connected with cases sent for trial and shall be responsible for their safe cus-
tody until the case is decided. When final orders are passed in the case, such weapons,
articles and property shall, if not made over to the owner, be made over to the sheriff.
(2) The head of the prosecuting agency shall similarly take charge of, and be responsible
for the safe custody of, suspicious property until the issue of the proclamation under Sec-
tion 523, Code of Criminal Procedure, when such property shall be made over to the
sheriff.
(3) Unclaimed property sent in by the police shall be made over to the sheriff as soon
after arrival as possible and a receipt thereof taken in register No. 1 [rule 27.16(1)].
(4) Property connected with a case in which the accused is at large and has been pro-
claimed shall, if likely to be of material advantage to the prosecution, be kept by the head
of the prosecuting agency in a strong box in his store-room. If such property, excepting
valuables, is too large to be kept in the strong box it may be kept on separate racks. If, af-
ter 50 years, the case still remains undecided the property shall be made over to the sheriff
for disposal.
When there are claimants to the property who would suffer hardship through its reten-
tion the orders of the magistrate shall be taken.
(5) Within the first ten days of each quarter the prosecuting inspector shall verify all
property of which he or a prosecuting sub-inspector at head- quarters is in charge and shall
782 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

submit a certificate to the Superintendent of Police that he has duly carried out the veri-
fication. Where a prosecuting sub-inspector is in sole charge of property or is in joint
charge with the prosecuting inspector, the prosecuting sub-inspector shall be present dur-
ing the verification and shall also sign the certificate.
Rule 27.18

27.18. Safe custody of property. - (1) Weapons, articles and property sent in connec-
tion with cases shall on receipt be entered in register No. 1 and shall (excluding livestock)
be properly stored in the store-room of the head of the prosecuting agency, or the police
station. See Rule 22.18. When required for production in court such articles shall, at
headquarters, be taken out in the presence and under the personal order of an officer of
rank not less than prosecuting sub-inspector and an entry made in the register of issue
from and return to the prosecuting agency’s store-room, which register shall be main-
tained in Form 27.18(1).
Animals sent in connection with cases shall be kept in the pound attached to the police
station at the place to which they have been sent, and the cost of their keep shall be recov-
ered from the District Magistrate in accordance with Rule 25.48.
(2) In all cases in which the property consists of bullion, cash, negotiable securities, cur-
rency notes or jewellery, exceeding in value Rs. 500 the Superintendent shall obtain the
permission of the District Magistrate, Additional District Magistrate or Sub-Divisional
Officer to make it over to the Treasury Officer for safe custody in the treasury.
(3) All cash, jewellery and other valuable property of small bulk, which is not required
under sub-rule (2) above to be sent to the treasury, shall be kept in a locked strong box in
the store-room. Each court orderly shall be provided with a strong lock-up box in which
he shall keep all case property while it is in his custody in the court to which he is attached.
Case property shall invariably be kept locked-up in such box except when it is actually
produced as an exhibit in the course of proceedings. After being so produced it shall be
immediately replaced in the lock-up box. Boxes shall be provided from funds at the dis-
posal of the District Magistrate.
(4) Property taken out of the main store-room for production in court shall be signed for
by the court orderly concerned in register No. 2 and the prosecuting officer authorizing
the removal shall initial this entry. Such officer shall similarly, after personal check, in-
itial the entry of return of the property to the main store-room on the closing of the courts.
(5) Every day, when the courts close, an officer of the prosecuting branch of rank not
less that of sub-inspector shall personally see that the articles produced in court are re-
turned to the store-room, restored to their proper places in the shelves, cup-boards or
strong box and registered as required by sub-rule (4) above. The opening of the store-
room in the morning and its closing in the evening shall invariably be in the presence of
the police officials named in this rule. Animals brought from the pound shall be
respounded under the supervision of a head constable.
Rule 27.19

27.19. Property in cases committed to a higher court. - (1) When an order of com-
mitment to a superior court is made, any weapons, articles or property capable of such
treatment shall be enclosed in a parcel in the presence of the committing magistrate.
The parcel shall be sealed with the seal of the court and made over to the head of the po-
lice prosecuting agency, who shall produce it with unbroken seals before the superior
court, or, if so ordered by competent authority, shall make it over to some other officer
authorized so to produce it.
(2) Special precautions shall be taken under the orders of the Superintendent in regard
to property which cannot be so treated.
Prosecution and Court Duties. 783
Rule 27.20

27.20. Prosecuting agency to attend office when courts are closed. - At district head-
quarters, on days on which the courts are closed, an officer of the prosecuting branch not
less in rank than a sub-inspector shall attend the office of the Superintendent to receive
accused persons, weapons, articles and property and to transact urgent business. At mag-
isterial outposts and tahsils the prosecuting sub-inspector and court orderly respectively
shall attend the police station for the same purpose.
Rule 27.21

27.21. Property of prisoners to be taken charge of. - Money or other property found
on the person of an under-trial prisoner, other than necessary wearing apparel, shall be
taken charge of by the prosecuting officer and an entry of it made in register No. 1. A list
of such articles shall be recorded on the back of the prisoner’s warrant and the head of the
prosecuting agency shall see that they are made over or forwarded to the prisoner, if he
is discharged or acquitted or punished otherwise than with imprisonment. An acknow-
ledgement of the receipt of such property shall be obtained in register No. 1.
If the prisoner is sentenced to imprisonment the articles shall be sent to the officer in-
charge of the jail, a reference to whose acknowledgement shall be given in a register No.
1.
Rule 27.22

27.22. Duties of prosecuting sub-inspector and court orderlies at tahsil. - (1) Prose-
cuting sub-inspectors at sub-divisions of districts shall perform the duties detailed in
clauses (i) to (v) and (vii) to (x) of Rule 27.15. As regards clause (vi) of Rule 27.15 the
prosecuting sub-inspector in a sub- division shall have the same duties in relation to the
gazetted police officer-in- charge of the sub-division and the sub-divisional officer as the
head of the prosecuting agency has in relation to the Superintendent of Police and the Dis-
trict Magistrate. He shall also submit to the gazetted officer in-charge of the sub-division
a daily diary in Form 27.15(vi).
(2) In sub-divisions of districts all registers prescribed in rule 27.16 shall be maintained
by the prosecuting agency.
(3) Rules 27.17 to 27.21 shall apply mutatis mutandis to all prosecuting sub- inspectors
at sub-divisions.
(4) Court orderlies at tahsils and other courts away from headquarters shall maintain
register No. 1 referred to in rule 27.16. They shall take charge of all property connected
with cases sent for trial by courts to which they are attached in accordance with Rules
27.18, 27.19 and 27.21 but shall in no circumstances retain such property longer than is
required for each day’s proceedings of the court. Every evening they shall deposit such
property with the clerk of the police station who will be responsible that it is disposed of
in accordance with rules 27.17, 27.18 and 27.19.
In addition, court orderlies in all courts are responsible that order is kept in courts under
the direction of magistrates. They will obey all orders given to them by the officers prose-
cuting cases and will take charge of exhibits and the police files of cases when ordered to
do so. They will also make copies of statement made to the poolice under section 162,
Code of Criminal Procedure, and provide them on payment to the accused - (see rule
27.23).
Rule 27.23

27.23. Supply of copies under sections 16 and 173(4), Code of Criminal Procedure.
- (1) Copies of statements recorded by the police under section 161, Code of Criminal Pro-
cedure, which are asked for by accused persons under section 162, Code of Criminal
Procedure, and copies of final reports similarly asked for under Section 173(4) of the
Code shall invariably be supplied on payment unless the presiding officer of the court de-
cides otherwise. The local Government has decided that the subordinate official
reposnible for making these copies shall ordinarily be the police constable appointed as
784 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

court orderly. This arramgement is only possible, however, when such police constable
is sufficiently educated for the purpose and can undertake the work without detriment to
his primary duties as prescribed in Rule 27.22. Superintendents should, in consultation
with the senior officer of the prosecuting branch, consider the circusmances of each court
in the district, as to the volume of such copying work and of the other duties of the court
orderly, and, if they consider that the latter official should be relieved of the whole or a
part of the copying work, should move the District Magistrate to nominate another offi-
cial of the court for the purpose.
(2) The half share of the copying fees which, in accordance with Financial Commisson-
ers’ Standing Order No. 5, is payable to the actual copyist, shall be paid to the court
orderly, when he is entitled to it, but neither that offical nor any other police officer shall
have any share in or responsibility for the collection of copying fees or the keeping of the
prescribed accounts thereof.
(3) The prosecuting officer attached to the Corut concerned shall be responsible that the
orders contained in Home Secretary’s letter No. 19893 (H. - Judl.), dated 8th September,
1925, are strictly complied with and no abuses are permitted in the method of payment
therein laid down.
Rule 27.24

27.24. Production of police records as evidence. - (1) A police officer is bound, under
the provisions of section 162 of the Evidence Act (I of 1872), to produce any document
in his possession or power if summoned to do so, but, if such document is an unpublished
official record relating to any affair of State, he is prohibited by section 123 of the same
Act from giving evidence derived from it and the court is prohibited from inspecting it.
(2) The following police records are privileged under section 123, Evidence Act. If
their production is demanded, a certificate in form 27.24(2) must be obtained from the In-
spector-General by the police officer called upon to produce them. The
Inspector-General may at his discretion allow evidence derived from such documents to
be given and in order to enable him to exercise this discretion it is important, that a Police
Officer claiming privilege in respect ofany document, should submit either the original
document, a copy, or a full translation if it is in vernacular, together with a report indicat-
ing why it is necessary to claim privilege and also that his claim is justified.
(1) The Surveillance Register (Rule 23.4(1)).
(2) Village Crime Register, Part IV (Rule 23.59).
(3) History Sheets (Rule 23.9).
(4) Bad Character Rolls and Information Sheets (Rules 23.16 and 23.17).
(5) Case diaries. in files or in the Police Gazette.
(6) All unpublished orders of Government or of the Inspector-General of Police con-
cerned.
(7) All documents or records which are classed as ‘‘Secret’’ or ‘‘Confidential’’.
(3) While the prohibition of the giving of evidence derived from other police records is
not absolute, the provisions of section 124, Evidence Act, permit a police officer to refuse
to disclose orders or other communications made to him in the course of his official du-
ties, when he considers that the public interests would suffer by such disclosure.
(4) When the production of official correspondence is in question, the head of the office
possessing such correspondence has authority to grant or withhold permission under sec-
tion 123 of the Evidence Act. In exercising this discretion he shall be guided by the
general rule that correspondence may not be produced without the permission of the high-
est authority concerned in it. Detailed instructions on this point were communicated to
all heads of Police Offices with the Inspector-General’s endorsement No. 1506-A/29-31-
26A of 10th August, 1928.
Prosecution and Court Duties. 785
Rule 27.25

27.25. Co-operation of Jail officials in identification of prisoners. - Information that


a convicted person has not been identified should invariably be given to the Superinten-
dent of the Jail concerned. Under the provisions of the Jail Manual such prisoners are
required to be specially classified and the Superintendent of the Jail is required to furnish
the police with the names and particulars of all persons who visit them and with clues as
to their identity which may be obtained from examination of letters despatched by or ad-
dressed to them.
Rule 27.26

27.26. Assaults on police - Prosecution for. - When assaults are committed upon the
members of the police force while in the execution of their duties, the prompt prosecution
of the offenders should be arranged for if possible at, or near, the scene of the offence, ade-
quate sentences being pressed for by the prosecuting agency.
Rule 27.27

27.27. Diet of accused persons. - The instructions regarding the dieting of accused per-
sons arrested by the police and the recovery of diet money are contained in rule 26.27.
Rule 27.28

27.28. Diet money and travelling expenses advanced to witnesses. - (1) Diet money
at the rates prescribed by Government from time to time, and travelling expenses, shall
invariably be advanced at the police station, at the time of bonds of appearance being
taken, to all witnesses required to appear in cases sent to court by the police. This pro-
cedure shall be followed both in cognizable cases and in preventive security and all other
cases in which the police select and take bonds from witnesses. Diet money may also be
advanced at the request of the accused or his legal adviser to witnesses required to appear
for the defence.
(2) Such diet money shall be paid from, and including, the day on which the witness en-
tered into his recognizance up to, and including, the day on which the charge-sheet will
be made over to the magistrate having jurisdiction in the case.
(3) Money so expended shall be entered in the road certificate and shall be recovered
when the charge-sheet is made over to the magistrate as a debit against the Judicial De-
partment a receipt being given in form 10.14(1). The prosecuting inspector or his
representative at courts away from headquarters, shall be responsible that sums advanced
under this rule by police stations are recovered on the day of presentation of the demand
from the court itself or the sheriff. Should there be any delay in the recovery of such
money the head of the prosecuting agency shall remit the amount of the police station
from his permanent advance. The head of the prosecuting agency shall bring to notice
any instance in which inadequate diet money or travelling expenses have been paid to wit-
nesses in police cases.
(4) Gazetted officers and inspectors hearing charge-sheets, and representatives of the
prosecuting agency in courts, shall satisfy themselves that diet money and travelling ex-
penses said to have been paid to complainants and witnesses at police stations have
actually been so paid.
Rule 27.29

27.29. Record of conviction. - Conviction and orders to execute bonds in all cogniza-
ble police cases shall be entered in (a) the Vernacular General Crime Register and the
English Register of Cognizable Offences which are maintained in the office of the Super-
intendent and (b) in the First Information Report Register which is maintained at the
police station reporting the offence. Convictions and orders in the cases detailed below
shall also be entered in (c) the Conviction Register which, for the purpose of Section 75,
Indian Penal Code, and Section 3 of the Punjab Habitual Offenders (Control and Reform)
Act, 19521, is maintained in each police station as prescribed in Chapter XXII.
786 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

I-(INDIAN PENAL CODE)


Chapter Sections

XI 193 to 195 Giving or fabricating false evidence.


211 - 377 False charge of committing an unnatural offence.
XII 231 to 232 Counterfeiting of coin.
233 to 235 Making, buying, selling or having in possession instruments or material for
counterfeiting coin.
236 Abetting the counterfeiting of coin out of India.
XII 237 to 238 Import or export of counterfeit coins.
239,
240, Possession or delivery of counterfeit coin.
242,
243
244 Unlawful alteration of weight or composition of coin by persons employed in Mints.
246 to 253 Unlawful alteration of wight, composition or appearance of coin and possession and
delivery of such coins.
255 Counterfeiting of Government stamps.
256 to 257 Making, buying, selling or having in possession to instruments or material for
counterfeiting Government stamps.
XII 258 to 259 Possession or sale of counterfeit Government stamps.
260 Using of counterfeit stamps.
261 to 263 Fraudulent effacement or erasure of Government stamps.
XVI 302 Murder
303 Murder by life convict.
304 Culpable honicide not amounting to murder
307 Attempts to commit murder
311 Beeing thug,.
326 Grevious hurt by dangerous weapon or means.
327 Hurt to extrot property or to constrain to any illegal act,
328 Hurting by means of poison etc.,
329 Grevious hurt to extort property etc.
354 Indencent assault of a woman.
363 to 369 Kidnapping
376 Rape
377 Unnatural offence.
XVII 379 to 382 Thefts of all kinds
384 to 389 Extortina of all kinds
392 to 394, Robbery of all kinds
397 and 398
395,
396,

4. See Punjab Government Notification dated 29.1.1963


Prosecution and Court Duties. 787

399,
Dakaiti of
all kinds.
402
400 and Belonging to a gang of thieves or dacoits
401
404 Dishonest misappropriation of property belonging to a deceased person.
406
to Criminal breach of trust by public servant.
409
411 to 414 Receiving stolen property
418 Cheating of all kinds, except simple cheating,
to Section 417.
420
XVII 429 to 433
and serious mischief.
435
to
440
449
to House-tresspass in order to commit an offence.
452
454 to 458 Lurking house-tresspass or house-breaking other than simple, section 453.
459 and 460 Grievoas hurt or death cause in house-breaking.
461 Dishonestly breaking open a closed receptacle.
462 Fraudulently opening a closed receptacle held in trust.
465 to 469 Forgery
XVIII 489A
to Forgery of currency notes and bank notes.
489D

All offences which would, if committed in British India have been punishable under
Chapter XII or Chapter XVII of the Indian Penal Code with imprisonment of either de-
scription for a term of three years or upwards, in which the order of conviction was passed
by a court or tribunal in the territories of any Indian Prince or State in India acting under
the general or special authority of the Governor-General in Council or of any local Gov-
ernment.
II. - CODE OF CRIMINAL PROCEDURE

Chapter VIII
Sections 108, 109 and 110 - Bad livelihood.
(III. - (MISCELLANEOUS ACTS).
Sections 3 and 4. Act III of 1867 - Gambling.
Section 9, Act I of 1878 - Opium smuggling.
Indian Arms Act, 1959, (No. 54 of 1959), Section 7 of the Essential Commodities Act,
1955.
788 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

IV - (OTHER OFFENCES)
All offences, in cases in which the subsequent proof of the conviction so recorded would
render the person convicted liable by law to enhanced punishment on subsequent convic-
tion of the same or similar offence by reason of the proof of such former conviction, and
all offences in which upon such proof, the law establishes a presumption in favour of the
prosecution.
Illustration. - (a) Offences under section 8 of Act XVI of 1861, as amended by Act XVI
of 1876, shall be so entered because an enhanced punishment is provided for every sub-
sequent conviction.
(b) Offences against rules made by the Local Government under Section 41 of Act VII
of 1878 (The Indian Forest Act) by reason of the provisions of the last clause of paragraph
2 of section 42 of the same Act.
(c) Offences under section 13 of Act XV of 1910 (The Cantonment Act).
Note. - Conviction for theft by courts-martial, although the persons convicted have not been sent
for trial or prosecution by the police, shall also be entered in the conviction registers in all
cases in which the convictions are intimated to the Civil authorities.
Rule 27.30

27.30. Entries in conviction register when made. - The entries shall be made -
(a) if there is no appeal immediately ;
(b) if an appeal is made and the conviction is upheld, when the result of the appeal
is known.
(c) if an appeal lies but is not made, when limitation has expired.
Rule 27.31

27.31. Entries of convictions how and when made. - (1) Entries of convictions shall
ordinarily be made from charge-sheet slips.
(2) When the entry has been made in the General Crime Register the charge- sheet slip
shall be sent to the police station.
(3) When charge-sheet slips are kept pending for results of appeals to be known they
shall be kept in pigeon holes by the official-in-charge of the General Crime Register and
separate intimation of the results of the case in the lower court shall be sent to the police
station.
Rule 27.32

27.32. Despatch register of charge-sheet and conviction slips. - (1) A Despatch Reg-
ister of charge-sheet and conviction slips referring to case included under rule 27.29 shall
be maintained in Form 27.32(1) by the official-in-charge of the General Crime Register.
Separate pages shall be alloted for each police station in the district and for conviction
slips received from magistrates of other districts.
(2) After the necessary entries have been made in the First Information Report Register
and Conviction Register, charge-sheet slips and conviction slips shall be returned for re-
cord in the office of the Superintendent of the district from which they were despatched.
Rule 27.33

27.33. Despatch of conviction slips in other cases. - (1) If the charge-sheet slip refers
to the conviction of a person for an offence included under rule 27.29 of a person who is
a resident of a police station other than that from which the case was sent for trial, the of-
ficial-in-charge of the General Crime Register shall send a conviction slip in Form
27.33(1) in addition to sending the charge-sheet slip to that police station of which such
person is a resident.
Prosecution and Court Duties. 789

If such police station is in another district the conviction slip shall be sent through the
Superintendent.
(2) If there is any doubt as to the residence of a convict, or if a convict is unidentified
or belongs to foreign territory, the conviction shall be recorded in the police station from
which the case was sent for trial. In such a case a notice may be sent for publication in
the Criminal Intelligence Gazette.
Rule 27.34

27.34. Intimation of convictions from courts. - Convictions in cases included under


rule 27.29, which are dealt with by Magistrates, direct, shall be entered in the Conviction
Register on receipt of intimation from magistrates.
Rule 27.35

27.35. Publication of conviction of Europeans, etc., in Criminal Intelligence Ga-


zette. - (1) Conviction, obtained in the Punjab, of Europeans, Anglo- Indians, or subjects
of any foreign state, shall in addition to the record prescribed in the above rules, be re-
corded in the like form, together with the descriptive roll of the person convicted in the
English and vernacular editions of the Criminal Intelligence Gazette.
(2) Superintendents may use their own discretion as to the publication of such convic-
tion in the case of persons who are subjects of Indian States. Ordinarily the convictions
of such persons shall only be published when they are habitual offenders.
Rule 27.36

27.36. General Crime Register. - A General Crime Register in Form 27.36 shall be
maintained in vernacular in the office of each Superintendent.
(1) The particulars of every cognizable offence reported to the police shall be en-
tered in such register.
(2) The register shall be divided into groups of offences corresponding with State-
ment ‘‘A’’ of the Annual Report. At the top of the first page allotted to each
group shall be written the heading of the group and the pages shall be cut to dis-
play the headings.
(3) On the receipt of the counterfoil of the first information report the return-writer
shall enter in the register as many of the particulars required as may be possible,
and shall endorse on such counterfoil the words ‘‘Entered contents in the Gen-
eral Crime Register’’ with the date and his signature.
As the investigation proceeds he shall enter from the case diaries any additional par-
ticulars necessary to complete the form, and shall similarly endorse such case
diaries.
(4) If a case sent up by the police is convicted under a section or law, other than that
entered in the register, a red line shall be drawn through the original entries and
fresh entries made under the group which includes the offence of which the of-
fender is actually convicted.
If one person is convicted of the offence ordinarily entered, and another person of
a different offence, the original entry shall be corrected and a fresh entry made
of the separate conviction.
(5) Every erasure and alteration shall be made so that the original entry remains leg-
ible.
(6) Cases cancelled or transferred to other districts shall be erased by a red line drawn
through them and an entry made giving an abstract of the order of cancellation
or transfer, with the date and the name of the officer who made it.
(7) At the close of each year the register for the year in question shall be totalled.
Each group of offences after deducting cases cancelled and transferred shall be to-
790 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

talled separately, these totals being required for the preparation of annual statis-
tics of crime.
(8) Each annual volume shall be strongly bound and kept for ten years.
Rule 27.37

27.37. General Crime Register - Rules for maintenance of. - The following rules
shall regulate the maintenance of the General Crime Register and the preparation of the
annual statistics of crime :-
(i) Each separate offence shall be reckoned as a separate case although several such
offences may have been joined for the purpose of the trial.
(ii) The question whether a set of facts constitutes one offence or more than one of-
fence shall be determined with reference to section 235, Code of Criminal Pro-
cedure.
(iii) In prosecutions for bad livelihood and for nuisance under section 34 of the Po-
lice Act, a separate case shall ordinarily be entered for each person arrested.
(iv) When a case is sent for trial and a final order is passed, such case shall be entered
under the section of the Act under which the accused person is convicted or ac-
quitted. The final order is the order which stands after all appeals have been
heard.
If such conviction or acquittal covers the facts reported by the police, the police re-
turns shall, if they differ, be amended accordingly and the original report can-
celled.
Illustrations.
(a) The police send up A for trial of murder. A is convicted of culpable homicide. The
returns shall be corrected by an entry under capable homicide and by cancelling the entry
under murder.
(b) The police send up B for trial of murder. B is convicted under section 318, Indian
Penal Code. Here, if a murder was committed, as the conviction does not cover the facts
of the police reports though it covers the evidence the police were able to produce, the en-
try of murder shall stand, and a new entry be made under section 318, Indian Penal Code.
(c) C is found in possession of suspicious property and is sent up for trial on a charge
of theft. He is convicted under section 411, Indian Penal Code. The property corre-
sponded with that stolen in a case reported. The theft may be cancelled and an entry made
under section 411, Indian Penal Code, if the evidence leaves the presumption evenly bal-
anced between theft and receiving; but if the evidence shows that C received the stolen
property from the thief, the case of the theft shall stand and a new entry, be made under
section 411, Indian Penal Code.
(v) Cases cancelled by order of the District Magistrate shall be excluded from the po-
lice returns but the arrest of any person in a case thus cancelled, together with
the particulars required by the form, shall be shown in the columns relating to
persons.
(vi) A case shall be shown only in the returns of the district in which it was inves-
tigated, or, if transferred to another district for trial, in the returns of such dis-
trict.
(vii) A ‘‘decided’’ case is a case which has been brought to trial.
(viii) A ‘‘discharged’’ person is one not brought to trial.
(ix) Bank notes, bills, and cheques payable to bearer shall, when their cash value has
been effectually transferred from the person from whom they were stolen, or
taken in an offence, be entered at their cash value.
Bonds, securities, cash books, ledgers, and the like shall be entered only at the value of
their component materials.
Prosecution and Court Duties. 791

Property stolen or recovered shall be entered in the returns of the year in which the re-
port is made irrespective of the true date of such loss or recovery.
No such loss or recovery shall be recorded in the returns of more than one year.
(x) When a summons case is dismissed or a compoundable case compounded, any
person arrested in such case shall be shown as acquitted.
(xi) If an accused person is discharged and subsequently re-arrested and convicted
on the same facts, or if an accused person is acquitted and such acquittal is sub-
sequently quashed and the peson convicted on the same facts, only one arrest
and one conviction shall be shown in the police returns.
(xii) When an accused person dies, commits suicide, or becomes of unsound mind
after the commission of an offence a note of the fact shall be made in the column
of remarks of the return in question.
(xiii) Persons shall be shown as acquitted or discharged, who die before the conclu-
sion of the trial or who are discharged or acquitted in a cognizable offence,
whether such offence has been cancelled or not and whether they are convicted
of a non-cognizable offence or not.
Rule 27.38

27.38. Records of First Information Reports and Case Diaries. - (1) Case diaries
shall be filed, in order of dates, with the first information report of the case in question.
(2) In the record room of each district police office there shall be an almirah containing
three rows of pigeon-holes, each row containing as many pigeon-holes as there are police
stations in the district.
A set of three pigeon-holes shall be allotted to each police station :-
(a) In the upper row shall be kept complete cases, in which the final report or charge-
sheet has been received, and papers connected with cases which have previously
been removed from the almirah.
(b) In the middle row shall be kept first information reports in pending cases and case
diaries which have been duly sorted and placed in order of dates.
(c) In the lower row shall be kept unsorted papers connected with pending cases.
(3) The files of cases under investigation or pending shall be removed from the middle
row and placed in the upper row so soon as the final report has been received and filed.
The papers in the lower row shall, as far as possible, be sorted daily and placed with their
respective first information reports in the middle row.
Rule 27.39

27.39. Monthly sorting. - (1) At the end of each month, or sooner if convenient, the
cases in the upper row which are no longer pending investigation shall be sorted and di-
vided into separate packets as follows :-
(a) All traced cases and untraced bailable cases, including cancelled cases.
(b) Untraced non-bailable cases, in which action under section 512, Code of Crimi-
nal Procedure, has not been taken.
(c) Untraced bailable and non-bailable cases in which action under Section 512,
Code of Criminal Procedure, has been taken.
Each packet shall be placed in the record room in the current year’s bundle of the police
station concerned.
A list of all the first information reports contained therein shall be kept with each packet
under (b) and (c).
In (a) packets the cases shall be arranged in order of the serial numbers of the first in-
formation reports.
792 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

(2) At the end of the current year the packets in the current year’s bundle shall be re-
moved and placed in other bundles in accordance with sub-rule (3).
(3) In the record room four separate bundles of case files shall be kept for each police
station as follows :-
One bundle for the current year’s case files, which shall contain all the packets under
(a), (b) and (c), in accordance with sub-rule (1).
One bundle for the previous year’s case files containing only packets under (a).
One bundle for the case files of the last year but one, containing only packets under
(a).
One bundle for the files of all cases under (b) reported during the past five years.
The bundles of each police station shall be tied up in cloth of a distinctive colour and
each bundle shall be marked with the name of the police station and the year to which its
contents belong, as follows :
Current year (a), (b) and (c) files.

Previous year (a) files.

Last year but one (a) files.

Previous five years (b) files.

(4) The files of cases coming under (c) of all police stations, shall, on removal from the
current year’s bundle, be tied up together in one bundle in cloth of a distinctive colour.
The bundle shall be labelled ‘‘50 years bundle’’ and names of all the police stations con-
cerned shall be entered on the label.
Such annual bundles shall be kept together in separate part of the record room.
(5) The packets of case files shall be disposed of as follows :-
(i) Packets coming under (a) will be removed and destroyed after two years from the
date of the decision of the case in the Trial Court provided that no appeal or re-
vision in the case is pending in the Appellate Courts. Untraced bailable cases
including cancelled cases will be removed and destroyed after two years from
the date on which the Magistrate has passed orders about the case being kept as
untraced or cancelled as the case may be.
(ii) Packets coming under (b) will be removed and destroyed after five years from
the date of order of the Magistrate for keeping the case as untraced.
(iii) Packets coming under (c) will be removed and destroyed after fifty years from
the date of conclusion of proceedings under Section 512, Criminal Procedure
Code.
APPENDIX No. 27.15 (VI).
EXTRACT FROM CHAPTER 3-A, OF VOLUME IV, HIGH COURT RULES AND
ORDERS REGARDING THE DUTIES OF THE PROSECUTIN G AGENCY TO-
WARDS THE DISTRICT MAGISTRATE.
(7) A convenient and valuable source of information for the adequate supervision of
criminal business is the Police Department English register of cognizable offences men-
tioned in the Police Rule 24.18(1). This register is placed before the District Magistrate
on each working day when he is at district headquarters. It gives information not only of
the action of the police (thus enabling the District Magistrate, to superintend their work)
but also affords the means of watching the progress and the results of business in Court.
The practice of merely intialling this register after a hasty glance at it too commonly pre-
vails, but a few minutes each day spent on considering the entries for the day and for
preceding days will enable the District Magistrate to maintain a close touch within all
Prosecution and Court Duties. 793

branches of the criminal administration. The entries for the day bring to light at once the
orders of courts which are prima facie unsatisfactory and which require the scrutiny of the
District Magistrate. The register, therefore, facilitates the making of references to the
High Court, and puts the Deputy Commissioner in a position at the earliest possible mo-
ment to initiate proceedings by way of appeal. It can also be used to disclose cases which
have been pending for an inordinate time.
(8) The Deputy Commissioner is the head of the prosecuting agency in the district and
this affords him a further opportunity of keeping in touch with the work in all courts. It
is easy for him to arrange to be informed by the prosecuting agency each day of an omis-
sion on the part of courts to record the evidence of witnesses produced and to investigate
promptly any complaint which may be made of dilatoriness in any particular court.
(9) * * * * * * * * *
(10) The Judges are strongly of opinion that it is necessary to revert to the old system
of sending up all material witnesses with the chalan. This system has been resumed in
some districts with very marked success, but it can be carried out only if the work of mag-
istrates is so arranged that they shall without delay commence the trial of chalans
presented to them by the police. No excuse for not proceeding at once with a chalan
should be accepted other than that the magistrate is already engaged on another challan,
or on a complaint case in which a postponement would work genuine hardship. In such
contingencies the fresh chalan should be proceeded with as soon as the Magistrate is free
from the first case, and it must be impressed upon Magistrates that witnesses should be
examined at once, that the trial must proceed from day to day without interruption, that
charges should be framed without delay and without adjournment for the purpose of con-
sidering whether a charge should be framed or not, and that deference should not be paid
to the wishes of an unready bar. If the presentation of witnesses along with challans ren-
ders it impossible on any particular day to record the statements of witnesses present in
complaint cases, the evidence of the latter should be recorded the first thing next morning
before the business of that day is undertaken, and similarly on any succeeding day the ar-
rears of the previous day should be disposed of before the set work of that day. In this way
it will be possible to avoid retaining any witnesses for more than two days at the utmost.
Should congestion occur or be threatened, the Magistrate should apply promptly to the
District Magistrate for sanction to fix one or more blank days in the week to be utilized
for catching up with arrears, and the District Magistrate will find it convenient to receive
each day from the prosecuting inspector a short note showing how the system is working
in each of the subordinate courts.
(11) All arrests made by the police without warrant are reported to District Magistrate
under section 62 of the Criminal Procedure Code, and all remand orders under section 167
passed by subordinate magistrates are similarly reported. Both these reports should be
forwarded to the ilaqa magistrate, who has already received the First Information Report.
The magistrate of the ilaqa is, thus, in a position to know that crime is under investigation
in his ilaqa, and what cases are likely to each his Court within the next few days. The
magistrate is responsible that the completion report under section 173 of the Criminal
Procedure Code is not unduly delayed, and his responsibility in this respect should be em-
phazised. He should insist on the prompt submission of the First Information Report and
of the arrest report, and he should call for the completion report from the Superintendent
of Police if that report is unduly delayed. The District Magistrate should cause the ilaqa
magistrate to realize that he is not a mere Judge whose duty it is simply to decide cases
produced before him, but that he is at all times responsible for the maintenance of the
peace in the area which is made over into his charge. Every effort should be made to get
the ilaqa magistrate to take a personal interest in and gain a thorough knowledge of his
own thanas.
(12) The Deputy Commissioner’s absence in camp must necessarily interfere with his
day-to-day supervision of the work of the subordinate courts, but the interference can be
794 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

minimised if arrangements are made with the Superintendent of Police that the register of
congnizable crime is submitted each day to the next senior Magistrate at Sadar. That
Magistrate, if not exercising the powers of a District Magistrate is not authorized to issue
orders to the police but the object is that he should bring immediately to the notice of the
District Magistrate cases in which his interference is called for, and in which Magisterial
records should be obtained. Similarly the senior magistrate can be entrusted with the du-
ties of securing the punctual attendance of subordinate magistrates and of seeing that
witnesses are not dismissed without their evidence being recorded or that chalan cases are
not delayed.
(13) Not inf4requently cases have occurred where undue delay has taken place in report-
ing for revision the unsatisfactory orders of subordinate Courts, or in moving Government
to institute appeals. The delay is largely due to reliance on the monthly business state-
ments which may not be submitted to the District Magistrate till a considerable time after
the objectionable order has been passed. District Magistrates should make free use of the
register of cogniazble crime for these purposes, and should take prompt action in cases
where such action appears necessary. Having done so, they should arrange to be in-
formed at once of any appeal that may be made to the Sessions Court in a case which has
been reported, and they must report promptly to the High Court first the fact of the appeal
having been filed and later its results.

FORM No. 27.1(3).


Memorandum of Chalan
In case
F.I.R. No. _____________, dated ________________ Crown vs. ____________
Police Station ____________ Section ____________ .
1. Whether all the papers and documents entered in the list given on the chalan are prop-
erly attached to the challan ?
2. Are all the columns of chalan form duly filled in ? Note any mistake made in filling
the form.
3. Does the list of property entered in column No. 5 tally with the list given in Road Cer-
tificate ? Note any discrepancies.
4. Is the copy of Police Station file complete ? Does it contain a copy of the F.I.R ? Is
the file properly prepared and signed by Station seal, etc. ?
5. Is the plan of spot prepared according to instructions, i.e., whether the notes on it are
entered by the investigating officer in red ink, and if these notes appear to be made cor-
rectly ?
6. Are the sketches of the weapons of offence attached to the chalan ? Do they bear the
signatures of the preparing officer and the weight of the weapon ?
7. Is the list of stolen property attached to the chalan ? If so, does it bear the signatures
of the complainant and the officer writing the list, with date ?
8. In murder and hurt cases whether the post-mortem reports, inquest reports, state-
ments of injuries, Chemical Examiner’s and Imperial Serologist’s reports attached to the
chalan or not ?
9. Whether the list of properties, etc. recovered, produced, or seized in the case are cor-
rectly prepared, dated and signed by witnesses and officer preparing them ? Also whether
the signatures of the witnesses of recovery who are entered in the chalan appear on the
lists ?
Prosecution and Court Duties. 795

10. Were the accused’s search slips sent to Bureau and was any reply received ? If so,
what ?
11. Are the identification certificates of the accused attached to chalan ?
12. Which the accused are persons who convicts ? Give brief note of their conviction
with dates.
13. Whether all the persons who were accused of committing the offence in the F.I.R.
or First Case diary have been sent up for trial ? Note if some of them are omitted or some
new are added. Also note if the officer sending the chalan has noted any reasons for doing
so in the brief.
14. Is the Police brief prepared according to instructions ? Note defects. [Paragraph
27.9].
15. Are all the eye or other necessary witnesses whose names were mentioned in F.I.R.
entered in the chalan ? If not, are any reasons given in brief for doing so ?
16. Note the dates on which the several accused were arrested.
17. Were remands regularly taken and was the chalan prepared in proper time ?
18. Whether all necessary evidence has been entered in the chalan ? Note if there are
any omissions.
19. Whether the personal bonds and bail bonds of accused persons and the recogni-
zances of all witnesses are attached to the chalan or not ? If they are attached, note if they
are complete, and properly bind the accused and witnesses for attendance. If arrange-
ments for producing witnesses along with the chalan have not been made, are any reasons
given in the chalan for not doing so ?
20. Note in cases sent up for proceedings under section 512, Criminal Procedure Code,
if the full description of the absconders and list of the property owned by them are at-
tached to the chalan. Whether separate report for obtaining the warrant of arrest of
absconder was received, whether proceedings under section 87/88, Criminal Procedure
Code, have been started.
21. In cases of kidnapping and abduction note if the medical opinion and copies of birth
register are attached with the chalan.
22. Whether the statements of prosecution witnesses were separately recorded under
Section 161/162, Criminal Procedure Code ?
23. By whom has the chalan been prepared ?
24. Has any unnecessary delay been made in the course of investigation or in chalaning
the case ?
25. Other necessary facts, defects and omissions made in the investigation, etc., which
require special notice or which necessitate some action. Particular care should be taken
to see whether enquiry has been made regarding the connections of Prosecution Wit-
nesses with the complainant and with the accused.
26. A brief order issued or action taken on the chalan.
27. Final decision of the case with date.
28. Note any undue delay made by court in dealing with the case. Instances in which
witnesses were produced with the chalan and were sent back unheard, delays in framing
charges, hearing arguments or pronouncing judgments, etc.
29. If the case ends in discharge or acquittal, copy of the judgment should be attached
with an opinion as to whether or not the case is a fit one for revision or an appeal.
796 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

FORM No. 27.2(1)(a)


POLICE STATION ______________ DISTRICT
Serial No. of charge sheet slip despatch register
Charge-sheet slip to accompany charge sheet No.
(1) No. of First Information (4) Date of sending up for trial
Report
(2) Date of report (5) Date of arrival in Court
 Stolen
(3) Value of Property 
 Recovered
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Name of ac- Offence Date Date of Orrence which Sentence, date of District serial
cused arrested, under which of transfer has been proved sentence, name of No. of P.R.
parentage, charged by arrest or against the court and presiding Slip (if any) as
Caste, resi- the Police escape accused or in officer with his entered in P.R.
dence, occupa- and place of which he has powers, the district in Register
tion, descrip- occurrence been acquitted which the trial was
tion and spe- held and whether the
cial marks of case was tried
identification summarily or otherwise

Signature of the Magistrate

FORM No. 27.2 (2)


LIST OF HEADINGS.
Station House Officer -
(1) Name.
(2) Parentage.
(3) Caste and tribe (settled or wandering).
(4) Age.
(5) Description.
(6) Residence. (In case he is not a British subject by birth both the original and the
present residence should be given).
(7) No. and date of Punjab Government Notification under section 3 of the Criminal
Tribes Act under which declared a member of a Criminal Tribe.
(8) Date and place of registration.
(9) F.P. Slip No.
(10) No. and date of Punjab Government Notification imposing restrictions :-
(a) Under Section 10.
(b) Under Section 11.
(11) Date and original area of restriction.
(12) Changes in area of restriction mentioned under No. 11 above, if any, with
authorities.
(13) Has he been in the Reformatory Settlement or in any other Criminal Tribes Set-
Prosecution and Court Duties. 797

tlement established under Section 16 previously and, if so, supply the following
information:-
(a) No. and date of restriction orders under Section 16 with name of Settle-
ment to which restricted.
(b) When was he released on form ‘L’ under rule 28-A ?
(c) No. and date of order under section 18 discharging him from settlement.
(14) Is there any objection to the Criminal Tribe member being allowed to remain
in his area of restriction mentioned above ? If so, furnish material on the follow-
ing points :-
(a) Has he any land at his village, and if not, has he any other means of livelihood
?
(b) Modus Operandi.
(c) Details of recorded and unrecorded suspicious with dates.
(d) Particulars of friends and relations of bad character and of other persons of bad
repute with whom the Criminal Tribe member associates.
(e) General reputation in the village together with the opinion of the village offi-
cials.
(f) Copy of Register A.
(g) Station House Officer’s report concerning eligibility of the Criminal Tribe
member for admission to the Reformatory Settlement after his release from jail
and any remarks.
(h) Offence now committed.
(i) Brief history of the case.
Station House Officer.
Prosecuting Branch -
(15) Result of the case and action taken under rule 28(3) of the Rules framed under
section 20 of the Criminal Tribes Act.
(16) Grounds on which the Criminal Tribe member is eligible for admission to Re-
formatory Settlement after his release from jail.
(17) Remarks by Superintendent of Police.
P.Dy. Supdt. Police
P.I.
Note. - The above form together with enclosures (in duplicate) should be forwarded to the Deputy
Commissioner for Criminal Tribes, Punjab, with his remarks.

FORM No. 27.9(1)


Police Department ........ District.
POLICE BRIEF IN CASE UNDER SECTION __________ FIRST INFORMATION
REPORT No.______________ , POLICE STATION _______________
(1) Place of occurrence and its distance from the Police Station.
(2) Date and time of occurrence.
(3) Date and time when F.I.R. was made at the Police Station, and explanation.
(4) Value of property stolen. Recovered.
(5) Name of complainant, with explanation. If not, the leading injured party.
(6) Name and parentage of accused and date of, arrest with explanation of any delay
798 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

in effecting arrest; also note whether mentioned in F.I.R. and if not when and
how first mentioned _________________________

_________________________________________________________________
[Fresh page]
(7) Concise statement of the case for the prosecution.
[Fresh page]
(8) List of witnesses, giving name, parentage and address.
[Fresh page]
(9) List of points to be proved by the prosecution to establish the offence, with serial
number of witness to prove each point.

1 2 3 4 5
Points to be proved to Serial Number of Abstract of statement of Reference to case REMARKS
establish the offence witness each witness as given in diaries relating to the
the Police file witness’s statement

Note 1. - For column 1 - See under "Practice-Evidence" in the appropriate section in "The Law of
Crimes".
Note 2. - In column 5 - Note anything which counsel should know, e.g., explanation for delay in
witness coming forward, credibility of witness (e.g., friendship with complainant, accused,
or other witnesses), possible discrepancies and explanation thereof.
[Fresh page]
10. List of exhibits together with the explanation of any delay in the recovery of any
article.
[Fresh page]
11. Probable line of defence with reasons of investigating officer for rejecting it and
suggested line of rebuttal. (Note here reasons for omission of any accused or
witnesses mentioned in F.I.R.)
[Fresh page]
12. Proceedings in Court.
Date of hearing What is to be done at this What has been done at this hearing REMARKS
hearing

PROCEEDINGS IN THE COURT OF, MAGISTRATE, CLASS


Date of hearing What is to be done on this hearing What has been done on this hearing
Prosecution and Court Duties. 799

FORM No. 27.10(2)


REQUISITION FOR PARTICULARS OF PREVIOUS CONVICTIONS
196 .
FROM
TO Superintendent

Superintendent
Dated ................................................ 
 No.
Received............................................ 
Sir,
I REQUEST you will please furnish extract of previous convictions of the individual
named within, certified under the hand of the Clerk of the Court or other officer having
the custory of the original records, so that the said certified extract may be used as evi-
dence under the provisions of section 511, Code of Criminal Procedure.
I have, &c.,
Superintendent of Police
REVERSE.

Name of accused. Description


Father’s name. Age
Residence. Description of offence with which now charged.
Clue to former conviction
Superintendent of Police

FORM No. 27.15(VI)


NAME OF PROSECUTING OFFICER ____________ DAILY DIARY OF THE
COURT OF __________________ FOR _______________
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Daily Case fixed Date Number Number Were all Number Explanation What Next REMAR
Serial for this day of of of witnesses of of the case proceedin date of KS
No (including first witnesses witnesses served ? witnesses was not gs were hearing
fresh cases) hearing summone attended If not, examined taken up taken of cases
with names of d give or if all the on this
of accused, case, reasons witnesses day?
offence for non- were not
F.I.R. No. service examined
and name of of or if, in
Police summons fresh
Station cases,
witnesses
were not
present
with the
chalan
800 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

Note 1. - Each case shall be dealt with separately, and when a fresh date for hearing is fixed, the
Prosecuting Officer shall immediately enter up the case under the new date and give a ref-
erence to the place in the diary when the case last came up for hearing.
Note 2. - Entries in column 8 must be confined to facts, and care must be taken to avoid any criti-
cism of a Magistrate.
FORM No. 27.15(VI) - Concluded
DETAILS OF CASES PENDING IN EACH COURT
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
PENDING RECEIVED RECEIVED BY CONVICTED DISCHARGED
FROM LAST DURING WEEK TRANSFER OR
WEEK FROM COURTS ACQUITTED
Serial Court Cases Persons Cases Persons Cases Persons Cases Persons Cases Persons
No.

8 9 10 11 12 13
TRANSFER PENDING AT PENDING PENDING OVER PENDING OVER REMARKS
TO COURT CLOSE OF OVER ONE 3 MONTHS 6 MONTHS
WEEK MONTH
Cases Persons Cases Persons Cases Persons Cases Persons Cases Persons
Prosecution and Court Duties. 801
802 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

FORM No. 27.15(VIII)


REGISTER OF JUDICIAL EXPENSES BILLS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Serial No. Date of Name of Diet of Fare of Diet of Fare of Carriage Carriage
receipt of Police witness witness accused accused expenses dead body
bill Station of property
submitting
bill and
other
particulars

10
Feeding Miscellaneous Total Authority Date of Date of Signature of REMARKS
charges of re- sanctioning handing over payment by the payee and
covered cat- the bill the bills of the the Nazir date
tle Nazir for
payment

FORM No. 27.16(1)


VERNACULAR REGISTER OF PROPERTY SENT IN CASES AND OF UN-
CLAIMED PROPERTY
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
Serial Referenc Name Name Name Offence Date Detail Detail How Date of REMARK
No e to of of of of of of disposed disposal S
First Police complai accused receipt property unclaimedof
Informat Station nant or or in cases property
ion from suppose suspecte
Report where d d
or to received owner person
case
diary or
report
Prosecution and Court Duties. 803

FORM No. 27.16(3)


JAILOR’S RECEIPT FOR ALL PRISONERS DELIVERED INTO JAIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial No. Name, Authority Name and Property, etc., Signature of Jailor, REMARKS
parentage and under which signature or sent with with date
residence of sent to Jail seal of officer- prisoner
prisoner in-charge

Note. - This register should be prepared by hand in vernacular in foolscap size and the headings
written and pasted on lengthwise.

FORM No. 27.16(3)(A),


POLICE DEPARTMENT _________DISTRICT
REGISTER OF INGRESS AND EGRESS OF UNDER-TRIALS IN THE JUDI-
CIAL LOCK-UP
INGRESS OF PRISONERS
No. Date Name and Name of the Place Initials of the REMARKS
parentage of officer wherefrom officer incharge of
the prisoner bringing the brought in the lock-up
brought into prisoner receiving the
the lock-up prisoner

EGRESS OF PRISONERS
Serial No. Date Name and Place where Name of the Initials or thumb REMARKS
parentage of sent officer mark of the officer
the prisoner incharge of taking over charge
taken out of the escorting of the prisoner
the lock- out party
804 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

FORM No. 27.16(4)


VERNACULAR REGISTER OF WARRANTS OF ARREST AND SEARCH AND
OF SUMMONSES RECEIVED FOR EXECUTION AND SERVICE BY THE PO-
LICE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
STEPS TAKEN BY THE POLICE
TO CARRY OUT
No. Name, For Warrant By Date of Date of Date of Date of Date of Date REMAR
caste, what or whom process hearing receipt endorseme execution of KS
occupatio offence summons issued of case of nt and of return
n and issued and for process despatch process to
residence what by the and name Court
of purpose Police of Police
person Departm Officer to
on ent whom
whom endorsed
the
process
is to be
served

FORM No. 27.16(5)


VERNACULAR REGISTER OF INTERMEDIATE ORDERS IN CASES
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
No. Complainant Accused Criminal Offence with Intermediate Final order REMARKS
Court No. and date of order
First Information
Report and name
of Police Station

FORM No. 27.16(6)


VERNACULAR REGISTER OF PERSONS ON SECURITY TO BE OF GOOD
BEHAVIOUR, THE NAMES OF SURETIES, ETC.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial No. Name, Residence Amount of Names, Residence Name of Court which
father’s name security and of father’s names of sureties passed the order to find
and caste of personal and caste of security, name of
person recognizance sureties presiding officer,
required to powers of the court,
find security district in which order
was passed and date of
order
Prosecution and Court Duties. 805

8 9 10 11
IMPRISONMENT IN DE- DATE OF EXPIRY OF Reference to First Reference to papers
FAULT OF SECURITY, PERIOD OF SECURITY Information Report or appertaining to
----------------------------------- papers in any case in which proceedings taken to
Date and month of a person on security was obtain forfeiture of
(a) Date (b) Date of 19 convicted and bond became security and result of
of going release 19 liable to forfeiture such proceedings.
to prison 19
19

FORM No. 27.24(2)


ORDER
Summons from the Court of the ........for the production at .........of the office files relat-
ing to the....................................
(a) I direct..............................to appear with the files mentioned in the summons a
brief description of which is given below and to claim privilege for them under
section 123 of the Evidence Act.
(b) Having examined the documents mentioned in the summons, I withhold permis-
sion to give any evidence derived from the files for which privilege is claimed
under this order.
It should be represented to the Court that these files contain unpublished official re-
cords relating to affairs of State for the purpose of section 123 and that, in view
of the provisions of section 162 of the Evidence Act, the files are not open to the
inspection of the Court :-
Dated________________________the ______________Inspector-General of Police
*Here insert a brief description of the nature of the documents summoned together with
the reasons for claiming privilege for example, this document is a report of C.I.D. Officer
making a secret inquiry into a case of fraud and it is undesirable in the interest of the in-
quiry that its contents should be disclosed.

FORM No. 27.32(1)


RECEIPT AND DESPATCH REGISTER OF CHARGE-SHEET SLIPS AND CON-
VICTIONS SLIPS REFERRING TO CASES INCLUDED UNDER RULE 27.29
1 2 3 4 5 6
Annual serial No. of Date of Name of police station, DISPOSAL OF CHARGE- Name,
charge-sheet slips or receipt with offence with section SHEET SLIPS parentage
conviction slips re- name of the and No. of First Date of Date of return from and caste
ceived from other dis- district Information Report despatch to the police station of the
tricts or from magis- police sending up the convict
trates station accused for trial
sending up
the accused
for trial
806 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
RESIDENCE DISPOSAL OF Number of Date of return of REMARKS
CONVICTION SLIPS entry in conviction slip to
Village Police District Date of Date of register No. district from which
Station despatch to return IX of the received. (The
the district from the police column will only be
or police district or station in filled in where
station in police which the conviction slips are
which the station in conviction received from other
convict which is entered districts)
resides the
convict
resides

FORM No. 27.16(7)


VERNACULAR REGISTER OF EXCISE CASES OCCURRING DURING THE
YEAR 19 . IN WHICH POLICE OFFICERS HAVE BEEN DIRECTLY CON-
CERNED
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Serial Name Date of Description of Nature of action Name and Final Amount REMARK
No. of report offence taken by the rank of result of of reward, S
Police committed with Police (e.g., officer by the case if any
Station section of Excise accused arrested, whom sanctioned
or Opium Act illicit spirits action for the
and No. and date detained, report referred to police in
of First made to Excise in column the case
Information Officer or as the 5 was
Report, if any ase may be) taken
Prosecution and Court Duties. 807

FORM No. 27.18(1)


REGISTER OF ISSUE FROM AND RETURNED TO THE PROSECUTING IN-
SPECTOR’S MALKHANA OF CASE PROPERTY DAILY PRODUCED IN
COURTS AND PENDING CASES. - VIDE POLICE RULE 27.18
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Serial Serial No. of Signature of Initials of the Signature of the Initials of the REMARKS
No. and property register the Court prosecuting head constable, prosecuting
date of is- (form No. orderly to Officer in incharge, officer in
sue 27.16(1) on whom whose Malkhana, who whose
which the property presence the receives back the presence the
property issued, is issued property was property, with property was
entered) issued date of receipt, returned to the
Malkhana

FORM No. 27.33(1)


POLICE DEPARTMENT _____________DISTRICT
CONVICTION SLIP OF A PERSON CONVICTED IN ABOVE DISTRICT WHO
IS SUPPOSED TO RESIDE IN THE POLICE STATION OF ______ DISTRICT___
Serial No. of charge-sheet slip despatch register.
1. F.I.R. Report No. __________ of Police Station__________________________
2. Name.___________________, son of _____________, alias ________________
3. Caste_______________________________________
4. Occupation __________________________________
5. Description _____________ Age _________ Height_________ particulars marks as
shown in charge-sheet.
6. Resident of village ________ Police Station_________ District_______
7. Brief account of offence with section and of law under which conviction was obtained
and place of offence.
8. Sentence -
(i) Date of sentence ..
(ii) Court of ..
(iii) Name of presiding Officer ..
(iv) District in which trial was held ..
(v) Was case tried summarily or otherwise ?
9. District Serial No. P.R. Slip with descriptive roll as shown therein
10. Remarks
You are requested to return this statement in the event of its being discovered that the
convicted person does not commonly reside in your police station or district.
808 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 27

Dated_________
The________196 . Superintendent of Police
Date of entry in the conviction register of the police station, with the signature of Clerk,
Head Constable and the Serial No. of the entry___________________________

FORM No. 27.36


General Register No. 1
POLICE DEPARTMENT _________.DISTRICT
COGNIZABLE CASES REPORTED AT A POLICE STATION FOR THE YEAR
19 .
1 2 3 4 5 6

Annual Serial No. Police Station No. Date and case of Section of Indian COMPLAINANT
of cases reported and date of First occurrence Penal Code or law
Information Report offended against
Name and Residence
parentage

7 8 9 10 11

ACCUSED

Name Parentage Caste and occupation Residence Age

12 13 14 15 16 17 18

CASES

True Cases

In which investi- Number of Number of Ending in Ending in Not Total of true


gation was re- cases proved cases in which conviction discharge detected cases
fused as false by the a mistake of or acquittal or (columns)
Magistrate or law or fact apprehende 12+15+16+17)
declared false occurred or d (cases
declared non- in column
cognizable by 12 will
a Magistrate not be
shown)
Prosecution and Court Duties. 809

19 20 21 22 23 24 25

PERSONS

Persons in cus- Arrested by Persons Persons Number Number Persons who


tody or on bail the Police released under sent for convicted acquitted had not been
under section during the year section 169, trial or arrested at end
170, Criminal Criminal discharged of year (only
Procedure code, Procedure persons for
at beginning of Code whom
the year warrants have
been issued
during the
year will be
included)

26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33

Reference Remarks
PROPERTY to the
entries in
Amount of property stolen Amount of property recovered Register of
Rupees Annas Pies Rupees Annas Pies Cognizable
Offences
810 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

CHAPTER 28

Railway Police and other Special Rules


Rule 28.1

28.1. Organisation. - The General Railway Police district administered by the Inspec-
tor-General of Police, Punjab, comprises the railway systems within the boundaries of the
jurisdiction of the Punjab Government. It is under the direct supervision of the Assistant
Inspector-General, Government Railway Police, who is invested with the same depart-
mental powers within his jurisdiction as a Deputy Inspector-General of a Range.
The Government Railway Police force is organized to meet the special requirements of
crime and the maintenance of law and order on the railway systems. The Assistant In-
spector-General exercises administrative control over the whole force and is in direct
executive control of the Central Investigating Agency. Under the control of the Assistant
Inspector-General an Assistant Superintendent of Police is in executive charge of interior
economy, of the Reserve, and of the staff inspectors, sergeants and lower subordinates
who are specially allocated to the protection of passengers and the maintenance of order
at railway stations. For the prevention and detection of crime and general police duties
the Government Railway Police jurisdiction is divided into such number of sub-divisions
as may be from time to time, authorized, in the executive charge of Deputy Superinten-
dents of Police. Sub-divisions are further divided into railway police station areas for the
purpose of the registration of crime, the upkeep of records and the distribution of the
force. For the investigation of crime, however, every sub-inspector of railway police has
the power of an officer in charge of a police station (vide Rule 1.12).
Rule 28.2

28.2. Jurisdiction. - The jurisdiction of the railway police is confined to "Railway


Limits," i.e., all ground and buildings within the railway boundary fencing or boundary
marks :-
Provided that all offences committed in or in close proximity to dwelling houses or
barracks of railway servants shall be taken cognizance of and investigated by
the district police. This proviso, however, does not extend to stations situated
in Indian States where the railway police take cognizance of such offences.
Rule 28.3

28.3. Central Investigating Agency. - The duties of the Central Investigating Agency
are :-
(1) to investigate serious or complicated cases or special outbreaks of crime;
(2) to maintain records for the classification and prevention of crime and for the con-
trol of fluctuations;
(3) to provide plain clothes detective staff;
(4) to provide armed train guards in special circumstances;
(5) to furnish seal checking posts at provincial boundaries and elsewhere as required,
for the purpose of localising investigations.
Rule 28.4

28.4. Recruitment and Training. - The Government Railway Police force recruits and
trains its own men and shares with the district police the facilities afforded by the Provin-
cial Training School.
Railway police constables may be attached to district police stations with the permission
of the Superintendent of district, for the purpose of acquiring knowledge of local bad
characters and suspects. They shall, while so attached, be under the orders and control of
the officer in charge of the police station for purposes of discipline and instruction.
Railway Police and other Special Rules 811
Rule 28.5

28.5. Duties and powers. - Gazetted officers, inspectors and officers in charge of rail-
way police stations and their subordinates, shall be governed and guided by the orders
defining the duties, responsibilities and powers of such officers contained in these rules,
the Code of Criminal Procedure, Railways Act and Police Act and other laws.
Rule 28.6

28.6. Special rules regarding investigations of railway accidents. - The following


rules regarding the investigation of railway accidents have special reference to the railway
police :-
(i) The railway police may make an investigation into the causes which led to any
accident occurring in the course of working of a railway, and shall do so -
(a) Whenever any such accident is attended with loss of human life or with
grievous hurt as defined in the Indian Penal Code, or with serious injury to
property, or has prima facie been due to any criminal act or omission;
(b) Whenever the District Magistrate, or other Magistrate appointed in this
behalf by the Provincial Government, directs an investigation to be held :
Provided that no such investigation shall be made when a magisterial enquiry has
been commenced or ordered.
(ii) Whenever an investigation is made under clause (a) or (b) of sub-rule preceding,
it shall be supervised by an officer not below the rank of an inspector. A police
officer attending a joint officer’s enquiry must be gazetted officer. The rules re-
garding notices of accidents, and enquiries by Government inspectors into rail-
way accidents issued by Government of India by notification in the Department
of Commerce and Industry, No. 801, dated the 24th March, 1905, and in pursu-
ance of section 84, Indian Railways Act, 1890, will be found in Appendix 28.6.
(iii) Except, when there is reason to suspect that a railway accident has been caused
by the commission of cognizable offence which the police officer in question
has jurisdiction to investigate, a police officer investigating a railway accident
has no power to compel the attendance of witnesses or to make arrests.
(iv) Whenever an investigation into a railway accident is started by the railway po-
lice, they shall give immediate information to, and, if necessary, enlist the co-
operation of, the local district police.
The railway police, and, in the absence of railway police, the district police, are required
to report immediately to the nearest station master, or responsible railway official, every
accident which may come to their notice, occurring in the course of working a railway,
in which serious injury to person or property has been caused or an offence appears to
have been committed.
An English and vernacular copy of that part of the rules, dealing with the duties of the
police in connection with railway accidents, shall be hung up in every railway police sta-
tion and post and the orders therein shall be complied with.
Rule 28.6-A

28.6-A. Arrest of railway servants. - When the arrest of a railway servant is to be ef-
fected, a request shall ordinarily be forwarded to the railway authorities concerned for the
relief from duty of the person so arrested. If the immediate removal of the railway servant
from duty would be likely to endanger the safety of the travelling public, or be a serious
inconvenience to the railway, the arrest shall ordinarily be deferred until the relief is ef-
fected; but the railway servant may be arrested and allowed to continue his duty under
guard if it is advisable to place him under immediate restraint.
Rule 28.7

28.7. Special duty of the railway police. - (1) The following particular duties, among
others, devolve upon the railway police :-
(a) To protect travellers from injury to person or property.
812 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

(b) To maintain law and order at railway stations and in trains.


(c) To attend the arrival and departure of passenger trains at stations and to render
all possible assistance to passengers and railway officers.
(d) To bring to the notice of the proper authorities all offences under the Railways
Act and breaches of bye-laws, and all cases of fraud, or oppression, on the part
of railway subordinates.
(e) To keep platforms clear of idlers and beggars and to keep a look-out for suspi-
cious persons, smugglers and persons travelling with arms without a licence.
(f) To search all empty carriages for property left behind by passengers.
(g) To control the hackney carriages plying for hire at railway stations and to en-
force the regulations of the railway authorities with regard to them.
(2) It is not the business of the railway police to undertake the watch and ward of rail-
way property or of property consigned to the railway for transportation. For these duties
a special force of watchmen is employed and administered by the railway authorities.
The railway police shall not be required to intervene in cases of shortage or of missing
goods or to examine or check the seals of goods waggons, unless they have reason to sus-
pect the commission of cognizable offences. The provision of guards on goods trains is
not one of normal duties of the police and should only be undertaken, if there is definite
reason to anticipate the commission of offences.
(3) When, however, offences are specially prevalent in any particular locality, the rail-
way police are authorized to take special measures, including the posting of police to
goods yards, special seal-checking operations and the investigation of shortages, with the
object of detecting such offences and apprehending the offenders. Such measures are
aimed solely at the control of crime and in no way affect the duties and responsibilities
of railway officials in respect of the protection of railway property and private property
entrusted to the railway for transport.
Rule 28.8

28.8. Relations with the railway authorities. - In regard to important matters con-
nected with the railway police administration, and with the protective duties of the police
and the preservation of order, the views of the Agent or other superior railway officers
concerned shall be ascertained and considered.
Rule 28.9

28.9. Relations with the district police. - The district and railway police are branches
of the same force and are required to co-operate and assist each other upon every occasion
and in every way possible. An opportunity of attending inter-district Police Conferences
shall invariably be given to sub- divisional officers of railway police concerned, and the
Assistant Inspector- General. Railway Police shall be similarly given the opportunity of
attending Conferences regarding criminal administration held by range Deputy Inspec-
tors-General.
Rule 28.10

28.10. Co-operation between railway and district police. - The rules which follow
have been framed to assist co-operation between railway and district police in particular
matters :-
(i) The Assistant Inspector-General of Railway Police shall keep in close touch with
the Superintendents of district police through whose jurisdiction railways run,
and should meet them periodically in order to arrange for satisfactory co-opera-
tion and harmonious working between their respective subordinates. The As-
sistant Inspector-General of Railway Police should also keep in touch with
District Magistrates and see that the railway police show proper deference to the
district authorities.
(ii) District Magistrates should, from time to time, examine the registers of railway
Railway Police and other Special Rules 813

police stations within their districts and record remarks on such examinations in
the Minute Book of the station. Officers in charge of police stations shall send
copies of such remarks through their sub-divisional officers to the Assistant In-
spector-General who will see that proper action is taken.
(iii) Superintendents of district police shall frequently visit railway police stations
situated in their districts and satisfy themselves that the orders in connection
with the deputation of district policemen to railway stations and co-operation
between railway and district police are being properly carried out. They should
enter in the Station Minute Book remarks and suggestions in connection with
these matters.
(iv) All serious crime, including offences of which special reports have, under the
police rules to be submitted by district police stations, shall be specially reported
at once by the railway police to the Superintendent of district police concerned
and to the District Magistrate. The use of the telegraph or telephone for these
reports is advisable in cases in which delay would otherwise ensue.
(v) Case diaries of the railway police shall be submitted by the railway police officer
making the investigation to the sub-divisional officer or Assistant Inspector-
General of Railway Police, for scrutiny and orders. A copy shall also be sent to
the Superintendent of Police of the district within those boundaries the case is
registered to enable him to prosecute when necessary; to be available should be
magistrate empowered to take cognizance of the offence call for it; and in order
that railway cases may be properly placed before the criminal courts.
(vi) There are many cases which, although initially and correctly registered in rail-
way police stations, could equally lawfully and more successfully be dealt with
by the district police. Cases of murder reported to have occurred within railway
jurisdiction fall into this category, if they arise out of district feuds and quarrels
or have been committed outside railway limits, the railway line being merely
used by the murderers with a view to creating the impression that death has been
accidental. Dacoities, robberies and train wrecking, and similar offences, can
often be better dealt with by the district police. It is important, therefore, that
Superintendents of Police should scrutinize First Information Reports received
from railway police stations, and transfer from the railway police jurisdiction,
to the district police stations, cases in which such transfer is desirable.
(vii) Superintendents of district police shall give the railway police all assistance
which they may require in following cases beyond railway limits. The presen-
tation in court and prosecution of railway police cases shall be undertaken by the
prosecuting staff of the district concerned with the same degree of energy and
supervision as is enjoined upon them in respect of cases registered by the district
police. Whenever possible the railway police will provide a special prosecuting
officer for important cases and cases which involve railway technicalities, but
such action shall not relieve the district police of responsibility for taking all
steps in their power to assist the prosecution.
(viii) Any defects or irregularities noticed in charge-sheets, and other papers re-
ceived from the railway police, shall be pointed out by the Superintendent of the
district police to the subordinate railway police direct, but no strictures on the
railway police shall be passed on such papers. When, in the opinion of the Su-
perintendent of district police, the conduct of the railway police merits reproof
he shall address the Assistant Inspector-General of Railway Police on the sub-
ject.
(ix) If cases which should be, or have been, registered by the railway police are
traced by the district police acting independently, information shall immedi-
ately be given to the railway police station concerned.
(x) When the Assistant Inspector General of Railway Police sends a case for orders
814 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

through a Superintendent of the district police to a magistrate empowered to


take cognizance of it, or to a District Magistrate, the Superintendent of Police
shall transmit it; he may not return it to the railway police with his own orders,
unless and until he has obtained the orders of the magistrate concerned.
(xi) When cognizable offences are committed in the vicinity of the railway, but such
offences are not required to be investigated by the railway police under these
rules, they shall to the utmost of their ability and without neglecting their more
immediate duties, use every endeavour to arrest the offender and to assist the
district police.
(xii) Whenever cognizable crime on the railway is specially prevalent in a particular
locality, the Assistant Inspector-General of Railway Police may call on the Su-
perintendent of Police concerned to co-operate with him in checking it. In such
circumstances the Superintendent of Police concerned shall make such disposi-
tions as, after a study of the situation, may be agreed upon by himself and the
Assistant Inspector-General Railway Police, to be most suitable. If the section
of line affected extends beyond the limits of one district, concerted preventive
measures shall be instituted after a conference of police officers representing all
the areas concerned.
(xiii) One or more literate railway police officers of or above the rank of constable
shall accompany each passenger train. These officers shall wear uniform
throughout their period of duty. They shall maintain a "Train Diary" in which
will be recorded information connected with cognizable offences, movements
of bad characters and suspects and such other matters as may be prescribed.
District police stations shall, as far as possible, depute one or more constables
in plain clothes to railway stations within the area of their jurisdiction to watch
for the arrival or departure by the railway of known criminals or suspicious
characters. Such constables shall exchange information with the railway police
officers travelling in passenger trains. Information received by this means shall
be communicated at the earliest opportunity by the constables concerned to their
officers in charge of police stations. If the travelling railway police officer is
unable to find the district plain clothes constable during the halt of his train, he
shall either make over a written message to the station master and request him
to have it delivered or in cases of urgency, he may himself alight and take the
message to the district police station.
(xiv) Doubtful cases and disputes as to jurisdiction in the case of railway police sta-
tions are governed by rule 25.5. The police station receiving a report of a cog-
nizable offence shall record it, according to those rules. Delay in registration
and investigation pending the settlement of jurisdiction is expressly forbidden.
Rule 28.11

28.11. Special training of Railway Police. - The railway police shall be trained in ac-
cordance with the principles and methods laid down in Chapter XIX. The application of
these principles shall have special reference to the requirements of railway police work.
Upper subordinates and educated lower subordinates shall be passed in rotation through
courses of instruction in the Central Investigating Agency. In the Headquarters lines
school special instruction shall be given in the elements of booking and checking goods
and the principles of train working, and in the methods of criminals who habitually op-
erate on railways.

Rule 28.12

28.12. Special arrangement for heavy passenger traffic. - On the occasion of fairs
and other assemblies creating unusually heavy traffic on a railway, the railway police
shall under the instructions and with the approval of the railway authorities, arrange to ad-
mit to the railway station for each train only so many passengers as can be accommodated.
Railway Police and other Special Rules 815

TOWN AND CANTONMENT POLICE SPECIAL RULES


Rule 28.13

28.13. Fixing beats system. - (1) In each town and cantonment for which a watch and
ward staff is sanctioned, detailed statements shall be prepared of all day and night beats,
patrols and traffic points to be furnished by the strength as calculated according to sub-
rule (2) below. To illustrate each statement, a map shall be prepared to a suitable scale
showing the boundaries of each beat, patrol area, & c., and the principal roads, lanes and
important buildings included therein. Beats etc., shall be grouped according to the police
station or post furnishing them, and within each group each beat, etc., shall be given a se-
rial number. The strength of each beat and patrol shall be fixed according to the
conditions of the locality.
(2) The length and size of each beat, etc., shall be regulated by the locality, the status
and character of the residents, incidence of crime and other local conditions. In thickly
populated areas of narrow lanes and intersecting roads, both beats and patrol areas shall
be sufficiently small to permit of no part being left unobserved long enough for a burglar
to effect an entry, collect his spoils and make good his escape. In residential and commer-
cial areas, where buildings are comparatively widely separated and roads are long and
broad the organization of police supervision should be such that, while all parts of a beat
and patrol area cannot be under constant observation, the moment at which any particular
spot within that area may be watched shall be uncertain. With this object in view both
beat constables and supervising patrols in such areas shall be provided with bicycles, as
far as funds permit. For such purposes bicycles shall be used (a) to convey the beat staff
rapidly and silently from one part of their area to another, being then deposited in some
convenient place while the police patrol on foot in a particular neighbourhood (b) for the
pursuit of criminals or suspicious persons.
(3) Patrols are of two kinds, (a) patrols under head constables or superior officers for
the supervision of beats, (b) patrols outside the area of fixed beats for the protection of
special buildings or areas or for the interception of criminals and suspicious persons com-
ing to or from the town or cantonment.
Rule 28.14

28.14. Division of town police. - When necessary, the town or cantonment shall be di-
vided into divisions distinguished by a letter of the alphabet each division being in charge
of a divisional officer of, or above, the rank of head constable, whose responsibilities and
duties shall be explicitly stated in the standing orders. Each divisional officer shall, if
possible, visit every beat in his division at least once during the day and night.
Rule 28.15

28.15. Sections of divisions. - The point and beat staff of a division shall be sub-di-
vided into sections when necessary, each section being in charge of a section officer of the
rank of head constable whose duties and responsibilities shall likewise be explicitly
stated.
Rule 28.16

28.16. Hours of duty of constables. - (1) The hours of night and day beat duty shall
be exactly stated and adapted to the seasons of the year.
(2) Day duties and beats shall be reduced as far as possible, after provision has been
made for general protection, the regulation of traffic and the prevention of nuisances.
(3) Except in cases of emergency, no policemen shall be employed continuously on
point or beat duty for more than 5 hours or more than 8 in 24 hours, and shall be given at
least one complete night off duty in each week.
Rule 28.17

28.17. The beat book. - A beat book shall be prepared for each town and cantonment
in which shall be recorded the dimensions of each night and day beat with the names of
816 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

the principles streets and lanes within its limits. Public buildings of importance series,
lodging-houses of ill-fame, liquor and drug shops, and all places needing special attention
situated within the beat, shall be shown in the beat book, and beat constables shall be spe-
cially instructed regarding their responsibility in connection with them.
Rule 28.18

28.18. Fixed traffic points, beats and patrols. - (1) Fixed points for the control of
traffic shall be placed only at those crossroads and other places where traffic streams con-
verge or cross in such volume as to make constant regulation necessary. For the
enforcement of traffic rules on roads where traffic is not in such volume as to constitute
a steady stream either or both of the following two methods shall be employed :-
(a) Traffic beats. - These beats shall normally consist of two constables, working
within sight and signalling distance of each other, but sufficiently far apart for
one constable to move out into the centre of the road and stop a vehicle, which
the other constable has signalled to him to intercept.
(b) Patrols. - Sergeants, head constables or constables, shall be employed to watch
from the footpath or side of the road at particular points, or along particular
stretches of road, with a view to checking contraventions of the rules framed by
Government under the Motor Vehicles Act, and all other traffic rules, local or
general. Police Officers so employed shall ordinarily content themselves, in the
case of motor vehicles, with noting the number of an offending vehicle. They
shall endeavour to stop and take particulars of offending vehicles other than mo-
tor vehicles and, if circumstances permit their stepping into the middle of the
road sufficiently far ahead of a motor vehicle to give the driver thereof a clear
signal to stop, they may do so, but, in no circumstances shall any attempt be
made to direct traffic by means of signals given from the side of the road. Notes
taken by patrols working under this rule shall be reported on return to the police
station concerned, and subsequent action for the issue of formal warnings or for
prosecution shall be taken under the orders of the Superintendent of Police.
Traffic points, beats and patrols shall be closely supervised by head constables
and, where available, sergeants mounted on cycles.
(2) On occasions such as fairs, public ceremonies, race-meetings and the like, when
traffic is heavily congested on particular roads for a limited period, special police arrange-
ments shall be made in accordance with the circumstances of each case, lines of
constables being posted if necessary to direct different classes of traffic into different
streams or along particular routes. On such occasions full use shall be made of special di-
rection posts; notices in the Press and other methods of informing the public of the
regulations to be observed.
(3) All police officers on beat or patrol duty shall act according to the principles pre-
scribed for traffic patrols in sub-rule (1) above in connection with contraventions of traffic
regulations occurring within their view.
(4) Vehicles shall not be stopped for interrogation at cross roads or in a manner liable
to interfere with the free flow of other traffic. When it is necessary to examine licences,
and make enquiries the driver concerned shall be directed to move his vehicle to a position
indicated by the police officer, where other traffic will not be impeded. Checking of per-
mits and tokens, registration numbers, correctness of lighting equipment, etc., can be
done to a great extent when vehicles are standing in parks.
(5) In exercise of the powers conferred on them by section 31 of the Police Act, police
officers on traffic duty shall require pedestrians to keep to the footpaths, or, where such
do not exist, to the side of the road and shall prevent them from causing obstruction and
danger to other classes of traffic.
(6) Police officers on traffic duty are required to have a thorough knowledge of the
neighbourhood and to be able to direct enquirers by the appropriate route to any area in
Railway Police and other Special Rules 817

that neighbourhood, or to important points such as railway stations, post offices and other
principal public buildings. Police Officers on such duty must on no account whatever al-
low themselves to be provoked into losing control of their tempers, or into the use of
discourteous language. They must remain firm but polite at all times, and, while answer-
ing reasonable enquiries clearly and concisely, shall abstain from argument of all sorts
and shall be on their guard against being distracted from attention to their duty by becom-
ing involved in conversation.
Rule 28.19

28.19. Parking of vehicles. - (1) The rules framed under the Motor Vehicles Act and
section 31 of the Police Act, supplemented in many cases by local bye-laws provide
power to prevent vehicles of all classes from loitering, standing, or being left unattended
in any public place to the obstruction or inconvenience of the public. To ensure obser-
vance of these regulations, the Superintendent of Police is authorized, with the approval
of the District Magistrate, to require the active assistance of local authorities in providing
stands at suitable places, at which hackney carriages and public motor vehicles may wait
for hirers, and parking spaces for private vehicles in congested business areas and in the
neighbourhood of places of public resort. The regulation of public motor vehicle and
hackney carriage stands is provided for by rules framed under the Motor Vehicles and
Hackney Carriage Acts.
(2) Arrangements for parking private motor vehicles must be accommodated to the cir-
cumstances of the place or occasion and the dimensions of, and nature of approaches to,
the available parking space. The following general rules shall, however, be observed :-
(a) Separate parks shall be arranged for motor and horse-drawn vehicles.
(b) In parks for motor vehicles, unattended vehicles shall be parked separately from
those with attendants, and special arrangements shall be made for the former to
be watched to prevent pilferage or wanton damage.
(c) Strict control shall be exercised over entry and departure of vehicles to and from
parks, and sufficient police shall be provided to ensure this and to prevent blocks
and disorder.
(d) Whenever possible, separate arrival and departure routes shall be prescribed for
motor and horse-drawn vehicles, respectively or they shall be kept in separate
streams.
(e) Whenever possible, the entrances and exists of a park shall be separate and,
where congestion is liable to occur owing to arrivals and departures taking place
simultaneously, departing vehicles shall not be allowed to cross those arriving.
(f) For parking at night, at balls, cinema theatres etc., it is advisable to enforce the
duplicate ticket system described in sub-rule (4) below.
(3) For state occasions and important public functions special additional arrangements
are necessary in order to secure the rapid and orderly evacuation of parks. In addition to
the sub-divisions of parks prescribed in sub-rule (2) above, space must be set aside (a) for
the carriages or motor cars of Their Excellencies the Viceroy, the Commander-in-Chief
and the Governor if attending the function, and such other vehicles as are required to ar-
rive and depart with them, (b) for the vehicles of Indian Ruling Chiefs and such staff as
is required to arrive and depart with them. This park must be arranged in the order of de-
parture of the Chiefs, which is invariably the exact reverse of the order of arrival, (c) for
a special park for the vehicles of those high officials to whom, under general or special
orders, "special park" labels have been issued in advance, conferring the privilege of ar-
riving after and leaving before the general public. No vehicle shall be allowed to leave
the general parks, till all vehicles in categories (a), (b) and (c) above have been cleared.
(4) On all occasions of the nature referred to in sub-rule (3) above, parking arrange-
ments shall be carefully worked out well in advance; on occasions of major importance
the arrangements made shall be fully rehearsed. On such occasions it is essential to ar-
818 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

range adequate arrival and departure platforms where a number of vehicles can set down
and take up passengers simultaneously. The practice, which is permissible on informal
occasions, of allowing the public to find their own vehicles in the parks, should not be fol-
lowed, but numbered tickets in duplicate should be issued on arrival to the owners and
drivers of vehicles. The vehicles shall be parked according to these numbers, and called
up by the police officers at the departure platforms as the duplicate number tickets are
handed to them, owners of unattended vehicles being allowed to fetch their vehicles from
the park allotted to them to the departure platform to pick up their passengers.
Rule 28.20

28.20. Supervision of guards, beats and patrols. - (1) Standing orders for beat, point
and patrol duties, and for all guards, shall be framed for each city and cantonment and
shall be approved and countersigned by the Deputy Inspector-General. Such standing or-
ders shall include directions for inter- communication between patrols beats, etc. and for
checking the movement of men those on duties. Permanent changes in the system so ap-
proved shall not be made without the sanction of the Deputy Inspector-General, and
minor changes made shall be submitted to that officer for approval at his inspections.
English and vernacular copies or abstracts of the standing orders shall be supplied to the
police stations, guards and posts concerned, and shall be kept up to date.
(2) Inspectors in charge of cities and cantonments shall go the rounds of guards, beats,
points and patrols at least once by day and once by night in each week; they should vary
the times and routes of their rounds and should make their night rounds as often in the sec-
ond as in the first half of the night. Assistant and Deputy Superintendents shall go the
rounds on the same principle at such intervals as the Superintendent may direct, subject
to the general rule that the city and cantonment at the headquarters of the district shall each
be patrolled by a gazetted officer not less than once by day and once by night in each
month. Cities and cantonments away from the headquarters of the district shall be simi-
larly visited by day and night by the gazetted officer or inspector in charge at such
intervals as the Superintendent may direct. In districts where there are several Assistant
or Deputy Superintendents posted at headquarters, all shall share the duties prescribed in
this rule.
Note. - The rounds prescribed above shall in Lahore include the Government House Guard.
(3) Superintendents shall satisfy themselves that the orders contained in the above rules
are properly complied with and Deputy Inspectors-General shall pay attention to the mat-
ter at their inspections.
Rule 28.21

28.21. Reports of sales of arms and ammunition. - (1) Licensed dealers in arms and
ammunition are required to report sales to the Superintendent of Police. When sales to
residents of other districts are so reported, the information shall be communicated to the
Superintendent of Police of the district concerned if that district is in the Punjab or in any
province other than those specified below.
(2) Reports referred to in sub-rule (1) above shall be communicated, in the case of the
towns of Madras, Bombay, Calcutta and Rangoon to the Commissioner of Police and in
the case of districts in Bengal and Madras to the District Magistrates.
Rule 28.22

28.22. Duties of police in connection with outbreaks of fire. - (1) It is the duty of
every police officer, on discovering or receiving information of an outbreak of fire on or
near his beat or patrol area, to give the alarm immediately (a) to the inmates of the prem-
ises on fire, (b) to the fire brigade, (c) to the nearest police station. Any police officer,
even though not actually on duty as above shall, on becoming aware of an outbreak of fire,
take the same action, if no beat or patrol officer is present and able to do so.
(2) In addition to giving the alarm, it is the duty of the police to save people in danger
at the scene of the fire; to protect the premises and adjoining premises from looting; to ar-
Railway Police and other Special Rules 819

range for property removed from buildings in the neighbourhood of the fire to be placed
under protection in a place where it will not impede the operations of the fire brigade, and
to assist in the removal of such property when asked to do so by the owners; to prevent
access to the burning building and neighbouring buildings by unauthorized persons and
to keep a way clear for the arrival of the fire brigade and space for its operations. The po-
lice are also required, in places where there is a piped water supply, to inform the
municipal or other official in charge of such supply of the locality of the fire, so that pres-
sure may be arranged accordingly, and to keep clear of crowds the way from all
neighbouring fire hydrants to the site of the fire. Where there is no piped water supply,
the police shall, pending the arrival of the fire brigade, take such steps as are possible to
arrange for a supply of water.
Note. - Municipal committees are required to furnish information to Superintendents of Police of
the position of water mains and fire hydrants and of places where the keys of mains are kept
both by day and night.
(3) Pending the arrival of the fire brigade, the police shall do what is possible to extin-
guish the fire and prevent it from spreading. In serious cases the senior police officer
present shall communicate information to the City Magistrate or other magistrate having
jurisdiction and shall arrange, if necessary, for the attendance of a doctor or ambulance.
(4) On arrival of the fire brigade the police shall assist its operations by controlling
crowds, preventing obstruction and protecting salvaged property. After the departure of
the fire brigade, police shall remain on the spot till all danger of recrudescence has passed,
and until all crowds have dispersed.
Rule 28.23

28.23. Fire Brigades. - (1) The duties of fire brigades are laid down in Ministry of
Education notification No. 15291, published in the Punjab Government Gazette of 26th
June, 1925. It is obligatory on all municipal committees, which maintain fire brigades,
to appoint a fire officer to exercise general control of the operations for extinguishing
fires, and no other person is authorised to exercise such control when such officer is pre-
sent. The fire officer will ordinarily be the Superintendent of Police or a senior
magistrate.
(2) Where a trained fire brigade exists, independently of the police, the work of fire
fighting and salvage shall be left entirely to such brigade once it has reached the scene of
fire. In such cases the police are not concerned with the handling or upkeep of fire appli-
ances.
(3) In places where a separate fire brigade does not exist, the care and manipulation of
fire engines and appliances supplied by the municipal committee may be undertaken by
the police, with the prior sanction in each case of the Inspector-General of Police who will
also decide in conformity with the instructions of the local Government, what additional
police establishment, if any, shall be entertained at the cost of the committee. In such
cases the Superintendent of Police shall be responsible for the training and discipline of
the police officers employed on fire brigade duties, and rules for their duties and training
shall be framed, with the approval of the District Magistrate and the municipal committee
concerned, and conforming, as far as possible, to the rules referred to in sub-rule (1)
above.
Rule 28.24

28.24. Fairs. - (1) Relevant extracts from the list of fairs appended to Punjab Consoli-
dated Circulars 41, duly corrected up to date, shall be hung up in the offices of
Superintendents of Police and of the police stations concerned. To supplement the gen-
eral orders contained in this rule a special file shall be maintained in each district
regarding the police arrangements for each fair of importance.
(2) The authority charged with the management of each fair is required to give timely
notice to the Superintendent of Police of the nature and extent of the duties for which po-
820 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

lice will be required; on receipt of this information the Superintendent of Police shall ar-
range to provide the number of police which he considers necessary. District Boards and
other authorities managing fairs are required to pay, from the fees levied from people at-
tending the fair, the extra cost entailed by concentrating police, entertaining extra-
chowkidars, and making suitable arrangements for the accommodation of the police both
on and off duty at the fair, but should not be charged with actual pay and allowances of
the police so employed.
(3) In addition to their normal duties of maintaining law and order, preventing and de-
tecting crime and controlling traffic, the police on duty at fairs are required to enforce the
sanitary regulations prescribed and to assist and support the sanitary and medical staff. In
making their arrangements Superintendent of Police should provide men for this duty.
All deaths occurring in the fair outside the hospital (if any) shall be reported to the medical
officer in charge at the fair and to the Superintendent of Police.
(4) The officer in charge of the local police station or, if of or above the rank of sub-
inspector, the officer in command of the police specially detailed for duty at the fair shall
submit a daily report to the Superintendent, showing the approximate number of persons
attending the fair, the crime reported, state of public health at the fair and any other mat-
ters of interest.
Rule 28.25

28.25. Town watchmen. - In certain municipal towns the police establishment is


wholly, or in part, a body of town watchmen, controlled by the Superintendent subject to
the general supervision of the District Magistrate. The rules regarding their appointment,
promotion, dismissal, powers and duties are given in Appendix 28.25. The directions in
rule 28.20 shall, so far as possible, apply to town watchmen.
Railway Department 821

APPENDIX No. 28.6.


Railway Department
(RAILWAY BOARD)

9 NOTIFICATION
New Delhi, the 19th March, 1930.
No. 1926-T. - In exercise of the powers conferred by the Notification of the Government
of India in the Department of Commerce and Industry No. 801, dated the 24th March,
1905, and in pursuance of Section 84 of the Indian Railways Act, 1890 (IX of 1890), the
Railway Board are pleased, in supersession of the rules published with their notification
No. 120-T.-18, dated the 21st March, 1923 to make the following rules, namely :-
Notices
1. The notices mentioned in section 83 of the Indian Railways Act, 1890 (hereinafter
in these Rules refer-IX of 1890 read to as "the Act") shall contain the following particulars
namely :-
mileage, or station or both, at which the accident occurred;
time and date of the accident;
number and description of the train or trains;
nature of the accident;
number of people killed or injured, as far as known;
cause of the accident, as far as known;
probable detention of traffic.
2. When any accident such as is described in section 83 of the Act occurs in the course
of working a railway, the station-master nearest to the place at which the accident has oc-
curred or, where there is no station-master, the railway servant in charge of the section of
the railway on which the accident has occurred, shall give notice of the accident by tele-
graph to the Government Inspector, the District Magistrate and the District
Superintendent of Police of the district in which the accident has occurred or such other
Magistrate or Police Officer as may be appointed in this behalf by the Local Government,
to the Superintendent of Railway Police and to the officer-in-charge of the police-station
within the local limits of which it has occurred.
Explanation. - For the purposes of this rule accidents of a description usually at-
tended with loss of human life are meant to include all accidents to passenger
trains such, for example, as slight collisions, derailments, train-wrecking or at-
tempted train-wrecking, cases of running over obstructions placed on the line,
of passengers falling out of trains or of fires in trains, in which no loss of life,
or grievous hurt as defined in the Indian Penal Code, or serious injury to prop-
erty has actually occurred, but which by the nature of the accident might reason-
ably have been expected to occur; also cases of landslides, or of breaches by rain
or flood which causes the interruption of any important through line of commu-
nication for at least 24 hours.
3. The notice of accidents required by section 83 of the Act to be sent without unnec-
essary delay by the Railway Administration to the Local Government shall be sent as
follows :-
(a) By telegram in the case of -
(i) accidents deemed under the Explanation to Rule 6 to be serious by reason
of loss of human life;
822 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

(ii) accidents by reason of which the permanent way is likely to be blocked for
more than 12 hours; and
(iii) cases of supposed train-wrecking or attempted train wrecking; and
(b) By letter in all other cases.
Duties of railway servants.
4. Every railway servant shall report, with as little delay as possible, every accident oc-
curring in the course of working the railway on which he is employed which may come
to his notice. Such report shall be made to the nearest Station-master, or, where there is
no Station-master, to the railway servant in charge of the section of the railway on which
the accident has occurred.
5. The Station-master, or the railway servant in charge of the section, shall report the
accident in accordance with the detailed rules laid down by the railway concerned for the
reporting of accidents.
Duties of District Traffic Officers.
6. Whenever a serious accident occurs, the District Traffic Superintendent concerned
shall supply by telegraph to the press soon after the accident as possible brief particulars,
as far as these are available as prescribed in rule 1 supplementary telegrams, if necessary,
being despatched immediately further information is available. A copy shall be sent si-
multaneously by "Express" telegram to the Railway Board and the Government
Inspector. In stating the cause of the accident the District Traffic Superintendent shall
avoid making any statement the correctness of which may subsequently be questioned.
Explanation. - For the purposes of this rule every accident to a train (whether car-
rying passengers or not) which is attended with loss of human life or with griev-
ous hurt as defined in the Indian Penal Code, or with serious injury to property,
which is roughly estimated to cost, say, Rs. 10,000 or over, also every accident,
such as a landslide, breach by rain or flood, derailment, etc., which causes the
interruption of any important through line of communication for at least 24
hours shall be deemed to be a serious accident. For the purposes of this rule
cases of trespassers run over and injured or killed through their own careless-
ness or of passengers injured or killed through their own carelessness shall not
be deemed to be serious accidents.
Duties of the Government Inspector appointed under section 4 sub-section (1) of the In-
dian Railways Act, 1890 (IX of 1890).
7. (1) Whenever the Government Inspector receives notice under section 83 of the Act
of the occurrence of an accident which he considers of a sufficiently serious nature to jus-
tify such a course he shall, as soon as may be, notify the Railway Board and the Agent or
Manager of the railway concerned, of his intention to hold an enquiry and shall at the same
time fix and communicate the date, time and place for the enquiry.
(2) For the purpose of this rule every accident to a train carrying passengers which is
attended with loss of human life or with serious injury to persons, or to property of the
value of approximately Rs. 10,000 or upwards, and any other accidents which, in the
opinion of the Government Inspector, requires the holding of an enquiry, shall be deemed
to be an accident of a sufficiently serious nature to require the holding of an enquiry.
(3) When an accident, requiring the holding of an enquiry occurs at a station where the
charges of two or more Government Inspectors meet, the duty of complying with this rule
shall devolve on the Government Inspector within whose jurisdiction lies the railway
working the station which is the scene of the accident.
(4) If, for any reason, the Government Inspector is unable to hold an enquiry, at an early
date, after the occurrence of such an accident, the Agent or the Manager of the Railway
concerned shall, on request by the Government Inspector, forward to him, with as little
delay as possible, the proceedings of the joint enquiry which has been made under Rule
Railway Department 823

18. The Government Inspector shall advise the Railway Board of the reason why an en-
quiry has not been held by himself. If the Government Inspector, after examination of the
joint enquiry proceedings, considers that an enquiry should be held by himself, he shall,
as soon as possible, notify the Railway Board and the Agent or Manager of the Railway
concerned, of his intention to hold an enquiry and shall at the same time fix and commu-
nicate the date, time and place for the enquiry.
8. Whenever the Government Inspector has made an enquiry under rule 7, or when he
disagrees with, or considers it necessary adversely to criticise the report of the joint or de-
partmental enquiry or the working of the railway, he shall submit a report in writing to the
Railway Board and, in the case of a railway under the control of a Local Government or
Administration, to such Local Government or Administration also; and shall forward a
copy of such report to the Agent or Manager of the railway concerned, and, if a magisterial
enquiry is being made, to the Magistrate who is making such enquiry.
9. (1) In the case of all accidents of the nature described in sub-rule (2) of rule 7, pre-
liminary brief narrative report shall be submitted by the Government Inspector to the
Railway Board immediately after the completion of his enquiry. This report shall not
contain any reference to persons implicated. The report, referred to in rule 8, shall be sub-
mitted in the form adopted by the Inspecting Officers of the Board of Trades and shall
contain -
(a) a brief description of the accident;
(b) a description of the locality of the accident;
(c) a detailed statement of the evidence taken;
(d) the conclusion arrived at;
(e) an appendix stating the damage done;
(f) (when necessary) a sketch illustrative of the accident.
(2) Reports, in connection with accidents which, although coming under Section 83 of
the Act, are not accidents of the nature described in sub-rule (2) of Rule 7, will be submit-
ted to the Railway Board only if, in the opinion of the Government Inspector, they contain
features of special importance or requiring special notice. When the Government Inspec-
tor recommends the publication of such a report, it shall be in the form adopted by the
Inspecting Officers of the Board of Trade when not recommended for publication, it may
be in the form of a letter explaining as briefly as possible, the special features which the
Government Inspector desires to bring to notice.
10. If the Agent or Manager makes any remarks on the Government Inspector’s report
under rules 16 and 17 or expresses an intention to do so, the Government Inspector shall
inform the Railway Board and the Local Government or Administration controlling the
Railway, of the steps which have been or are proposed to be taken by the Railway admini-
stration to prevent a recurrence of similar accidents, and whether in his opinion, further
action in the matter is desirable.
11. The Government Inspector shall, as far as possible, assist any Magistrate making
an enquiry under rule 22 or a judicial enquiry, whenever he may be called upon to do so.
12. Nothing in these rules shall be deemed to limit or otherwise affect the exercise of
any of the powers conferred on Government Inspectors by section 5 of the Act.
Duties of the Agent or Manager and of the Head of the Department concerned.
13. Whenever any accident has occurred in the course of working a Railway, the Agent
or Manager shall give all reasonable aid to the District Magistrate or the Magistrate ap-
pointed or deputed under rule 22, and to the Government Inspector, Medical Officers, the
police, and others concerned to enable them promptly to reach the scene of the accident,
and shall assist those authorities in making enquiries and in obtaining evidence as to the
cause of the accident.
824 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

14. Whenever any accident, occurring in the course of working a railway, has been at-
tended with grievous hurt, as defined in the Indian Penal Code, it shall be the duty of the
Agent or Manager to afford medical aid to the sufferers, and to see that they are properly
and carefully attended to till removed to their home or handed over to the care of their rela-
tives or friends. In any such case, or in any case in which any loss of human life or
grievous hurt, as defined in the Indian Penal Code, has occurred, the nearest local medical
officer should be communicated with, if he is nearer than any railway medical officer.
15. When any enquiry, under rule 7 or rule 22, or any judicial enquiry is being made,
the Agent or Manager shall arrange for the attendance, as long as may be necessary, at the
office or place of enquiry, of all railway servants whose evidence is likely to be required.
If the enquiry is to be held by the Government Inspector under rule 7, the Agent or Man-
ager shall cause notice of the date, hour and place at which the enquiry will begin to be
given to the officers mentioned in clauses (a) and (c) of rule 19. He shall also arrange for
the attendance of the District Officers at the enquiry.
16. Whenever the Agent or Manager receives a copy of the Government Inspector’s re-
port under rule 8 he shall at once acknowledge its receipt. If he differs from the views
expressed in the report, he shall at the same time submit his remarks thereon, or, if he is
not immediately able to do so, he shall, in his acknowledgement of the report, inform the
Government Inspector of his intention to submit his remarks later. If the Agent or Man-
ager desires to prosecute any person or persons, he shall immediately forward a copy of
the report together with a statement of the persons he wishes to prosecute, to the District
Magistrate of the district in which the accident occurred, or to such other officer, as the
Local Government may appoint in this behalf.
17. Whenever the report of the Government Inspector points to the necessity for or sug-
gests a change in any of the rules or in the system of working, the Agent or Manager shall,
when acknowledging the report, intimate the action which has been taken, or which it is
proposed to take, to prevent a recurrence of similar accidents, or shall inform the Govern-
ment Inspector of his intention to report further on the Government Inspector’s proposals.
18. (1) Whenever an accident, such as is described in section 83 of the Act, has oc-
curred in the course of working a Railway, the Agent or Manager shall cause an enquiry
to be promptly made by a committee of Railway Officers (to be called a "joint enquiry")
for the thorough investigation of the causes which led to the accident :
Provided that such enquiry may be dispensed with -
(a) if any enquiry is to be held by the Government Inspector under rule 7;
(b) if the accident has not been attended with loss of human life, or with grievous hurt
as defined in the Indian Penal Code, or with serious injury to property or;
(c) if there is no reasonable doubt as to the cause of the accident; or
(d) if one department of the railway intimates that it accepts all responsibility in the
matter.
(2) Where such enquiry is dispensed with, it shall be the duty of the head of the depart-
ment of the railway responsible for the accident to make such enquiry (to be called a
"departmental enquiry") as he may consider necessary, and if his staff or the system of
working is at fault, to adopt or suggest such measures as he may consider expedient for
preventing a recurrence of similar accidents.
19. (1) Whenever a joint enquiry is to be made, the Agent or Manager shall cause no-
tice of the date and hour, at which the enquiry will commence, to be given to the following
officers, namely :-
(a) the District Magistrate of the district in which the accident occurred, or such other
officer as the Local Government may appoint in this behalf, the Superintendent
of Railway Police and the District Superintendent of Police.
Railway Department 825

(b) the Government Inspector for the section of the railway on which the accident oc-
curred; and
(c) the officer-in-charge of the Railway police, or if there are no Railway police, the
officer-in-charge of the police-station in the jurisdiction of which the accident
occurred.
(2) The date and hour at which the enquiry will commence shall be fixed, so as to give
the officers mentioned in sub-rule (1) sufficient time to reach the place where the enquiry
is to be held.
20. (1) As soon as any joint or departmental enquiry has completed, the President of
the Committee or the head of the department, as the case may be, shall send to the Agent
or Manager a report which in the case of all accidents of the nature described in the ex-
planation to rule 6 must be submitted in the form prescribed by sub-rule (1) of rule 9.
(2) The Agent or Manager shall forward, with his remarks as to the action it is intended
to take in regard to the staff responsible for the accident, or for the revision of the rules
of the system of working, a copy of such report -
(a) to the Government Inspector for the section of the railway on which the accident
occurred;
(b) if no enquiry or investigation has been made under rule 22 or if a joint or depart-
mental enquiry has been held first, to the Magistrate or officer appointed under
Clause (a) of sub-rule (1) of rule 19; and
(c) if any judicial enquiry is being made, to the Magistrate making such enquiry.
(3) Such copy shall be accompanied in the case referred to in clause (b) of sub-rule (2),
by a statement of the persons, if any, whom the Agent or Manager desire to prosecute, and
in the case referred to in clause (c) of the same sub-rule, by a copy of the evidence taken
at the enquiry.
21. A copy of reports of inquiries held on accidents not of the nature specified in section
83 of the Act, such as averted collisions, technical accidents, or breaches of block rules,
shall be forwarded to the Government Inspector for the section of the Railway on which
the accident occurred.
Duties of Magistrates.
22. Whenever an accident, such as is described in Section 83 of the Act, has occurred
in the course of working a Railway the District Magistrate, or any other Magistrate, who
may be appointed in this behalf by the Local Government, may, either -
(a) himself make an enquiry into the causes which led to the accident; or
(b) depute a subordinate Magistrate, who, if possible, should be a Magistrate of the
first class, to make such an enquiry; or
(c) direct an investigation into the causes which led to the accident to be made by the
police.
23. Whenever it is decided to make an enquiry under clause (a) or clause (b) of rule 22,
the District Magistrate or other Magistrate appointed as aforesaid or the Magistrate de-
puted under clause (b) of rule 22, as the case may be, shall proceed to the scene of the
accident and conduct the enquiry there, and shall at once advise the Agent or Manager of
the railway and the Government Inspector by telegraph of the date and hour at which the
enquiry will commence, so as to enable the railway administration to summon the requi-
site expert evidence.
24. A Magistrate, making an enquiry under Rule 22, may summon any railway servant,
and any other person whose presence he may think necessary, and, after taking the evi-
dence and completing the enquiry, shall if he considers there are sufficient grounds for a
judicial enquiry, take the requisite steps for bringing to trial any person whom he may
consider to be criminally liable for the accident. Whenever technical points are involved,
826 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

the Magistrate should call for the opinion of the Government Inspector or other profes-
sional persons.
25. The result of every enquiry or investigation made under rule 22 shall be commu-
nicated by the Magistrate to the Agent or Manager of the Railway and to the Government
Inspector.
26. If, in the course of any judicial enquiry, into an accident occurring in the course of
working a railway, the Magistrate desires the assistance of the Government Inspector or
of the Agent or Manager of the railway, or the attendance of any officer of the railway,
to explain any matter relating to railway supervision, management or working, he will is-
sue a requisition to the Agent or Manager for the attendance at court of an officer
competent to explain such matter, stating at the same time the nature of the assistance re-
quired. In summoning railway servants, the Magistrate will take care not to summon so
large a number of the employees, especially of one class, on the same day, as to cause in-
convenience to the working of the railway. In the case of very serious accidents it will
generally be advisable for the Magistrate to obtain a report, from both the Government In-
spector and the Agent or Manager of the railway, in regard to the accident, before finally
concluding the judicial enquiry.
27. On the conclusion of any such judicial enquiry the Magistrate shall send a copy of
his decision to the Agent or Manager of the Railway, and to the Government Inspector,
and shall, unless in any case he thinks it unnecessary to do so, report the result of the en-
quiry to the Local Government.
Duties of Police Officers.
28. (1) The Railway police may make an investigation into the causes which led to any
accident occurring in the course of working a Railway and shall do so -
(a) Whenever any such accident is attended with loss of human life, or with grievous
hurt as defined in the Indian Penal Code, or with serious injury to property or has
prima facie been due to any criminal act or omission; or
(b) Whenever the District Magistrate or the Magistrate appointed under rule 22 has
given a direction under clause (c) of that rule.
Provided that no such investigation shall be made when an enquiry has been com-
menced or ordered under clause (a) or clause (b) of rule 22.
(2) The Railway police shall report, with little delay as possible, to the nearest Station-
master or, where there is no Station-master, to the Railway servant in charge of the section
of the Railway on which the accident has occurred, every accident which may come to
their notice occurring in the course of working a Railway attended with loss of human life,
or with grievous hurt as defined in the Indian Penal Code, or with serious injury to prop-
erty, or which has prima facie been due to any criminal act or omission.
29. (1) Whenever an investigation is to be made by the Railway police -
(a) in a case in which an accident is attended with loss of human life or with grievous
hurt as defined in the Indian Penal Code, or with serious injury to property; or
(b) in pursuance of direction given under clause (c) of rule 22, the investigation shall
be conducted by the officer-in-charge of the Railway police, or, if that officer
should be unable to conduct the investigation himself, then by an officer to be
deputed by him.
(2) The officer deputed under sub-rule (1) shall ordinarily be the senior officer avail-
able, and shall whenever possible be a gazetted officer, and shall in no case be of rank
lower than that of Inspector :
Provided that the investigation may be carried out by an officer-in- charge of a police
station -
(i) in such a case as is referred to in clause (a) of sub-rule (1) unless loss of life or
Railway Department 827

grievous hurt has been caused to more persons than one or injury to property has
been caused to a value exceeding Rs. 10,000, or there is a reason to suspect that
any servant of the Railway has been guilty of neglect of Rules, or
(ii) in the case referred to clause (b) of sub-rule (1) if the District Magistrate so di-
rects.
30. The officer who is to conduct an investigation in pursuance of rule 29 shall proceed
without delay to the scene of the accident and conduct the investigation there and shall at
once advise the Agent or Manager of the Railway and the Traffic Officer of the district
by telegraph of the date and hour at which the investigation will commence so that, if pos-
sible, the presence of a Railway official may be arranged for to watch the proceedings and
to aid the officer making the investigation. The absence of a railway official must not,
however, be allowed to delay the investigation, which should be made as soon as possible
after the accident has taken place.
31. (1) In every case to which rule 29 applies, immediate information shall be given
by the Railway police to the district police, who, if so required, shall afford all necessary
assistance and shall, if occasion arises, carry the investigation beyond the limits of the
Railway premises. But the Railway police are primarily entrusted with the duty of car-
rying on the investigation within such limits.
(2) Subject to any provisions elsewhere contained in these rules, the further prosecution
of the case, on the conclusion of the police investigation, shall rest with the Railway po-
lice.
32. The result of every police investigation shall be reported at once to the District Mag-
istrate or other officer appointed in this behalf by the Local Government or the Agent or
Manager of the Railway or other officer appointed by him, and to the Government Inspec-
tor.
33. Where there are no Railway police, the duties imposed by rules 28, 29 and 30, sub-
rule (2) of rule 31, and rule 32 on the Railway police, or on the officer-in-charge of the
Railway police, shall be discharged by the District police or by the District Superinten-
dent of Police, as the case may be.
J.F. BLACKWOOD
Secretary, Railway Board.
APPENDIX No. 28.25
Notification No. 96, dated 27th July, 1888
Under the provisions of Section 154(o) of the Punjab Municipal Act, 1884,1 the
Hon’ble the Lieutenant-Governor is pleased to make the following rules for the appoint-
ment, promotion and dismissal of town watchmen in the municipalities specified in the
schedule2 hereto annexed.
The following directions regarding the duties of such town watchmen have also been
framed by the Lieutenant-Governor under the provisions of Section 76(1)(c) of the same
enactment.
The rules and directions will have effect from the date of the publication of this notifi-
cation in the Gazette :-
Rules regarding the appointment, promotion and dismissal of town watchmen.

1. Now Act III of 1911.


2. (Not Printed).
828 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

When the police establishment maintained under Chapter V, Act XIII of 18841, is
wholly or in part a body of watchmen, such watchmen shall be under the orders of the Su-
perintendent of Police, subject to the general control of the District Magistrate.
2. (a) The appointment and promotion of town watchmen shall rest with the Superin-
tendent of Police, and the rules sanctioned by Government for appointment and
promotion of enrolled policemen, as given in the Police Rules, shall be applied so far as
the Magistrate of the district shall deem necessary for the efficiency of the said watchmen.
(b) The Superintendent of Police shall keep up a register in which shall be recorded the
names of all applicants for appointment as town watchman whom the Municipal Commit-
tee by resolution may approve of and nominate, and appointments shall be made from
such candidates if fit for the duty. If not fit, the Superintendent of Police may, after re-
cording his reasons for rejecting such nominees, appoint men selected by himself.
3. (a) The Superintendent of Police may at any time dismiss, suspend, or reduce any
town watchman whom he may think remiss or negligent in the discharge of his duty or un-
fit for the same, or fine any town watchman to any amount not exceeding one month’s pay
who shall discharge his duty in a careless or negligent manner, or who by any act of his
own shall render himself unfit for the discharge thereof.
(b) The municipal committee or the President of the Municipal Committee may by
resolution bring to the notice of the Superintendent of Police through the District Magis-
trate any town watchman who in their opinion has been negligent in his duty or guilty of
misconduct, and the Superintendent of Police shall enquire into the case and report for the
approval of the District Magistrate and for the information of the committee the result of
his enquiry.
4. No town watchman or daffadar shall withdraw from the duties of his office unless-
(1) he has received permission to resign from the Superintendent of Police, or from
some other person authorized by the Superintendent of Police to accept his res-
ignation; or
(2) two months have elapsed since he gave notice of his intention to resign to the Su-
perintendent of Police.
Directions regarding the duties to be performed by town watchmen.
5. (a) It is the duty of every town watchman to keep watch and ward in the town.
(b) A watchman shall be bound to render all assistance in his power in case of confla-
grations within the limits of the municipality.
(c) A watchman shall take charge of any property found unclaimed within the limits of
the municipality, and hand it over to the officer-in-charge of the police station.
6. Every town watchman is bound forthwith to communicate to the officer-in- charge
of the police station within the limits of which his beat is situated any information he may
obtain respecting any person found lurking in such beat who has no ostensible means of
subsistence, or who cannot give a satisfactory account of himself; or respecting the resi-
dence in or resort to, any place within the limits of such beat of any person who is a reputed
house-breaker or thief or who is of notoriously bad livelihood.
7. Every town watchman shall observe and from time to time report to the officer men-
tioned in rule 5, the movements of all bad characters in his beat, and shall report the arrival
of suspicious characters in the neighbourhood.
8. Every town watchman shall give timely intimation to the officer mentioned in rule

1. Now Act III of 1911.


Railway Department 829

6 in the event of any notorious bad character residing in his beat being absent at night
without having given notice of his departure, or associating with individuals of bad re-
pute, or cessing to labour or to obtain a livelihood by honest means.
9. Every town watchman shall keep the officer mentioned in Rule 6 informed of all dis-
putes which are likely to lead to any riot or serious affray, and of all intelligence he
receives affecting the public peace within or near his beat.
10. It shall be the duty of the town watchman to report to the officer-in- charge of the
police station within the limits of which his beat is situated all deaths which occur in such
beat and to furnish such other information in connection with vital statistics as may be re-
quired of him by the Deputy Commissioner from time to time.
11. Every town watchman shall in like manner report the appearance of any epidemic
in his beat, and shall supply, to the best of his ability, any local information which the Dep-
uty Commissioner may require.
12. Every town watchman shall prevent, and may interpose for the purpose of prevent-
ing the commission of any cognizable offence as defined in the Code of Criminal
Procedure.
13. Every town watchman receiving information of the commission of or of a design
to commit, any cognizable offence, shall at once communicate such information to the of-
ficer-in-charge of the police station within the limits of which his beat is situated.
14. Every town watchman knowing of a design to commit any cognizable offence may
arrest, without orders from a Magistrate and without a warrant, the person so designing,
if the commission of the offence cannot be otherwise prevented.
15. Every town watchman may of his own authority interpose for the prevention of any
injury attempted to be committed in his view to any Government, Municipal, or Railway
property, moveable or immoveable, or to prevent the removal or injury of any public land
mark.
16. Every town watchman may, without orders from a Magistrate and without a war-
rant, arrest -
Firstly, any person who has been concerned in any cognizable offence or against
whom a reasonable complaint has been made, or credible information has been
received, or a reasonable suspicion exists, of his having been so concerned;
Secondly, any person having in his possession, without lawful excuse, the burden of
proving which excuse shall lie on such person, any implement of house-break-
ing;
Thirdly, any person who has been proclaimed as an offender either under the Code
of Criminal Procedure or by order of the Local Government;
Fourthly, any person in whose possession anything is found which may reasonably
be suspected to be stolen property, and who may reasonably be suspected of
having committed an offence with reference to such thing.
Fifthly, any person who obstructs a police officer or a town watchman while in the
execution of his duty or who has escaped, or attempts to escape, from lawful
custody;
Sixthly, any person reasonably suspected of being a deserter from Her Majesty’s
Army or Navy; and
Seventhly, any person who in his sight commits any offence under section 34 of Act
V of 1861 within the limits of the town, provided such section has been specially
extended thereto by the Local Government.
17. If a person forcibly resists an endeavour to arrest him every town watchman may
use all means necessary to effect the arrest.
830 Punjab Police Rules, 1934 Volume 3, CHAPTER 28

18. No person arrested by a town watchman shall be subjected to more restraint than
is necessary to prevent his escape.
19. The town watchman shall take charge of all persons arrested under these rules or
by any private person under any law for the time being in force, and shall forthwith take
or send any person or persons, so taken charge of by him, or any person or persons he him-
self may arrest, before the officer-in-charge of the police station within the limits of which
his beat is situated; provided that during the hours of darkness the person or persons ar-
rested may be detained in custody, but must be taken as early as possible on the following
morning to the police station.
20. It shall be the duty of every town watchman promptly to obey and execute all orders
and warrants lawfully issued to him by any competent authority; to collect and commu-
nicate intelligence affecting the public peace; to prevent the commission of offences and
public nuisances; to detect and bring offenders of justice; and to apprehend all persons
whom he is legally authorized to apprehend, and for whose apprehension sufficient
ground exists; and it shall be lawful for every town watchman, for any of the purposes
mentioned in this section without a warrant, to enter and the inspect any drinking shop,
gaming house, or other place of resort of loose and disorderly characters.
21. It shall be the duty of the town watchman to keep order on the public roads and in
the public streets, thoroughfares, ghats, and landing places, and at all other places of pub-
lic resort, and to prevent obstruction on the occasion of assemblies and processions on the
public roads and in the public streets, or in the neighbourhood of places of worship during
the time of public worship and in any case when any road, street, thoroughfare, ghat, or
landing-place, may be thronged or may not liable to be obstructed.
Note. - Under the provisions of section 76(1)(d) of Act XIII of 18841, all town watchmen appointed
under these rules possess the same powers, are entitled to the same assistance, enjoy the same
protection, are subject to the same responsibilities, and are liable to the same penalties as if
they were police officers enrolled under Act V of 1861.

-------------

1. Now Act III of 1911.


Railway Department 831

******

You might also like